Copy configure option documentation to gdb.texinfo
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
550 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
551 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
552 Stafford Horne.
553
554 @node Sample Session
555 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
556
557 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
558 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
559 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
560
561 @iftex
562 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
563 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
564 @end iftex
565
566 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
567 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
568
569 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
570 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
571 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
572 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
573 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
574 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
575 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
576 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
577 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
578
579 @smallexample
580 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
581 $ @b{./m4}
582 @b{define(foo,0000)}
583
584 @b{foo}
585 0000
586 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
587
588 @b{bar}
589 0000
590 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
591
592 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
593 @b{baz}
594 @b{Ctrl-d}
595 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
600
601 @smallexample
602 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
603 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
604 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
605 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
606 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
607 the conditions.
608 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
609 for details.
610
611 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
612 (@value{GDBP})
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
617 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
618 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
619 that examples fit in this manual.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
627 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
628 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
629 @code{break} command.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
633 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
634 @end smallexample
635
636 @noindent
637 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
638 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
639 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
643 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
644 @b{define(foo,0000)}
645
646 @b{foo}
647 0000
648 @end smallexample
649
650 @noindent
651 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
652 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
653 context where it stops.
654
655 @smallexample
656 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
657
658 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
659 at builtin.c:879
660 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
665 the next line of the current function.
666
667 @smallexample
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
669 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
670 : nil,
671 @end smallexample
672
673 @noindent
674 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
675 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
676 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
677 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
678
679 @smallexample
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
681 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
682 at input.c:530
683 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
684 @end smallexample
685
686 @noindent
687 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
688 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
689 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
690 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
691 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
692 stack frame for each active subroutine.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
696 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
697 at input.c:530
698 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
699 at builtin.c:882
700 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
701 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
702 at macro.c:71
703 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
704 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
709 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
710 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
714 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
716 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
717 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
719 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
720 : xstrdup(rq);
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
722 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
727 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
728 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
729 (@code{print}) to see their values.
730
731 @smallexample
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
733 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
735 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
740 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
741 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
742
743 @smallexample
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
745 533 xfree(rquote);
746 534
747 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
748 : xstrdup (lq);
749 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
750 : xstrdup (rq);
751 537
752 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
753 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
754 540 @}
755 541
756 542 void
757 @end smallexample
758
759 @noindent
760 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
761 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
762
763 @smallexample
764 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
765 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
766 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
767 540 @}
768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
769 $3 = 9
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
771 $4 = 7
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
776 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
777 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
778 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
779 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
780 assignments.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
784 $5 = 7
785 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
786 $6 = 9
787 @end smallexample
788
789 @noindent
790 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
791 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
792 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
793 example that caused trouble initially:
794
795 @smallexample
796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
797 Continuing.
798
799 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
800
801 baz
802 0000
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
807 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
808 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
809
810 @smallexample
811 @b{Ctrl-d}
812 Program exited normally.
813 @end smallexample
814
815 @noindent
816 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
817 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
818 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
819
820 @smallexample
821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @node Invocation
825 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
826
827 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
828 The essentials are:
829 @itemize @bullet
830 @item
831 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
832 @item
833 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
834 @end itemize
835
836 @menu
837 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
838 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
839 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
840 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
841 @end menu
842
843 @node Invoking GDB
844 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
845
846 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
847 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
848
849 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
850 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
851
852 The command-line options described here are designed
853 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
854 options may effectively be unavailable.
855
856 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
857 specifying an executable program:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
865 specified:
866
867 @smallexample
868 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
869 @end smallexample
870
871 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
872 to debug a running process:
873
874 @smallexample
875 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
876 @end smallexample
877
878 @noindent
879 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
880 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
881
882 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
883 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
884 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
885 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
886 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
887
888 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
889 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
890 option processing.
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
893 @end smallexample
894 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
895 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
896
897 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
898 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
899 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} --silent
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
907 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
908
909 @noindent
910 Type
911
912 @smallexample
913 @value{GDBP} -help
914 @end smallexample
915
916 @noindent
917 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
918 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
919
920 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
921 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
922 @samp{-x} option is used.
923
924
925 @menu
926 * File Options:: Choosing files
927 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
928 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
929 @end menu
930
931 @node File Options
932 @subsection Choosing Files
933
934 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
935 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
936 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
937 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
938 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
939 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
940 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
941 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
942 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
943 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
944 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
945 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
946 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
947
948 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
949 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
950 argument and ignore it.
951
952 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
953 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
954 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
955 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
956 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
957
958 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
959 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
960 @c it.
961
962 @table @code
963 @item -symbols @var{file}
964 @itemx -s @var{file}
965 @cindex @code{--symbols}
966 @cindex @code{-s}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
968
969 @item -exec @var{file}
970 @itemx -e @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--exec}
972 @cindex @code{-e}
973 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
974 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
975
976 @item -se @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--se}
978 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
979 file.
980
981 @item -core @var{file}
982 @itemx -c @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--core}
984 @cindex @code{-c}
985 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
986
987 @item -pid @var{number}
988 @itemx -p @var{number}
989 @cindex @code{--pid}
990 @cindex @code{-p}
991 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
992
993 @item -command @var{file}
994 @itemx -x @var{file}
995 @cindex @code{--command}
996 @cindex @code{-x}
997 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
998 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
999 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1000
1001 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1002 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1003 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1004 @cindex @code{-ex}
1005 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1006
1007 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1008 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1009
1010 @smallexample
1011 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1012 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1013 @end smallexample
1014
1015 @item -init-command @var{file}
1016 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1017 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1018 @cindex @code{-ix}
1019 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1020 after loading gdbinit files).
1021 @xref{Startup}.
1022
1023 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1024 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1025 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1026 @cindex @code{-iex}
1027 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1028 after loading gdbinit files).
1029 @xref{Startup}.
1030
1031 @item -directory @var{directory}
1032 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1033 @cindex @code{--directory}
1034 @cindex @code{-d}
1035 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1036
1037 @item -r
1038 @itemx -readnow
1039 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1040 @cindex @code{-r}
1041 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1042 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1043 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1044
1045 @item --readnever
1046 @anchor{--readnever}
1047 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1048 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1049 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1050 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1051 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1052 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1053 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1054 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1055 @end table
1056
1057 @node Mode Options
1058 @subsection Choosing Modes
1059
1060 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1061 batch mode or quiet mode.
1062
1063 @table @code
1064 @anchor{-nx}
1065 @item -nx
1066 @itemx -n
1067 @cindex @code{--nx}
1068 @cindex @code{-n}
1069 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1070 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1071
1072 @table @code
1073 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1074 This is the system-wide init file.
1075 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1076 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1077 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1078 have been processed.
1079 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1080 This is the init file in your home directory.
1081 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1082 command options have been processed.
1083 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1084 This is the init file in the current directory.
1085 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1086 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1087 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1088 @end table
1089
1090 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1091 For documentation on how to write command files,
1092 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1093
1094 @anchor{-nh}
1095 @item -nh
1096 @cindex @code{--nh}
1097 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1098 in your home directory.
1099 @xref{Startup}.
1100
1101 @item -quiet
1102 @itemx -silent
1103 @itemx -q
1104 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1105 @cindex @code{--silent}
1106 @cindex @code{-q}
1107 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1108 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1109
1110 @item -batch
1111 @cindex @code{--batch}
1112 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1113 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1114 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1115 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1116 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1117 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1118 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1119
1120 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1121 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1122 make this more useful, the message
1123
1124 @smallexample
1125 Program exited normally.
1126 @end smallexample
1127
1128 @noindent
1129 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1130 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1131 mode.
1132
1133 @item -batch-silent
1134 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1135 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1136 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1137 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1138 for an interactive session.
1139
1140 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1141 messages, for example.
1142
1143 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1144 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1145
1146 @item -return-child-result
1147 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1148 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1149 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1150
1151 @itemize @bullet
1152 @item
1153 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1154 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1155 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1156 @item
1157 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1158 @item
1159 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1160 the exit code will be -1.
1161 @end itemize
1162
1163 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1164 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1165 interface.
1166
1167 @item -nowindows
1168 @itemx -nw
1169 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1170 @cindex @code{-nw}
1171 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1172 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1173 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1174
1175 @item -windows
1176 @itemx -w
1177 @cindex @code{--windows}
1178 @cindex @code{-w}
1179 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1180 used if possible.
1181
1182 @item -cd @var{directory}
1183 @cindex @code{--cd}
1184 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1185 instead of the current directory.
1186
1187 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1188 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1190 @cindex @code{-D}
1191 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1192 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1193 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1194
1195 @item -fullname
1196 @itemx -f
1197 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1198 @cindex @code{-f}
1199 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1200 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1201 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1202 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1203 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1204 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1205 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1206 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1207 frame.
1208
1209 @item -annotate @var{level}
1210 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1211 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1212 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1213 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1214 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1215 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1216 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1217 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1218 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1219
1220 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1221 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1222
1223 @item --args
1224 @cindex @code{--args}
1225 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1226 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1227 This option stops option processing.
1228
1229 @item -baud @var{bps}
1230 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1231 @cindex @code{--baud}
1232 @cindex @code{-b}
1233 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1234 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1235
1236 @item -l @var{timeout}
1237 @cindex @code{-l}
1238 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1239 for remote debugging.
1240
1241 @item -tty @var{device}
1242 @itemx -t @var{device}
1243 @cindex @code{--tty}
1244 @cindex @code{-t}
1245 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1246 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1247
1248 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1249 @item -tui
1250 @cindex @code{--tui}
1251 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1252 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1253 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1254 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1255 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1256 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1257
1258 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1259 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1260 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1261 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1262 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1263 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1264
1265 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1266 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1267 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1268 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1269 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1270 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1271
1272 @item -write
1273 @cindex @code{--write}
1274 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1275 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1276 (@pxref{Patching}).
1277
1278 @item -statistics
1279 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1280 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1281 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1282
1283 @item -version
1284 @cindex @code{--version}
1285 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1286 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1287
1288 @item -configuration
1289 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1290 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1291 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1292 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1293
1294 @end table
1295
1296 @node Startup
1297 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1298 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1299
1300 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1301
1302 @enumerate
1303 @item
1304 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1305 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1306
1307 @item
1308 @cindex init file
1309 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1310 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1311 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1312 that file.
1313
1314 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1315 @item
1316 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1317 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1318 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1319 that file.
1320
1321 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1322 @item
1323 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1324 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1325 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1326 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1327 gets loaded.
1328
1329 @item
1330 Processes command line options and operands.
1331
1332 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1333 @item
1334 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1335 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1336 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1337 This is only done if the current directory is
1338 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1339 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1340 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1341 @value{GDBN}.
1342
1343 @item
1344 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1345 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1346 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1347 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1348
1349 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1350 you must do something like the following:
1351
1352 @smallexample
1353 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1354 @end smallexample
1355
1356 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1357 off too late.
1358
1359 @item
1360 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1361 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1362 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1363
1364 @item
1365 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1366 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1367 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1368 @end enumerate
1369
1370 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1371 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1372 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1373 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1374 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1375 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1376
1377 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1378 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1379
1380 @cindex init file name
1381 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1382 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1383 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1384 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1385 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1386 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1387 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1388 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1389
1390
1391 @node Quitting GDB
1392 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1393 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1394 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1395
1396 @table @code
1397 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1398 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1399 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1400 @itemx q
1401 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1402 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1403 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1404 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1405 error code.
1406 @end table
1407
1408 @cindex interrupt
1409 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1410 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1411 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1412 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1413 until a time when it is safe.
1414
1415 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1416 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1417 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1418
1419 @node Shell Commands
1420 @section Shell Commands
1421
1422 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1423 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1424 just use the @code{shell} command.
1425
1426 @table @code
1427 @kindex shell
1428 @kindex !
1429 @cindex shell escape
1430 @item shell @var{command-string}
1431 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1432 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1433 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1434 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1435 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1436 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1437 @end table
1438
1439 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1440 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1441 @value{GDBN}:
1442
1443 @table @code
1444 @kindex make
1445 @cindex calling make
1446 @item make @var{make-args}
1447 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1448 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1449 @end table
1450
1451 @node Logging Output
1452 @section Logging Output
1453 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1454 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1455
1456 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1457 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1458
1459 @table @code
1460 @kindex set logging
1461 @item set logging on
1462 Enable logging.
1463 @item set logging off
1464 Disable logging.
1465 @cindex logging file name
1466 @item set logging file @var{file}
1467 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1468 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1469 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1470 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1471 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1472 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1473 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1474 @kindex show logging
1475 @item show logging
1476 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1477 @end table
1478
1479 @node Commands
1480 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1481
1482 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1483 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1484 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1485 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1486 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1487
1488 @menu
1489 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1490 * Completion:: Command completion
1491 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1492 @end menu
1493
1494 @node Command Syntax
1495 @section Command Syntax
1496
1497 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1498 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1499 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1500 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1501 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1502 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1503
1504 @cindex abbreviation
1505 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1506 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1507 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1508 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1509 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1510 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1511 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1512
1513 @cindex repeating commands
1514 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1515 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1516 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1517 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1518 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1519 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1520 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1521
1522 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1523 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1524 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1525
1526 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1527 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1528 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1529 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1530 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1531
1532 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1533 @cindex comment
1534 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1535 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1536 Files,,Command Files}).
1537
1538 @cindex repeating command sequences
1539 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1540 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1541 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1542 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1543 for editing.
1544
1545 @node Completion
1546 @section Command Completion
1547
1548 @cindex completion
1549 @cindex word completion
1550 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1551 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1552 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1553 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1554
1555 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1556 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1557 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1558 enter it). For example, if you type
1559
1560 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1561 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1562 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1563 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1564 @smallexample
1565 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1566 @end smallexample
1567
1568 @noindent
1569 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1570 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1574 @end smallexample
1575
1576 @noindent
1577 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1578 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1579 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1580 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1581 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1582 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1583
1584 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1585 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1586 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1587 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1588 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1589 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1590 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1591 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1592 example:
1593
1594 @smallexample
1595 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1596 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1597 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1598 make_abs_section make_function_type
1599 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1600 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1601 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1602 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1607 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1608 command.
1609
1610 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1611 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1612 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1613 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1614 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1615
1616 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1617 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1618 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1622 main
1623 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1624 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1625 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 @noindent
1629 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1630
1631 @table @code
1632 @kindex set max-completions
1633 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1634 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1635 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1636 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1637 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1638 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1639 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1640 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1641 completion slow.
1642 @kindex show max-completions
1643 @item show max-completions
1644 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1645 during completion.
1646 @end table
1647
1648 @cindex quotes in commands
1649 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1650 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1651 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1652 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1653 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1654 @value{GDBN} commands.
1655
1656 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1657 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1658 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1659 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1660 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1661 Operators}).
1662
1663 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1664 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1665 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1666 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1667 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1668 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1669 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1670 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1671 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1675 func<int>() func<float>()
1676 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1677 @end smallexample
1678
1679 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1680 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1681 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1682 function:
1683
1684 @smallexample
1685 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1686 func<int>() func<float>()
1687 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1691 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1692 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1693 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1694 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1695 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1696
1697 @smallexample
1698 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1699 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1700 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1701 bubble(double)
1702 @end smallexample
1703
1704 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1705 require quoting.
1706
1707 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1708 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1709 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1710 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1711
1712 @cindex completion of structure field names
1713 @cindex structure field name completion
1714 @cindex completion of union field names
1715 @cindex union field name completion
1716 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1717 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1718 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1719 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1720 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1721 left-hand-side:
1722
1723 @smallexample
1724 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1725 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1726 to_data to_isatty to_write
1727 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1728 to_flush to_read
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 @noindent
1732 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1733 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1734 follows:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 struct ui_file
1738 @{
1739 int *magic;
1740 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1741 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1742 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1743 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1744 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1745 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1746 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1747 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1748 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1749 void *to_data;
1750 @}
1751 @end smallexample
1752
1753
1754 @node Help
1755 @section Getting Help
1756 @cindex online documentation
1757 @kindex help
1758
1759 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1760 using the command @code{help}.
1761
1762 @table @code
1763 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1764 @item help
1765 @itemx h
1766 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1767 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help
1771 List of classes of commands:
1772
1773 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1774 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1775 data -- Examining data
1776 files -- Specifying and examining files
1777 internals -- Maintenance commands
1778 obscure -- Obscure features
1779 running -- Running the program
1780 stack -- Examining the stack
1781 status -- Status inquiries
1782 support -- Support facilities
1783 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1784 stopping the program
1785 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1786
1787 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1788 commands in that class.
1789 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1790 documentation.
1791 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1792 (@value{GDBP})
1793 @end smallexample
1794 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1795
1796 @item help @var{class}
1797 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1798 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1799 help display for the class @code{status}:
1800
1801 @smallexample
1802 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1803 Status inquiries.
1804
1805 List of commands:
1806
1807 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1808 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1809 info -- Generic command for showing things
1810 about the program being debugged
1811 show -- Generic command for showing things
1812 about the debugger
1813
1814 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1815 documentation.
1816 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1817 (@value{GDBP})
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @item help @var{command}
1821 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1822 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1823
1824 @kindex apropos
1825 @item apropos @var{args}
1826 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1827 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1828 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1829
1830 @smallexample
1831 apropos alias
1832 @end smallexample
1833
1834 @noindent
1835 results in:
1836
1837 @smallexample
1838 @c @group
1839 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1840 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1841 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1842 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1843 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1844 @c @end group
1845 @end smallexample
1846
1847 @kindex complete
1848 @item complete @var{args}
1849 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1850 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1851 command you want completed. For example:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 complete i
1855 @end smallexample
1856
1857 @noindent results in:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 @group
1861 if
1862 ignore
1863 info
1864 inspect
1865 @end group
1866 @end smallexample
1867
1868 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1869 @end table
1870
1871 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1872 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1873 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1874 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1875 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1876 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1877 Index}.
1878
1879 @c @group
1880 @table @code
1881 @kindex info
1882 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1883 @item info
1884 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1885 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1886 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1887 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1888 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1889 @w{@code{help info}}.
1890
1891 @kindex set
1892 @item set
1893 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1894 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1895 @code{set prompt $}.
1896
1897 @kindex show
1898 @item show
1899 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1900 @value{GDBN} itself.
1901 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1902 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1903 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1904 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1905
1906 @kindex info set
1907 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1908 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1909 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1910 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1911 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1912 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1913 @end table
1914 @c @end group
1915
1916 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1917 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1918
1919 @table @code
1920 @kindex show version
1921 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1922 @item show version
1923 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1924 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1925 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1926 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1927 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1928 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1929 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1930 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1931 @value{GDBN}.
1932
1933 @kindex show copying
1934 @kindex info copying
1935 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1936 @item show copying
1937 @itemx info copying
1938 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1939
1940 @kindex show warranty
1941 @kindex info warranty
1942 @item show warranty
1943 @itemx info warranty
1944 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1945 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1946
1947 @kindex show configuration
1948 @item show configuration
1949 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1950 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1951 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1952 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1953 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1954 your report.
1955
1956 @end table
1957
1958 @node Running
1959 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1960
1961 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1962 debugging information when you compile it.
1963
1964 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1965 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1966 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1967 kill a child process.
1968
1969 @menu
1970 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1971 * Starting:: Starting your program
1972 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1973 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1974
1975 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1976 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1977 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1978 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1979
1980 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1981 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1982 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1983 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1984 @end menu
1985
1986 @node Compilation
1987 @section Compiling for Debugging
1988
1989 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1990 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1991 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1992 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1993 and addresses in the executable code.
1994
1995 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1996 the compiler.
1997
1998 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1999 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2000 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2001 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2002 executables containing debugging information.
2003
2004 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2005 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2006 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2007 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2008 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2009
2010 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2011 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2012 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2013
2014 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2015 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2016 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2017 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2018 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2019 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2020
2021 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2022 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2023 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2024
2025 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2026 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2027 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2028 format in @value{GDBN}.
2029
2030 @need 2000
2031 @node Starting
2032 @section Starting your Program
2033 @cindex starting
2034 @cindex running
2035
2036 @table @code
2037 @kindex run
2038 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2039 @item run
2040 @itemx r
2041 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2042 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2043 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2044 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2045 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2046
2047 @end table
2048
2049 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2050 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2051 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2052 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2053 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2054 message like this one:
2055
2056 @smallexample
2057 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2058 Try "help target" or "continue".
2059 @end smallexample
2060
2061 @noindent
2062 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2063 first (@pxref{load}).
2064
2065 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2066 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2067 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2068 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2069 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2070 divided into four categories:
2071
2072 @table @asis
2073 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2074 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2075 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2076 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2077 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2078 the arguments.
2079 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2080 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2081 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2082 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2083 below for details).
2084
2085 @item The @emph{environment.}
2086 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2087 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2088 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2089 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2090
2091 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2092 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2093 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2094 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2095 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2096 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2097 Directory}.
2098
2099 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2100 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2101 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2102 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2103 set a different device for your program.
2104 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2105
2106 @cindex pipes
2107 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2108 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2109 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2110 wrong program.
2111 @end table
2112
2113 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2114 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2115 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2116 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2117 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2118
2119 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2120 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2121 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2122 your current breakpoints.
2123
2124 @table @code
2125 @kindex start
2126 @item start
2127 @cindex run to main procedure
2128 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2129 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2130 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2131 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2132 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2133 procedure, depending on the language used.
2134
2135 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2136 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2137 the @samp{run} command.
2138
2139 @cindex elaboration phase
2140 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2141 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2142 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2143 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2144 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2145 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2146 will remain to halt execution.
2147
2148 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2149 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2150 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2151 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2152 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2153
2154 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2155 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2156 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2157 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2158 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2159 use the @code{starti} command.
2160
2161 @kindex starti
2162 @item starti
2163 @cindex run to first instruction
2164 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2165 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2166 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2167 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2168 the start of the elaboration phase.
2169
2170 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2171 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2172 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2173 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2174 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2175 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2176 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2177 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2178 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2179 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2180 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2181 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2182
2183 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2184 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2185 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2186 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2187
2188 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2189 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2190 environment:
2191
2192 @smallexample
2193 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2194 (@value{GDBP}) run
2195 @end smallexample
2196
2197 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2198 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2199
2200 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2201 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2202 @item set startup-with-shell
2203 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2204 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2205 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2206 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2207 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2208 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2209 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2210 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2211 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2212 startup failures such as:
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) run
2216 Starting program: ./a.out
2217 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2218 @end smallexample
2219
2220 @noindent
2221 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2222 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2223 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2224 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2225 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2226 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2227
2228 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2229 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2230 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2231 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2232 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2233 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2234
2235 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2236 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2237 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2238 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2239 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2240 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2241
2242 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2243 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2244 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2245
2246 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2247 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2248
2249 @smallexample
2250 (@value{GDBP}) run
2251 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2252 @end smallexample
2253
2254 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2255 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2256
2257 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2258 @code{target native} command. For example,
2259
2260 @smallexample
2261 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2262 (@value{GDBP}) run
2263 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2264 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2265 (@value{GDBP}) run
2266 Starting program: ./a.out
2267 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2268 @end smallexample
2269
2270 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2271 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2272 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2273 disconnect.
2274
2275 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2276 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2277 proc}, @code{info os}.
2278
2279 @kindex set disable-randomization
2280 @item set disable-randomization
2281 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2282 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2283 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2284 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2285 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2286
2287 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2288 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2289
2290 @smallexample
2291 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2292 @end smallexample
2293
2294 @item set disable-randomization off
2295 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2296 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2297 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2298 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2299 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2300 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2301
2302 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2303 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2304 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2305 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2306 a code at its expected addresses.
2307
2308 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2309 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2310 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2311 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2312 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2313 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2314 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2315 a randomly chosen address.
2316
2317 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2318 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2319 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2320 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2321 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2322
2323 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2324 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2325
2326 @item show disable-randomization
2327 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2328 the virtual address space of the started program.
2329
2330 @end table
2331
2332 @node Arguments
2333 @section Your Program's Arguments
2334
2335 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2336 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2337 @code{run} command.
2338 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2339 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2340 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2341 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2342 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2343
2344 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2345 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2346 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2347 the program, not by the shell.
2348
2349 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2350 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2351
2352 @table @code
2353 @kindex set args
2354 @item set args
2355 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2356 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2357 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2358 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2359 it again without arguments.
2360
2361 @kindex show args
2362 @item show args
2363 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2364 @end table
2365
2366 @node Environment
2367 @section Your Program's Environment
2368
2369 @cindex environment (of your program)
2370 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2371 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2372 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2373 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2374 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2375 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2376 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2377
2378 @table @code
2379 @kindex path
2380 @item path @var{directory}
2381 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2382 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2383 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2384 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2385 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2386 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2387 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2388
2389 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2390 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2391 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2392 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2393 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2394 @var{directory} to the search path.
2395 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2396 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2397
2398 @kindex show paths
2399 @item show paths
2400 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2401 environment variable).
2402
2403 @kindex show environment
2404 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2405 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2406 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2407 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2408 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2409
2410 @kindex set environment
2411 @anchor{set environment}
2412 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2413 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2414 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2415 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2416 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2417 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2418 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2419 null value.
2420 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2421 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2422
2423 For example, this command:
2424
2425 @smallexample
2426 set env USER = foo
2427 @end smallexample
2428
2429 @noindent
2430 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2431 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2432 are not actually required.)
2433
2434 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2435 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2436 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2437 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2438 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2439
2440 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2441 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2442 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2443
2444 @kindex unset environment
2445 @anchor{unset environment}
2446 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2447 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2448 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2449 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2450 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2451
2452 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2453 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2454 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2455 @end table
2456
2457 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2458 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2459 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2460 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2461 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2462 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2463 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2464 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2465 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2466 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2467
2468 @node Working Directory
2469 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2470
2471 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2472 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2473 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2474 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2475 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2476 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2477 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2478 debugging.
2479
2480 @table @code
2481 @kindex set cwd
2482 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2483 @anchor{set cwd command}
2484 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2485 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2486 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2487 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2488 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2489 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2490 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2491 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2492 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2493 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2494 fallback.
2495
2496 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2497 the @code{cd} command.
2498 @xref{cd command}.
2499
2500 @kindex show cwd
2501 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2502 @item show cwd
2503 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2504 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2505 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2506
2507 @kindex cd
2508 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2509 @anchor{cd command}
2510 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2511 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2512 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2513
2514 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2515 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2516 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2517 @xref{set cwd command}.
2518
2519 @kindex pwd
2520 @item pwd
2521 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2522 @end table
2523
2524 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2525 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2526 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2527 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2528 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2529 current working directory of the debuggee.
2530
2531 @node Input/Output
2532 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2533
2534 @cindex redirection
2535 @cindex i/o
2536 @cindex terminal
2537 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2538 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2539 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2540 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2541 running your program.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info terminal
2545 @item info terminal
2546 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2547 program is using.
2548 @end table
2549
2550 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2551 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 run > outfile
2555 @end smallexample
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2559
2560 @kindex tty
2561 @cindex controlling terminal
2562 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2563 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2564 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2565 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2566 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2567
2568 @smallexample
2569 tty /dev/ttyb
2570 @end smallexample
2571
2572 @noindent
2573 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2574 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2575 that as their controlling terminal.
2576
2577 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2578 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2579 terminal.
2580
2581 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2582 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2583 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2584 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2585
2586 @cindex inferior tty
2587 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2588 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2589 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2590 program.
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2594 @kindex set inferior-tty
2595 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2596 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2597 @value{GDBN}.
2598
2599 @item show inferior-tty
2600 @kindex show inferior-tty
2601 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2602 @end table
2603
2604 @node Attach
2605 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2606 @kindex attach
2607 @cindex attach
2608
2609 @table @code
2610 @item attach @var{process-id}
2611 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2612 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2613 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2614 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2615 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2616
2617 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2618 executing the command.
2619 @end table
2620
2621 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2622 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2623 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2624 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2625
2626 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2627 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2628 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2629 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2630 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2631 Specify Files}.
2632
2633 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2634 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2635 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2636 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2637 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2638 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2639 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2640
2641 @table @code
2642 @kindex detach
2643 @item detach
2644 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2645 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2646 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2647 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2648 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2649 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2650 executing the command.
2651 @end table
2652
2653 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2654 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2655 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2656 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2657 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2658 Messages}).
2659
2660 @node Kill Process
2661 @section Killing the Child Process
2662
2663 @table @code
2664 @kindex kill
2665 @item kill
2666 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2667 @end table
2668
2669 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2670 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2671 is running.
2672
2673 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2674 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2675 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2676 outside the debugger.
2677
2678 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2679 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2680 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2681 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2682 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2683 breakpoint settings).
2684
2685 @node Inferiors and Programs
2686 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2687
2688 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2689 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2690 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2691 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2692 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2693 from multiple executables.
2694
2695 @cindex inferior
2696 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2697 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2698 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2699 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2700 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2701 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2702 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2703 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2704 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2705 threads running in it.
2706
2707 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2708 inferiors}}:
2709
2710 @table @code
2711 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2712 @item info inferiors
2713 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2714 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2715 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2716 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2717
2718 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2719
2720 @enumerate
2721 @item
2722 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2723
2724 @item
2725 the target system's inferior identifier
2726
2727 @item
2728 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2729
2730 @end enumerate
2731
2732 @noindent
2733 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2734 indicates the current inferior.
2735
2736 For example,
2737 @end table
2738 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2739
2740 @smallexample
2741 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2742 Num Description Executable
2743 2 process 2307 hello
2744 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2748
2749 @table @code
2750 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2751 @item inferior @var{infno}
2752 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2753 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2754 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2755 @end table
2756
2757 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2758 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2759 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2760 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2761 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2762 information on convenience variables.
2763
2764 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2765 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2766 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2767 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2768 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2769 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex add-inferior
2773 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2774 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2775 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2776 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2777 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2778 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2779
2780 @kindex clone-inferior
2781 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2782 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2783 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2784 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2785 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2786
2787 @smallexample
2788 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2789 Num Description Executable
2790 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2791 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2792 Added inferior 2.
2793 1 inferiors added.
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 2 <null> helloworld
2797 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2798 @end smallexample
2799
2800 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2801
2802 @kindex remove-inferiors
2803 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2804 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2805 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2806 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2807
2808 @end table
2809
2810 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2811 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2812 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2813 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2814
2815 @table @code
2816 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2817 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2818 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2819 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2820 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2821 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2822
2823 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2825 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2826 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2827 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2828 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2829 @end table
2830
2831 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2832 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2833 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2834 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2835
2836
2837 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2838 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2839
2840 @table @code
2841 @kindex set print inferior-events
2842 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2843 @item set print inferior-events
2844 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2845 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2846 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2847 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2848 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2849 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2850
2851 @kindex show print inferior-events
2852 @item show print inferior-events
2853 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2854 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2855 @end table
2856
2857 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2858 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2859 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2860
2861
2862 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2863 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2864 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2865 info program-spaces}} command.
2866
2867 @table @code
2868 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2869 @item maint info program-spaces
2870 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2871 @value{GDBN}.
2872
2873 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2874
2875 @enumerate
2876 @item
2877 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2878
2879 @item
2880 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2881 the @code{file} command.
2882
2883 @end enumerate
2884
2885 @noindent
2886 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2887 indicates the current program space.
2888
2889 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2890 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2891 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2892
2893 @smallexample
2894 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2895 Id Executable
2896 * 1 hello
2897 2 goodbye
2898 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2899 @end smallexample
2900
2901 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2902 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2903 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2904 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2905 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2906
2907 @smallexample
2908 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2909 Id Executable
2910 * 1 vfork-test
2911 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2912 @end smallexample
2913
2914 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2915 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2916 @end table
2917
2918 @node Threads
2919 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2920
2921 @cindex threads of execution
2922 @cindex multiple threads
2923 @cindex switching threads
2924 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2925 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2926 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2927 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2928 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2929 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2930 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2931
2932 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2933 programs:
2934
2935 @itemize @bullet
2936 @item automatic notification of new threads
2937 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2938 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2939 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2940 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2941 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2942 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2943 messages on thread start and exit.
2944 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2945 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2946 isn't compatible with the program.
2947 @end itemize
2948
2949 @cindex focus of debugging
2950 @cindex current thread
2951 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2952 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2953 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2954 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2955 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2956
2957 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2958 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2959 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2960 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2961 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2962 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2963 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2964 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2965 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2966 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2967
2968 @smallexample
2969 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @noindent
2973 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2974 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2975 further qualifier.
2976
2977 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2978 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2979 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2980 @c program?
2981 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2982 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2983 @c threads ab initio?
2984
2985 @anchor{thread numbers}
2986 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2987 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2988 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2989 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2990 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2991 between threads of different inferiors.
2992
2993 @cindex qualified thread ID
2994 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2995 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2996 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2997 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2998 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2999 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3000 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3001 inferior.
3002
3003 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3004 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3005 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3006 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3007
3008 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3009 @cindex thread ID lists
3010 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3011 argument. A list element can be:
3012
3013 @enumerate
3014 @item
3015 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3016 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3017 @samp{1}.
3018
3019 @item
3020 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3021 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3022 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3023
3024 @item
3025 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3026 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3027 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3028 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3029 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3030
3031 @end enumerate
3032
3033 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3034 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3035 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3036 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3037 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3038 7.1}.
3039
3040
3041 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3042 @cindex global thread number
3043 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3044 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3045 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3046 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3047 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3048 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3049
3050 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3051 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3052 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3053
3054 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3055 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3056 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3057 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3058 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3059 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3060 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3061 general information on convenience variables.
3062
3063 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3064 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3065 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3066
3067 @smallexample
3068 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3069 @end smallexample
3070
3071 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 @table @code
3078 @kindex info threads
3079 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3080
3081 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3082 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3083 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3084 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3085
3086 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3087
3088 @enumerate
3089 @item
3090 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3091
3092 @item
3093 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3094 option was specified
3095
3096 @item
3097 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3098
3099 @item
3100 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3101 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3102 program itself.
3103
3104 @item
3105 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3106 @end enumerate
3107
3108 @noindent
3109 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3110 indicates the current thread.
3111
3112 For example,
3113 @end table
3114 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3115
3116 @smallexample
3117 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3120 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3121 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3122 at threadtest.c:68
3123 @end smallexample
3124
3125 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3126 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3127 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3128
3129 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3130 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3131
3132 @smallexample
3133 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3134 Id GId Target Id Frame
3135 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3136 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3137 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3138 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3139 @end smallexample
3140
3141 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3142 Solaris-specific command:
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @item maint info sol-threads
3146 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3147 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3148 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3149 @end table
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3153 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3154 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3155 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3156 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3157 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3158
3159 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3160 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3161
3162 @smallexample
3163 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3164 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3165 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3166 8 printf ("hello\n");
3167 @end smallexample
3168
3169 @noindent
3170 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3171 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3172 threads.
3173
3174 @kindex thread apply
3175 @cindex apply command to several threads
3176 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3177 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3178 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3179 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3180 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3181 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3182 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3183 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3184
3185 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3186 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3187 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3188 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3189 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3190
3191 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3192 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3193 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3194 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3195
3196 @table @code
3197 @item -c
3198 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3199 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3200 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3201 @item -s
3202 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3203 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3204 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3205 are not printed.
3206 @item -q
3207 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3208 information.
3209 @end table
3210
3211 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3212
3213 @kindex taas
3214 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3215 @item taas @var{command}
3216 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3217 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3218
3219 @kindex tfaas
3220 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item tfaas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3224 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3225 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3226 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3227 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3228 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3229 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3230
3231 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3232 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3233 is, using:
3234 @smallexample
3235 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3236 @end smallexample
3237
3238
3239 @kindex thread name
3240 @cindex name a thread
3241 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3242 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3243 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3244 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3245
3246 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3247 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3248 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3249 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3250 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3251
3252 @kindex thread find
3253 @cindex search for a thread
3254 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3255 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3256 matches the supplied regular expression.
3257
3258 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3259 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3260 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3261 is the LWP id.
3262
3263 @smallexample
3264 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3265 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3266 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3267 Id Target Id Frame
3268 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3269 @end smallexample
3270
3271 @kindex set print thread-events
3272 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3273 @item set print thread-events
3274 @itemx set print thread-events on
3275 @itemx set print thread-events off
3276 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3277 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3278 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3279 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3280 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3281
3282 @kindex show print thread-events
3283 @item show print thread-events
3284 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3285 have started and exited.
3286 @end table
3287
3288 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3289 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3290 programs with multiple threads.
3291
3292 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3293 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3294
3295 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3296 @table @code
3297 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3298 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3299 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3300 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3301 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3302 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3303 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3304 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3305 macro.
3306
3307 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3308 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3309 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3310 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3311 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3312 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3313
3314 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3315 refers to the default system directories that are
3316 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3317 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3318 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3322 was loaded in the inferior process.
3323
3324 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3325 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3326 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3327 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3328 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3329 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3330 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3331
3332 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3333 only on some platforms.
3334
3335 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3336 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3337 Display current libthread_db search path.
3338
3339 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3340 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3341 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3342 @item set debug libthread-db
3343 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3344 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3345 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3346 @end table
3347
3348 @node Forks
3349 @section Debugging Forks
3350
3351 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3352 @cindex multiple processes
3353 @cindex processes, multiple
3354 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3355 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3356 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3357 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3358 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3359 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3360 will cause it to terminate.
3361
3362 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3363 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3364 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3365 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3366 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3367 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3368 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3369 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3370 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3371 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3372
3373 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3374 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3375 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3376 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3377
3378 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3379 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3380 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3381
3382 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3383 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3384
3385 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3386 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3387
3388 @table @code
3389 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3390 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3391 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3392 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3393 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3394
3395 @table @code
3396 @item parent
3397 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3398 unimpeded. This is the default.
3399
3400 @item child
3401 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3402 unimpeded.
3403
3404 @end table
3405
3406 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3407 @item show follow-fork-mode
3408 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3409 @end table
3410
3411 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3412 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3413 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3414
3415 @table @code
3416 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3417 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3418 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3419 retain debugger control over them both.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @item on
3423 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3424 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3425 independently. This is the default.
3426
3427 @item off
3428 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3429 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3431 is held suspended.
3432
3433 @end table
3434
3435 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3436 @item show detach-on-fork
3437 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3438 @end table
3439
3440 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3441 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3442 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3443 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3444 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3445 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3446
3447 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3448 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3449 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3450 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3451 and Programs}.
3452
3453 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3454 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3455 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3456 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3457 the child process's @code{main}.
3458
3459 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3460 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3461
3462 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3463 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3464 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3465 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3466 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3467 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3468 command.
3469
3470 @table @code
3471 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3472 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3473
3474 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3475 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3476
3477 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3478
3479 @table @code
3480 @item new
3481 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3482 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3483 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3484 original inferior.
3485
3486 For example:
3487
3488 @smallexample
3489 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3490 (gdb) info inferior
3491 Id Description Executable
3492 * 1 <null> prog1
3493 (@value{GDBP}) run
3494 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3495 Program exited normally.
3496 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 1 <null> prog1
3499 * 2 <null> prog2
3500 @end smallexample
3501
3502 @item same
3503 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3504 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3505 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3506 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3507 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3508
3509 For example:
3510
3511 @smallexample
3512 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3513 Id Description Executable
3514 * 1 <null> prog1
3515 (@value{GDBP}) run
3516 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3517 Program exited normally.
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog2
3521 @end smallexample
3522
3523 @end table
3524 @end table
3525
3526 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3527 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3528
3529 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3530 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3531 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3532
3533 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3534 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3535
3536 @cindex checkpoint
3537 @cindex restart
3538 @cindex bookmark
3539 @cindex snapshot of a process
3540 @cindex rewind program state
3541
3542 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3543 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3544 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3545 later.
3546
3547 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3548 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3549 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3550 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3551 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3552
3553 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3554 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3555 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3556 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3557 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3558 start again from there.
3559
3560 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3561 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3562
3563 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3564
3565 @table @code
3566 @kindex checkpoint
3567 @item checkpoint
3568 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3569 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3570 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3571
3572 @kindex info checkpoints
3573 @item info checkpoints
3574 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3575 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3576 listed:
3577
3578 @table @code
3579 @item Checkpoint ID
3580 @item Process ID
3581 @item Code Address
3582 @item Source line, or label
3583 @end table
3584
3585 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3586 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3587 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3588 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3589 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3590 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3591 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3592
3593 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3594 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3595 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3596 the debugger.
3597
3598 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3599 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3600 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3601
3602 @end table
3603
3604 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3605 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3606 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3607 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3608 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3609 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3610 previously read data can be read again.
3611
3612 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3613 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3614 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3615 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3616 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3617 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3618
3619 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3620 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3621 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3622 different execution path this time.
3623
3624 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3625 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3626 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3627 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3628 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3629 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3630 potentially pose a problem.
3631
3632 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3633
3634 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3635 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3636 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3637 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3638 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3639 next.
3640
3641 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3642 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3643 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3644 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3645 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3646
3647 @node Stopping
3648 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3649
3650 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3651 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3652 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3653
3654 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3655 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3656 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3657 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3658 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3659 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3660 explicitly request this information at any time.
3661
3662 @table @code
3663 @kindex info program
3664 @item info program
3665 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3666 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3667 @end table
3668
3669 @menu
3670 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3671 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3672 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3673 Skipping over functions and files
3674 * Signals:: Signals
3675 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3676 @end menu
3677
3678 @node Breakpoints
3679 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3680
3681 @cindex breakpoints
3682 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3683 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3684 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3685 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3686 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3687 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3688 program.
3689
3690 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3691 the executable is run.
3692
3693 @cindex watchpoints
3694 @cindex data breakpoints
3695 @cindex memory tracing
3696 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3697 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3698 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3699 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3700 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3701 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3702 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3703 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3704 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3705 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3706 same commands.
3707
3708 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3709 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3710 Automatic Display}.
3711
3712 @cindex catchpoints
3713 @cindex breakpoint on events
3714 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3715 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3716 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3717 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3718 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3719 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3720 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3721
3722 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3723 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3724 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3725 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3726 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3727 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3728 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3729 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3730 enable it again.
3731
3732 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3733 @cindex breakpoint lists
3734 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3735 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3736 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3737 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3738 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3739 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3740 are operated on.
3741
3742 @menu
3743 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3744 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3745 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3746 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3747 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3748 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3749 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3750 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3751 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3752 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3753 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3754 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3755 @end menu
3756
3757 @node Set Breaks
3758 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3759
3760 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3761 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3762 @c
3763 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3764
3765 @kindex break
3766 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3767 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3768 @cindex latest breakpoint
3769 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3770 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3771 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3772 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3773 convenience variables.
3774
3775 @table @code
3776 @item break @var{location}
3777 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3778 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3779 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3780 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3781 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3782
3783 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3784 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3785 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3786 that situation.
3787
3788 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3789 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3790 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3791
3792 @item break
3793 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3794 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3795 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3796 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3797 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3798 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3799 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3800 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3801 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3802 inside loops.
3803
3804 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3805 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3806 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3807 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3808 existed when your program stopped.
3809
3810 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3811 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3812 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3813 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3814 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3815 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3816 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3817
3818 @kindex tbreak
3819 @item tbreak @var{args}
3820 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3821 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3822 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3823 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3824
3825 @kindex hbreak
3826 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3827 @item hbreak @var{args}
3828 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3829 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3830 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3831 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3832 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3833 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3834 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3835 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3836 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3837 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3838 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3839 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3840 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3841 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3842 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3843 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3844 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3845 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3846
3847 @kindex thbreak
3848 @item thbreak @var{args}
3849 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3850 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3851 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3852 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3853 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3854 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3855 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3856 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3857
3858 @kindex rbreak
3859 @cindex regular expression
3860 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3861 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3862 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3863 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3864 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3865 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3866 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3867 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3868 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3869
3870 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3871 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3872 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3873 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3874 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3875 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3876
3877 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3878 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3879 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3880 classes.
3881
3882 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3883 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3884 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3885
3886 @smallexample
3887 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3888 @end smallexample
3889
3890 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3891 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3892 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3893 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3894 every function in a given file:
3895
3896 @smallexample
3897 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3898 @end smallexample
3899
3900 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3901 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3902
3903 @kindex info breakpoints
3904 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3905 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3906 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3907 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3908 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3909 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3910 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3911
3912 @table @emph
3913 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3914 @item Type
3915 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3916 @item Disposition
3917 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3918 @item Enabled or Disabled
3919 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3920 that are not enabled.
3921 @item Address
3922 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3923 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3924 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3925 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3926 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3927 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3928 @item What
3929 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3930 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3931 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3932 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3933 @end table
3934
3935 @noindent
3936 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3937 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3938 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3939 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3940 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3941 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3942
3943 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3944 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3945 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3946 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3947
3948 @noindent
3949 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3950 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3951 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3952 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3953 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3954
3955 @noindent
3956 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3957 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3958 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3959 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3960 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3961 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3962
3963 @noindent
3964 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3965 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3966
3967 @end table
3968
3969 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3970 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3971 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3972 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3973
3974 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3975 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3976 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3977 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3978
3979 @itemize @bullet
3980 @item
3981 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3982
3983 @item
3984 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3985 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3986
3987 @item
3988 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3989 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3990
3991 @item
3992 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3993 several places where that function is inlined.
3994 @end itemize
3995
3996 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3997 the relevant locations.
3998
3999 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4000 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4001 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4002 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4003 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4004 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4005 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4006
4007 For example:
4008
4009 @smallexample
4010 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4011 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4012 stop only if i==1
4013 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4014 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4015 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4016 @end smallexample
4017
4018 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4019 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4020 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4021 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4022 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4023 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4024 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4025 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4026 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4027 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4028 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4029
4030 @cindex pending breakpoints
4031 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4032 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4033 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4034 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4035 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4036 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4037 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4038 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4039 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4040 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4041 is not yet resolved.
4042
4043 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4044 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4045 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4046 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4047 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4048 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4049
4050 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4051 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4052 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4053 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4054
4055 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4056 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4057 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4058
4059 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4060 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4061 address specification to an address:
4062
4063 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4064 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4065 @table @code
4066 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4067 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4068 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4069
4070 @item set breakpoint pending on
4071 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4072 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4073
4074 @item set breakpoint pending off
4075 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4076 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4077 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4078
4079 @item show breakpoint pending
4080 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4081 @end table
4082
4083 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4084 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4085 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4086
4087 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4088 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4089 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4090 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4091 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4092 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4093 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4094 breakpoints.
4095
4096 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4097
4098 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4099 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4100 @table @code
4101 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4102 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4103 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4104 breakpoint must be used.
4105
4106 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4107 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4108 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4109 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4110 @end table
4111
4112 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4113 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4114 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4115 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4116 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4117 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4118 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4119 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4120 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4121
4122 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4123 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4124 @table @code
4125 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4126 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4127 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4128 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4129
4130 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4131 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4132 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4133 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4134 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4135 @end table
4136
4137 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4138 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4139 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4140
4141 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4142 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4143
4144 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4145
4146 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4147 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4148 @table @code
4149 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4150 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4151 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4152 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4153 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4154
4155 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4156 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4157 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4158 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4159 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4160 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4161 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4162 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4163 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4164 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4165 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4166 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4167 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4168
4169 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4170 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4171 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4172 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4173 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4174 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4175 @end table
4176
4177
4178 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4179 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4180 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4181 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4182 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4183 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4184 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4185 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4186
4187
4188 @node Set Watchpoints
4189 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4190
4191 @cindex setting watchpoints
4192 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4193 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4194 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4195 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4196 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4197
4198 @itemize @bullet
4199 @item
4200 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4201
4202 @item
4203 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4204 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4205 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4206
4207 @item
4208 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4209 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4210 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4211 @end itemize
4212
4213 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4214 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4215 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4216 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4217 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4218 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4219 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4220 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4221 the expression changes.
4222
4223 @cindex software watchpoints
4224 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4225 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4226 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4227 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4228 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4229 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4230 culprit.)
4231
4232 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4233 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4234 slow down the running of your program.
4235
4236 @table @code
4237 @kindex watch
4238 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4239 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4240 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4241 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4242 to watch the value of a single variable:
4243
4244 @smallexample
4245 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4246 @end smallexample
4247
4248 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4249 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4250 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4251 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4252 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4253 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4254
4255 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4256 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4257 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4258 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4259 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4260 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4261 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4262 error.
4263
4264 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4265 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4266 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4267 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4268 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4269 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4270 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4271 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4272 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4273 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4274 Examples:
4275
4276 @smallexample
4277 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4278 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4279 @end smallexample
4280
4281 @kindex rwatch
4282 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4283 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4284 by the program.
4285
4286 @kindex awatch
4287 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4288 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4289 or written into by the program.
4290
4291 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4292 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4293 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4294 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4295 @end table
4296
4297 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4298 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4299 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4300 a never-changing value:
4301
4302 @smallexample
4303 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4304 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4305 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4306 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4307 @end smallexample
4308
4309 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4310 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4311 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4312 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4313 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4314 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4315
4316 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4317 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4318 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4319 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4320 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4321 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4322 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4323 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4324
4325 @table @code
4326 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4327 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4328 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4329
4330 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4331 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4332 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4333 @end table
4334
4335 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4336 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4337 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4338
4339 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4340
4341 @smallexample
4342 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4343 @end smallexample
4344
4345 @noindent
4346 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4347
4348 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4349 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4350 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4351 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4352 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4353 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4354 will print a message like this:
4355
4356 @smallexample
4357 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4361 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4362 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4363 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4364 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4365 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4366 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4367 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4368
4369 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4370 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4371 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4372 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4373 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4374 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4375
4376 @smallexample
4377 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4378 @end smallexample
4379
4380 @noindent
4381 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4382
4383 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4384 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4385 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4386 expression with separately allocated resources.
4387
4388 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4389 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4390 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4391
4392 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4393 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4394 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4395 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4396 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4397 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4398 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4399 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4400 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4401
4402 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4403 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4404 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4405 watched expression from every thread.
4406
4407 @quotation
4408 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4409 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4410 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4411 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4412 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4413 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4414 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4415 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4416 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4417 @end quotation
4418
4419 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4420
4421 @node Set Catchpoints
4422 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4423 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4424 @cindex exception handlers
4425 @cindex event handling
4426
4427 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4428 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4429 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4430
4431 @table @code
4432 @kindex catch
4433 @item catch @var{event}
4434 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4435
4436 @table @code
4437 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4438 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4439 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4440 @kindex catch throw
4441 @kindex catch rethrow
4442 @kindex catch catch
4443 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4444 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4445
4446 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4447 regular expression will be caught.
4448
4449 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4450 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4451 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4452 exception being thrown.
4453
4454 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4455 @value{GDBN}:
4456
4457 @itemize @bullet
4458 @item
4459 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4460 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4461 supported.
4462
4463 @item
4464 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4465 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4466 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4467 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4468 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4469 built.
4470
4471 @item
4472 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4473 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4474
4475 @item
4476 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4477 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4478 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4479 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4480
4481 @item
4482 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4483 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4484 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4485 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4486 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4487 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4488 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4489 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4490 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4491
4492 @item
4493 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4494
4495 @item
4496 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4497 @end itemize
4498
4499 @item exception
4500 @kindex catch exception
4501 @cindex Ada exception catching
4502 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4503 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4504 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4505 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4506 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4507
4508 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4509 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4510 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4511 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4512 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4513 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4514 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4515 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4516
4517 @item handlers
4518 @kindex catch handlers
4519 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4520 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4521 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4522 specified at the end of the command
4523 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4524 only when this specific exception is handled.
4525 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4526
4527 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4528 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4529 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4530 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4531 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4532 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4533 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4534 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4535 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4536
4537 @item exception unhandled
4538 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4539 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4540
4541 @item assert
4542 @kindex catch assert
4543 A failed Ada assertion.
4544
4545 @item exec
4546 @kindex catch exec
4547 @cindex break on fork/exec
4548 A call to @code{exec}.
4549
4550 @item syscall
4551 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4552 @kindex catch syscall
4553 @cindex break on a system call.
4554 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4555 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4556 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4557 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4558 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4559 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4560 will be caught.
4561
4562 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4563 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4564 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4565 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4566
4567 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4568 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4569 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4570 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4571
4572 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4573 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4574 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4575 available choices.
4576
4577 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4578 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4579 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4580 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4581 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4582 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4583 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4584 behind the OS upgrades).
4585
4586 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4587 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4588 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4589 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4590 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4591 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4592 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4593 syscall groups available on your environment.
4594
4595 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4596 arguments to it:
4597
4598 @smallexample
4599 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4600 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4601 (@value{GDBP}) r
4602 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4603
4604 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4605 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4606 (@value{GDBP}) c
4607 Continuing.
4608
4609 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4610 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4611 (@value{GDBP})
4612 @end smallexample
4613
4614 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4615
4616 @smallexample
4617 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4618 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4619 (@value{GDBP}) r
4620 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4621
4622 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4623 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4624 (@value{GDBP}) c
4625 Continuing.
4626
4627 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4628 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4629 (@value{GDBP})
4630 @end smallexample
4631
4632 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4633 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4634 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4635
4636 @smallexample
4637 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4638 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4639 (@value{GDBP}) r
4640 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4641
4642 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4643 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4644 (@value{GDBP}) c
4645 Continuing.
4646
4647 Program exited normally.
4648 (@value{GDBP})
4649 @end smallexample
4650
4651 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4652
4653 @smallexample
4654 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4655 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4656 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4657 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4658 (@value{GDBP}) r
4659 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4660
4661 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4662 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4663
4664 (@value{GDBP}) c
4665 Continuing.
4666 @end smallexample
4667
4668 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4669 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4670 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4671 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4672
4673 @smallexample
4674 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4675 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4676 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4677 (@value{GDBP})
4678 @end smallexample
4679
4680 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4681 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4682 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4683 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4684 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4685 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4689 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4690 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4691 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4692 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4693 (@value{GDBP})
4694 @end smallexample
4695
4696 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4697
4698 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4699 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4700
4701 @smallexample
4702 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4703 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4704 @end smallexample
4705
4706 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4707
4708 @item fork
4709 @kindex catch fork
4710 A call to @code{fork}.
4711
4712 @item vfork
4713 @kindex catch vfork
4714 A call to @code{vfork}.
4715
4716 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4717 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4718 @kindex catch load
4719 @kindex catch unload
4720 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4721 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4722 matches one of the affected libraries.
4723
4724 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4725 @kindex catch signal
4726 The delivery of a signal.
4727
4728 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4729 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4730 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4731
4732 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4733 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4734 signal names.
4735
4736 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4737 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4738 will be caught.
4739
4740 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4741 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4742 catchpoint.
4743
4744 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4745 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4746 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4747 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4748 commands.
4749
4750 @end table
4751
4752 @item tcatch @var{event}
4753 @kindex tcatch
4754 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4755 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4756
4757 @end table
4758
4759 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4760
4761
4762 @node Delete Breaks
4763 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4764
4765 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4766 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4767 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4768 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4769 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4770 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4771
4772 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4773 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4774 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4775 their breakpoint numbers.
4776
4777 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4778 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4779 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4780
4781 @table @code
4782 @kindex clear
4783 @item clear
4784 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4785 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4786 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4787 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4788
4789 @item clear @var{location}
4790 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4791 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4792 most useful ones are listed below:
4793
4794 @table @code
4795 @item clear @var{function}
4796 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4797 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4798
4799 @item clear @var{linenum}
4800 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4801 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4802 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4803 @end table
4804
4805 @cindex delete breakpoints
4806 @kindex delete
4807 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4808 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4809 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4810 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4811 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4812 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4813 @end table
4814
4815 @node Disabling
4816 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4817
4818 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4819 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4820 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4821 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4822 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4823
4824 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4825 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4826 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4827 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4828 do not know which numbers to use.
4829
4830 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4831 affects all of its locations.
4832
4833 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4834 different states of enablement:
4835
4836 @itemize @bullet
4837 @item
4838 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4839 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4840 @item
4841 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4842 @item
4843 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4844 disabled.
4845 @item
4846 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4847 N times, then becomes disabled.
4848 @item
4849 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4850 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4851 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4852 @end itemize
4853
4854 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4855 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4856
4857 @table @code
4858 @kindex disable
4859 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4860 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4861 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4862 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4863 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4864 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4865 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4866
4867 @kindex enable
4868 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4869 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4870 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4871
4872 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4873 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4874 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4875
4876 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4877 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4878 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4879 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4880 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4881 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4882 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4883
4884 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4885 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4886 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4887 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4888 @end table
4889
4890 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4891 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4892 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4893 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4894 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4895 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4896 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4897 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4898 Stepping}.)
4899
4900 @node Conditions
4901 @subsection Break Conditions
4902 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4903 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4904
4905 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4906 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4907 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4908 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4909 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4910 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4911 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4912 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4913
4914 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4915 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4916 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4917 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4918 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4919
4920 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4921 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4922 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4923 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4924 one.
4925
4926 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4927 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4928 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4929 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4930 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4931 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4932 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4933 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4934 conditions for the
4935 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4936 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4937
4938 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4939 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4940 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4941 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4942 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4943 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4944
4945 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4946 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4947 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4948 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4949 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4950
4951 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4952 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4954 with the @code{condition} command.
4955
4956 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4957 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4958 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4959 catchpoint.
4960
4961 @table @code
4962 @kindex condition
4963 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4964 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4965 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4966 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4967 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4968 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4969 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4970 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4971 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4972 prints an error message:
4973
4974 @smallexample
4975 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4976 @end smallexample
4977
4978 @noindent
4979 @value{GDBN} does
4980 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4981 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4982 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4983
4984 @item condition @var{bnum}
4985 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4986 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4987 @end table
4988
4989 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4990 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4991 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4992 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4993 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4994 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4995 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4996 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4997 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4998 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4999 your program reaches it.
5000
5001 @table @code
5002 @kindex ignore
5003 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5004 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5005 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5006 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5007 takes no action.
5008
5009 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5010 a count of zero.
5011
5012 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5013 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5014 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5015 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5016
5017 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5018 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5019 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5020
5021 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5022 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5023 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5024 Variables}.
5025 @end table
5026
5027 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5028
5029
5030 @node Break Commands
5031 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5032
5033 @cindex breakpoint commands
5034 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5035 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5036 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5037 enable other breakpoints.
5038
5039 @table @code
5040 @kindex commands
5041 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5042 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5043 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5044 @itemx end
5045 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5046 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5047 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5048
5049 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5050 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5051
5052 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5053 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5054 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5055 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5056 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5057 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5058 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5059 Expressions}).
5060 @end table
5061
5062 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5063 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5064
5065 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5066 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5067 that resumes execution.
5068
5069 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5070 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5071 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5072 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5073 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5074
5075 @kindex silent
5076 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5077 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5078 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5079 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5080 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5081 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5082
5083 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5084 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5085 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5086
5087 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5088 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5089
5090 @smallexample
5091 break foo if x>0
5092 commands
5093 silent
5094 printf "x is %d\n",x
5095 cont
5096 end
5097 @end smallexample
5098
5099 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5100 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5101 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5102 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5103 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5104 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5105 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5106
5107 @smallexample
5108 break 403
5109 commands
5110 silent
5111 set x = y + 4
5112 cont
5113 end
5114 @end smallexample
5115
5116 @node Dynamic Printf
5117 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5118
5119 @cindex dynamic printf
5120 @cindex dprintf
5121 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5122 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5123 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5124 having to recompile it.
5125
5126 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5127 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5128 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5129 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5130 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5131 redirects to files and so forth.
5132
5133 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5134 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5135 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5136 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5137 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5138 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5139 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5140
5141 @table @code
5142 @kindex dprintf
5143 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5144 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5145 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5146 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5147
5148 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5149 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5150 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5151 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5152 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5153 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5154
5155 @table @code
5156 @item gdb
5157 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5158 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5159
5160 @item call
5161 @kindex dprintf-style call
5162 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5163 @code{printf}).
5164
5165 @item agent
5166 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5167 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5168 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5169 support running commands on the target.
5170 @end table
5171
5172 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5173 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5174 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5175 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5176 command.
5177
5178 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5179 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5180 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5181 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5182 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5183 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5184
5185 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5186 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5187 you could do the following:
5188
5189 @example
5190 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5191 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5192 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5193 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5194 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5195 (gdb) info break
5196 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5197 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5198 continue
5199 (gdb)
5200 @end example
5201
5202 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5203 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5204 the variable settings.
5205
5206 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5207 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5208 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5209 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5210 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5211 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5212
5213 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5214 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5215 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5216
5217 @end table
5218
5219 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5220 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5221 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5222 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5223 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5224 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5225
5226 @node Save Breakpoints
5227 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5228
5229 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5230 breakpoints}} command.
5231
5232 @table @code
5233 @kindex save breakpoints
5234 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5235 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5236 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5237 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5238 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5239 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5240 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5241 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5242 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5243 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5244 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5245 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5246 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5247 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5248 that can no longer be recreated.
5249 @end table
5250
5251 @node Static Probe Points
5252 @subsection Static Probe Points
5253
5254 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5255 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5256 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5257 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5258 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5259
5260 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5261 ELF-compatible systems:
5262
5263 @itemize @bullet
5264
5265 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5266 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5267 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5268 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5269 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5270 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5271 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5272 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5273
5274 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5275 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5276 C@t{++} languages.
5277 @end itemize
5278
5279 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5280 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5281 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5282 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5283 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5284 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5285 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5286 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5287 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5288
5289 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5290 probes}, with optional arguments:
5291
5292 @table @code
5293 @kindex info probes
5294 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5295 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5296 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5297 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5298
5299 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5300 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5301 probes from all providers are listed.
5302
5303 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5304 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5305 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5306
5307 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5308 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5309 given, all object files are considered.
5310
5311 @item info probes all
5312 List the available static probes, from all types.
5313 @end table
5314
5315 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5316 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5317 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5318 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5319 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5320
5321 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5322 commands, with optional arguments:
5323
5324 @table @code
5325 @kindex enable probes
5326 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5327 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5328 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5329 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5330
5331 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5332 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5333 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5334
5335 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5336 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5337 given, all object files are considered.
5338
5339 @kindex disable probes
5340 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5341 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5342 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5343 @end table
5344
5345 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5346 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5347 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5348 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5349 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5350 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5351 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5352 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5353 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5354 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5355 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5356 at the current probe point.
5357
5358 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5359 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5360 an error message.
5361
5362
5363 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5364 @node Error in Breakpoints
5365 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5366
5367 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5368 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5369
5370 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5371 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5372 @smallexample
5373 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5374 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5375 @end smallexample
5376
5377 @noindent
5378 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5379 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5380 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5381
5382 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5383 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5384
5385 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5386 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5387 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5388
5389 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5390 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5391 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5392 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5393
5394 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5395 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5396 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5397 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5398 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5399 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5400 first in the bundle.
5401
5402 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5403 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5404 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5405 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5406 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5407 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5408 is hit.
5409
5410 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5411 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5412
5413 @smallexample
5414 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5415 @end smallexample
5416
5417 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5418 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5419 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5420 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5421 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5422 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5423 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5424 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5425
5426 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5427 adjusted breakpoints:
5428
5429 @smallexample
5430 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5431 to 0x00010410.
5432 @end smallexample
5433
5434 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5435 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5436 frequently than expected.
5437
5438 @node Continuing and Stepping
5439 @section Continuing and Stepping
5440
5441 @cindex stepping
5442 @cindex continuing
5443 @cindex resuming execution
5444 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5445 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5446 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5447 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5448 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5449 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5450 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5451 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5452 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5453 handlers}).)
5454
5455 @table @code
5456 @kindex continue
5457 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5458 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5459 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5460 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5461 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5462 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5463 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5464 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5465 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5466 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5467
5468 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5469 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5470 @code{continue} is ignored.
5471
5472 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5473 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5474 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5475 @code{continue}.
5476 @end table
5477
5478 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5479 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5480 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5481 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5482
5483 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5484 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5485 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5486 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5487 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5488 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5489
5490 @table @code
5491 @kindex step
5492 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5493 @item step
5494 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5495 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5496 abbreviated @code{s}.
5497
5498 @quotation
5499 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5500 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5501 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5502 @c distinction here.
5503 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5504 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5505 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5506 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5507 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5508 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5509 below.
5510 @end quotation
5511
5512 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5513 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5514 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5515 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5516 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5517 called within the line.
5518
5519 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5520 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5521 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5522 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5523 was any debugging information about the routine.
5524
5525 @item step @var{count}
5526 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5527 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5528 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5529
5530 @kindex next
5531 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5532 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5533 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5534 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5535 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5536 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5537 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5538 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5539
5540 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5541
5542
5543 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5544 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5545 @c
5546 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5547 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5548 @c function are executed without stopping.
5549
5550 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5551 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5552 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5553
5554 @kindex set step-mode
5555 @item set step-mode
5556 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5557 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5558 @itemx set step-mode on
5559 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5560 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5561 information rather than stepping over it.
5562
5563 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5564 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5565 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5566
5567 @item set step-mode off
5568 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5569 debug information. This is the default.
5570
5571 @item show step-mode
5572 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5573 source line debug information.
5574
5575 @kindex finish
5576 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5577 @item finish
5578 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5579 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5580 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5581
5582 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5583 ,Returning from a Function}).
5584
5585 @kindex until
5586 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5587 @cindex run until specified location
5588 @item until
5589 @itemx u
5590 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5591 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5592 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5593 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5594 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5595 than the address of the jump.
5596
5597 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5598 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5599 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5600 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5601 through the next iteration.
5602
5603 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5604 stack frame.
5605
5606 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5607 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5608 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5609 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5610 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5611
5612 @smallexample
5613 (@value{GDBP}) f
5614 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5615 206 expand_input();
5616 (@value{GDBP}) until
5617 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5618 @end smallexample
5619
5620 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5621 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5622 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5623 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5624 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5625 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5626 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5627
5628 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5629 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5630 argument.
5631
5632 @item until @var{location}
5633 @itemx u @var{location}
5634 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5635 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5636 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5637 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5638 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5639 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5640 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5641 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5642 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5643 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5644 invocations have returned.
5645
5646 @smallexample
5647 94 int factorial (int value)
5648 95 @{
5649 96 if (value > 1) @{
5650 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5651 98 @}
5652 99 return (value);
5653 100 @}
5654 @end smallexample
5655
5656
5657 @kindex advance @var{location}
5658 @item advance @var{location}
5659 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5660 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5661 @ref{Specify Location}.
5662 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5663 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5664 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5665 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5666
5667
5668 @kindex stepi
5669 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5670 @item stepi
5671 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5672 @itemx si
5673 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5674
5675 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5676 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5677 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5678 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5679
5680 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5681
5682 @need 750
5683 @kindex nexti
5684 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5685 @item nexti
5686 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5687 @itemx ni
5688 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5689 proceed until the function returns.
5690
5691 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5692
5693 @end table
5694
5695 @anchor{range stepping}
5696 @cindex range stepping
5697 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5698 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5699 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5700 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5701 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5702 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5703 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5704 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5705 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5706 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5707 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5708 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5709 if necessary:
5710
5711 @table @code
5712 @kindex set range-stepping
5713 @kindex show range-stepping
5714 @item set range-stepping
5715 @itemx show range-stepping
5716 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5717
5718 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5719 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5720 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5721 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5722 default is @code{on}.
5723
5724 @end table
5725
5726 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5727 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5728 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5729
5730 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5731 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5732 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5733 a particular file when stepping.
5734
5735 For example, consider the following C function:
5736
5737 @smallexample
5738 101 int func()
5739 102 @{
5740 103 foo(boring());
5741 104 bar(boring());
5742 105 @}
5743 @end smallexample
5744
5745 @noindent
5746 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5747 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5748 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5749 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5750
5751 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5752 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5753 is called from many places.
5754
5755 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5756 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5757 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5758 @code{foo}.
5759
5760 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5761 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5762 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5763
5764 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5765 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5766 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5767 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5768 the underlying system.
5769 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5770 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5771
5772 @table @code
5773 @kindex skip
5774 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5775 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5776 that specify what to skip.
5777 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5778
5779 @table @code
5780 @item -file @var{file}
5781 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5782 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5783
5784 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5785 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5786 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5787 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5788 over when stepping.
5789
5790 @smallexample
5791 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5792 @end smallexample
5793
5794 @item -function @var{linespec}
5795 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5796 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5797 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5798 @xref{Specify Location}.
5799
5800 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5801 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5802 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5803 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5804
5805 This form is useful for complex function names.
5806 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5807 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5808 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5809 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5810 regular expression makes this easier.
5811
5812 @smallexample
5813 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5814 @end smallexample
5815
5816 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5817 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5818
5819 @smallexample
5820 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5821 @end smallexample
5822 @end table
5823
5824 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5825 will be skipped.
5826
5827 @kindex skip function
5828 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5829 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5830 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5831 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5832
5833 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5834 will be skipped.
5835
5836 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5837 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5838
5839 @kindex skip file
5840 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5841 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5842 will be skipped over when stepping.
5843
5844 @smallexample
5845 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5846 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5847 @end smallexample
5848
5849 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5850 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5851 @end table
5852
5853 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5854 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5855
5856 @table @code
5857 @kindex info skip
5858 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5859 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5860 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5861 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5862
5863 @table @emph
5864 @item Identifier
5865 A number identifying this skip.
5866 @item Enabled or Disabled
5867 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5868 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5869 @item Glob
5870 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5871 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5872 @item File
5873 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5874 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5875 @item RE
5876 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5877 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5878 @item Function
5879 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5880 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5881 @end table
5882
5883 @kindex skip delete
5884 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5885 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5886 skips.
5887
5888 @kindex skip enable
5889 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5890 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5891 skips.
5892
5893 @kindex skip disable
5894 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5895 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5896 skips.
5897
5898 @kindex set debug skip
5899 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5900 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5901
5902 @kindex show debug skip
5903 @item show debug skip
5904 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5905
5906 @end table
5907
5908 @node Signals
5909 @section Signals
5910 @cindex signals
5911
5912 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5913 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5914 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5915 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5916 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5917 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5918 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5919 requested an alarm).
5920
5921 @cindex fatal signals
5922 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5923 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5924 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5925 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5926 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5927 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5928
5929 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5930 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5931 signal.
5932
5933 @cindex handling signals
5934 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5935 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5936 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5937 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5938 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5939
5940 @table @code
5941 @kindex info signals
5942 @kindex info handle
5943 @item info signals
5944 @itemx info handle
5945 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5946 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5947 the defined types of signals.
5948
5949 @item info signals @var{sig}
5950 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5951
5952 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5953
5954 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5955 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5956 for details about this command.
5957
5958 @kindex handle
5959 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5960 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5961 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5962 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5963 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5964 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5965 say what change to make.
5966 @end table
5967
5968 @c @group
5969 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5970 Their full names are:
5971
5972 @table @code
5973 @item nostop
5974 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5975 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5976
5977 @item stop
5978 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5979 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5980
5981 @item print
5982 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5983
5984 @item noprint
5985 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5986 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5987
5988 @item pass
5989 @itemx noignore
5990 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5991 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5992 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5993
5994 @item nopass
5995 @itemx ignore
5996 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5997 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5998 @end table
5999 @c @end group
6000
6001 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6002 program until you
6003 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6004 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6005 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6006 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6007 program sees that signal when you continue.
6008
6009 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6010 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6011 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6012 erroneous signals.
6013
6014 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6015 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6016 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6017 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6018 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6019 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6020 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6021 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6022 Program a Signal}.
6023
6024 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6025 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6026
6027 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6028 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6029 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6030 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6031 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6032 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6033 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6034 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6035 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6036 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6037 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6038 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6039 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6040
6041 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6042
6043 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6044 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6045 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6046 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6047
6048 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6049 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6050 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6051 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6052
6053 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6054 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6055
6056 @smallexample
6057 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6058 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6059 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6060 (@value{GDBP}) c
6061 Continuing.
6062
6063 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6064 main () sigusr1.c:28
6065 28 p = 0;
6066 (@value{GDBP}) si
6067 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6068 9 @{
6069 @end smallexample
6070
6071 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6072 program to receive the signal first:
6073
6074 @smallexample
6075 (@value{GDBP}) n
6076 28 p = 0;
6077 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6078 (@value{GDBP}) si
6079 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6080 9 @{
6081 (@value{GDBP})
6082 @end smallexample
6083
6084 @cindex extra signal information
6085 @anchor{extra signal information}
6086
6087 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6088 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6089 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6090 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6091 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6092 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6093 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6094 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6095 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6096 system header.
6097
6098 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6099 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6100
6101 @smallexample
6102 @group
6103 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6104 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6105 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6106 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6107 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6108 type = struct @{
6109 int si_signo;
6110 int si_errno;
6111 int si_code;
6112 union @{
6113 int _pad[28];
6114 struct @{...@} _kill;
6115 struct @{...@} _timer;
6116 struct @{...@} _rt;
6117 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6118 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6119 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6120 @} _sifields;
6121 @}
6122 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6123 type = struct @{
6124 void *si_addr;
6125 @}
6126 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6127 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6128 @end group
6129 @end smallexample
6130
6131 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6132
6133 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6134 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6135 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6136 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6137 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6138 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6139 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6140 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6141 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6142 information is displayed.
6143
6144 The usual output of a segfault is:
6145 @smallexample
6146 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6147 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6148 68 value = *(p + len);
6149 @end smallexample
6150
6151 While a bound violation is presented as:
6152 @smallexample
6153 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6154 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6155 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6156 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6157 68 value = *(p + len);
6158 @end smallexample
6159
6160 @node Thread Stops
6161 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6162
6163 @cindex stopped threads
6164 @cindex threads, stopped
6165
6166 @cindex continuing threads
6167 @cindex threads, continuing
6168
6169 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6170 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6171 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6172 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6173 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6174 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6175 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6176 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6177 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6178
6179 @menu
6180 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6181 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6182 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6183 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6184 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6185 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6186 @end menu
6187
6188 @node All-Stop Mode
6189 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6190
6191 @cindex all-stop mode
6192
6193 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6194 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6195 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6196 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6197 underfoot.
6198
6199 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6200 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6201 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6202
6203 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6204 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6205 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6206 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6207 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6208 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6209 stops.
6210
6211 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6212 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6213 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6214 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6215
6216 @cindex automatic thread selection
6217 @cindex switching threads automatically
6218 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6219 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6220 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6221 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6222 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6223 thread.
6224
6225 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6226 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6227
6228 @table @code
6229 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6230 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6231 @cindex lock scheduler
6232 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6233 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6234 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6235 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6236 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6237 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6238 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6239 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6240 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6241 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6242 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6243 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6244 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6245 @code{on} in replay mode.
6246
6247 @item show scheduler-locking
6248 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6249 @end table
6250
6251 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6252 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6253 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6254 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6255 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6256 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6257 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6258 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6259 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6260 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6261 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6262 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6263 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6264 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6265
6266 @table @code
6267 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6268 @item set schedule-multiple
6269 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6270 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6271 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6272 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6273 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6274 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6275
6276 @item show schedule-multiple
6277 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6278 multiple processes.
6279 @end table
6280
6281 @node Non-Stop Mode
6282 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6283
6284 @cindex non-stop mode
6285
6286 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6287 @c with more details.
6288
6289 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6290 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6291 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6292 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6293 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6294 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6295
6296 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6297 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6298 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6299 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6300 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6301 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6302 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6303 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6304 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6305 independently and simultaneously.
6306
6307 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6308 or attach to your program:
6309
6310 @smallexample
6311 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6312 set pagination off
6313
6314 # Finally, turn it on!
6315 set non-stop on
6316 @end smallexample
6317
6318 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6319
6320 @table @code
6321 @kindex set non-stop
6322 @item set non-stop on
6323 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6324 @item set non-stop off
6325 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6326 @kindex show non-stop
6327 @item show non-stop
6328 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6329 @end table
6330
6331 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6332 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6333 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6334 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6335 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6336 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6337 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6338 default.
6339
6340 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6341 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6342 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6343
6344 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6345 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6346 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6347 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6348 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6349
6350 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6351 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6352 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6353 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6354 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6355
6356 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6357
6358 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6359 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6360 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6361 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6362 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6363 previously current thread.
6364
6365 @node Background Execution
6366 @subsection Background Execution
6367
6368 @cindex foreground execution
6369 @cindex background execution
6370 @cindex asynchronous execution
6371 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6372
6373 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6374 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6375 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6376 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6377 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6378 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6379
6380 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6381 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6382
6383 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6384 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6385 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6386 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6387 are:
6388
6389 @table @code
6390 @kindex run&
6391 @item run
6392 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6393
6394 @item attach
6395 @kindex attach&
6396 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6397
6398 @item step
6399 @kindex step&
6400 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6401
6402 @item stepi
6403 @kindex stepi&
6404 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6405
6406 @item next
6407 @kindex next&
6408 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6409
6410 @item nexti
6411 @kindex nexti&
6412 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6413
6414 @item continue
6415 @kindex continue&
6416 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6417
6418 @item finish
6419 @kindex finish&
6420 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6421
6422 @item until
6423 @kindex until&
6424 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6425
6426 @end table
6427
6428 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6429 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6430 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6431 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6432 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6433 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6434
6435 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6436 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6437
6438 @table @code
6439 @kindex interrupt
6440 @item interrupt
6441 @itemx interrupt -a
6442
6443 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6444 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6445 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6446 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6447 @end table
6448
6449 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6450 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6451
6452 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6453 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6454 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6455
6456 @table @code
6457 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6458 @cindex thread breakpoints
6459 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6460 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6461 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6462 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6463 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6464 specify some source line.
6465
6466 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6467 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6468 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6469 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6470 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6471
6472 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6473 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6474 program.
6475
6476 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6477 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6478 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6479
6480 @smallexample
6481 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6482 @end smallexample
6483
6484 @end table
6485
6486 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6487 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6488 thread list. For example:
6489
6490 @smallexample
6491 (@value{GDBP}) c
6492 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6493 @end smallexample
6494
6495 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6496 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6497 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6498 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6499 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6500 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6501 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6502 command.
6503
6504 @node Interrupted System Calls
6505 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6506
6507 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6508 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6509 @cindex premature return from system calls
6510 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6511 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6512 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6513 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6514 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6515 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6516 stop execution.
6517
6518 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6519 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6520 style anyways.
6521
6522 For example, do not write code like this:
6523
6524 @smallexample
6525 sleep (10);
6526 @end smallexample
6527
6528 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6529 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6530
6531 Instead, write this:
6532
6533 @smallexample
6534 int unslept = 10;
6535 while (unslept > 0)
6536 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6537 @end smallexample
6538
6539 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6540 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6541 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6542 @value{GDBN}.
6543
6544 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6545 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6546 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6547 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6548
6549 @node Observer Mode
6550 @subsection Observer Mode
6551
6552 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6553 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6554 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6555 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6556 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6557
6558 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6559 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6560 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6561 mode.
6562
6563 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6564 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6565 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6566 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6567 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6568
6569 @table @code
6570
6571 @kindex observer
6572 @item set observer on
6573 @itemx set observer off
6574 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6575 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6576 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6577 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6578
6579 @item show observer
6580 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6581
6582 @kindex may-write-registers
6583 @item set may-write-registers on
6584 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6585 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6586 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6587 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6588
6589 @item show may-write-registers
6590 Show the current permission to write registers.
6591
6592 @kindex may-write-memory
6593 @item set may-write-memory on
6594 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6595 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6596 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6597 defaults to @code{on}.
6598
6599 @item show may-write-memory
6600 Show the current permission to write memory.
6601
6602 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6603 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6604 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6605 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6606 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6607 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6608
6609 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6610 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6611
6612 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6613 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6614 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6615 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6616 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6617 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6618 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6619
6620 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6621 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6622
6623 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6624 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6625 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6626 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6627 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6628 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6629 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6630
6631 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6632 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6633
6634 @kindex may-interrupt
6635 @item set may-interrupt on
6636 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6637 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6638 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6639 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6640 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6641
6642 @item show may-interrupt
6643 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6644
6645 @end table
6646
6647 @node Reverse Execution
6648 @chapter Running programs backward
6649 @cindex reverse execution
6650 @cindex running programs backward
6651
6652 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6653 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6654 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6655 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6656
6657 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6658 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6659 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6660 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6661 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6662 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6663
6664 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6665 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6666 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6667 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6668 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6669 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6670 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6671 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6672 prior values@footnote{
6673 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6674 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6675 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6676
6677 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6678 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6679 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6680 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6681 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6682 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6683 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6684 }.
6685
6686 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6687 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6688
6689 @table @code
6690 @kindex reverse-continue
6691 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6692 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6693 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6694 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6695 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6696 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6697 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6698
6699 @kindex reverse-step
6700 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6701 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6702 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6703 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6704
6705 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6706 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6707 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6708 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6709 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6710 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6711
6712 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6713 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6714
6715 @kindex reverse-stepi
6716 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6717 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6718 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6719 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6720 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6721 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6722 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6723
6724 @kindex reverse-next
6725 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6726 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6727 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6728 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6729 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6730 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6731 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6732 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6733 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6734 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6735
6736 @kindex reverse-nexti
6737 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6738 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6739 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6740 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6741 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6742 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6743 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6744 frame) is reached.
6745
6746 @kindex reverse-finish
6747 @item reverse-finish
6748 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6749 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6750 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6751 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6752
6753 @kindex set exec-direction
6754 @item set exec-direction
6755 Set the direction of target execution.
6756 @item set exec-direction reverse
6757 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6758 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6759 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6760 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6761 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6762 @item set exec-direction forward
6763 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6764 This is the default.
6765 @end table
6766
6767
6768 @node Process Record and Replay
6769 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6770 @cindex process record and replay
6771 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6772
6773 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6774 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6775 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6776
6777 @cindex replay mode
6778 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6779 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6780 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6781 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6782 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6783 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6784 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6785 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6786 execution log.
6787
6788 @cindex record mode
6789 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6790 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6791 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6792 for future replay.
6793
6794 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6795 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6796 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6797 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6798 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6799 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6800
6801 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6802 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6803 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6804 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6805
6806 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6807 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6808
6809 @table @code
6810 @kindex target record
6811 @kindex target record-full
6812 @kindex target record-btrace
6813 @kindex record
6814 @kindex record full
6815 @kindex record btrace
6816 @kindex record btrace bts
6817 @kindex record btrace pt
6818 @kindex record bts
6819 @kindex record pt
6820 @kindex rec
6821 @kindex rec full
6822 @kindex rec btrace
6823 @kindex rec btrace bts
6824 @kindex rec btrace pt
6825 @kindex rec bts
6826 @kindex rec pt
6827 @item record @var{method}
6828 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6829 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6830 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6831 recording methods are available:
6832
6833 @table @code
6834 @item full
6835 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6836 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6837 execution.
6838
6839 @item btrace @var{format}
6840 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6841 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6842 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6843 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6844 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6845 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6846 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6847
6848 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6849 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6850 formats are available:
6851
6852 @table @code
6853 @item bts
6854 @cindex branch trace store
6855 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6856 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6857 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6858
6859 @item pt
6860 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6861 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6862 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6863 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6864
6865 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6866 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6867 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6868
6869 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6870 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6871 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6872 buffer-size with care.
6873 @end table
6874
6875 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6876 @end table
6877
6878 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6879 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6880 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6881 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6882
6883 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6884 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6885 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6886 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6887 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6888
6889 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6890 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6891 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6892 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6893 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6894 does not support these two modes.
6895
6896 @kindex record stop
6897 @kindex rec s
6898 @item record stop
6899 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6900 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6901 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6902
6903 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6904 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6905 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6906 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6907 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6908
6909 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6910 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6911 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6912 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6913 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6914
6915 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6916 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6917
6918 @kindex record goto
6919 @item record goto
6920 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6921 ways to specify the location to go to:
6922
6923 @table @code
6924 @item record goto begin
6925 @itemx record goto start
6926 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6927
6928 @item record goto end
6929 Go to the end of the execution log.
6930
6931 @item record goto @var{n}
6932 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6933 @end table
6934
6935 @kindex record save
6936 @item record save @var{filename}
6937 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6938 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6939 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6940
6941 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6942
6943 @kindex record restore
6944 @item record restore @var{filename}
6945 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6946 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6947
6948 @kindex set record full
6949 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6950 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6951 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6952 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6953
6954 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6955 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6956 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6957 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6958 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6959 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6960 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6961 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6962
6963 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6964 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6965 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6966
6967 @kindex show record full
6968 @item show record full insn-number-max
6969 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6970 recording method.
6971
6972 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6973 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6974 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6975 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6976 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6977 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6978 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6979 oldest one to be deleted.
6980
6981 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6982 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6983
6984 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6985 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6986
6987 @item set record full memory-query
6988 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6989 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6990 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6991 case.
6992
6993 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6994 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6995 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6996 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6997 results.
6998
6999 @item show record full memory-query
7000 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7001
7002 @kindex set record btrace
7003 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7004 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7005 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7006 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7007 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7008 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7009 You can use the following command for that:
7010
7011 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7012 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7013 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7014 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7015 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7016 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7017 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7018 position.
7019
7020 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7021 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7022 errata when decoding the trace.
7023
7024 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7025 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7026 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7027 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7028 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7029 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7030 which the trace was recorded.
7031
7032 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7033 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7034 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7035 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7036 disable the workarounds.
7037
7038 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7039 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7040 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7041 (default).
7042
7043 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7044 identifiers are currently supported:
7045
7046 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7047
7048 @item @code{intel}
7049 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7050
7051 @end multitable
7052
7053 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7054 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7055
7056 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7057 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7058 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7059
7060 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7061 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7062 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7063 supports.
7064
7065 @smallexample
7066 (gdb) info record
7067 Active record target: record-btrace
7068 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7069 Buffer size: 16kB.
7070 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7071 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7072 (gdb) info record
7073 Active record target: record-btrace
7074 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7075 Buffer size: 16kB.
7076 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7077 @end smallexample
7078
7079 @kindex show record btrace
7080 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7081 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7082
7083 @item show record btrace cpu
7084 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7085 workarounds.
7086
7087 @kindex set record btrace bts
7088 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7089 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7090 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7091 format. Default is 64KB.
7092
7093 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7094 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7095 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7096 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7097 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7098 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7099 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7100
7101 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7102 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7103
7104 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7105 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7106
7107 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7108 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7109 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7110
7111 @kindex set record btrace pt
7112 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7113 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7114 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7115 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7116
7117 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7118 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7119 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7120 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7121 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7122 actual buffer size for each thread.
7123
7124 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7125 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7126
7127 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7128 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7129
7130 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7131 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7132 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7133
7134 @kindex info record
7135 @item info record
7136 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7137 method:
7138
7139 @table @code
7140 @item full
7141 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7142 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7143
7144 @itemize @bullet
7145 @item
7146 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7147 @item
7148 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7149 @item
7150 Highest recorded instruction number.
7151 @item
7152 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7153 @item
7154 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7155 @item
7156 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7157 @end itemize
7158
7159 @item btrace
7160 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7161
7162 @itemize @bullet
7163 @item
7164 Recording format.
7165 @item
7166 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7167 @item
7168 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7169 instructions.
7170 @item
7171 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7172 @end itemize
7173
7174 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7175 @itemize @bullet
7176 @item
7177 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7178 @end itemize
7179
7180 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7181 @itemize @bullet
7182 @item
7183 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7184 @end itemize
7185 @end table
7186
7187 @kindex record delete
7188 @kindex rec del
7189 @item record delete
7190 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7191 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7192 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7193 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7194
7195 @kindex record instruction-history
7196 @kindex rec instruction-history
7197 @item record instruction-history
7198 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7199 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7200 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7201 are printed in execution order.
7202
7203 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7204 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7205 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7206
7207 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7208 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7209 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7210 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7211 @code{/p} modifier.
7212
7213 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7214 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7215 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7216
7217 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7218 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7219
7220 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7221 disassemble:
7222
7223 @table @code
7224 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7225 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7226 @var{insn}.
7227
7228 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7229 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7230 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7231 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7232 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7233 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7234
7235 @item record instruction-history
7236 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7237
7238 @item record instruction-history -
7239 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7240
7241 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7242 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7243 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7244 number @var{end} is included.
7245 @end table
7246
7247 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7248
7249 @kindex set record
7250 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7251 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7252 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7253 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7254 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7255
7256 @kindex show record
7257 @item show record instruction-history-size
7258 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7259 instruction-history} command.
7260
7261 @kindex record function-call-history
7262 @kindex rec function-call-history
7263 @item record function-call-history
7264 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7265 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7266 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7267 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7268 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7269 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7270 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7271 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7272 given together.
7273
7274 @smallexample
7275 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7276 1 void foo (void)
7277 2 @{
7278 3 @}
7279 4
7280 5 void bar (void)
7281 6 @{
7282 7 ...
7283 8 foo ();
7284 9 ...
7285 10 @}
7286 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7287 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7288 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7289 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7290 @end smallexample
7291
7292 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7293 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7294 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7295 to print:
7296
7297 @table @code
7298 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7299 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7300
7301 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7302 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7303 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7304 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7305 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7306
7307 @item record function-call-history
7308 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7309
7310 @item record function-call-history -
7311 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7312
7313 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7314 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7315 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7316 @end table
7317
7318 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7319
7320 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7321 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7322 Define how many lines to print in the
7323 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7324 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7325
7326 @item show record function-call-history-size
7327 Show how many lines to print in the
7328 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7329 @end table
7330
7331
7332 @node Stack
7333 @chapter Examining the Stack
7334
7335 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7336 stopped and how it got there.
7337
7338 @cindex call stack
7339 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7340 is generated.
7341 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7342 the arguments of the call,
7343 and the local variables of the function being called.
7344 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7345 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7346 stack}.
7347
7348 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7349 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7350
7351 @cindex selected frame
7352 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7353 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7354 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7355 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7356 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7357 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7358
7359 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7360 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7361 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7362
7363 @menu
7364 * Frames:: Stack frames
7365 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7366 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7367 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7368 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7369 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7370
7371 @end menu
7372
7373 @node Frames
7374 @section Stack Frames
7375
7376 @cindex frame, definition
7377 @cindex stack frame
7378 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7379 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7380 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7381 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7382 which the function is executing.
7383
7384 @cindex initial frame
7385 @cindex outermost frame
7386 @cindex innermost frame
7387 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7388 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7389 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7390 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7391 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7392 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7393 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7394 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7395
7396 @cindex frame pointer
7397 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7398 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7399 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7400 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7401 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7402 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7403
7404 @cindex frame level
7405 @cindex frame number
7406 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7407 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7408 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7409 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7410 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7411 describe this number.
7412
7413 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7414 @c underflow problems.
7415 @cindex frameless execution
7416 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7417 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7418 @smallexample
7419 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7420 @end smallexample
7421 generates functions without a frame.)
7422 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7423 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7424 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7425 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7426 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7427 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7428 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7429
7430 @node Backtrace
7431 @section Backtraces
7432
7433 @cindex traceback
7434 @cindex call stack traces
7435 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7436 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7437 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7438 stack.
7439
7440 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7441 @kindex backtrace
7442 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7443 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7444 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7445 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7446 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7447 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7448
7449 @table @code
7450 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7451 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7452 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7453 be one of the following:
7454
7455 @table @code
7456 @item @var{n}
7457 @itemx @var{n}
7458 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7459 number.
7460
7461 @item -@var{n}
7462 @itemx -@var{n}
7463 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7464 number.
7465
7466 @item full
7467 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7468 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7469
7470 @item no-filters
7471 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7472 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7473 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7474 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7475 support.
7476
7477 @item hide
7478 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7479 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7480 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7481 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7482 @end table
7483 @end table
7484
7485 @kindex where
7486 @kindex info stack
7487 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7488 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7489
7490 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7491 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7492 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7493 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7494 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7495 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7496 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7497 multi-threaded program.
7498
7499 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7500 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7501 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7502 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7503 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7504 line number.
7505
7506 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7507 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7508
7509 @smallexample
7510 @group
7511 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7512 at builtin.c:993
7513 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7514 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7515 at macro.c:71
7516 (More stack frames follow...)
7517 @end group
7518 @end smallexample
7519
7520 @noindent
7521 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7522 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7523 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7524
7525 @noindent
7526 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7527 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7528 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7529 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7530 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7531
7532 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7533 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7534 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7535 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7536 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7537 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7538 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7539 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7540 such a backtrace might look like:
7541
7542 @smallexample
7543 @group
7544 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7545 at builtin.c:993
7546 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7547 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7548 at macro.c:71
7549 (More stack frames follow...)
7550 @end group
7551 @end smallexample
7552
7553 @noindent
7554 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7555 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7556
7557 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7558 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7559 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7560
7561 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7562 @cindex program entry point
7563 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7564 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7565 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7566 @code{main}@footnote{
7567 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7568 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7569 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7570 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7571 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7572 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7573
7574 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7575 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7576
7577 @table @code
7578 @item set backtrace past-main
7579 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7580 @kindex set backtrace
7581 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7582
7583 @item set backtrace past-main off
7584 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7585 default.
7586
7587 @item show backtrace past-main
7588 @kindex show backtrace
7589 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7590
7591 @item set backtrace past-entry
7592 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7593 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7594 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7595 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7596
7597 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7598 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7599 application. This is the default.
7600
7601 @item show backtrace past-entry
7602 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7603
7604 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7605 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7606 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7607 @cindex backtrace limit
7608 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7609 or zero means unlimited levels.
7610
7611 @item show backtrace limit
7612 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7613 @end table
7614
7615 You can control how file names are displayed.
7616
7617 @table @code
7618 @item set filename-display
7619 @itemx set filename-display relative
7620 @cindex filename-display
7621 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7622
7623 @item set filename-display basename
7624 Display only basename of a filename.
7625
7626 @item set filename-display absolute
7627 Display an absolute filename.
7628
7629 @item show filename-display
7630 Show the current way to display filenames.
7631 @end table
7632
7633 @node Selection
7634 @section Selecting a Frame
7635
7636 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7637 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7638 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7639 of the stack frame just selected.
7640
7641 @table @code
7642 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7643 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7644 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7645 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7646 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7647 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7648
7649 @table @code
7650 @kindex frame level
7651 @item @var{num}
7652 @item level @var{num}
7653 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7654 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7655 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
7656 for @code{main}.
7657
7658 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
7659 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
7660 commands are equivalent:
7661
7662 @smallexample
7663 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
7664 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
7665 @end smallexample
7666
7667 @kindex frame address
7668 @item address @var{stack-address}
7669 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
7670 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
7671 @command{info frame}, for example:
7672
7673 @smallexample
7674 (gdb) info frame
7675 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7676 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
7677 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
7678 source language c++.
7679 Arglist at unknown address.
7680 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
7681 @end smallexample
7682
7683 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
7684 indicated by the line:
7685
7686 @smallexample
7687 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7688 @end smallexample
7689
7690 @kindex frame function
7691 @item function @var{function-name}
7692 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
7693 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
7694 most stack frame is selected.
7695
7696 @kindex frame view
7697 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
7698 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
7699 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
7700 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
7701
7702 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
7703 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
7704 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
7705 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
7706
7707 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
7708 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
7709 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
7710 for example @command{frame level 0}.
7711
7712 @end table
7713
7714 @kindex up
7715 @item up @var{n}
7716 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7717 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7718 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7719
7720 @kindex down
7721 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7722 @item down @var{n}
7723 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7724 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7725 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7726 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7727 @end table
7728
7729 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7730 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7731 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7732 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7733
7734 @need 1000
7735 For example:
7736
7737 @smallexample
7738 @group
7739 (@value{GDBP}) up
7740 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7741 at env.c:10
7742 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7743 @end group
7744 @end smallexample
7745
7746 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7747 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7748 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7749 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7750 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7751 for details.
7752
7753 @table @code
7754 @kindex select-frame
7755 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7756 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7757 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7758 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7759 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
7760 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
7761 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7762
7763 @kindex down-silently
7764 @kindex up-silently
7765 @item up-silently @var{n}
7766 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7767 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7768 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7769 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7770 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7771 distracting.
7772 @end table
7773
7774 @node Frame Info
7775 @section Information About a Frame
7776
7777 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7778 stack frame.
7779
7780 @table @code
7781 @item frame
7782 @itemx f
7783 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7784 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7785 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7786 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7787 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7788
7789 @kindex info frame
7790 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7791 @item info frame
7792 @itemx info f
7793 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7794 including:
7795
7796 @itemize @bullet
7797 @item
7798 the address of the frame
7799 @item
7800 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7801 @item
7802 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7803 @item
7804 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7805 @item
7806 the address of the frame's arguments
7807 @item
7808 the address of the frame's local variables
7809 @item
7810 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7811 @item
7812 which registers were saved in the frame
7813 @end itemize
7814
7815 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7816 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7817 the usual conventions.
7818
7819 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7820 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7821 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
7822 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
7823 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
7824 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
7825
7826 @kindex info args
7827 @item info args
7828 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7829
7830 @item info locals
7831 @kindex info locals
7832 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7833 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7834 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7835
7836 @end table
7837
7838 @node Frame Apply
7839 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7840 @kindex frame apply
7841 @cindex apply command to several frames
7842 @table @code
7843 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7844 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7845 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7846
7847 @table @code
7848 @item @code{all}
7849 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7850
7851 @item @var{count}
7852 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7853 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7854
7855 @item @var{-count}
7856 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7857 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7858
7859 @item @code{level}
7860 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7861 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7862 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7863 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7864 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7865 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7866
7867 @end table
7868
7869 @end table
7870
7871 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7872 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7873 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7874 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7875
7876 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7877 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7878 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7879 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7880 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7881
7882 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7883 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7884 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7885 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7886
7887 @table @code
7888 @item -c
7889 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7890 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7891 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7892 @item -s
7893 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7894 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7895 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7896 are not printed.
7897 @item -q
7898 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7899 information.
7900 @end table
7901
7902 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7903 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7904 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7905 @code{#1 main} frame.
7906
7907 @smallexample
7908 @group
7909 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7910 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7911 No symbol "j" in current context.
7912 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7913 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7914 No symbol "j" in current context.
7915 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7916 $1 = 5
7917 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7918 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7919 $2 = 5
7920 (gdb)
7921 @end group
7922 @end smallexample
7923
7924 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7925 information before the command output:
7926
7927 @smallexample
7928 @group
7929 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
7930 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7931 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7932 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7933 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7934 (gdb)
7935 @end group
7936 @end smallexample
7937
7938 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
7939 @smallexample
7940 @group
7941 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
7942 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7943 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7944 (gdb)
7945 @end group
7946 @end smallexample
7947
7948 @table @code
7949
7950 @kindex faas
7951 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
7952 @item faas @var{command}
7953 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
7954 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
7955
7956 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
7957 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
7958 is, using:
7959 @smallexample
7960 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
7961 @end smallexample
7962
7963 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
7964 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
7965 @end table
7966
7967
7968 @node Frame Filter Management
7969 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7970 @cindex managing frame filters
7971
7972 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7973 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7974
7975 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7976 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7977
7978 @table @code
7979 @kindex info frame-filter
7980 @item info frame-filter
7981 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7982 their name, priority and enabled status.
7983
7984 @kindex disable frame-filter
7985 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7986 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7987 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7988 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7989 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7990 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7991 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7992 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7993 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7994 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7995 may be enabled again later.
7996
7997 @kindex enable frame-filter
7998 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7999 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8000 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8001 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8002 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8003 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8004 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8005 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8006 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8007
8008 Example:
8009
8010 @smallexample
8011 (gdb) info frame-filter
8012
8013 global frame-filters:
8014 Priority Enabled Name
8015 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8016 100 Yes Reverse
8017
8018 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8019 Priority Enabled Name
8020 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8021
8022 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8023 Priority Enabled Name
8024 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8025
8026 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8027 (gdb) info frame-filter
8028
8029 global frame-filters:
8030 Priority Enabled Name
8031 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8032 100 Yes Reverse
8033
8034 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8035 Priority Enabled Name
8036 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8037
8038 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8039 Priority Enabled Name
8040 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8041
8042 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8043 (gdb) info frame-filter
8044
8045 global frame-filters:
8046 Priority Enabled Name
8047 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8048 100 Yes Reverse
8049
8050 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8051 Priority Enabled Name
8052 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8053
8054 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8055 Priority Enabled Name
8056 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8057 @end smallexample
8058
8059 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8060 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8061 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8062 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8063 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8064 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8065 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8066
8067 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8068 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8069 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8070 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8071 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8072 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8073 dictionary resides.
8074
8075 Example:
8076
8077 @smallexample
8078 (gdb) info frame-filter
8079
8080 global frame-filters:
8081 Priority Enabled Name
8082 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8083 100 Yes Reverse
8084
8085 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8086 Priority Enabled Name
8087 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8088
8089 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8090 Priority Enabled Name
8091 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8092
8093 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8094 (gdb) info frame-filter
8095
8096 global frame-filters:
8097 Priority Enabled Name
8098 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8099 50 Yes Reverse
8100
8101 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8102 Priority Enabled Name
8103 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8104
8105 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8106 Priority Enabled Name
8107 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8108 @end smallexample
8109 @end table
8110
8111 @node Source
8112 @chapter Examining Source Files
8113
8114 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8115 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8116 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8117 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8118 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8119 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8120 source files by explicit command.
8121
8122 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8123 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8124 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8125
8126 @menu
8127 * List:: Printing source lines
8128 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8129 * Edit:: Editing source files
8130 * Search:: Searching source files
8131 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8132 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8133 @end menu
8134
8135 @node List
8136 @section Printing Source Lines
8137
8138 @kindex list
8139 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8140 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8141 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8142 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8143 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8144
8145 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8146
8147 @table @code
8148 @item list @var{linenum}
8149 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8150 current source file.
8151
8152 @item list @var{function}
8153 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8154 @var{function}.
8155
8156 @item list
8157 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8158 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8159 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8160 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8161 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8162
8163 @item list -
8164 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8165 @end table
8166
8167 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8168 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8169 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8170
8171 @table @code
8172 @kindex set listsize
8173 @item set listsize @var{count}
8174 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8175 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8176 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8177 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8178
8179 @kindex show listsize
8180 @item show listsize
8181 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8182 @end table
8183
8184 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8185 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8186 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8187 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8188 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8189
8190 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8191 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8192 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8193 to specify some source line.
8194
8195 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8196
8197 @table @code
8198 @item list @var{location}
8199 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8200
8201 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8202 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8203 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8204 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8205 the same source file as the first location.
8206
8207 @item list ,@var{last}
8208 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8209
8210 @item list @var{first},
8211 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8212
8213 @item list +
8214 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8215
8216 @item list -
8217 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8218
8219 @item list
8220 As described in the preceding table.
8221 @end table
8222
8223 @node Specify Location
8224 @section Specifying a Location
8225 @cindex specifying location
8226 @cindex location
8227 @cindex source location
8228
8229 @menu
8230 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8231 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8232 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8233 @end menu
8234
8235 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8236 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8237 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8238 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8239 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8240
8241 @node Linespec Locations
8242 @subsection Linespec Locations
8243 @cindex linespec locations
8244
8245 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8246 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8247 specifying a linespec:
8248
8249 @table @code
8250 @item @var{linenum}
8251 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8252
8253 @item -@var{offset}
8254 @itemx +@var{offset}
8255 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8256 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8257 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8258 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8259 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8260 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8261 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8262 linespec.
8263
8264 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8265 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8266 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8267 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8268 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8269 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8270 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8271
8272 @item @var{function}
8273 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8274 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8275
8276 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8277 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8278 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8279 means in all packages.
8280
8281 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8282 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8283 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8284
8285 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8286 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8287 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8288 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8289
8290 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8291
8292 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8293 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8294
8295 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8296 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8297 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8298 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8299 functions in different source files.
8300
8301 @item @var{label}
8302 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8303 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8304 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8305 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8306
8307 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8308 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8309 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8310 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8311 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8312 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8313
8314 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8315 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8316 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8317 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8318 each one of those probes.
8319 @end table
8320
8321 @node Explicit Locations
8322 @subsection Explicit Locations
8323 @cindex explicit locations
8324
8325 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8326 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8327
8328 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8329 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8330 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8331 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8332 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8333
8334 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8335 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8336 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8337 the symbol table to know.
8338
8339 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8340 following table:
8341
8342 @table @code
8343 @item -source @var{filename}
8344 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8345 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8346 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8347 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8348 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8349
8350 @item -function @var{function}
8351 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8352 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8353 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8354 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8355
8356 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8357 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8358 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8359 means in all packages.
8360
8361 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8362 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8363 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8364 breakpoint on both symbols.
8365
8366 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8367
8368 @item -qualified
8369
8370 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8371 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8372
8373 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8374 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8375 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8376
8377 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8378 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8379 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8380
8381 @item -label @var{label}
8382 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8383 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8384 selected stack frame.
8385
8386 @item -line @var{number}
8387 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8388 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8389 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8390 relative to the current line.
8391 @end table
8392
8393 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8394 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8395
8396 @node Address Locations
8397 @subsection Address Locations
8398 @cindex address locations
8399
8400 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8401 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8402
8403 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8404 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8405 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8406 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8407 source files.
8408
8409 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8410 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8411 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8412 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8413 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8414 of @var{address}:
8415
8416 @table @code
8417 @item @var{expression}
8418 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8419
8420 @item @var{funcaddr}
8421 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8422 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8423 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8424 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8425 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8426 (although the Pascal form also works).
8427
8428 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8429 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8430
8431 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8432 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8433 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8434 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8435 functions with identical names in different source files.
8436 @end table
8437
8438 @node Edit
8439 @section Editing Source Files
8440 @cindex editing source files
8441
8442 @kindex edit
8443 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8444 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8445 The editing program of your choice
8446 is invoked with the current line set to
8447 the active line in the program.
8448 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8449 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8450
8451 @table @code
8452 @item edit @var{location}
8453 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8454 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8455 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8456 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8457 command most commonly used:
8458
8459 @table @code
8460 @item edit @var{number}
8461 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8462
8463 @item edit @var{function}
8464 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8465 @end table
8466
8467 @end table
8468
8469 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8470 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8471 @footnote{
8472 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8473 following command-line syntax:
8474 @smallexample
8475 ex +@var{number} file
8476 @end smallexample
8477 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8478 the file where to start editing.}.
8479 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8480 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8481 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8482 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8483 @smallexample
8484 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8485 export EDITOR
8486 gdb @dots{}
8487 @end smallexample
8488 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8489 @smallexample
8490 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8491 gdb @dots{}
8492 @end smallexample
8493
8494 @node Search
8495 @section Searching Source Files
8496 @cindex searching source files
8497
8498 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8499 regular expression.
8500
8501 @table @code
8502 @kindex search
8503 @kindex forward-search
8504 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8505 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8506 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8507 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8508 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8509 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8510 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8511 @code{fo}.
8512
8513 @kindex reverse-search
8514 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8515 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8516 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8517 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8518 this command as @code{rev}.
8519 @end table
8520
8521 @node Source Path
8522 @section Specifying Source Directories
8523
8524 @cindex source path
8525 @cindex directories for source files
8526 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8527 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8528 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8529 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8530 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8531 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8532 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8533
8534 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8535 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8536 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8537 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8538 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8539 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8540 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8541 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8542 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8543 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8544 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8545
8546 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8547 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8548 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8549 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8550 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8551 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8552
8553 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8554 source files.
8555
8556 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8557 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8558 each line is in the file.
8559
8560 @kindex directory
8561 @kindex dir
8562 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8563 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8564 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8565
8566 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8567 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8568
8569 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8570 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8571 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8572 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8573 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8574 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8575 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8576 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8577 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8578 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8579 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8580 name to look up the sources.
8581
8582 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8583 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8584 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8585 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8586 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8587 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8588 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8589 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8590
8591 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8592 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8593 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8594 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8595 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8596 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8597 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8598
8599 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8600 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8601 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8602 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8603 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8604 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8605 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8606 command.
8607
8608 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8609 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8610 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8611 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8612 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8613 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8614 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8615
8616 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8617 @cindex default source path substitution
8618 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8619 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8620 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8621 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8622 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8623 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8624 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8625 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8626 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8627 together.
8628
8629 @table @code
8630 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8631 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8632 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8633 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8634 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8635 part of absolute file names) or
8636 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8637 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8638
8639 @kindex cdir
8640 @kindex cwd
8641 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8642 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8643 @cindex compilation directory
8644 @cindex current directory
8645 @cindex working directory
8646 @cindex directory, current
8647 @cindex directory, compilation
8648 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8649 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8650 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8651 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8652 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8653 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8654
8655 @item directory
8656 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8657
8658 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8659 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8660
8661 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8662 @kindex set directories
8663 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8664 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8665
8666 @item show directories
8667 @kindex show directories
8668 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8669
8670 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8671 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8672 @kindex set substitute-path
8673 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8674 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8675 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8676
8677 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8678 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8679
8680 @smallexample
8681 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8682 @end smallexample
8683
8684 @noindent
8685 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8686 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8687 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8688
8689 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8690 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8691 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8692 the substitution.
8693
8694 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8695
8696 @smallexample
8697 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8698 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8699 @end smallexample
8700
8701 @noindent
8702 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8703 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8704 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8705 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8706
8707
8708 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8709 @kindex unset substitute-path
8710 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8711 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8712 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8713
8714 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8715
8716 @item show substitute-path [path]
8717 @kindex show substitute-path
8718 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8719 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8720
8721 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8722 rules.
8723
8724 @end table
8725
8726 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8727 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8728 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8729
8730 @enumerate
8731 @item
8732 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8733
8734 @item
8735 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8736 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8737 directories in one command.
8738 @end enumerate
8739
8740 @node Machine Code
8741 @section Source and Machine Code
8742 @cindex source line and its code address
8743
8744 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8745 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8746 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8747 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8748 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8749 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8750 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8751 well as hex.
8752
8753 @table @code
8754 @kindex info line
8755 @item info line
8756 @itemx info line @var{location}
8757 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8758 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8759 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8760 information about the current source line is printed.
8761 @end table
8762
8763 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8764 the object code for the first line of function
8765 @code{m4_changequote}:
8766
8767 @smallexample
8768 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8769 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8770 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8771 @end smallexample
8772
8773 @noindent
8774 @cindex code address and its source line
8775 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8776 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8777 @smallexample
8778 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8779 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8780 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8781 @end smallexample
8782
8783 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8784 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8785 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8786 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8787 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8788 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8789 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8790 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8791 Variables}).
8792
8793 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8794 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8795 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8796 line.
8797
8798 @table @code
8799 @kindex disassemble
8800 @cindex assembly instructions
8801 @cindex instructions, assembly
8802 @cindex machine instructions
8803 @cindex listing machine instructions
8804 @item disassemble
8805 @itemx disassemble /m
8806 @itemx disassemble /s
8807 @itemx disassemble /r
8808 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8809 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8810 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8811 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8812 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8813 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8814 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8815 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8816 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8817 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8818
8819 @table @code
8820 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8821 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8822 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8823 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8824 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8825 @end table
8826
8827 @noindent
8828 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8829 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8830
8831 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8832 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8833
8834 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8835 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8836 @end table
8837
8838 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8839 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8840
8841 @smallexample
8842 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8843 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8844 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8845 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8846 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8847 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8848 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8849 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8850 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8851 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8852 End of assembler dump.
8853 @end smallexample
8854
8855 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8856 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8857 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8858
8859 @smallexample
8860 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8861 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8862 5 @{
8863 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8864 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8865 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8866 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8867 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8868
8869 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8870 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8871 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8872
8873 7 return 0;
8874 8 @}
8875 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8876 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8877 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8878
8879 End of assembler dump.
8880 @end smallexample
8881
8882 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8883 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8884 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8885 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8886 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8887 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8888 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8889 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8890 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8891
8892 @file{foo.h}:
8893
8894 @smallexample
8895 int
8896 foo (int a)
8897 @{
8898 if (a < 0)
8899 return a * 2;
8900 if (a == 0)
8901 return 1;
8902 return a + 10;
8903 @}
8904 @end smallexample
8905
8906 @file{foo.c}:
8907
8908 @smallexample
8909 #include "foo.h"
8910 volatile int x, y;
8911 int
8912 main ()
8913 @{
8914 x = foo (y);
8915 return 0;
8916 @}
8917 @end smallexample
8918
8919 @smallexample
8920 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8921 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8922 5 @{
8923
8924 6 x = foo (y);
8925 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8926 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8927
8928 7 return 0;
8929 8 @}
8930 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8931 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8932 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8933 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8934
8935 End of assembler dump.
8936 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8937 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8938 foo.c:
8939 5 @{
8940 6 x = foo (y);
8941 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8942
8943 foo.h:
8944 4 if (a < 0)
8945 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8946 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8947
8948 6 if (a == 0)
8949 7 return 1;
8950 8 return a + 10;
8951 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8952 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8953 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8954 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8955
8956 foo.c:
8957 6 x = foo (y);
8958 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8959
8960 7 return 0;
8961 8 @}
8962 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8963 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8964
8965 foo.h:
8966 5 return a * 2;
8967 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8968 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8969 End of assembler dump.
8970 @end smallexample
8971
8972 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8973
8974 @smallexample
8975 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8976 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8977 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8978 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8979 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8980 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8981 End of assembler dump.
8982 @end smallexample
8983
8984 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8985 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8986 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8987 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8988
8989 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8990 mnemonics or other syntax.
8991
8992 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8993 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8994 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8995 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8996 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8997
8998 @table @code
8999 @kindex set disassembler-options
9000 @cindex disassembler options
9001 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9002 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9003 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9004 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9005 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9006 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9007 The default value is the empty string.
9008
9009 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9010 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9011 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9012 and S/390.
9013
9014 @kindex show disassembler-options
9015 @item show disassembler-options
9016 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9017 @end table
9018
9019 @table @code
9020 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9021 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9022 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9023 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9024 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9025 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9026
9027 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9028 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9029 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9030 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9031
9032 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9033 @item show disassembly-flavor
9034 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9035 @end table
9036
9037 @table @code
9038 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9039 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9040 @item set disassemble-next-line
9041 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9042 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9043 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9044 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9045 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9046 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9047 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9048 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9049 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9050 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9051 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9052 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9053 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9054 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9055 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9056 instruction.
9057 @end table
9058
9059
9060 @node Data
9061 @chapter Examining Data
9062
9063 @cindex printing data
9064 @cindex examining data
9065 @kindex print
9066 @kindex inspect
9067 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9068 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9069 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9070 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9071 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9072 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9073
9074 @table @code
9075 @item print @var{expr}
9076 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9077 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9078 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9079 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9080 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9081 Formats}.
9082
9083 @item print
9084 @itemx print /@var{f}
9085 @cindex reprint the last value
9086 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9087 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9088 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9089 @end table
9090
9091 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9092 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9093 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9094
9095 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9096 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9097 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9098 Table}.
9099
9100 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9101 @kindex explore
9102 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9103 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9104 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9105 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9106 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9107 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9108 embedded in the higher level data types.
9109
9110 @table @code
9111 @item explore @var{arg}
9112 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9113 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9114 @end table
9115
9116 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9117 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9118 C program as
9119
9120 @smallexample
9121 struct SimpleStruct
9122 @{
9123 int i;
9124 double d;
9125 @};
9126
9127 struct ComplexStruct
9128 @{
9129 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9130 int arr[10];
9131 @};
9132 @end smallexample
9133
9134 @noindent
9135 followed by variable declarations as
9136
9137 @smallexample
9138 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9139 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9140 @end smallexample
9141
9142 @noindent
9143 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9144 @code{explore} command as follows.
9145
9146 @smallexample
9147 (gdb) explore cs
9148 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9149 the following fields:
9150
9151 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9152 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9153
9154 Enter the field number of choice:
9155 @end smallexample
9156
9157 @noindent
9158 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9159 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9160 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9161 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9162 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9163 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9164 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9165 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9166
9167 @smallexample
9168 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9169 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9170 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9171 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9172
9173 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9174 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9175
9176 Press enter to return to parent value:
9177 @end smallexample
9178
9179 @noindent
9180 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9181 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9182 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9183 to explore.
9184
9185 @smallexample
9186 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9187 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9188
9189 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9190
9191 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9192
9193 Press enter to return to parent value:
9194 @end smallexample
9195
9196 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9197 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9198 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9199 level data structure).
9200
9201 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9202 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9203 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9204 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9205 same example as above, your can explore the type
9206 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9207 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9208
9209 @smallexample
9210 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9211 @end smallexample
9212
9213 @noindent
9214 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9215 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9216 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9217 example.
9218
9219 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9220 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9221 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9222 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9223 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9224
9225 @table @code
9226 @item explore value @var{expr}
9227 @cindex explore value
9228 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9229 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9230 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9231 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9232 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9233
9234 @item explore type @var{arg}
9235 @cindex explore type
9236 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9237 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9238 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9239 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9240 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9241 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9242 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9243 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9244 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9245 @end table
9246
9247 @menu
9248 * Expressions:: Expressions
9249 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9250 * Variables:: Program variables
9251 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9252 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9253 * Memory:: Examining memory
9254 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9255 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9256 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9257 * Value History:: Value history
9258 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9259 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9260 * Registers:: Registers
9261 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9262 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9263 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9264 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9265 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9266 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9267 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9268 character set than GDB does
9269 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9270 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9271 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9272 @end menu
9273
9274 @node Expressions
9275 @section Expressions
9276
9277 @cindex expressions
9278 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9279 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9280 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9281 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9282 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9283 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9284 @ref{Compilation}.
9285
9286 @cindex arrays in expressions
9287 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9288 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9289 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9290 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9291 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9292 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9293
9294 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9295 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9296 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9297 languages.
9298
9299 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9300 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9301
9302 @cindex casts, in expressions
9303 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9304 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9305 at that address in memory.
9306 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9307
9308 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9309 to programming languages:
9310
9311 @table @code
9312 @item @@
9313 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9314 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9315
9316 @item ::
9317 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9318 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9319
9320 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9321 @cindex type casting memory
9322 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9323 @cindex casts, to view memory
9324 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9325 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9326 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9327 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9328 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9329 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9330 @end table
9331
9332 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9333 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9334 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9335
9336 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9337 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9338 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9339 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9340 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9341 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9342 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9343
9344 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9345 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9346 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9347 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9348 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9349 as well.
9350
9351 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9352 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9353 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9354 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9355 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9356 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9357 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9358 choices.
9359
9360 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9361 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9362 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9363
9364 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9365 @smallexample
9366 @group
9367 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9368 [0] cancel
9369 [1] all
9370 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9371 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9372 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9373 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9374 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9375 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9376 > 2 4 6
9377 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9378 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9379 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9380 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9381 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9382 breakpoints.
9383 (@value{GDBP})
9384 @end group
9385 @end smallexample
9386
9387 @table @code
9388 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9389 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9390 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9391
9392 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9393 is ambiguous.
9394
9395 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9396 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9397 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9398 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9399 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9400 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9401 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9402 in the use of the menu.
9403
9404 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9405 when an ambiguity is detected.
9406
9407 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9408 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9409
9410 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9411 @item show multiple-symbols
9412 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9413 @end table
9414
9415 @node Variables
9416 @section Program Variables
9417
9418 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9419 in your program.
9420
9421 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9422 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9423
9424 @itemize @bullet
9425 @item
9426 global (or file-static)
9427 @end itemize
9428
9429 @noindent or
9430
9431 @itemize @bullet
9432 @item
9433 visible according to the scope rules of the
9434 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9435 @end itemize
9436
9437 @noindent This means that in the function
9438
9439 @smallexample
9440 foo (a)
9441 int a;
9442 @{
9443 bar (a);
9444 @{
9445 int b = test ();
9446 bar (b);
9447 @}
9448 @}
9449 @end smallexample
9450
9451 @noindent
9452 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9453 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9454 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9455 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9456
9457 @cindex variable name conflict
9458 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9459 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9460 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9461 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9462 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9463 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9464 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9465
9466 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9467 @ifnotinfo
9468 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9469 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9470 @end ifnotinfo
9471 @smallexample
9472 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9473 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9474 @end smallexample
9475
9476 @noindent
9477 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9478 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9479 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9480 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9481
9482 @smallexample
9483 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9484 @end smallexample
9485
9486 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9487 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9488 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9489 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9490 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9491
9492 @smallexample
9493 void
9494 foo (int a)
9495 @{
9496 if (a < 10)
9497 bar (a);
9498 else
9499 process (a); /* Stop here */
9500 @}
9501
9502 int
9503 bar (int a)
9504 @{
9505 foo (a + 5);
9506 @}
9507 @end smallexample
9508
9509 @noindent
9510 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9511 here is what you might see
9512 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9513
9514 @smallexample
9515 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9516 $1 = 10
9517 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9518 $2 = 5
9519 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9520 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9521 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9522 $3 = 5
9523 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9524 $4 = 0
9525 @end smallexample
9526
9527 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9528 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9529 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9530 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9531 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9532
9533 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9534 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9535 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9536 @code{some_global}.
9537
9538 @smallexample
9539 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9540 $1 = 23
9541 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9542 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9543 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9544 $2 = 27
9545 @end smallexample
9546
9547 @cindex wrong values
9548 @cindex variable values, wrong
9549 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9550 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9551 @quotation
9552 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9553 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9554 scope, and just before exit.
9555 @end quotation
9556 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9557 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9558 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9559 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9560 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9561 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9562 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9563 variable definitions may be gone.
9564
9565 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9566 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9567 when compiling.
9568
9569 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9570 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9571 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9572 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9573 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9574 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9575 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9576
9577 @smallexample
9578 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9579 @end smallexample
9580
9581 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9582 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9583 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9584 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9585 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9586
9587 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9588 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9589 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9590 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9591
9592 @cindex no debug info variables
9593 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9594 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9595 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9596 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9597 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9598 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9599 example, in a C program:
9600
9601 @smallexample
9602 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9603 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9604 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9605 $1 = 3.14
9606 @end smallexample
9607
9608 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9609 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9610 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9611 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9612 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9613
9614 @smallexample
9615 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9616 29 i++;
9617 (gdb) next
9618 30 e (i);
9619 (gdb) print i
9620 $1 = 31
9621 (gdb) print i@@entry
9622 $2 = 30
9623 @end smallexample
9624
9625 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9626 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9627 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9628 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9629 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9630 For program code
9631
9632 @smallexample
9633 char var0[] = "A";
9634 signed char var1[] = "A";
9635 @end smallexample
9636
9637 You get during debugging
9638 @smallexample
9639 (gdb) print var0
9640 $1 = "A"
9641 (gdb) print var1
9642 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9643 @end smallexample
9644
9645 @node Arrays
9646 @section Artificial Arrays
9647
9648 @cindex artificial array
9649 @cindex arrays
9650 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9651 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9652 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9653 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9654 program.
9655
9656 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9657 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9658 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9659 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9660 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9661 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9662 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9663 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9664 example. If a program says
9665
9666 @smallexample
9667 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9668 @end smallexample
9669
9670 @noindent
9671 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9672
9673 @smallexample
9674 p *array@@len
9675 @end smallexample
9676
9677 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9678 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9679 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9680 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9681 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9682
9683 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9684 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9685 The value need not be in memory:
9686 @smallexample
9687 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9688 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9689 @end smallexample
9690
9691 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9692 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9693 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9694 @smallexample
9695 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9696 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9697 @end smallexample
9698
9699 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9700 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9701 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9702 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9703 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9704 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9705 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9706 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9707 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9708 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9709
9710 @smallexample
9711 set $i = 0
9712 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9713 @key{RET}
9714 @key{RET}
9715 @dots{}
9716 @end smallexample
9717
9718 @node Output Formats
9719 @section Output Formats
9720
9721 @cindex formatted output
9722 @cindex output formats
9723 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9724 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9725 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9726 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9727 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9728
9729 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9730 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9731 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9732 letters supported are:
9733
9734 @table @code
9735 @item x
9736 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9737 hexadecimal.
9738
9739 @item d
9740 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9741
9742 @item u
9743 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9744
9745 @item o
9746 Print as integer in octal.
9747
9748 @item t
9749 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9750 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9751 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9752 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9753
9754 @item a
9755 @cindex unknown address, locating
9756 @cindex locate address
9757 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9758 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9759 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9760
9761 @smallexample
9762 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9763 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9764 @end smallexample
9765
9766 @noindent
9767 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9768 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9769
9770 @item c
9771 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9772 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9773 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9774 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9775
9776 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9777 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9778 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9779 data.
9780
9781 @item f
9782 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9783 using typical floating point syntax.
9784
9785 @item s
9786 @cindex printing strings
9787 @cindex printing byte arrays
9788 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9789 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9790 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9791 natural types.
9792
9793 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9794 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9795 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9796 array.
9797
9798 @item z
9799 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9800 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9801 to the size of the integer type.
9802
9803 @item r
9804 @cindex raw printing
9805 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9806 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9807 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9808 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9809 pretty-printer which might exist.
9810 @end table
9811
9812 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9813
9814 @smallexample
9815 p/x $pc
9816 @end smallexample
9817
9818 @noindent
9819 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9820 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9821
9822 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9823 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9824 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9825
9826 @node Memory
9827 @section Examining Memory
9828
9829 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9830 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9831
9832 @cindex examining memory
9833 @table @code
9834 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9835 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9836 @itemx x @var{addr}
9837 @itemx x
9838 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9839 @end table
9840
9841 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9842 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9843 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9844 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9845 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9846
9847 @table @r
9848 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9849 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9850 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9851 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9852 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9853 @c 4.1.2.
9854
9855 @item @var{f}, the display format
9856 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9857 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9858 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9859 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9860 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9861
9862 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9863 The unit size is any of
9864
9865 @table @code
9866 @item b
9867 Bytes.
9868 @item h
9869 Halfwords (two bytes).
9870 @item w
9871 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9872 @item g
9873 Giant words (eight bytes).
9874 @end table
9875
9876 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9877 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9878 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9879 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9880 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9881 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9882 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9883 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9884 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9885 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9886 be altered.
9887
9888 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9889 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9890 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9891 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9892 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9893 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9894 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9895 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9896 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9897 a value from memory).
9898 @end table
9899
9900 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9901 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9902 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9903 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9904 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9905
9906 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9907 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9908 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9909
9910 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9911 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9912 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9913 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9914 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9915
9916 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9917 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9918 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9919 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9920 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9921 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9922 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9923 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9924 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9925
9926 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9927 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9928 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9929 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9930 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9931 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9932
9933 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9934 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9935 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9936 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9937 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9938 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9939 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9940
9941 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9942 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9943
9944 @smallexample
9945 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9946 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9947 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9948 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9949 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9950 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9951 @end smallexample
9952
9953 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9954 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9955 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9956 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9957 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9958 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9959 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9960 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9961 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9962
9963 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9964 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9965 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9966
9967 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9968 @cindex addressable memory unit
9969 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9970 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9971 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9972 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9973 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9974 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9975 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9976 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9977 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9978
9979 @cindex remote memory comparison
9980 @cindex target memory comparison
9981 @cindex verify remote memory image
9982 @cindex verify target memory image
9983 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9984 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9985 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9986 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9987 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9988 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9989
9990 @table @code
9991 @kindex compare-sections
9992 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9993 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9994 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9995 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9996 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9997 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9998
9999 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10000 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10001 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10002 @end table
10003
10004 @node Auto Display
10005 @section Automatic Display
10006 @cindex automatic display
10007 @cindex display of expressions
10008
10009 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10010 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10011 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10012 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10013 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10014 The automatic display looks like this:
10015
10016 @smallexample
10017 2: foo = 38
10018 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10019 @end smallexample
10020
10021 @noindent
10022 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10023 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10024 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10025 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10026 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10027 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10028
10029 @table @code
10030 @kindex display
10031 @item display @var{expr}
10032 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10033 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10034
10035 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10036
10037 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10038 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10039 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10040 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10041 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10042
10043 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10044 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10045 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10046 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10047 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10048 @end table
10049
10050 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10051 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10052 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10053
10054 @table @code
10055 @kindex delete display
10056 @kindex undisplay
10057 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10058 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10059 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10060 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10061 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10062 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10063 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10064
10065 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10066 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10067
10068 @kindex disable display
10069 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10070 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10071 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10072 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10073 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10074 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10075 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10076 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10077
10078 @kindex enable display
10079 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10080 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10081 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10082 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10083 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10084 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10085 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10086
10087 @item display
10088 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10089 done when your program stops.
10090
10091 @kindex info display
10092 @item info display
10093 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10094 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10095 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10096 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10097 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10098 @end table
10099
10100 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10101 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10102 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10103 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10104 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10105 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10106 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10107 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10108 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10109 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10110 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10111
10112 @node Print Settings
10113 @section Print Settings
10114
10115 @cindex format options
10116 @cindex print settings
10117 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10118 and symbols are printed.
10119
10120 @noindent
10121 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10122
10123 @table @code
10124 @kindex set print
10125 @item set print address
10126 @itemx set print address on
10127 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10128 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10129 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10130 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10131 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10132 @code{set print address on}:
10133
10134 @smallexample
10135 @group
10136 (@value{GDBP}) f
10137 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10138 at input.c:530
10139 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10140 @end group
10141 @end smallexample
10142
10143 @item set print address off
10144 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10145 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10146
10147 @smallexample
10148 @group
10149 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10150 (@value{GDBP}) f
10151 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10152 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10153 @end group
10154 @end smallexample
10155
10156 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10157 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10158 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10159 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10160
10161 @kindex show print
10162 @item show print address
10163 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10164 @end table
10165
10166 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10167 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10168 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10169 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10170 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10171 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10172 it prints a symbolic address:
10173
10174 @table @code
10175 @item set print symbol-filename on
10176 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10177 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10178 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10179 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10180
10181 @item set print symbol-filename off
10182 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10183 default.
10184
10185 @item show print symbol-filename
10186 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10187 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10188 @end table
10189
10190 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10191 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10192 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10193
10194 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10195 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10196
10197 @table @code
10198 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10199 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10200 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10201 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10202 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10203 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10204 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10205 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10206
10207 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10208 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10209 symbolic address.
10210 @end table
10211
10212 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10213 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10214 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10215 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10216 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10217 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10218 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10219 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10220
10221 @smallexample
10222 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10223 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10224 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10225 @end smallexample
10226
10227 @quotation
10228 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10229 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10230 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10231 @end quotation
10232
10233 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10234 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10235
10236 @table @code
10237 @item set print symbol on
10238 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10239 one exists.
10240
10241 @item set print symbol off
10242 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10243 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10244 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10245
10246 @item show print symbol
10247 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10248 address.
10249 @end table
10250
10251 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10252
10253 @table @code
10254 @item set print array
10255 @itemx set print array on
10256 @cindex pretty print arrays
10257 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10258 but uses more space. The default is off.
10259
10260 @item set print array off
10261 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10262
10263 @item show print array
10264 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10265 arrays.
10266
10267 @cindex print array indexes
10268 @item set print array-indexes
10269 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10270 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10271 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10272 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10273
10274 @item set print array-indexes off
10275 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10276
10277 @item show print array-indexes
10278 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10279 arrays.
10280
10281 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10282 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10283 @cindex number of array elements to print
10284 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10285 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10286 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10287 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10288 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10289 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10290 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10291 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10292
10293 @item show print elements
10294 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10295 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10296
10297 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10298 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10299 @cindex printing frame argument values
10300 @cindex print all frame argument values
10301 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10302 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10303 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10304 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10305 values are:
10306
10307 @table @code
10308 @item all
10309 The values of all arguments are printed.
10310
10311 @item scalars
10312 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10313 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10314 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10315 only scalar arguments are shown:
10316
10317 @smallexample
10318 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10319 at frame-args.c:23
10320 @end smallexample
10321
10322 @item none
10323 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10324 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10325
10326 @smallexample
10327 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10328 at frame-args.c:23
10329 @end smallexample
10330 @end table
10331
10332 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10333 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10334 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10335 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10336 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10337 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10338 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10339 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10340 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10341 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10342
10343 @item show print frame-arguments
10344 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10345
10346 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10347 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10348
10349 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10350 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10351 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10352 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10353 This is the default.
10354
10355 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10356 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10357
10358 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10359 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10360 @kindex set print entry-values
10361 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10362 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10363 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10364 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10365 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10366
10367 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10368 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10369 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10370 @code{no} setting.
10371
10372 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10373 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10374 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10375 this information.
10376
10377 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10378
10379 @table @code
10380 @item no
10381 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10382 point.
10383 @smallexample
10384 #0 equal (val=5)
10385 #0 different (val=6)
10386 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10387 #0 born (val=10)
10388 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10389 @end smallexample
10390
10391 @item only
10392 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10393 values are never printed.
10394 @smallexample
10395 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10396 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10397 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10398 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10399 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10400 @end smallexample
10401
10402 @item preferred
10403 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10404 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10405 value for such parameter.
10406 @smallexample
10407 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10408 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10409 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10410 #0 born (val=10)
10411 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10412 @end smallexample
10413
10414 @item if-needed
10415 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10416 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10417 parameter.
10418 @smallexample
10419 #0 equal (val=5)
10420 #0 different (val=6)
10421 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10422 #0 born (val=10)
10423 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10424 @end smallexample
10425
10426 @item both
10427 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10428 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10429 optimizations.
10430 @smallexample
10431 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10432 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10433 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10434 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10435 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10436 @end smallexample
10437
10438 @item compact
10439 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10440 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10441 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10442 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10443 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10444 @smallexample
10445 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10446 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10447 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10448 #0 born (val=10)
10449 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10450 @end smallexample
10451
10452 @item default
10453 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10454 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10455 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10456 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10457 @smallexample
10458 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10459 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10460 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10461 #0 born (val=10)
10462 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10463 @end smallexample
10464 @end table
10465
10466 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10467 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10468
10469 @item show print entry-values
10470 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10471 entry.
10472
10473 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10474 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10475 @cindex repeated array elements
10476 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10477 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10478 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10479 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10480 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10481 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10482 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10483 is 10.
10484
10485 @item show print repeats
10486 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10487 elements.
10488
10489 @item set print null-stop
10490 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10491 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10492 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10493 contain only short strings.
10494 The default is off.
10495
10496 @item show print null-stop
10497 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10498 @sc{null} character.
10499
10500 @item set print pretty on
10501 @cindex print structures in indented form
10502 @cindex indentation in structure display
10503 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10504 per line, like this:
10505
10506 @smallexample
10507 @group
10508 $1 = @{
10509 next = 0x0,
10510 flags = @{
10511 sweet = 1,
10512 sour = 1
10513 @},
10514 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10515 @}
10516 @end group
10517 @end smallexample
10518
10519 @item set print pretty off
10520 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10521
10522 @smallexample
10523 @group
10524 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10525 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10526 @end group
10527 @end smallexample
10528
10529 @noindent
10530 This is the default format.
10531
10532 @item show print pretty
10533 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10534
10535 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10536 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10537 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10538 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10539 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10540 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10541 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10542 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10543
10544 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10545 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10546 international character sets, and is the default.
10547
10548 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10549 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10550
10551 @item set print union on
10552 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10553 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10554 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10555
10556 @item set print union off
10557 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10558 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10559 instead.
10560
10561 @item show print union
10562 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10563 structures and other unions.
10564
10565 For example, given the declarations
10566
10567 @smallexample
10568 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10569 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10570 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10571 Bug_forms;
10572
10573 struct thing @{
10574 Species it;
10575 union @{
10576 Tree_forms tree;
10577 Bug_forms bug;
10578 @} form;
10579 @};
10580
10581 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10582 @end smallexample
10583
10584 @noindent
10585 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10586
10587 @smallexample
10588 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10589 @end smallexample
10590
10591 @noindent
10592 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10593
10594 @smallexample
10595 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10596 @end smallexample
10597
10598 @noindent
10599 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10600 and in Pascal.
10601 @end table
10602
10603 @need 1000
10604 @noindent
10605 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10606
10607 @table @code
10608 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10609 @item set print demangle
10610 @itemx set print demangle on
10611 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10612 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10613 linkage. The default is on.
10614
10615 @item show print demangle
10616 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10617
10618 @item set print asm-demangle
10619 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10620 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10621 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10622 The default is off.
10623
10624 @item show print asm-demangle
10625 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10626 or demangled form.
10627
10628 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10629 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10630 @kindex set demangle-style
10631 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10632 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10633 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10634
10635 @table @code
10636 @item auto
10637 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10638 This is the default.
10639
10640 @item gnu
10641 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10642
10643 @item hp
10644 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10645
10646 @item lucid
10647 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10648
10649 @item arm
10650 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10651 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10652 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10653 require further enhancement to permit that.
10654
10655 @end table
10656 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10657
10658 @item show demangle-style
10659 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10660
10661 @item set print object
10662 @itemx set print object on
10663 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10664 @cindex display derived types
10665 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10666 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10667 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10668 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10669 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10670 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10671 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10672
10673 @item set print object off
10674 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10675 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10676
10677 @item show print object
10678 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10679
10680 @item set print static-members
10681 @itemx set print static-members on
10682 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10683 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10684
10685 @item set print static-members off
10686 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10687
10688 @item show print static-members
10689 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10690
10691 @item set print pascal_static-members
10692 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10693 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10694 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10695 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10696
10697 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10698 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10699
10700 @item show print pascal_static-members
10701 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10702
10703 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10704 @item set print vtbl
10705 @itemx set print vtbl on
10706 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10707 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10708 @cindex VTBL display
10709 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10710 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10711 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10712
10713 @item set print vtbl off
10714 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10715
10716 @item show print vtbl
10717 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10718 @end table
10719
10720 @node Pretty Printing
10721 @section Pretty Printing
10722
10723 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10724 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10725 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10726
10727 @menu
10728 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10729 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10730 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10731 @end menu
10732
10733 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10734 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10735
10736 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10737 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10738 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10739
10740 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10741 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10742 pretty-printers with their names.
10743 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10744 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10745 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10746 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10747
10748 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10749 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10750 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10751 do anything special.
10752
10753 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10754
10755 @itemize @bullet
10756 @item
10757 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10758 all inferiors.
10759
10760 @item
10761 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10762 when debugging that program.
10763 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10764
10765 @item
10766 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10767 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10768 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10769 @end itemize
10770
10771 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10772 pretty-printers are selected,
10773
10774 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10775 for new types.
10776
10777 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10778 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10779
10780 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10781
10782 @smallexample
10783 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10784 $1 = @{
10785 static npos = 4294967295,
10786 _M_dataplus = @{
10787 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10788 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10789 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10790 @},
10791 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10792 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10793 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10794 @}
10795 @}
10796 @end smallexample
10797
10798 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10799
10800 @smallexample
10801 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10802 $2 = "abcd"
10803 @end smallexample
10804
10805 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10806 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10807 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10808
10809 @table @code
10810 @kindex info pretty-printer
10811 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10812 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10813 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10814
10815 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10816 whose pretty-printers to list.
10817 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10818 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10819 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10820 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10821 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10822
10823 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10824 to list.
10825
10826 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10827 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10828 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10829 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10830
10831 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10832 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10833 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10834 @end table
10835
10836 Example:
10837
10838 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10839 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10840 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10841 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10842
10843 @smallexample
10844 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10845 library1.so:
10846 foo
10847 library2.so:
10848 bar
10849 bar1
10850 bar2
10851 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10852 library2.so:
10853 bar
10854 bar1
10855 bar2
10856 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10857 1 printer disabled
10858 2 of 3 printers enabled
10859 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10860 library1.so:
10861 foo [disabled]
10862 library2.so:
10863 bar
10864 bar1
10865 bar2
10866 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10867 1 printer disabled
10868 1 of 3 printers enabled
10869 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10870 library1.so:
10871 foo [disabled]
10872 library2.so:
10873 bar
10874 bar1 [disabled]
10875 bar2
10876 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10877 1 printer disabled
10878 0 of 3 printers enabled
10879 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10880 library1.so:
10881 foo [disabled]
10882 library2.so:
10883 bar [disabled]
10884 bar1 [disabled]
10885 bar2
10886 @end smallexample
10887
10888 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10889 as can each individual subprinter.
10890
10891 @node Value History
10892 @section Value History
10893
10894 @cindex value history
10895 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10896 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10897 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10898 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10899 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10900 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10901 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10902 symbol table.
10903
10904 @cindex @code{$}
10905 @cindex @code{$$}
10906 @cindex history number
10907 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10908 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10909 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10910 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10911 history number.
10912
10913 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10914 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10915 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10916 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10917 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10918 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10919 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10920
10921 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10922 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10923
10924 @smallexample
10925 p *$
10926 @end smallexample
10927
10928 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10929 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10930
10931 @smallexample
10932 p *$.next
10933 @end smallexample
10934
10935 @noindent
10936 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10937 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10938
10939 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10940 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10941
10942 @smallexample
10943 print x
10944 set x=5
10945 @end smallexample
10946
10947 @noindent
10948 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10949 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10950
10951 @table @code
10952 @kindex show values
10953 @item show values
10954 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10955 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10956 values} does not change the history.
10957
10958 @item show values @var{n}
10959 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10960
10961 @item show values +
10962 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10963 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10964 @end table
10965
10966 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10967 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10968
10969 @node Convenience Vars
10970 @section Convenience Variables
10971
10972 @cindex convenience variables
10973 @cindex user-defined variables
10974 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10975 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10976 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10977 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10978 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10979
10980 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10981 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10982 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10983 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10984 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10985
10986 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10987 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10988 For example:
10989
10990 @smallexample
10991 set $foo = *object_ptr
10992 @end smallexample
10993
10994 @noindent
10995 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10996 @code{object_ptr}.
10997
10998 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10999 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11000 value with another assignment at any time.
11001
11002 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11003 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11004 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11005 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11006
11007 @table @code
11008 @kindex show convenience
11009 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11010 @item show convenience
11011 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11012 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11013 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11014
11015 @kindex init-if-undefined
11016 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11017 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11018 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11019 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11020 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11021 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11022 override default values used in a command script.
11023
11024 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11025 any side-effects do not occur.
11026 @end table
11027
11028 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11029 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11030 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11031
11032 @smallexample
11033 set $i = 0
11034 print bar[$i++]->contents
11035 @end smallexample
11036
11037 @noindent
11038 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11039
11040 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11041 values likely to be useful.
11042
11043 @table @code
11044 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11045 @item $_
11046 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11047 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11048 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11049 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11050 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11051 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11052 to the type of @code{$__}.
11053
11054 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11055 @item $__
11056 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11057 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11058 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11059
11060 @item $_exitcode
11061 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11062 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11063 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11064 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11065
11066 @item $_exitsignal
11067 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11068 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11069 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11070 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11071
11072 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11073 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11074 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11075 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11076 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11077
11078 @smallexample
11079 #include <signal.h>
11080
11081 int
11082 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11083 @{
11084 raise (SIGALRM);
11085 return 0;
11086 @}
11087 @end smallexample
11088
11089 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11090 or signalled would be:
11091
11092 @smallexample
11093 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11094 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11095 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11096 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11097 >echo The program has exited\n
11098 >else
11099 >echo The program has signalled\n
11100 >end
11101 >end
11102 (@value{GDBP}) run
11103 Starting program:
11104
11105 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11106 The program no longer exists.
11107 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11108 The program has signalled
11109 @end smallexample
11110
11111 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11112 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11113 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11114 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11115
11116 @smallexample
11117 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11118 The program has exited
11119 @end smallexample
11120
11121 @item $_exception
11122 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11123 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11124
11125 @item $_probe_argc
11126 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11127 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11128
11129 @item $_sdata
11130 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11131 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11132 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11133 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11134 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11135
11136 @item $_siginfo
11137 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11138 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11139 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11140 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11141 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11142
11143 @item $_tlb
11144 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11145 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11146 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11147 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11148 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11149 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11150
11151 @item $_inferior
11152 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11153 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11154
11155 @item $_thread
11156 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11157
11158 @item $_gthread
11159 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11160
11161 @end table
11162
11163 @node Convenience Funs
11164 @section Convenience Functions
11165
11166 @cindex convenience functions
11167 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11168 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11169 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11170 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11171 @value{GDBN}.
11172
11173 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11174 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11175
11176 @table @code
11177
11178 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11179 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11180 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11181 returns zero.
11182
11183 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11184 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11185 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11186 it is @code{void}:
11187
11188 @smallexample
11189 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11190 $1 = void
11191 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11192 $2 = 1
11193 (@value{GDBP}) run
11194 Starting program: ./a.out
11195 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11196 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11197 $3 = 0
11198 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11199 $4 = 0
11200 @end smallexample
11201
11202 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11203 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11204 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11205 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11206 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11207 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11208 anymore.
11209
11210 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11211 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11212
11213 @smallexample
11214 void
11215 foo (void)
11216 @{
11217 @}
11218 @end smallexample
11219
11220 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11221
11222 @smallexample
11223 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11224 $1 = void
11225 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11226 $2 = 1
11227 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11228 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11229 $3 = void
11230 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11231 $4 = 1
11232 @end smallexample
11233
11234 @end table
11235
11236 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11237 @code{Python} support.
11238
11239 @table @code
11240
11241 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11242 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11243 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11244 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11245 Otherwise it returns zero.
11246
11247 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11248 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11249 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11250 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11251 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11252 regular expression support.
11253
11254 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11255 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11256 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11257 Otherwise it returns zero.
11258
11259 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11260 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11261 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11262
11263 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11264 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11265 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11266 Otherwise it returns zero.
11267
11268 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11269 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11270 The default is 1.
11271
11272 Example:
11273
11274 @smallexample
11275 (gdb) backtrace
11276 #0 bottom_func ()
11277 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11278 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11279 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11280 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11281 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11282 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11283 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11284 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11285 $1 = 1
11286 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11287 $1 = 1
11288 @end smallexample
11289
11290 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11291 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11292 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11293 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11294
11295 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11296 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11297 The default is 1.
11298
11299 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11300 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11301 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11302 Otherwise it returns zero.
11303
11304 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11305 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11306 The default is 1.
11307
11308 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11309 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11310 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11311 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11312
11313 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11314 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11315 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11316 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11317
11318 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11319 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11320 The default is 1.
11321
11322 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11323 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11324 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11325 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11326
11327 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11328 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11329 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11330
11331 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11332 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11333 an enumerated type:
11334
11335 @smallexample
11336 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11337 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11338 @end smallexample
11339
11340 @end table
11341
11342 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11343 convenience functions.
11344
11345 @table @code
11346 @item help function
11347 @kindex help function
11348 @cindex show all convenience functions
11349 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11350 @end table
11351
11352 @node Registers
11353 @section Registers
11354
11355 @cindex registers
11356 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11357 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11358 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11359 your machine.
11360
11361 @table @code
11362 @kindex info registers
11363 @item info registers
11364 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11365 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11366
11367 @kindex info all-registers
11368 @cindex floating point registers
11369 @item info all-registers
11370 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11371 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11372
11373 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11374 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11375 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11376 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11377
11378 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11379 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11380 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11381 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11382 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11383 @end table
11384
11385 @anchor{standard registers}
11386 @cindex stack pointer register
11387 @cindex program counter register
11388 @cindex process status register
11389 @cindex frame pointer register
11390 @cindex standard registers
11391 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11392 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11393 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11394 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11395 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11396 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11397 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11398 you could print the program counter in hex with
11399
11400 @smallexample
11401 p/x $pc
11402 @end smallexample
11403
11404 @noindent
11405 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11406
11407 @smallexample
11408 x/i $pc
11409 @end smallexample
11410
11411 @noindent
11412 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11413 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11414 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11415 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11416 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11417 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11418 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11419
11420 @smallexample
11421 set $sp += 4
11422 @end smallexample
11423
11424 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11425 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11426 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11427 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11428 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11429 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11430 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11431
11432 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11433 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11434 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11435 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11436 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11437 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11438 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11439
11440 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11441 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11442 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11443 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11444 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11445 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11446 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11447 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11448 prints the data in both formats.
11449
11450 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11451 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11452 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11453 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11454 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11455 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11456 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11457
11458 @smallexample
11459 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11460 $1 = @{
11461 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11462 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11463 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11464 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11465 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11466 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11467 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11468 @}
11469 @end smallexample
11470
11471 @noindent
11472 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11473 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11474 value to a @code{struct} member:
11475
11476 @smallexample
11477 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11478 @end smallexample
11479
11480 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11481 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11482 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11483 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11484 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11485 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11486
11487 @cindex caller-saved registers
11488 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11489 @cindex volatile registers
11490 @cindex <not saved> values
11491 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11492 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11493 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11494 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11495 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11496 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11497 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11498 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11499 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11500 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11501 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11502 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11503 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11504 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11505 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11506 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11507 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11508 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11509 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11510 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11511 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11512 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11513 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11514
11515 @node Floating Point Hardware
11516 @section Floating Point Hardware
11517 @cindex floating point
11518
11519 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11520 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11521
11522 @table @code
11523 @kindex info float
11524 @item info float
11525 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11526 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11527 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11528 the ARM and x86 machines.
11529 @end table
11530
11531 @node Vector Unit
11532 @section Vector Unit
11533 @cindex vector unit
11534
11535 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11536 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11537
11538 @table @code
11539 @kindex info vector
11540 @item info vector
11541 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11542 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11543 @end table
11544
11545 @node OS Information
11546 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11547 @cindex OS information
11548
11549 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11550 you debug your program.
11551
11552 @cindex auxiliary vector
11553 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11554 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11555 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11556 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11557 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11558 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11559 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11560 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11561 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11562 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11563 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11564 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11565
11566 @table @code
11567 @kindex info auxv
11568 @item info auxv
11569 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11570 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11571 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11572 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11573 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11574 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11575 an unrecognized tag.
11576 @end table
11577
11578 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11579 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11580 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11581 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11582 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11583 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11584 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11585
11586 @table @code
11587 @kindex info os
11588 @item info os @var{infotype}
11589
11590 Display OS information of the requested type.
11591
11592 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11593
11594 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11595 @table @code
11596 @kindex info os cpus
11597 @item cpus
11598 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11599 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11600 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11601 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11602 kernel initialization.
11603
11604 @kindex info os files
11605 @item files
11606 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11607 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11608 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11609 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11610
11611 @kindex info os modules
11612 @item modules
11613 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11614 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11615 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11616 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11617 in memory.
11618
11619 @kindex info os msg
11620 @item msg
11621 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11622 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11623 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11624 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11625 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11626 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11627 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11628 the message queue was last changed.
11629
11630 @kindex info os processes
11631 @item processes
11632 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11633 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11634 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11635 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11636 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11637 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11638
11639 @kindex info os procgroups
11640 @item procgroups
11641 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11642 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11643 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11644 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11645 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11646 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11647 and the process group leader is listed first.
11648
11649 @kindex info os semaphores
11650 @item semaphores
11651 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11652 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11653 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11654 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11655 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11656
11657 @kindex info os shm
11658 @item shm
11659 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11660 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11661 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11662 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11663 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11664 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11665 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11666
11667 @kindex info os sockets
11668 @item sockets
11669 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11670 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11671 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11672 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11673 connection.
11674
11675 @kindex info os threads
11676 @item threads
11677 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11678 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11679 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11680 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11681 process is not listed.
11682 @end table
11683
11684 @item info os
11685 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11686 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11687 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11688 types, this command will report an error.
11689 @end table
11690
11691 @node Memory Region Attributes
11692 @section Memory Region Attributes
11693 @cindex memory region attributes
11694
11695 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11696 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11697 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11698 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11699 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11700 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11701 user can override the fetched regions.
11702
11703 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11704 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11705 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11706 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11707 all memory.
11708
11709 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11710 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11711
11712 @table @code
11713 @kindex mem
11714 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11715 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11716 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11717 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11718 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11719 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11720
11721 @item mem auto
11722 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11723 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11724
11725 @kindex delete mem
11726 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11727 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11728 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11729
11730 @kindex disable mem
11731 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11732 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11733 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11734 It may be enabled again later.
11735
11736 @kindex enable mem
11737 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11738 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11739
11740 @kindex info mem
11741 @item info mem
11742 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11743 for each region:
11744
11745 @table @emph
11746 @item Memory Region Number
11747 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11748 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11749 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11750
11751 @item Lo Address
11752 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11753
11754 @item Hi Address
11755 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11756
11757 @item Attributes
11758 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11759 @end table
11760 @end table
11761
11762
11763 @subsection Attributes
11764
11765 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11766 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11767 write accesses to a memory region.
11768
11769 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11770 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11771 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11772
11773 @table @code
11774 @item ro
11775 Memory is read only.
11776 @item wo
11777 Memory is write only.
11778 @item rw
11779 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11780 @end table
11781
11782 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11783 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11784 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11785 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11786 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11787
11788 @table @code
11789 @item 8
11790 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11791 @item 16
11792 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11793 @item 32
11794 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11795 @item 64
11796 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11797 @end table
11798
11799 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11800 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11801 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11802 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11803 @c
11804 @c @table @code
11805 @c @item hwbreak
11806 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11807 @c @item swbreak (default)
11808 @c @end table
11809
11810 @subsubsection Data Cache
11811 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11812 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11813 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11814 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11815 registers.
11816
11817 @table @code
11818 @item cache
11819 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11820 @item nocache
11821 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11822 @end table
11823
11824 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11825 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11826 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11827 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11828 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11829
11830 @table @code
11831 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11832 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11833 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11834 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11835 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11836 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11837 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11838 The default value is @code{on}.
11839 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11840 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11841 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11842 @end table
11843
11844
11845 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11846 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11847 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11848 @c
11849 @c @table @code
11850 @c @item verify
11851 @c @item noverify (default)
11852 @c @end table
11853
11854 @node Dump/Restore Files
11855 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11856 @cindex dump/restore files
11857 @cindex append data to a file
11858 @cindex dump data to a file
11859 @cindex restore data from a file
11860
11861 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11862 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11863 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11864 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11865 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11866 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11867 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11868
11869 @table @code
11870
11871 @kindex dump
11872 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11873 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11874 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11875 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11876
11877 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11878 @table @code
11879 @item binary
11880 Raw binary form.
11881 @item ihex
11882 Intel hex format.
11883 @item srec
11884 Motorola S-record format.
11885 @item tekhex
11886 Tektronix Hex format.
11887 @item verilog
11888 Verilog Hex format.
11889 @end table
11890
11891 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11892 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11893 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11894 form.
11895
11896 @kindex append
11897 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11898 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11899 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11900 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11901 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11902
11903 @kindex restore
11904 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11905 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11906 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11907 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11908 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11909
11910 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11911 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11912 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11913 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11914 from that location.
11915
11916 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11917 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11918 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11919 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11920
11921 @end table
11922
11923 @node Core File Generation
11924 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11925 @cindex dump core from inferior
11926
11927 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11928 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11929 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11930 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11931 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11932 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11933 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11934
11935 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11936 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11937 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11938
11939 @table @code
11940 @kindex gcore
11941 @kindex generate-core-file
11942 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11943 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11944 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11945 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11946 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11947 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11948
11949 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11950 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11951
11952 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11953 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11954 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
11955 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
11956 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
11957
11958 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11959 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11960 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11961 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11962 Enable or disable the use of the file
11963 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11964 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11965 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11966 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11967
11968 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11969 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11970 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11971 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11972 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11973 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11974 about the bits that can be set in the
11975 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11976 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11977
11978 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11979 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11980 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11981 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11982 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11983 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11984 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11985 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11986
11987 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
11988 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
11989 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
11990 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
11991 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
11992 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
11993 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
11994
11995 The default value is @code{off}.
11996 @end table
11997
11998 @node Character Sets
11999 @section Character Sets
12000 @cindex character sets
12001 @cindex charset
12002 @cindex translating between character sets
12003 @cindex host character set
12004 @cindex target character set
12005
12006 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12007 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12008 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12009 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12010 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12011 @dfn{target character set}.
12012
12013 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12014 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12015 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12016 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12017 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12018 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12019 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12020 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12021 character and string literals in expressions.
12022
12023 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12024 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12025 target-charset} command, described below.
12026
12027 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12028 support:
12029
12030 @table @code
12031 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12032 @kindex set target-charset
12033 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12034 list of supported target character sets, type
12035 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12036
12037 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12038 @kindex set host-charset
12039 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12040
12041 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12042 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12043 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12044 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12045 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12046
12047 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12048 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12049 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12050
12051 @item set charset @var{charset}
12052 @kindex set charset
12053 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12054 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12055 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12056 for both host and target.
12057
12058 @item show charset
12059 @kindex show charset
12060 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12061
12062 @item show host-charset
12063 @kindex show host-charset
12064 Show the name of the current host character set.
12065
12066 @item show target-charset
12067 @kindex show target-charset
12068 Show the name of the current target character set.
12069
12070 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12071 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12072 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12073 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12074 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12075 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12076
12077 @item show target-wide-charset
12078 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12079 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12080 @end table
12081
12082 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12083 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12084 @file{charset-test.c}:
12085
12086 @smallexample
12087 #include <stdio.h>
12088
12089 char ascii_hello[]
12090 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12091 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12092 char ibm1047_hello[]
12093 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12094 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12095
12096 main ()
12097 @{
12098 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12099 @}
12100 @end smallexample
12101
12102 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12103 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12104 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12105
12106 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12107
12108 @smallexample
12109 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12110 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12111 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12112 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12113 @dots{}
12114 (@value{GDBP})
12115 @end smallexample
12116
12117 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12118 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12119 strings:
12120
12121 @smallexample
12122 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12123 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12124 (@value{GDBP})
12125 @end smallexample
12126
12127 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12128 initial character set:
12129 @smallexample
12130 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12131 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12132 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12133 (@value{GDBP})
12134 @end smallexample
12135
12136 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12137 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12138 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12139 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12140 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12141
12142 @smallexample
12143 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12144 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12145 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12146 $2 = 72 'H'
12147 (@value{GDBP})
12148 @end smallexample
12149
12150 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12151 literals you use in expressions:
12152
12153 @smallexample
12154 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12155 $3 = 43 '+'
12156 (@value{GDBP})
12157 @end smallexample
12158
12159 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12160 character.
12161
12162 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12163 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12164 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12165
12166 @smallexample
12167 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12168 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12169 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12170 $5 = 200 '\310'
12171 (@value{GDBP})
12172 @end smallexample
12173
12174 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12175 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12176
12177 @smallexample
12178 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12179 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12180 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12181 @end smallexample
12182
12183 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12184 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12185 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12186 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12187 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12188
12189 @smallexample
12190 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12191 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12192 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12193 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12194 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12195 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12196 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12197 $7 = 72 '\110'
12198 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12199 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12200 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12201 $9 = 200 'H'
12202 (@value{GDBP})
12203 @end smallexample
12204
12205 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12206 string literals you use in expressions:
12207
12208 @smallexample
12209 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12210 $10 = 78 '+'
12211 (@value{GDBP})
12212 @end smallexample
12213
12214 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12215 character.
12216
12217 @node Caching Target Data
12218 @section Caching Data of Targets
12219 @cindex caching data of targets
12220
12221 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12222 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12223 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12224 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12225 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12226 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12227 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12228 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12229 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12230 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12231 is executing.
12232 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12233 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12234 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12235 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12236 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12237 in the code segment.
12238 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12239 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12240
12241 @table @code
12242 @kindex set remotecache
12243 @item set remotecache on
12244 @itemx set remotecache off
12245 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12246 with old scripts.
12247
12248 @kindex show remotecache
12249 @item show remotecache
12250 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12251
12252 @kindex set stack-cache
12253 @item set stack-cache on
12254 @itemx set stack-cache off
12255 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12256 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12257
12258 @kindex show stack-cache
12259 @item show stack-cache
12260 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12261
12262 @kindex set code-cache
12263 @item set code-cache on
12264 @itemx set code-cache off
12265 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12266 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12267 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12268
12269 @kindex show code-cache
12270 @item show code-cache
12271 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12272 accesses.
12273
12274 @kindex info dcache
12275 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12276 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12277 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12278 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12279 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12280 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12281
12282 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12283 printed in hex.
12284
12285 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12286 @cindex dcache size
12287 @kindex set dcache size
12288 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12289
12290 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12291 @cindex dcache line-size
12292 @kindex set dcache line-size
12293 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12294 Must be a power of 2.
12295
12296 @item show dcache size
12297 @kindex show dcache size
12298 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12299
12300 @item show dcache line-size
12301 @kindex show dcache line-size
12302 Show default size of dcache lines.
12303
12304 @end table
12305
12306 @node Searching Memory
12307 @section Search Memory
12308 @cindex searching memory
12309
12310 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12311 @code{find} command.
12312
12313 @table @code
12314 @kindex find
12315 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12316 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12317 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12318 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12319 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12320 @end table
12321
12322 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12323 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12324
12325 @table @r
12326 @item @var{s}, search query size
12327 The size of each search query value.
12328
12329 @table @code
12330 @item b
12331 bytes
12332 @item h
12333 halfwords (two bytes)
12334 @item w
12335 words (four bytes)
12336 @item g
12337 giant words (eight bytes)
12338 @end table
12339
12340 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12341 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12342 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12343 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12344 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12345
12346 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12347 value's type in the current language.
12348 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12349 pattern as a mixture of types.
12350 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12351 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12352 which is typically four bytes.
12353
12354 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12355 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12356 @end table
12357
12358 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12359 (@code{"}).
12360 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12361 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12362
12363 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12364 number of matches found.
12365
12366 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12367 @samp{$_}.
12368 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12369
12370 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12371
12372 @smallexample
12373 void
12374 hello ()
12375 @{
12376 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12377 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12378 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12379 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12380 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12381 @}
12382 @end smallexample
12383
12384 @noindent
12385 you get during debugging:
12386
12387 @smallexample
12388 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12389 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12390 1 pattern found
12391 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12392 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12393 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12394 2 patterns found.
12395 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12396 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12397 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12398 2 patterns found.
12399 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12400 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12401 1 pattern found
12402 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12403 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12404 1 pattern found
12405 (gdb) print $numfound
12406 $1 = 1
12407 (gdb) print $_
12408 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12409 @end smallexample
12410
12411 @node Value Sizes
12412 @section Value Sizes
12413
12414 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12415 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12416 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12417 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12418 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12419
12420 @table @code
12421 @kindex set max-value-size
12422 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12423 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12424 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12425 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12426 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12427
12428 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12429 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12430
12431 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12432 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12433 currently 16 bytes.
12434
12435 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12436 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12437 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12438 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12439 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12440 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12441 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12442 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12443
12444 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12445
12446 @kindex show max-value-size
12447 @item show max-value-size
12448 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12449 allocate for the contents of a value.
12450 @end table
12451
12452 @node Optimized Code
12453 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12454 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12455 @cindex debugging optimized code
12456
12457 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12458 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12459 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12460 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12461 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12462 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12463 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12464
12465 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12466 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12467 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12468 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12469
12470 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12471 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12472 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12473 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12474 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12475 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12476
12477 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12478 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12479 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12480 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12481 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12482
12483 @menu
12484 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12485 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12486 @end menu
12487
12488 @node Inline Functions
12489 @section Inline Functions
12490 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12491
12492 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12493 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12494 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12495 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12496 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12497 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12498 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12499 @code{info frame} command.
12500
12501 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12502 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12503 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12504 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12505 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12506 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12507 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12508 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12509 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12510 local variables in the caller.
12511
12512 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12513 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12514 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12515 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12516 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12517 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12518 instructions are executed.
12519
12520 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12521 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12522 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12523 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12524
12525 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12526 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12527
12528 @itemize @bullet
12529 @item
12530 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12531 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12532 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12533 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12534 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12535 or inside the inlined function instead.
12536
12537 @item
12538 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12539 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12540 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12541 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12542
12543 @end itemize
12544
12545 @node Tail Call Frames
12546 @section Tail Call Frames
12547 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12548
12549 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12550 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12551 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12552 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12553 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12554
12555 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12556 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12557 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12558 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12559 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12560 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12561 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12562
12563 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12564 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12565 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12566 this information.
12567
12568 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12569 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12570
12571 @smallexample
12572 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12573 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12574 (gdb) info frame
12575 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12576 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12577 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12578 source language c++.
12579 Arglist at unknown address.
12580 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12581 @end smallexample
12582
12583 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12584 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12585 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12586 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12587 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12588 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12589
12590 @table @code
12591 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12592 @item set debug entry-values
12593 @kindex set debug entry-values
12594 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12595 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12596 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12597 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12598 result.
12599
12600 @item show debug entry-values
12601 @kindex show debug entry-values
12602 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12603 values at function entry and tail calls.
12604 @end table
12605
12606 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12607 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12608 reference by variable @code{x}):
12609
12610 @smallexample
12611 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12612 void (*x) (void) = c;
12613 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12614 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12615 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12616
12617 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12618 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12619 a () at t.c:3
12620 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12621 (gdb) bt
12622 #0 a () at t.c:3
12623 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12624 @end smallexample
12625
12626 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12627
12628 @smallexample
12629 int i;
12630 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12631 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12632 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12633 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12634 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12635 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12636 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12637 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12638
12639 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12640 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12641 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12642 (gdb) bt
12643 #0 f () at t.c:2
12644 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12645 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12646 @end smallexample
12647
12648 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12649 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12650
12651 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12652 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12653 @set ARROW @click{}
12654 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12655 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12656 @end ifset
12657 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12658 @set ARROW ->
12659 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12660 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12661 @end ifclear
12662
12663 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12664 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12665 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12666
12667 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12668 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12669 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12670 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12671 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12672 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12673
12674 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12675 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12676 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12677 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12678 omitted.
12679
12680 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12681 entry may fail:
12682
12683 @smallexample
12684 int v;
12685 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12686 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12687 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12688 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12689 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12690 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12691
12692 (gdb) bt
12693 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12694 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12695 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12696 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12697 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12698 @end smallexample
12699
12700 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12701 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12702 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12703 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12704 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12705
12706 @node Macros
12707 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12708
12709 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12710 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12711 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12712 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12713 where it was defined.
12714
12715 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12716 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12717 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12718 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12719
12720 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12721 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12722 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12723 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12724 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12725 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12726 see @ref{List}.
12727
12728 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12729 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12730 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12731
12732 @table @code
12733
12734 @kindex macro expand
12735 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12736 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12737 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12738 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12739 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12740 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12741 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12742 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12743 it can be any string of tokens.
12744
12745 @kindex macro exp1
12746 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12747 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12748 @cindex expand macro once
12749 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12750 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12751 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12752 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12753 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12754 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12755 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12756 can be any string of tokens.
12757
12758 @kindex info macro
12759 @cindex macro definition, showing
12760 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12761 @cindex macros, from debug info
12762 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12763 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12764 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12765 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12766 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12767 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12768
12769 @kindex info macros
12770 @item info macros @var{location}
12771 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12772 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12773 command-line where those definitions were established.
12774
12775 @kindex macro define
12776 @cindex user-defined macros
12777 @cindex defining macros interactively
12778 @cindex macros, user-defined
12779 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12780 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12781 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12782 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12783 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12784 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12785 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12786 @var{arglist}.
12787
12788 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12789 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12790 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12791 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12792 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12793
12794 @kindex macro undef
12795 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12796 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12797 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12798 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12799 in the program being debugged.
12800
12801 @kindex macro list
12802 @item macro list
12803 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12804 @end table
12805
12806 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12807 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12808 show our source files:
12809
12810 @smallexample
12811 $ cat sample.c
12812 #include <stdio.h>
12813 #include "sample.h"
12814
12815 #define M 42
12816 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12817
12818 main ()
12819 @{
12820 #define N 28
12821 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12822 #undef N
12823 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12824 #define N 1729
12825 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12826 @}
12827 $ cat sample.h
12828 #define Q <
12829 $
12830 @end smallexample
12831
12832 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12833 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12834 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12835 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12836 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12837 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12838 information.
12839
12840 @smallexample
12841 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12842 $
12843 @end smallexample
12844
12845 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12846
12847 @smallexample
12848 $ gdb -nw sample
12849 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12850 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12851 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12852 (@value{GDBP})
12853 @end smallexample
12854
12855 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12856 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12857 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12858
12859 @smallexample
12860 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12861 3
12862 4 #define M 42
12863 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12864 6
12865 7 main ()
12866 8 @{
12867 9 #define N 28
12868 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12869 11 #undef N
12870 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12871 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12872 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12873 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12874 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12875 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12876 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12877 #define Q <
12878 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12879 expands to: (42 + 1)
12880 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12881 expands to: once (M + 1)
12882 (@value{GDBP})
12883 @end smallexample
12884
12885 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12886 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12887 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12888 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12889
12890 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12891 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12892
12893 @smallexample
12894 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12895 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12896 (@value{GDBP}) run
12897 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12898
12899 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12900 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12901 (@value{GDBP})
12902 @end smallexample
12903
12904 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12905
12906 @smallexample
12907 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12908 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12909 #define N 28
12910 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12911 expands to: 28 < 42
12912 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12913 $1 = 1
12914 (@value{GDBP})
12915 @end smallexample
12916
12917 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12918 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12919 thereof) in force at each point:
12920
12921 @smallexample
12922 (@value{GDBP}) next
12923 Hello, world!
12924 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12925 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12926 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12927 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12928 (@value{GDBP}) next
12929 We're so creative.
12930 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12931 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12932 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12933 #define N 1729
12934 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12935 expands to: 1729 < 42
12936 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12937 $2 = 0
12938 (@value{GDBP})
12939 @end smallexample
12940
12941 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12942 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12943 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12944 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12945
12946 @smallexample
12947 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12948 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12949 -D__STDC__=1
12950 (@value{GDBP})
12951 @end smallexample
12952
12953
12954 @node Tracepoints
12955 @chapter Tracepoints
12956 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12957 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12958
12959 @cindex tracepoints
12960 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12961 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12962 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12963 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12964 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12965 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12966 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12967
12968 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12969 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12970 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12971 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12972 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12973 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12974 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12975 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12976 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12977 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12978 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12979
12980 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12981 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12982 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12983 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12984 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12985 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12986 Packets}.
12987
12988 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12989 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12990 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12991
12992 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12993
12994 @menu
12995 * Set Tracepoints::
12996 * Analyze Collected Data::
12997 * Tracepoint Variables::
12998 * Trace Files::
12999 @end menu
13000
13001 @node Set Tracepoints
13002 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13003
13004 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13005 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13006 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13007 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13008 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13009 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13010 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13011
13012 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13013 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13014 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13015 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13016 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13017 tracepoint was hit.
13018
13019 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13020 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13021 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13022 either.
13023
13024 @cindex fast tracepoints
13025 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13026 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13027 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13028
13029 @cindex static tracepoints
13030 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13031 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13032 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13033 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13034 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13035 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13036 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13037 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13038 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13039 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13040 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13041 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13042 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13043 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13044 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13045 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13046 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13047 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13048 static tracepoint marker.
13049
13050 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13051 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13052
13053 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13054 conditions and actions.
13055
13056 @menu
13057 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13058 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13059 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13060 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13061 * Trace State Variables::
13062 * Tracepoint Actions::
13063 * Listing Tracepoints::
13064 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13065 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13066 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13067 @end menu
13068
13069 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13070 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13071
13072 @table @code
13073 @cindex set tracepoint
13074 @kindex trace
13075 @item trace @var{location}
13076 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13077 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13078 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13079 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13080 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13081 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13082 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13083 in tracing}).
13084 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13085 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13086 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13087 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13088 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13089 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13090 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13091 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13092 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13093 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13094 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13095 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13096
13097 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13098
13099 @smallexample
13100 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13101
13102 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13103
13104 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13105
13106 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13107
13108 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13109 @end smallexample
13110
13111 @noindent
13112 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13113
13114 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13115 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13116 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13117 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13118 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13119 information on tracepoint conditions.
13120
13121 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13122 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13123 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13124 @kindex ftrace
13125 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13126 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13127 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13128 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13129 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13130 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13131 message.
13132
13133 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13134 @code{trace}.
13135
13136 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13137 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13138 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13139 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13140 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13141 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13142 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13143 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13144
13145 @example
13146 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13147 @end example
13148
13149 @noindent
13150 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13151 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13152
13153 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13154 @cindex set static tracepoint
13155 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13156 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13157 @kindex strace
13158 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13159 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13160 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13161 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13162 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13163
13164 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13165 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13166 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13167 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13168 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13169 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13170 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13171 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13172 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13173 tracing engine:
13174
13175 @smallexample
13176 main ()
13177 @{
13178 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13179 @}
13180 @end smallexample
13181
13182 @noindent
13183 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13184 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13185
13186 @smallexample
13187 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13188 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13189 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13190 Data: "str %s"
13191 [etc...]
13192 @end smallexample
13193
13194 @noindent
13195 so you may probe the marker above with:
13196
13197 @smallexample
13198 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13199 @end smallexample
13200
13201 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13202 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13203 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13204 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13205 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13206 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13207 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13208 the @samp{Data:} field.
13209
13210 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13211 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13212 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13213
13214 @vindex $tpnum
13215 @cindex last tracepoint number
13216 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13217 @cindex tracepoint number
13218 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13219 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13220
13221 @kindex delete tracepoint
13222 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13223 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13224 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13225 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13226 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13227
13228 Examples:
13229
13230 @smallexample
13231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13232
13233 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13234 @end smallexample
13235
13236 @noindent
13237 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13238 @end table
13239
13240 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13241 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13242
13243 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13244
13245 @table @code
13246 @kindex disable tracepoint
13247 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13248 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13249 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13250 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13251 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13252 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13253 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13254 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13255 next trace experiment.
13256
13257 @kindex enable tracepoint
13258 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13259 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13260 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13261 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13262 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13263 next time a trace experiment is run.
13264 @end table
13265
13266 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13267 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13268
13269 @table @code
13270 @kindex passcount
13271 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13272 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13273 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13274 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13275 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13276 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13277 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13278 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13279 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13280 user.
13281
13282 Examples:
13283
13284 @smallexample
13285 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13286 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13287
13288 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13289 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13290 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13291 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13292 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13293 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13294 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13295 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13296 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13297 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13298 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13299 @end smallexample
13300 @end table
13301
13302 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13303 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13304 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13305 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13306
13307 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13308 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13309 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13310 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13311 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13312 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13313 is true.
13314
13315 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13316 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13317 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13318 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13319 just as with breakpoints.
13320
13321 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13322 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13323 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13324 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13325 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13326 accesses, and so forth.
13327
13328 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13329 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13330 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13331 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13332 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13333 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13334 search through.
13335
13336 @smallexample
13337 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13338 @end smallexample
13339
13340 @node Trace State Variables
13341 @subsection Trace State Variables
13342 @cindex trace state variables
13343
13344 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13345 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13346 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13347 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13348 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13349 integers.
13350
13351 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13352 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13353 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13354 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13355
13356 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13357 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13358 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13359 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13360 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13361 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13362 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13363 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13364 variable with the same name.
13365
13366 @table @code
13367
13368 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13369 @kindex tvariable
13370 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13371 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13372 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13373 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13374 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13375 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13376 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13377 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13378 value. The default initial value is 0.
13379
13380 @item info tvariables
13381 @kindex info tvariables
13382 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13383 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13384 currently running.
13385
13386 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13387 @kindex delete tvariable
13388 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13389 are specified.
13390
13391 @end table
13392
13393 @node Tracepoint Actions
13394 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13395
13396 @table @code
13397 @kindex actions
13398 @cindex tracepoint actions
13399 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13400 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13401 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13402 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13403 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13404 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13405 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13406 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13407 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13408 @code{while-stepping}.
13409
13410 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13411 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13412 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13413
13414 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13415 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13416 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13417
13418 @smallexample
13419 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13420
13421 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13422
13423 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13424 @end smallexample
13425
13426 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13427 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13428 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13429 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13430 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13431 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13432 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13433 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13434
13435 @smallexample
13436 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13437 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13438 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13439 > collect bar,baz
13440 > collect $regs
13441 > while-stepping 12
13442 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13443 > end
13444 end
13445 @end smallexample
13446
13447 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13448 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13449 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13450 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13451 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13452 special arguments are supported:
13453
13454 @table @code
13455 @item $regs
13456 Collect all registers.
13457
13458 @item $args
13459 Collect all function arguments.
13460
13461 @item $locals
13462 Collect all local variables.
13463
13464 @item $_ret
13465 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13466 of a backtrace.
13467
13468 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13469 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13470 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13471 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13472 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13473 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13474
13475 @item $_probe_argc
13476 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13477 tracepoint is located.
13478 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13479
13480 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13481 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13482 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13483 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13484
13485 @item $_sdata
13486 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13487 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13488 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13489 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13490 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13491 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13492 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13493 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13494 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13495
13496 @smallexample
13497 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13498 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13499 @end smallexample
13500
13501 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13502 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13503 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13504 @value{GDBN}.
13505 @end table
13506
13507 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13508 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13509 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13510
13511 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13512 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13513 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13514 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13515 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13516 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13517 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13518 @samp{mystr}.
13519
13520 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13521 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13522
13523 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13524 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13525 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13526 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13527 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13528 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13529 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13530 action were used.
13531
13532 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13533 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13534 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13535 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13536 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13537 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13538
13539 @smallexample
13540 > while-stepping 12
13541 > collect $regs, myglobal
13542 > end
13543 >
13544 @end smallexample
13545
13546 @noindent
13547 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13548 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13549 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13550 @code{stepping}.
13551
13552 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13553 @kindex set default-collect
13554 @cindex default collection action
13555 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13556 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13557 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13558 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13559 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13560 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13561
13562 @item show default-collect
13563 @kindex show default-collect
13564 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13565 tracepoint hit.
13566
13567 @end table
13568
13569 @node Listing Tracepoints
13570 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13571
13572 @table @code
13573 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13574 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13575 @cindex information about tracepoints
13576 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13577 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13578 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13579 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13580 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13581 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13582
13583 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13584 tracing:
13585
13586 @itemize @bullet
13587 @item
13588 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13589
13590 @item
13591 the state about installed on target of each location
13592 @end itemize
13593
13594 @smallexample
13595 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13596 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13597 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13598 while-stepping 20
13599 collect globfoo, $regs
13600 end
13601 collect globfoo2
13602 end
13603 pass count 1200
13604 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13605 collect $eip
13606 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13607 installed on target
13608 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13609 installed on target
13610 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13611 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13612 not installed on target
13613 (@value{GDBP})
13614 @end smallexample
13615
13616 @noindent
13617 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13618 @end table
13619
13620 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13621 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13622
13623 @table @code
13624 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13625 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13626 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13627 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13628 program.
13629
13630 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13631
13632 @table @emph
13633 @item Count
13634 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13635 stable identifier.
13636 @item ID
13637 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13638 @item Enabled or Disabled
13639 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13640 that are not enabled.
13641 @item Address
13642 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13643 @item What
13644 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13645 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13646 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13647 will be left blank.
13648 @end table
13649
13650 @noindent
13651 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13652
13653 @table @emph
13654 @item Data
13655 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13656 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13657 marker call.
13658 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13659 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13660 @end table
13661
13662 @smallexample
13663 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13664 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13665 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13666 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13667 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13668 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13669 Data: str %s
13670 (@value{GDBP})
13671 @end smallexample
13672 @end table
13673
13674 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13675 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13676
13677 @table @code
13678 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13679 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13680 @cindex collected data discarded
13681 @item tstart
13682 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13683 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13684 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13685 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13686 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13687 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13688 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13689 information, and so forth.
13690
13691 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13692 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13693 @item tstop
13694 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13695 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13696 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13697 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13698 needs to be stopped quickly.
13699
13700 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13701 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13702 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13703
13704 @kindex tstatus
13705 @cindex status of trace data collection
13706 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13707 @item tstatus
13708 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13709 collection.
13710 @end table
13711
13712 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13713
13714 @smallexample
13715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13717 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13718 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13719 > while-stepping 11
13720 > collect $regs
13721 > end
13722 > end
13723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13724 [time passes @dots{}]
13725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13726 @end smallexample
13727
13728 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13729 @cindex disconnected tracing
13730 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13731 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13732 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13733 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13734 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13735 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13736 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13737 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13738
13739 @table @code
13740 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13741 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13742 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13743 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13744 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13745 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13746 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13747 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13748
13749 @item show disconnected-tracing
13750 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13751 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13752
13753 @end table
13754
13755 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13756 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13757 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13758 it will continue after reconnection.
13759
13760 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13761 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13762 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13763 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13764 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13765 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13766 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13767 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13768 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13769 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13770
13771 @cindex circular trace buffer
13772 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13773 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13774 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13775 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13776 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13777 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13778 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13779 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13780 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13781 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13782 the next run.
13783
13784 @table @code
13785 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13786 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13787 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13788 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13789 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13790 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13791 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13792
13793 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13794 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13795 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13796 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13797 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13798 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13799
13800 @end table
13801
13802 @table @code
13803 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13804 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13805 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13806 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13807 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13808 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13809 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13810 likes. This is also the default.
13811
13812 @item show trace-buffer-size
13813 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13814 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13815 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13816 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13817 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13818 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13819 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13820 @end table
13821
13822 @table @code
13823 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13824 @kindex set trace-user
13825
13826 @item show trace-user
13827 @kindex show trace-user
13828
13829 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13830 @kindex set trace-notes
13831 Set the trace run's notes.
13832
13833 @item show trace-notes
13834 @kindex show trace-notes
13835 Show the trace run's notes.
13836
13837 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13838 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13839 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13840 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13841 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13842
13843 @item show trace-stop-notes
13844 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13845 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13846
13847 @end table
13848
13849 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13850 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13851
13852 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13853 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13854 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13855 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13856 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13857 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13858 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13859 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13860 mentioned here.
13861
13862 @itemize @bullet
13863
13864 @item
13865 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13866 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13867 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13868 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13869 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13870 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13871 cannot be collected either.
13872
13873 @item
13874 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13875 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13876 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13877 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13878 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13879 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13880 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13881 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13882 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13883 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13884
13885 @item
13886 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13887 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13888 in a misleading way.
13889
13890 @item
13891 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13892 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13893 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13894 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13895 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13896 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13897 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13898 by @code{ptr}.
13899
13900 @item
13901 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13902 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13903 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13904 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13905 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13906 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13907 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13908 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13909 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13910 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13911 invalid address.
13912
13913 @item
13914 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13915 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13916 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13917 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13918 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13919 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13920 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13921 it to zero.
13922
13923 @end itemize
13924
13925 @node Analyze Collected Data
13926 @section Using the Collected Data
13927
13928 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13929 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13930 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13931 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13932 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13933 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13934 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13935 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13936 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13937 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13938 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13939 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13940 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13941 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13942 the buffer will fail.
13943
13944 @menu
13945 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13946 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13947 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13948 @end menu
13949
13950 @node tfind
13951 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13952
13953 @kindex tfind
13954 @cindex select trace snapshot
13955 @cindex find trace snapshot
13956 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13957 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13958 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13959 snapshot is selected.
13960
13961 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13962
13963 @table @code
13964 @item tfind start
13965 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13966 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13967
13968 @item tfind none
13969 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13970
13971 @item tfind end
13972 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13973
13974 @item tfind
13975 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13976 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13977
13978 @item tfind -
13979 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13980 retracing earlier steps.
13981
13982 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13983 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13984 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13985 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13986 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13987
13988 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13989 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13990 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13991 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13992 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13993
13994 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13995 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13996 addresses (exclusive).
13997
13998 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13999 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14000 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14001
14002 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14003 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14004 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14005 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14006 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14007 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14008 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14009 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14010 @end table
14011
14012 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14013 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14014 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14015 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14016 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14017 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14018 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14019 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14020 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14021 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14022 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14023 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14024 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14025 tracepoint as the current one.
14026
14027 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14028 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14029 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14030 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14031 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14032
14033 @smallexample
14034 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14035 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14036 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14037 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14038 > tfind
14039 > end
14040
14041 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14042 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14043 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14044 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14045 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14046 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14047 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14048 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14049 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14050 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14051 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14052 @end smallexample
14053
14054 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14055 the buffer:
14056
14057 @smallexample
14058 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14059 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14060 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14061 > tfind line
14062 > end
14063
14064 Frame 0, X = 1
14065 Frame 7, X = 2
14066 Frame 13, X = 255
14067 @end smallexample
14068
14069 @node tdump
14070 @subsection @code{tdump}
14071 @kindex tdump
14072 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14073 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14074
14075 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14076 the current trace snapshot.
14077
14078 @smallexample
14079 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14080 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14081 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14082 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14083 > end
14084
14085 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14086
14087 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14088 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14089 at gdb_test.c:444
14090 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14091
14092 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14093 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14094 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14095 d1 0x18 24
14096 d2 0x80 128
14097 d3 0x33 51
14098 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14099 d5 0x22 34
14100 d6 0xe0 224
14101 d7 0x380035 3670069
14102 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14103 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14104 a2 0x100 256
14105 a3 0x322000 3284992
14106 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14107 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14108 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14109 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14110 ps 0x0 0
14111 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14112 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14113 fpstatus 0x0 0
14114 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14115 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14116 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14117 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14118 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14119 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14120 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14121 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14122 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14123
14124 (@value{GDBP})
14125 @end smallexample
14126
14127 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14128 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14129 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14130 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14131
14132 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14133 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14134 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14135 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14136 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14137 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14138 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14139 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14140 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14141 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14142
14143 @node save tracepoints
14144 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14145 @kindex save tracepoints
14146 @kindex save-tracepoints
14147 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14148
14149 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14150 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14151 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14152 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14153 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14154 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14155
14156 @node Tracepoint Variables
14157 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14158 @cindex tracepoint variables
14159 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14160
14161 @table @code
14162 @vindex $trace_frame
14163 @item (int) $trace_frame
14164 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14165 snapshot is selected.
14166
14167 @vindex $tracepoint
14168 @item (int) $tracepoint
14169 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14170
14171 @vindex $trace_line
14172 @item (int) $trace_line
14173 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14174
14175 @vindex $trace_file
14176 @item (char []) $trace_file
14177 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14178
14179 @vindex $trace_func
14180 @item (char []) $trace_func
14181 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14182 @end table
14183
14184 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14185 use @code{output} instead.
14186
14187 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14188 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14189 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14190 which are managed by the target.
14191
14192 @smallexample
14193 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14194
14195 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14196 > output $trace_file
14197 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14198 > tfind
14199 > end
14200 @end smallexample
14201
14202 @node Trace Files
14203 @section Using Trace Files
14204 @cindex trace files
14205
14206 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14207 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14208 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14209 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14210 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14211
14212 @table @code
14213
14214 @kindex tsave
14215 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14216 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14217 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14218 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14219 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14220 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14221 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14222 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14223 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14224 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14225 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14226 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14227 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14228 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14229 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14230
14231 @kindex target tfile
14232 @kindex tfile
14233 @kindex target ctf
14234 @kindex ctf
14235 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14236 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14237 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14238 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14239 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14240 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14241 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14242 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14243 the host.
14244
14245 @smallexample
14246 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14247 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14248 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14249 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14250 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14251 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14252 i = 0
14253 a = 0
14254 b = 1 '\001'
14255 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14256 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14257 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14258 $1 = 1
14259 @end smallexample
14260
14261 @end table
14262
14263 @node Overlays
14264 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14265 @cindex overlays
14266
14267 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14268 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14269 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14270 use overlays.
14271
14272 @menu
14273 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14274 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14275 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14276 mapped by asking the inferior.
14277 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14278 @end menu
14279
14280 @node How Overlays Work
14281 @section How Overlays Work
14282 @cindex mapped overlays
14283 @cindex unmapped overlays
14284 @cindex load address, overlay's
14285 @cindex mapped address
14286 @cindex overlay area
14287
14288 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14289 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14290 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14291 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14292 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14293
14294 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14295 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14296 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14297 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14298 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14299 largest overlay as well.
14300
14301 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14302 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14303 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14304 there.
14305
14306 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14307 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14308 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14309
14310 @smallexample
14311 @group
14312 Data Instruction Larger
14313 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14314 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14315 | | | | | |
14316 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14317 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14318 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14319 | and heap | | | | | |
14320 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14321 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14322 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14323 | | | | | |
14324 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14325 address | | | | | |
14326 | overlay | <-' | | |
14327 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14328 | | <---. | | load address
14329 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14330 | | | |
14331 +-----------+ | |
14332 +-----------+
14333 | |
14334 +-----------+
14335
14336 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14337 @end group
14338 @end smallexample
14339
14340 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14341 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14342 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14343 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14344 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14345 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14346 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14347 program and the overlay area.
14348
14349 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14350 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14351 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14352 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14353 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14354 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14355 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14356
14357 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14358 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14359 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14360
14361 @itemize @bullet
14362
14363 @item
14364 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14365 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14366 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14367 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14368
14369 @item
14370 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14371 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14372 your program's performance.
14373
14374 @item
14375 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14376 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14377 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14378 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14379 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14380 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14381 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14382
14383 @item
14384 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14385 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14386 instruction and data spaces.
14387
14388 @end itemize
14389
14390 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14391 improved in many ways:
14392
14393 @itemize @bullet
14394
14395 @item
14396 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14397 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14398 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14399 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14400 area in the usual way.
14401
14402 @item
14403 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14404 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14405
14406 @item
14407 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14408 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14409 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14410 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14411 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14412 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14413 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14414
14415 @end itemize
14416
14417
14418 @node Overlay Commands
14419 @section Overlay Commands
14420
14421 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14422 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14423 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14424 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14425 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14426 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14427
14428 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14429 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14430
14431 @table @code
14432 @item overlay off
14433 @kindex overlay
14434 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14435 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14436 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14437 overlay support is disabled.
14438
14439 @item overlay manual
14440 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14441 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14442 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14443 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14444 commands described below.
14445
14446 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14447 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14448 @cindex map an overlay
14449 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14450 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14451 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14452 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14453 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14454 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14455
14456 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14457 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14458 @cindex unmap an overlay
14459 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14460 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14461 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14462 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14463
14464 @item overlay auto
14465 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14466 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14467 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14468 Overlay Debugging}.
14469
14470 @item overlay load-target
14471 @itemx overlay load
14472 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14473 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14474 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14475 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14476 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14477 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14478
14479 @item overlay list-overlays
14480 @itemx overlay list
14481 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14482 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14483 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14484
14485 @end table
14486
14487 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14488 of the function the address falls in:
14489
14490 @smallexample
14491 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14492 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14493 @end smallexample
14494 @noindent
14495 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14496 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14497 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14498 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14499
14500 @smallexample
14501 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14502 No sections are mapped.
14503 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14504 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14505 @end smallexample
14506 @noindent
14507 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14508 name normally:
14509
14510 @smallexample
14511 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14512 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14513 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14514 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14515 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14516 @end smallexample
14517
14518 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14519 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14520 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14521 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14522 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14523
14524 @itemize @bullet
14525 @item
14526 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14527 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14528 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14529 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14530 @item
14531 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14532 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14533 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14534 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14535 breakpoints properly.
14536 @end itemize
14537
14538
14539 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14540 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14541 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14542
14543 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14544 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14545 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14546 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14547 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14548 current state of the overlays.
14549
14550 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14551 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14552
14553 @table @asis
14554
14555 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14556 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14557
14558 @smallexample
14559 struct
14560 @{
14561 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14562 unsigned long vma;
14563
14564 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14565 unsigned long size;
14566
14567 /* The overlay's load address. */
14568 unsigned long lma;
14569
14570 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14571 zero otherwise. */
14572 unsigned long mapped;
14573 @}
14574 @end smallexample
14575
14576 @item @code{_novlys}:
14577 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14578 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14579
14580 @end table
14581
14582 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14583 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14584 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14585 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14586 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14587 currently mapped.
14588
14589 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14590 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14591 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14592 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14593 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14594 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14595 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14596 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14597 are not being executed.
14598
14599 @node Overlay Sample Program
14600 @section Overlay Sample Program
14601 @cindex overlay example program
14602
14603 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14604 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14605 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14606 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14607 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14608 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14609 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14610
14611 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14612 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14613 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14614 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14615
14616 @table @file
14617 @item overlays.c
14618 The main program file.
14619 @item ovlymgr.c
14620 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14621 @item foo.c
14622 @itemx bar.c
14623 @itemx baz.c
14624 @itemx grbx.c
14625 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14626 @item d10v.ld
14627 @itemx m32r.ld
14628 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14629 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14630 @end table
14631
14632 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14633 cross-compiler like this:
14634
14635 @smallexample
14636 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14637 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14638 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14639 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14640 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14641 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14642 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14643 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14644 @end smallexample
14645
14646 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14647 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14648 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14649
14650
14651 @node Languages
14652 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14653 @cindex languages
14654
14655 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14656 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14657 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14658 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14659 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14660 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14661
14662 @cindex working language
14663 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14664 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14665 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14666 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14667 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14668 language}.
14669
14670 @menu
14671 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14672 * Show:: Displaying the language
14673 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14674 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14675 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14676 @end menu
14677
14678 @node Setting
14679 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14680
14681 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14682 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14683 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14684 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14685 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14686 are printed, etc.
14687
14688 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14689 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14690 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14691 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14692 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14693 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14694 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14695 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14696 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14697 Displaying the Language}.
14698
14699 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14700 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14701 another language. In that case, make the
14702 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14703 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14704 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14705
14706 @menu
14707 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14708 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14709 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14710 @end menu
14711
14712 @node Filenames
14713 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14714
14715 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14716 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14717
14718 @table @file
14719 @item .ada
14720 @itemx .ads
14721 @itemx .adb
14722 @itemx .a
14723 Ada source file.
14724
14725 @item .c
14726 C source file
14727
14728 @item .C
14729 @itemx .cc
14730 @itemx .cp
14731 @itemx .cpp
14732 @itemx .cxx
14733 @itemx .c++
14734 C@t{++} source file
14735
14736 @item .d
14737 D source file
14738
14739 @item .m
14740 Objective-C source file
14741
14742 @item .f
14743 @itemx .F
14744 Fortran source file
14745
14746 @item .mod
14747 Modula-2 source file
14748
14749 @item .s
14750 @itemx .S
14751 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14752 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14753 @end table
14754
14755 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14756 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14757
14758 @node Manually
14759 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14760
14761 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14762 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14763 your program.
14764
14765 @kindex set language
14766 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14767 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14768 a language, such as
14769 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14770 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14771
14772 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14773 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14774 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14775 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14776 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14777 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14778 command such as:
14779
14780 @smallexample
14781 print a = b + c
14782 @end smallexample
14783
14784 @noindent
14785 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14786 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14787 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14788 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14789
14790 @node Automatically
14791 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14792
14793 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14794 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14795 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14796 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14797 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14798 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14799 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14800 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14801 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14802
14803 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14804 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14805 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14806 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14807 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14808
14809 @node Show
14810 @section Displaying the Language
14811
14812 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14813 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14814
14815 @table @code
14816 @item show language
14817 @anchor{show language}
14818 @kindex show language
14819 Display the current working language. This is the
14820 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14821 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14822
14823 @item info frame
14824 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14825 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14826 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14827 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14828 information listed here.
14829
14830 @item info source
14831 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14832 Display the source language of this source file.
14833 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14834 information listed here.
14835 @end table
14836
14837 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14838 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14839 with a language explicitly:
14840
14841 @table @code
14842 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14843 @kindex set extension-language
14844 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14845 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14846
14847 @item info extensions
14848 @kindex info extensions
14849 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14850 @end table
14851
14852 @node Checks
14853 @section Type and Range Checking
14854
14855 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14856 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14857 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14858 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14859 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14860 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14861 errors when your program is running.
14862
14863 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14864 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14865 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14866 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14867
14868 @menu
14869 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14870 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14871 @end menu
14872
14873 @cindex type checking
14874 @cindex checks, type
14875 @node Type Checking
14876 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14877
14878 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14879 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14880 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14881 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14882
14883 @smallexample
14884 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14885
14886 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14887 $1 = 2
14888 @exdent but
14889 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14890 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14891 @end smallexample
14892
14893 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14894 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14895
14896 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14897 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14898 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14899 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14900 expressions like the second example above.
14901
14902 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14903 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14904 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14905 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14906 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14907 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14908
14909 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14910
14911 @kindex set check type
14912 @kindex show check type
14913 @table @code
14914 @item set check type on
14915 @itemx set check type off
14916 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14917 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14918 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14919
14920 @item show check type
14921 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14922 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14923 @end table
14924
14925 @cindex range checking
14926 @cindex checks, range
14927 @node Range Checking
14928 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14929
14930 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14931 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14932 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14933 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14934 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14935
14936 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14937 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14938 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14939 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14940
14941 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14942 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14943 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14944 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14945 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14946 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14947
14948 @smallexample
14949 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14950 @end smallexample
14951
14952 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14953 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14954 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14955
14956 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14957
14958 @kindex set check range
14959 @kindex show check range
14960 @table @code
14961 @item set check range auto
14962 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14963 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14964 each language.
14965
14966 @item set check range on
14967 @itemx set check range off
14968 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14969 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14970 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14971 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14972
14973 @item set check range warn
14974 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14975 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14976 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14977 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14978 systems).
14979
14980 @item show range
14981 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14982 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14983 @end table
14984
14985 @node Supported Languages
14986 @section Supported Languages
14987
14988 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14989 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14990 @c This is false ...
14991 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14992 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14993 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14994 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14995 language.
14996
14997 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14998 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14999 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15000 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15001 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15002 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15003 language reference or tutorial.
15004
15005 @menu
15006 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15007 * D:: D
15008 * Go:: Go
15009 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15010 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15011 * Fortran:: Fortran
15012 * Pascal:: Pascal
15013 * Rust:: Rust
15014 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15015 * Ada:: Ada
15016 @end menu
15017
15018 @node C
15019 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15020
15021 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15022 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15023
15024 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15025 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15026 together.
15027
15028 @cindex C@t{++}
15029 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15030 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15031 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15032 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15033 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15034 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15035 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15036
15037 @menu
15038 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15039 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15040 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15041 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15042 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15043 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15044 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15045 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15046 @end menu
15047
15048 @node C Operators
15049 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15050
15051 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15052
15053 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15054 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15055 often defined on groups of types.
15056
15057 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15058
15059 @itemize @bullet
15060
15061 @item
15062 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15063 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15064
15065 @item
15066 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15067 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15068
15069 @item
15070 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15071
15072 @item
15073 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15074
15075 @end itemize
15076
15077 @noindent
15078 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15079 in order of increasing precedence:
15080
15081 @table @code
15082 @item ,
15083 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15084 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15085 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15086
15087 @item =
15088 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15089 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15090
15091 @item @var{op}=
15092 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15093 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15094 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15095 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15096 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15097
15098 @item ?:
15099 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15100 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15101 should be of an integral type.
15102
15103 @item ||
15104 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15105
15106 @item &&
15107 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15108
15109 @item |
15110 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15111
15112 @item ^
15113 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15114
15115 @item &
15116 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15117
15118 @item ==@r{, }!=
15119 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15120 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15121
15122 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15123 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15124 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15125 and non-zero for true.
15126
15127 @item <<@r{, }>>
15128 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15129
15130 @item @@
15131 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15132
15133 @item +@r{, }-
15134 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15135 pointer types.
15136
15137 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15138 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15139 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15140 integral types.
15141
15142 @item ++@r{, }--
15143 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15144 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15145 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15146 operation takes place.
15147
15148 @item *
15149 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15150 @code{++}.
15151
15152 @item &
15153 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15154
15155 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15156 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15157 to examine the address
15158 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15159 stored.
15160
15161 @item -
15162 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15163 precedence as @code{++}.
15164
15165 @item !
15166 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15167 @code{++}.
15168
15169 @item ~
15170 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15171 @code{++}.
15172
15173
15174 @item .@r{, }->
15175 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15176 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15177 pointer based on the stored type information.
15178 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15179
15180 @item .*@r{, }->*
15181 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15182
15183 @item []
15184 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15185 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15186
15187 @item ()
15188 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15189
15190 @item ::
15191 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15192 and @code{class} types.
15193
15194 @item ::
15195 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15196 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15197 above.
15198 @end table
15199
15200 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15201 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15202 predefined meaning.
15203
15204 @node C Constants
15205 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15206
15207 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15208
15209 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15210 following ways:
15211
15212 @itemize @bullet
15213 @item
15214 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15215 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15216 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15217 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15218 @code{long} value.
15219
15220 @item
15221 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15222 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15223 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15224 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15225 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15226 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15227 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15228 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15229 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15230 constant.
15231
15232 @item
15233 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15234 integral equivalents.
15235
15236 @item
15237 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15238 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15239 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15240 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15241 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15242 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15243 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15244 @samp{\n} for newline.
15245
15246 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15247 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15248 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15249 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15250
15251 @item
15252 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15253 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15254 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15255 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15256 characters.
15257
15258 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15259 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15260 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15261
15262 @item
15263 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15264 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15265
15266 @item
15267 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15268 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15269 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15270 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15271 @end itemize
15272
15273 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15274 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15275
15276 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15277 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15278
15279 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15280 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15281 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15282 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15283 @quotation
15284 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15285 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15286 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15287 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15288 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15289 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15290 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15291 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15292 @end quotation
15293
15294 @enumerate
15295
15296 @cindex member functions
15297 @item
15298 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15299
15300 @smallexample
15301 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15302 @end smallexample
15303
15304 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15305 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15306 @item
15307 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15308 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15309 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15310 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15311 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15312
15313 @cindex call overloaded functions
15314 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15315 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15316 @item
15317 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15318 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15319 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15320 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15321 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15322 default arguments.
15323
15324 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15325 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15326 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15327 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15328 number of function arguments.
15329
15330 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15331 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15332 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15333
15334 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15335 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15336 @smallexample
15337 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15338 @end smallexample
15339
15340 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15341 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15342
15343 @cindex reference declarations
15344 @item
15345 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15346 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15347 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15348
15349 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15350 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15351 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15352 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15353 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15354
15355 @item
15356 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15357 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15358 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15359 necessary, for example in an expression like
15360 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15361 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15362 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15363
15364 @item
15365 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15366 specification.
15367 @end enumerate
15368
15369 @node C Defaults
15370 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15371
15372 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15373
15374 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15375 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15376 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15377 selects the working language.
15378
15379 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15380 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15381 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15382 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15383 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15384 for further details.
15385
15386 @node C Checks
15387 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15388
15389 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15390
15391 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15392 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15393 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15394 constants to pointers.
15395
15396 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15397 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15398 that is not itself an array.
15399
15400 @node Debugging C
15401 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15402
15403 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15404 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15405 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15406 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15407
15408 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15409 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15410 ,Expressions}.
15411
15412 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15413 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15414
15415 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15416
15417 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15418 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15419
15420 @table @code
15421 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15422 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15423 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15424 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15425 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15426 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15427
15428 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15429 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15430 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15431 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15432 classes.
15433 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15434
15435 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15436 @item catch throw
15437 @itemx catch rethrow
15438 @itemx catch catch
15439 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15440 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15441
15442 @cindex inheritance
15443 @item ptype @var{typename}
15444 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15445 @var{typename}.
15446 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15447
15448 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15449 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15450 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15451 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15452 multiple inheritance is in use.
15453
15454 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15455 @item demangle @var{name}
15456 Demangle @var{name}.
15457 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15458
15459 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15460 @item set print demangle
15461 @itemx show print demangle
15462 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15463 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15464 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15465 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15466 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15467
15468 @item set print object
15469 @itemx show print object
15470 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15471 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15472
15473 @item set print vtbl
15474 @itemx show print vtbl
15475 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15476 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15477 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15478 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15479
15480 @kindex set overload-resolution
15481 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15482 @item set overload-resolution on
15483 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15484 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15485 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15486 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15487 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15488 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15489
15490 @item set overload-resolution off
15491 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15492 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15493 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15494 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15495 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15496 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15497 argument types.
15498
15499 @kindex show overload-resolution
15500 @item show overload-resolution
15501 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15502
15503 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15504 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15505 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15506 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15507 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15508 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15509 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15510
15511 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15512
15513 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15514 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15515 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15516 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15517 for more detail.
15518
15519 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15520 function that returns a std::string:
15521
15522 @smallexample
15523 std::string function(int);
15524 @end smallexample
15525
15526 @noindent
15527 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15528 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15529
15530 @smallexample
15531 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15532 @end smallexample
15533
15534 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15535 tag. For example:
15536
15537 @smallexample
15538 (gdb) b function(int)
15539 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15540 (gdb) info breakpoints
15541 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15542 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15543 at main.cc:10
15544 @end smallexample
15545
15546 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15547 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15548 name, like:
15549
15550 @smallexample
15551 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15552 @end smallexample
15553 @end table
15554
15555 @node Decimal Floating Point
15556 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15557 @cindex decimal floating point format
15558
15559 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15560 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15561 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15562 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15563
15564 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15565 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15566 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15567 configured target.
15568
15569 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15570 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15571 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15572
15573 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15574 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15575 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15576
15577 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15578 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15579 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15580
15581 @node D
15582 @subsection D
15583
15584 @cindex D
15585 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15586 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15587 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15588
15589 @node Go
15590 @subsection Go
15591
15592 @cindex Go (programming language)
15593 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15594 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15595
15596 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15597
15598 @table @code
15599 @cindex current Go package
15600 @item The current Go package
15601 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15602 specifying global variables and functions.
15603
15604 For example, given the program:
15605
15606 @example
15607 package main
15608 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15609 func main () @{
15610 // ...
15611 @}
15612 @end example
15613
15614 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15615
15616 @example
15617 (gdb) p myglob
15618 (gdb) p main.myglob
15619 @end example
15620
15621 @cindex builtin Go types
15622 @item Builtin Go types
15623 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15624 as a string.
15625
15626 @cindex builtin Go functions
15627 @item Builtin Go functions
15628 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15629 function and handles it internally.
15630
15631 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15632 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15633 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15634 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15635 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15636 @end table
15637
15638 @node Objective-C
15639 @subsection Objective-C
15640
15641 @cindex Objective-C
15642 This section provides information about some commands and command
15643 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15644 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15645 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15646
15647 @menu
15648 * Method Names in Commands::
15649 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15650 @end menu
15651
15652 @node Method Names in Commands
15653 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15654
15655 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15656 names as line specifications:
15657
15658 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15659 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15660 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15661 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15662 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15663 @itemize
15664 @item @code{clear}
15665 @item @code{break}
15666 @item @code{info line}
15667 @item @code{jump}
15668 @item @code{list}
15669 @end itemize
15670
15671 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15672
15673 @smallexample
15674 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15675 @end smallexample
15676
15677 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15678 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15679 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15680 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15681 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15682 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15683 debugged, enter:
15684
15685 @smallexample
15686 break -[Fruit create]
15687 @end smallexample
15688
15689 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15690 enter:
15691
15692 @smallexample
15693 list +[NSText initialize]
15694 @end smallexample
15695
15696 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15697 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15698 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15699 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15700
15701 @smallexample
15702 break create
15703 @end smallexample
15704
15705 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15706 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15707 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15708 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15709 none apply.
15710
15711 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15712 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15713
15714 @smallexample
15715 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15716 @end smallexample
15717
15718 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15719 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15720 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15721 @kindex print-object
15722 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15723
15724 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15725
15726 @smallexample
15727 print -[@var{object} hash]
15728 @end smallexample
15729
15730 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15731 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15732 @noindent
15733 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15734 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15735 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15736 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15737 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15738 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15739
15740 @node OpenCL C
15741 @subsection OpenCL C
15742
15743 @cindex OpenCL C
15744 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15745
15746 @menu
15747 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15748 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15749 * OpenCL C Operators::
15750 @end menu
15751
15752 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15753 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15754
15755 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15756 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15757 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15758 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15759 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15760
15761 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15762 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15763
15764 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15765 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15766 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15767 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15768
15769 @node OpenCL C Operators
15770 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15771
15772 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15773 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15774 vector data types.
15775
15776 @node Fortran
15777 @subsection Fortran
15778 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15779
15780 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15781 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15782
15783 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15784 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15785 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15786 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15787 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15788 underscore.
15789
15790 @menu
15791 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15792 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15793 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15794 @end menu
15795
15796 @node Fortran Operators
15797 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15798
15799 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15800
15801 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15802 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15803 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15804
15805 @table @code
15806 @item **
15807 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15808 of the second one.
15809
15810 @item :
15811 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15812 represent a section of array.
15813
15814 @item %
15815 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15816 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15817 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15818 union type.
15819 @end table
15820
15821 @node Fortran Defaults
15822 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15823
15824 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15825
15826 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15827 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15828 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15829 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15830
15831 @node Special Fortran Commands
15832 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15833
15834 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15835
15836 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15837 such as displaying common blocks.
15838
15839 @table @code
15840 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15841 @kindex info common
15842 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15843 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15844 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15845 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15846 printed.
15847 @end table
15848
15849 @node Pascal
15850 @subsection Pascal
15851
15852 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15853 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15854 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15855 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15856 syntax.
15857
15858 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15859 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15860 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15861
15862 @node Rust
15863 @subsection Rust
15864
15865 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15866 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15867 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15868 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15869
15870 @itemize @bullet
15871 @item
15872 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15873 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15874 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15875
15876 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15877 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15878 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15879 @samp{B}.
15880
15881 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15882 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15883
15884 @item
15885 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15886 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15887 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15888 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15889 @samp{K::x::y}.
15890
15891 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15892 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15893 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15894 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15895 scope.
15896
15897 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15898 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15899
15900 @item
15901 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15902 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15903
15904 @item
15905 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15906
15907 @item
15908 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15909 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15910 never be destroyed.
15911
15912 @item
15913 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15914 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15915 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15916
15917 @item
15918 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15919 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15920 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15921 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15922 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15923 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15924 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15925 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15926
15927 @item
15928 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15929 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15930 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15931 @itemize @bullet
15932
15933 @item
15934 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15935
15936 @item
15937 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15938
15939 @item
15940 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15941 type names.
15942
15943 @item
15944 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15945
15946 @item
15947 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15948 available in the crate.
15949 @end itemize
15950 @end itemize
15951
15952 @node Modula-2
15953 @subsection Modula-2
15954
15955 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15956
15957 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15958 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15959 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15960 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15961 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15962 table.
15963
15964 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15965 @menu
15966 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15967 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15968 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15969 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15970 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15971 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15972 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15973 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15974 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15975 @end menu
15976
15977 @node M2 Operators
15978 @subsubsection Operators
15979 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15980
15981 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15982 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15983 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15984 following definitions hold:
15985
15986 @itemize @bullet
15987
15988 @item
15989 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15990 their subranges.
15991
15992 @item
15993 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15994
15995 @item
15996 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15997
15998 @item
15999 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16000 @var{type}}.
16001
16002 @item
16003 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16004
16005 @item
16006 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16007
16008 @item
16009 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16010 @end itemize
16011
16012 @noindent
16013 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16014 increasing precedence:
16015
16016 @table @code
16017 @item ,
16018 Function argument or array index separator.
16019
16020 @item :=
16021 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16022 @var{value}.
16023
16024 @item <@r{, }>
16025 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16026 types.
16027
16028 @item <=@r{, }>=
16029 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16030 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16031 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16032
16033 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16034 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16035 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16036 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16037 comment character.
16038
16039 @item IN
16040 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16041 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16042
16043 @item OR
16044 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16045
16046 @item AND@r{, }&
16047 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16048
16049 @item @@
16050 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16051
16052 @item +@r{, }-
16053 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16054 and difference on set types.
16055
16056 @item *
16057 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16058 on set types.
16059
16060 @item /
16061 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16062 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16063
16064 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16065 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16066 precedence as @code{*}.
16067
16068 @item -
16069 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16070
16071 @item ^
16072 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16073
16074 @item NOT
16075 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16076 @code{^}.
16077
16078 @item .
16079 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16080 precedence as @code{^}.
16081
16082 @item []
16083 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16084
16085 @item ()
16086 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16087 as @code{^}.
16088
16089 @item ::@r{, }.
16090 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16091 @end table
16092
16093 @quotation
16094 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16095 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16096 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16097 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16098 @end quotation
16099
16100
16101 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16102 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16103 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16104
16105 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16106 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16107
16108 @table @var
16109
16110 @item a
16111 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16112
16113 @item c
16114 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16115
16116 @item i
16117 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16118
16119 @item m
16120 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16121 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16122 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16123
16124 @item n
16125 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16126
16127 @item r
16128 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16129
16130 @item t
16131 represents a type.
16132
16133 @item v
16134 represents a variable.
16135
16136 @item x
16137 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16138 explanation of the function for details.
16139 @end table
16140
16141 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16142
16143 @table @code
16144 @item ABS(@var{n})
16145 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16146
16147 @item CAP(@var{c})
16148 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16149 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16150
16151 @item CHR(@var{i})
16152 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16153
16154 @item DEC(@var{v})
16155 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16156
16157 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16158 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16159 new value.
16160
16161 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16162 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16163 set.
16164
16165 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16166 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16167
16168 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16169 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16170
16171 @item INC(@var{v})
16172 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16173
16174 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16175 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16176 new value.
16177
16178 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16179 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16180 there. Returns the new set.
16181
16182 @item MAX(@var{t})
16183 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16184
16185 @item MIN(@var{t})
16186 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16187
16188 @item ODD(@var{i})
16189 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16190
16191 @item ORD(@var{x})
16192 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16193 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16194 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16195 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16196
16197 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16198 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16199 variable or a type.
16200
16201 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16202 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16203
16204 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16205 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16206 variable or a type.
16207
16208 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16209 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16210 @end table
16211
16212 @quotation
16213 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16214 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16215 an error.
16216 @end quotation
16217
16218 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16219 @node M2 Constants
16220 @subsubsection Constants
16221
16222 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16223 ways:
16224
16225 @itemize @bullet
16226
16227 @item
16228 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16229 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16230 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16231 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16232
16233 @item
16234 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16235 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16236 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16237 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16238 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16239 digits.
16240
16241 @item
16242 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16243 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16244 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16245 followed by a @samp{C}.
16246
16247 @item
16248 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16249 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16250 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16251 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16252 sequences.
16253
16254 @item
16255 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16256
16257 @item
16258 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16259 @code{FALSE}.
16260
16261 @item
16262 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16263
16264 @item
16265 Set constants are not yet supported.
16266 @end itemize
16267
16268 @node M2 Types
16269 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16270 @cindex Modula-2 types
16271
16272 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16273 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16274 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16275 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16276 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16277 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16278
16279 The first example contains the following section of code:
16280
16281 @smallexample
16282 VAR
16283 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16284 r: [20..40] ;
16285 @end smallexample
16286
16287 @noindent
16288 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16289 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16290
16291 @smallexample
16292 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16293 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16294 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16295 SET OF CHAR
16296 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16297 21
16298 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16299 [20..40]
16300 @end smallexample
16301
16302 @noindent
16303 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16304
16305 @smallexample
16306 VAR
16307 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16308 @end smallexample
16309
16310 @noindent
16311 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16312
16313 @smallexample
16314 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16315 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16316 @end smallexample
16317
16318 @noindent
16319 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16320 expressions using the debugger.
16321
16322 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16323 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16324
16325 @smallexample
16326 VAR
16327 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16328 @end smallexample
16329
16330 @smallexample
16331 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16332 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16333 @end smallexample
16334
16335 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16336 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16337 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16338 above.
16339
16340 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16341
16342 @smallexample
16343 TYPE
16344 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16345 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16346 VAR
16347 s: t ;
16348 BEGIN
16349 s := blue ;
16350 @end smallexample
16351
16352 @noindent
16353 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16354 and value of a variable.
16355
16356 @smallexample
16357 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16358 $1 = blue
16359 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16360 type = [blue..yellow]
16361 @end smallexample
16362
16363 @noindent
16364 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16365 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16366 their @code{C} counterparts.
16367
16368 @smallexample
16369 VAR
16370 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16371 BEGIN
16372 s[1] := 1 ;
16373 @end smallexample
16374
16375 @smallexample
16376 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16377 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16378 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16379 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16380 @end smallexample
16381
16382 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16383 pointer types as shown in this example:
16384
16385 @smallexample
16386 VAR
16387 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16388 BEGIN
16389 NEW(s) ;
16390 s^[1] := 1 ;
16391 @end smallexample
16392
16393 @noindent
16394 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16395
16396 @smallexample
16397 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16398 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16399 @end smallexample
16400
16401 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16402 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16403 types:
16404
16405 @smallexample
16406 TYPE
16407 foo = RECORD
16408 f1: CARDINAL ;
16409 f2: CHAR ;
16410 f3: myarray ;
16411 END ;
16412
16413 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16414 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16415 VAR
16416 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16417 @end smallexample
16418
16419 @noindent
16420 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16421 below.
16422
16423 @smallexample
16424 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16425 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16426 f1 : CARDINAL;
16427 f2 : CHAR;
16428 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16429 END
16430 @end smallexample
16431
16432 @node M2 Defaults
16433 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16434 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16435
16436 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16437 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16438 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16439 selected the working language.
16440
16441 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16442 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16443 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16444 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16445
16446 @node Deviations
16447 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16448 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16449
16450 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16451 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16452
16453 @itemize @bullet
16454 @item
16455 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16456 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16457 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16458 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16459 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16460 returned a pointer.)
16461
16462 @item
16463 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16464 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16465 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16466 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16467
16468 @item
16469 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16470 argument.
16471
16472 @item
16473 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16474 @end itemize
16475
16476 @node M2 Checks
16477 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16478 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16479
16480 @quotation
16481 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16482 range checking.
16483 @end quotation
16484 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16485
16486 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16487
16488 @itemize @bullet
16489 @item
16490 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16491 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16492
16493 @item
16494 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16495 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16496 @end itemize
16497
16498 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16499 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16500
16501 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16502 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16503
16504 @node M2 Scope
16505 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16506 @cindex scope
16507 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16508 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16509 @ifinfo
16510 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16511 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16512 @end ifinfo
16513 @ifnotinfo
16514 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16515 @end ifnotinfo
16516
16517 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16518 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16519 similar syntax:
16520
16521 @smallexample
16522
16523 @var{module} . @var{id}
16524 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16525 @end smallexample
16526
16527 @noindent
16528 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16529 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16530 identifier within your program, except another module.
16531
16532 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16533 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16534 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16535 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16536
16537 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16538 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16539 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16540 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16541 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16542 @var{module}.
16543
16544 @node GDB/M2
16545 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16546
16547 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16548 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16549 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16550 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16551 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16552 analogue in Modula-2.
16553
16554 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16555 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16556 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16557 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16558 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16559 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16560
16561 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16562 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16563 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16564
16565 @node Ada
16566 @subsection Ada
16567 @cindex Ada
16568
16569 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16570 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16571 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16572 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16573 to be difficult.
16574
16575
16576 @cindex expressions in Ada
16577 @menu
16578 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16579 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16580 in @value{GDBN}.
16581 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16582 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16583 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16584 subprograms.
16585 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16586 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16587 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16588 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16589 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16590 Profile
16591 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16592 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16593 @end menu
16594
16595 @node Ada Mode Intro
16596 @subsubsection Introduction
16597 @cindex Ada mode, general
16598
16599 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16600 syntax, with some extensions.
16601 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16602
16603 @itemize @bullet
16604 @item
16605 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16606 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16607 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16608 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16609
16610 @item
16611 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16612 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16613
16614 @item
16615 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16616 @end itemize
16617
16618 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16619 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16620 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16621 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16622 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16623
16624 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16625 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16626 was translated from an Ada source file.
16627
16628 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16629 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16630 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16631 middle (to allow based literals).
16632
16633 @node Omissions from Ada
16634 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16635 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16636
16637 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16638
16639 @itemize @bullet
16640 @item
16641 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16642
16643 @itemize @minus
16644 @item
16645 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16646 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16647
16648 @item
16649 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16650
16651 @item
16652 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16653
16654 @item
16655 @t{'Tag}.
16656
16657 @item
16658 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16659 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16660
16661 @item
16662 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16663 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16664
16665 @item
16666 @t{'Address}.
16667 @end itemize
16668
16669 @item
16670 The names in
16671 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16672 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16673 not currently available.
16674
16675 @item
16676 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16677 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16678 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16679 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16680 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16681 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16682 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16683 indeterminate values.
16684
16685 @item
16686 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16687 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16688 are not implemented.
16689
16690 @item
16691 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16692 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16693 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16694 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16695 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16696
16697 @smallexample
16698 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16699 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16700 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16701 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16702 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16703 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16704 @end smallexample
16705
16706 Changing a
16707 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16708 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16709 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16710 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16711 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16712 declared to have a type such as:
16713
16714 @smallexample
16715 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16716 Id : Integer;
16717 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16718 end record;
16719 @end smallexample
16720
16721 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16722 assignments:
16723
16724 @smallexample
16725 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16726 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16727 @end smallexample
16728
16729 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16730 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16731 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16732 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16733 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16734 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16735 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16736 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16737
16738 @item
16739 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16740
16741 @item
16742 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16743 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16744 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16745 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16746 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16747 the proper resolution.
16748
16749 @item
16750 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16751
16752 @item
16753 Entry calls are not implemented.
16754
16755 @item
16756 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16757 formats are not supported.
16758
16759 @item
16760 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16761
16762 @item
16763 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16764 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16765 context.
16766 Should your program
16767 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16768 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16769 @end itemize
16770
16771 @node Additions to Ada
16772 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16773 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16774
16775 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16776 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16777
16778 @itemize @bullet
16779 @item
16780 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16781 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16782 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16783 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16784 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16785 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16786 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16787 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16788
16789 @item
16790 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16791 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16792 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16793
16794 @item
16795 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16796 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16797
16798 @item
16799 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16800 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16801 @end itemize
16802
16803 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16804 additions specific to Ada:
16805
16806 @itemize @bullet
16807 @item
16808 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16809 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16810
16811 @smallexample
16812 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16813 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16814 @end smallexample
16815
16816 @item
16817 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16818 the value of its right-hand operand.
16819 This allows, for example,
16820 complex conditional breaks:
16821
16822 @smallexample
16823 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16824 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16825 @end smallexample
16826
16827 @item
16828 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16829 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16830 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16831 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16832 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16833 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16834 in strings. For example,
16835 @smallexample
16836 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16837 @end smallexample
16838 @noindent
16839 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16840 after each period.
16841
16842 @item
16843 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16844 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16845 to write
16846
16847 @smallexample
16848 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16849 @end smallexample
16850
16851 @item
16852 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16853 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16854 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16855 of 3 might print as
16856
16857 @smallexample
16858 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16859 @end smallexample
16860
16861 @noindent
16862 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16863 clause.
16864
16865 @item
16866 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16867 multi-character subsequence of
16868 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16869 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16870 in place of @t{a'length}.
16871
16872 @item
16873 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16874 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16875 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16876 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16877 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16878 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16879 For example,
16880 @smallexample
16881 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16882 @end smallexample
16883
16884 @item
16885 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16886 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16887 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16888 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16889 object.
16890
16891 @end itemize
16892
16893 @node Overloading support for Ada
16894 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16895 @cindex overloading, Ada
16896
16897 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16898 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16899 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16900 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16901 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16902 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16903
16904 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16905 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16906 use, for instance:
16907
16908 @smallexample
16909 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16910 Multiple matches for f
16911 [0] cancel
16912 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16913 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16914 >
16915 @end smallexample
16916
16917 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16918 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16919 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16920
16921 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16922 case:
16923
16924 @table @code
16925
16926 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16927 @item set ada print-signatures
16928 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16929 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16930 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16931
16932 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16933 @item show ada print-signatures
16934 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16935 overloads selection menu.
16936 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16937
16938 @end table
16939
16940 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16941 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16942
16943 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16944 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16945 before reaching the main procedure.
16946 As defined in the Ada Reference
16947 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16948 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16949 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16950 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16951
16952 @node Ada Exceptions
16953 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16954
16955 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16956
16957 @table @code
16958 @kindex info exceptions
16959 @item info exceptions
16960 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16961 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16962 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16963 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16964 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16965 @end table
16966
16967 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16968 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16969 argument.
16970
16971 @smallexample
16972 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16973 All defined Ada exceptions:
16974 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16975 program_error: 0x613d20
16976 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16977 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16978 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16979 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16980 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16981 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16982 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16983 @end smallexample
16984
16985 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16986 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16987
16988 @node Ada Tasks
16989 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16990 @cindex Ada, tasking
16991
16992 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16993 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16994
16995 @table @code
16996 @kindex info tasks
16997 @item info tasks
16998 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16999
17000
17001 @smallexample
17002 @iftex
17003 @leftskip=0.5cm
17004 @end iftex
17005 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17006 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17007 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17008 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17009 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17010 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17011
17012 @end smallexample
17013
17014 @noindent
17015 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17016 task currently being inspected.
17017
17018 @table @asis
17019 @item ID
17020 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17021
17022 @item TID
17023 The Ada task ID.
17024
17025 @item P-ID
17026 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17027
17028 @item Pri
17029 The base priority of the task.
17030
17031 @item State
17032 Current state of the task.
17033
17034 @table @code
17035 @item Unactivated
17036 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17037 executing.
17038
17039 @item Runnable
17040 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17041 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17042
17043 @item Terminated
17044 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17045 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17046 terminated themselves.
17047
17048 @item Child Activation Wait
17049 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17050
17051 @item Accept Statement
17052 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17053
17054 @item Waiting on entry call
17055 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17056
17057 @item Async Select Wait
17058 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17059 select statement.
17060
17061 @item Delay Sleep
17062 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17063 alternative open.
17064
17065 @item Child Termination Wait
17066 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17067 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17068 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17069
17070 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17071 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17072 finish terminating.
17073
17074 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17075 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17076 @end table
17077
17078 @item Name
17079 Name of the task in the program.
17080
17081 @end table
17082
17083 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17084 @item info task @var{taskno}
17085 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17086 the following example:
17087 @smallexample
17088 @iftex
17089 @leftskip=0.5cm
17090 @end iftex
17091 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17092 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17093 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17094 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17095 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17096 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17097 Name: task_1
17098 Thread: 0x807f378
17099 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17100 Base Priority: 15
17101 State: Runnable
17102 @end smallexample
17103
17104 @item task
17105 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17106 @cindex current Ada task ID
17107 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17108
17109 @smallexample
17110 @iftex
17111 @leftskip=0.5cm
17112 @end iftex
17113 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17114 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17115 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17116 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17117 (@value{GDBP}) task
17118 [Current task is 2]
17119 @end smallexample
17120
17121 @item task @var{taskno}
17122 @cindex Ada task switching
17123 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17124 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17125 from the current task to the given task.
17126
17127 @smallexample
17128 @iftex
17129 @leftskip=0.5cm
17130 @end iftex
17131 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17132 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17133 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17134 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17135 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17136 [Switching to task 1]
17137 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17138 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17139 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17140 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17141 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17142 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17143 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17144 @end smallexample
17145
17146 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17147 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17148 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17149 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17150 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17151 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17152 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17153 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17154 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17155
17156 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17157 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17158 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17159 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17160 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17161
17162 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17163 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17164 program.
17165
17166 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17167 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17168 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17169
17170 For example,
17171
17172 @smallexample
17173 @iftex
17174 @leftskip=0.5cm
17175 @end iftex
17176 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17177 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17178 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17179 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17180 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17181 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17182 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17183 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17184 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17185 Continuing.
17186 task # 1 running
17187 task # 2 running
17188
17189 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17190 15 flush;
17191 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17192 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17193 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17194 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17195 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17196 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17197 @end smallexample
17198 @end table
17199
17200 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17201 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17202 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17203
17204 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17205 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17206 the platform being used.
17207 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17208 switching is not supported.
17209
17210 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17211 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17212 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17213 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17214 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17215 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17216
17217 @node Ravenscar Profile
17218 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17219 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17220
17221 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17222 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17223 requirements.
17224
17225 @table @code
17226 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17227 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17228 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17229 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17230 Profile. This is the default.
17231
17232 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17233 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17234 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17235 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17236 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17237 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17238 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17239
17240 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17241 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17242 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17243 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17244
17245 @end table
17246
17247 @node Ada Settings
17248 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17249 @cindex Ada settings
17250
17251 @table @code
17252 @kindex set varsize-limit
17253 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17254 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17255 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17256 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17257 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17258 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17259 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17260
17261 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17262 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17263 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17264 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17265 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17266 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17267 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17268 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17269 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17270 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17271 size is less than @var{size}.
17272
17273 @kindex show varsize-limit
17274 @item show varsize-limit
17275 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17276 @end table
17277
17278 @node Ada Glitches
17279 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17280 @cindex Ada, problems
17281
17282 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17283 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17284 @value{GDBN},
17285 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17286 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17287
17288 @itemize @bullet
17289 @item
17290 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17291 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17292
17293 @item
17294 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17295 argument lists are treated as positional).
17296
17297 @item
17298 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17299
17300 @item
17301 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17302 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17303 the host machine.
17304
17305 @item
17306 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17307 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17308 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17309 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17310 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17311 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17312 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17313 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17314 you can usually resolve the confusion
17315 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17316 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17317 @end itemize
17318
17319 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17320 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17321 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17322 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17323 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17324 enabled.
17325
17326 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17327 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17328 @table @code
17329
17330 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17331 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17332 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17333 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17334 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17335 This is the default.
17336
17337 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17338 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17339 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17340 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17341 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17342 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17343 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17344
17345 @end table
17346
17347 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17348 @cindex GNAT encoding
17349 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17350 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17351 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17352 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17353 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17354 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17355
17356 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17357 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17358 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17359 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17360 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17361 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17362 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17363 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17364
17365 @table @code
17366
17367 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17368 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17369 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17370 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17371
17372 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17373 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17374 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17375
17376 @end table
17377
17378 @node Unsupported Languages
17379 @section Unsupported Languages
17380
17381 @cindex unsupported languages
17382 @cindex minimal language
17383 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17384 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17385 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17386 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17387 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17388 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17389
17390 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17391 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17392 language.
17393
17394 @node Symbols
17395 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17396
17397 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17398 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17399 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17400 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17401 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17402 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17403 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17404
17405 @cindex symbol names
17406 @cindex names of symbols
17407 @cindex quoting names
17408 @anchor{quoting names}
17409 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17410 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17411 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17412 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17413 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17414 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17415 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17416 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17417
17418 @smallexample
17419 p 'foo.c'::x
17420 @end smallexample
17421
17422 @noindent
17423 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17424
17425 @table @code
17426 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17427 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17428 @kindex set case-sensitive
17429 @item set case-sensitive on
17430 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17431 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17432 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17433 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17434 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17435 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17436 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17437 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17438 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17439 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17440 case-insensitive matches.
17441
17442 @kindex show case-sensitive
17443 @item show case-sensitive
17444 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17445 lookups.
17446
17447 @kindex set print type methods
17448 @item set print type methods
17449 @itemx set print type methods on
17450 @itemx set print type methods off
17451 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17452 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17453 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17454 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17455 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17456 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17457
17458 @kindex show print type methods
17459 @item show print type methods
17460 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17461 classes.
17462
17463 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17464 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17465 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17466 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17467 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17468 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17469 types defined in classes.
17470
17471 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17472 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17473 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17474 printing classes.
17475
17476 @kindex set print type typedefs
17477 @item set print type typedefs
17478 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17479 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17480
17481 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17482 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17483 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17484 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17485 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17486 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17487 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17488 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17489 types.
17490
17491 @kindex show print type typedefs
17492 @item show print type typedefs
17493 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17494 printing classes.
17495
17496 @kindex info address
17497 @cindex address of a symbol
17498 @item info address @var{symbol}
17499 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17500 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17501 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17502 is always stored.
17503
17504 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17505 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17506 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17507
17508 @kindex info symbol
17509 @cindex symbol from address
17510 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17511 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17512 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17513 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17514 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17515
17516 @smallexample
17517 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17518 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17519 @end smallexample
17520
17521 @noindent
17522 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17523 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17524
17525 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17526 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17527
17528 @smallexample
17529 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17530 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17531 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17532 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17533 @end smallexample
17534
17535 @kindex demangle
17536 @cindex demangle
17537 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17538 Demangle @var{name}.
17539 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17540 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17541
17542 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17543 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17544
17545 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17546 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17547
17548 @kindex whatis
17549 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17550 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17551 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17552 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17553
17554 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17555 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17556 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17557
17558 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17559 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17560 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17561 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17562 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17563 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17564 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17565 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17566 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17567
17568 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17569 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17570 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17571 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17572 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17573 unroll it.
17574
17575 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17576 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17577 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17578
17579 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17580 Available flags are:
17581
17582 @table @code
17583 @item r
17584 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17585 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17586 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17587
17588 @item m
17589 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17590
17591 @item M
17592 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17593 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17594
17595 @item t
17596 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17597 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17598 names are substituted when printing other types.
17599
17600 @item T
17601 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17602 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17603
17604 @item o
17605 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17606 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17607
17608 For example, given the following declarations:
17609
17610 @smallexample
17611 struct tuv
17612 @{
17613 int a1;
17614 char *a2;
17615 int a3;
17616 @};
17617
17618 struct xyz
17619 @{
17620 int f1;
17621 char f2;
17622 void *f3;
17623 struct tuv f4;
17624 @};
17625
17626 union qwe
17627 @{
17628 struct tuv fff1;
17629 struct xyz fff2;
17630 @};
17631
17632 struct tyu
17633 @{
17634 int a1 : 1;
17635 int a2 : 3;
17636 int a3 : 23;
17637 char a4 : 2;
17638 int64_t a5;
17639 int a6 : 5;
17640 int64_t a7 : 3;
17641 @};
17642 @end smallexample
17643
17644 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17645
17646 @smallexample
17647 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17648 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17649 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17650 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17651 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17652 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17653
17654 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17655 @}
17656 @end smallexample
17657
17658 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17659 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17660 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17661 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17662 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17663 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17664 its fields.
17665
17666 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17667
17668 @smallexample
17669 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17670 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17671 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17672 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17673 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17674 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17675 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17676
17677 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17678 @} fff1;
17679 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17680 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17681 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17682 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17683 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17684 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17685 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17686 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17687 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17688 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17689
17690 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17691 @} f4;
17692
17693 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17694 @} fff2;
17695
17696 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17697 @}
17698 @end smallexample
17699
17700 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17701 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17702 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17703 of these structures' fields.
17704
17705 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17706 bitfields:
17707
17708 @smallexample
17709 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17710 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17711 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17712 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17713 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17714 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17715 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17716 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17717 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17718 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17719 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17720
17721 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17722 @}
17723 @end smallexample
17724
17725 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17726 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17727 @end table
17728
17729 @kindex ptype
17730 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17731 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17732 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17733 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17734
17735 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17736 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17737 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17738 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17739 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17740 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17741 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17742 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17743
17744 For example, for this variable declaration:
17745
17746 @smallexample
17747 typedef double real_t;
17748 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17749 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17750 complex_t var;
17751 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17752 @end smallexample
17753
17754 @noindent
17755 the two commands give this output:
17756
17757 @smallexample
17758 @group
17759 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17760 type = complex_t
17761 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17762 type = struct complex @{
17763 real_t real;
17764 double imag;
17765 @}
17766 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17767 type = struct complex
17768 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17769 type = struct complex
17770 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17771 type = struct complex @{
17772 real_t real;
17773 double imag;
17774 @}
17775 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17776 type = real_t *
17777 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17778 type = double *
17779 @end group
17780 @end smallexample
17781
17782 @noindent
17783 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17784 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17785
17786 @cindex incomplete type
17787 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17788 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17789 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17790 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17791 given these declarations:
17792
17793 @smallexample
17794 struct foo;
17795 struct foo *fooptr;
17796 @end smallexample
17797
17798 @noindent
17799 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17800
17801 @smallexample
17802 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17803 $1 = <incomplete type>
17804 @end smallexample
17805
17806 @noindent
17807 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17808 completely specified.
17809
17810 @cindex unknown type
17811 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17812 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17813 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17814 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17815 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17816 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17817 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17818 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17819
17820 @smallexample
17821 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17822 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17823 @end smallexample
17824
17825 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17826 of such variables.
17827
17828 @kindex info types
17829 @item info types @var{regexp}
17830 @itemx info types
17831 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17832 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17833 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17834 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17835 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17836 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17837 name is @code{value}.
17838
17839 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17840 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17841 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17842
17843 @kindex info type-printers
17844 @item info type-printers
17845 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17846 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17847 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17848 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17849 type printers.
17850
17851 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17852
17853 @kindex enable type-printer
17854 @kindex disable type-printer
17855 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17856 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17857 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17858
17859 @kindex info scope
17860 @cindex local variables
17861 @item info scope @var{location}
17862 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17863 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17864 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17865 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17866 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17867
17868 @smallexample
17869 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17870 Scope for command_line_handler:
17871 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17872 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17873 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17874 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17875 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17876 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17877 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17878 @end smallexample
17879
17880 @noindent
17881 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17882 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17883 collect}.
17884
17885 @kindex info source
17886 @item info source
17887 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17888 the function containing the current point of execution:
17889 @itemize @bullet
17890 @item
17891 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17892 @item
17893 the directory it was compiled in,
17894 @item
17895 its length, in lines,
17896 @item
17897 which programming language it is written in,
17898 @item
17899 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17900 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17901 @item
17902 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17903 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17904 @item
17905 whether the debugging information includes information about
17906 preprocessor macros.
17907 @end itemize
17908
17909
17910 @kindex info sources
17911 @item info sources
17912 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17913 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17914 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17915
17916 @kindex info functions
17917 @item info functions
17918 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17919 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17920 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17921 number.
17922
17923 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17924 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types of
17925 functions whose names contain a match for regular expression
17926 @var{regexp}. Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
17927 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17928 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
17929 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17930 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17931
17932 @kindex info variables
17933 @item info variables
17934 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17935 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17936 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
17937 their respective source line numbers.
17938
17939 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17940 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the names and data types of
17941 non-local variables whose names contain a match for regular expression
17942 @var{regexp}.
17943
17944 @kindex info classes
17945 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17946 @item info classes
17947 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17948 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17949 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17950 expression.
17951
17952 @kindex info selectors
17953 @item info selectors
17954 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17955 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17956 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17957 expression.
17958
17959 @ignore
17960 This was never implemented.
17961 @kindex info methods
17962 @item info methods
17963 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17964 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17965 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17966 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17967 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17968 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17969 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17970 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17971 @end ignore
17972
17973 @cindex opaque data types
17974 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17975 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17976 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17977 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17978 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17979 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17980 another source file. The default is on.
17981
17982 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17983 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17984
17985 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17986 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17987 is printed as follows:
17988 @smallexample
17989 @{<no data fields>@}
17990 @end smallexample
17991
17992 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17993 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17994 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17995
17996 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17997 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17998 @item set print symbol-loading
17999 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18000 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18001 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18002 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18003 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18004 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18005 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18006 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18007 can be annoying.
18008 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18009 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18010 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18011 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18012
18013 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18014 @item show print symbol-loading
18015 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18016 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18017
18018 @kindex maint print symbols
18019 @cindex symbol dump
18020 @kindex maint print psymbols
18021 @cindex partial symbol dump
18022 @kindex maint print msymbols
18023 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18024 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18025 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18026 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18027 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18028 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18029 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18030 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18031 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18032 that objfile.
18033 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18034 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18035 @code{main}.
18036 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18037 source file.
18038
18039 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18040 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18041 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18042 tables.
18043 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18044 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18045 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18046 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18047 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18048 ``ELF symbols''.
18049
18050 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18051 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18052
18053 @kindex maint info symtabs
18054 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18055 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18056 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18057 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18058 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18059 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18060 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18061
18062 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18063 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18064 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18065 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18066 structure in more detail. For example:
18067
18068 @smallexample
18069 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18070 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18071 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18072 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18073 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18074 readin no
18075 fullname (null)
18076 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18077 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18078 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18079 dependencies (none)
18080 @}
18081 @}
18082 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18083 (@value{GDBP})
18084 @end smallexample
18085 @noindent
18086 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18087 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18088 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18089 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18090 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18091
18092 @smallexample
18093 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18094 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18095 line 1574.
18096 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18097 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18098 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18099 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18100 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18101 dirname (null)
18102 fullname (null)
18103 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18104 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18105 debugformat DWARF 2
18106 @}
18107 @}
18108 (@value{GDBP})
18109 @end smallexample
18110
18111 @kindex maint info line-table
18112 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18113 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18114 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18115
18116 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18117 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18118 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18119
18120 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18121 @cindex symbol cache size
18122 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18123 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18124 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18125 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18126 with different sizes.
18127
18128 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18129 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18130 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18131
18132 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18133 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18134 @item maint print symbol-cache
18135 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18136 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18137
18138 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18139 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18140 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18141 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18142 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18143
18144 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18145 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18146 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18147 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18148 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18149 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18150
18151 @end table
18152
18153 @node Altering
18154 @chapter Altering Execution
18155
18156 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18157 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18158 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18159 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18160 program.
18161
18162 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18163 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18164 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18165
18166 @menu
18167 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18168 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18169 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18170 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18171 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18172 * Patching:: Patching your program
18173 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18174 @end menu
18175
18176 @node Assignment
18177 @section Assignment to Variables
18178
18179 @cindex assignment
18180 @cindex setting variables
18181 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18182 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18183
18184 @smallexample
18185 print x=4
18186 @end smallexample
18187
18188 @noindent
18189 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18190 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18191 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18192 information on operators in supported languages.
18193
18194 @kindex set variable
18195 @cindex variables, setting
18196 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18197 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18198 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18199 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18200 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18201
18202 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18203 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18204 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18205 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18206 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18207 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18208 command @code{set width}:
18209
18210 @smallexample
18211 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18212 type = double
18213 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18214 $4 = 13
18215 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18216 Invalid syntax in expression.
18217 @end smallexample
18218
18219 @noindent
18220 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18221 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18222
18223 @smallexample
18224 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18225 @end smallexample
18226
18227 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18228 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18229 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18230 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18231 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18232 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18233
18234 @smallexample
18235 @group
18236 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18237 type = double
18238 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18239 $1 = 1
18240 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18241 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18242 $2 = 1
18243 (@value{GDBP}) r
18244 The program being debugged has been started already.
18245 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18246 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18247 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18248 Invalid bfd target.
18249 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18250 The current BFD target is "=4".
18251 @end group
18252 @end smallexample
18253
18254 @noindent
18255 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18256 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18257 @code{g}, use
18258
18259 @smallexample
18260 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18261 @end smallexample
18262
18263 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18264 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18265 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18266 same length or shorter.
18267 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18268 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18269
18270 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18271 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18272 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18273 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18274 and representation in memory), and
18275
18276 @smallexample
18277 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18278 @end smallexample
18279
18280 @noindent
18281 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18282
18283 @node Jumping
18284 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18285
18286 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18287 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18288 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18289
18290 @table @code
18291 @kindex jump
18292 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18293 @item jump @var{location}
18294 @itemx j @var{location}
18295 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18296 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18297 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18298 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18299 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18300
18301 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18302 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18303 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18304 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18305 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18306 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18307 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18308 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18309 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18310 @end table
18311
18312 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18313 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18314 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18315 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18316 example,
18317
18318 @smallexample
18319 set $pc = 0x485
18320 @end smallexample
18321
18322 @noindent
18323 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18324 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18325 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18326
18327 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18328 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18329 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18330 detail.
18331
18332 @c @group
18333 @node Signaling
18334 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18335 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18336
18337 @table @code
18338 @kindex signal
18339 @item signal @var{signal}
18340 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18341 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18342 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18343 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18344
18345 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18346 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18347 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18348 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18349 signal.
18350
18351 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18352 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18353 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18354 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18355 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18356 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18357 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18358 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18359
18360 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18361 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18362 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18363 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18364 passes the signal directly to your program.
18365
18366 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18367 after executing the command.
18368
18369 @kindex queue-signal
18370 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18371 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18372 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18373 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18374 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18375 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18376 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18377 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18378 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18379
18380 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18381 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18382 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18383 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18384 @code{continue} command.
18385
18386 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18387 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18388 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18389 (@pxref{Signals}).
18390 @end table
18391 @c @end group
18392
18393 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18394 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18395
18396 @node Returning
18397 @section Returning from a Function
18398
18399 @table @code
18400 @cindex returning from a function
18401 @kindex return
18402 @item return
18403 @itemx return @var{expression}
18404 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18405 command. If you give an
18406 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18407 value.
18408 @end table
18409
18410 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18411 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18412 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18413 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18414
18415 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18416 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18417 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18418 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18419 of functions.
18420
18421 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18422 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18423 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18424 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18425 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18426
18427 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18428 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18429 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18430 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18431 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18432 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18433 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18434 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18435 assignment into the right register(s).
18436
18437 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18438 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18439 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18440 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18441 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18442 into a @code{long long int}:
18443
18444 @smallexample
18445 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18446 29 return 31;
18447 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18448 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18449 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18450 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18451 (@value{GDBP})
18452 @end smallexample
18453
18454 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18455 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18456 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18457 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18458 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18459 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18460 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18461 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18462
18463 @smallexample
18464 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18465 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18466 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18467 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18468 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18469 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18470 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18471 (@value{GDBP})
18472 @end smallexample
18473
18474 @node Calling
18475 @section Calling Program Functions
18476
18477 @table @code
18478 @cindex calling functions
18479 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18480 @item print @var{expr}
18481 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18482 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18483 debugged.
18484
18485 @kindex call
18486 @item call @var{expr}
18487 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18488 returned values.
18489
18490 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18491 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18492 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18493 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18494 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18495 value history.
18496 @end table
18497
18498 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18499 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18500 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18501 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18502
18503 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18504 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18505 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18506 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18507 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18508 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18509 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18510 in that case is controlled by the
18511 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18512
18513 @table @code
18514 @item set unwindonsignal
18515 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18516 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18517 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18518 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18519 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18520 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18521 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18522 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18523 received.
18524
18525 @item show unwindonsignal
18526 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18527 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18528 @value{GDBN}.
18529
18530 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18531 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18532 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18533 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18534 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18535 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18536 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18537 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18538 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18539 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18540
18541 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18542 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18543 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18544 @value{GDBN}.
18545
18546 @end table
18547
18548 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18549
18550 @cindex no debug info functions
18551 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18552 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18553 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18554 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18555 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18556 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18557
18558 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18559 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18560 declared return type. For example:
18561
18562 @smallexample
18563 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18564 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18565 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18566 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18567 @end smallexample
18568
18569 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18570 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18571 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18572 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18573
18574 @smallexample
18575 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18576 @end smallexample
18577
18578 @noindent
18579 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18580
18581 @smallexample
18582 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18583 @end smallexample
18584
18585 @noindent
18586 these calls are equivalent:
18587
18588 @smallexample
18589 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18590 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18591 @end smallexample
18592
18593 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18594 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18595 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18596 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18597 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18598 float parameters, and no debug info:
18599
18600 @smallexample
18601 float
18602 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18603 float v1, v2;
18604 @{
18605 return v1 * v2;
18606 @}
18607 @end smallexample
18608
18609 @noindent
18610 you call it like this:
18611
18612 @smallexample
18613 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18614 @end smallexample
18615
18616 @node Patching
18617 @section Patching Programs
18618
18619 @cindex patching binaries
18620 @cindex writing into executables
18621 @cindex writing into corefiles
18622
18623 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18624 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18625 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18626 patching your program's binary.
18627
18628 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18629 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18630 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18631 repairs.
18632
18633 @table @code
18634 @kindex set write
18635 @item set write on
18636 @itemx set write off
18637 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18638 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18639 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18640
18641 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18642 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18643 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18644
18645 @item show write
18646 @kindex show write
18647 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18648 as well as reading.
18649 @end table
18650
18651 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18652 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18653 @cindex injecting code
18654 @cindex writing into executables
18655 @cindex compiling code
18656
18657 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18658 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18659 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18660 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18661
18662 @table @code
18663 @kindex compile code
18664 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18665 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18666 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18667 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18668 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18669 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18670 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18671 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18672 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18673 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18674 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18675 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18676
18677 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18678 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18679 E.g.:
18680
18681 @smallexample
18682 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18683 @end smallexample
18684
18685 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18686 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18687 from actual source code. E.g.:
18688
18689 @smallexample
18690 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18691 @end smallexample
18692
18693 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18694 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18695 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18696 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18697 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18698 editor.
18699
18700 @smallexample
18701 compile code
18702 >printf ("hello\n");
18703 >printf ("world\n");
18704 >end
18705 @end smallexample
18706
18707 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18708 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18709 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18710 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18711 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18712 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18713 inferior symbols otherwise.
18714
18715 @kindex compile file
18716 @item compile file @var{filename}
18717 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18718 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18719
18720 @smallexample
18721 compile file /home/user/example.c
18722 @end smallexample
18723 @end table
18724
18725 @table @code
18726 @item compile print @var{expr}
18727 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18728 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18729 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18730 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18731 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18732 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18733 Formats}.
18734
18735 @item compile print
18736 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18737 @cindex reprint the last value
18738 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18739 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18740 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18741 multiple-line editor.
18742 @end table
18743
18744 @noindent
18745 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18746
18747 @table @code
18748 @anchor{set debug compile}
18749 @item set debug compile
18750 @cindex compile command debugging info
18751 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18752 injecting the code. The default is off.
18753
18754 @item show debug compile
18755 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18756 compiling and injecting the code.
18757
18758 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18759 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18760 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18761 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18762 The default is off.
18763
18764 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18765 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18766 C@t{++} type conversion.
18767 @end table
18768
18769 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18770
18771 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18772 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18773 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18774 injecting process.
18775
18776 @noindent
18777 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18778
18779 @table @asis
18780 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18781 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18782 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18783 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18784
18785 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18786 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18787 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18788 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18789 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18790 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18791 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18792 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18793
18794 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18795 @end table
18796
18797 @noindent
18798 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18799
18800 @table @code
18801 @item set compile-args
18802 @cindex compile command options override
18803 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18804 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18805 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18806 compilation.
18807
18808 @item show compile-args
18809 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18810 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18811 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18812 @end table
18813
18814 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18815
18816 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18817 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18818 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18819
18820 @table @asis
18821 @item C code examples and caveats
18822 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18823 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18824 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18825 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18826 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18827
18828 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18829 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18830 much like any other normal debugging session.
18831
18832 @smallexample
18833 void function1 (void)
18834 @{
18835 int i = 42;
18836 printf ("function 1\n");
18837 @}
18838
18839 void function2 (void)
18840 @{
18841 int j = 12;
18842 function1 ();
18843 @}
18844
18845 int main(void)
18846 @{
18847 int k = 6;
18848 int *p;
18849 function2 ();
18850 return 0;
18851 @}
18852 @end smallexample
18853
18854 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18855 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18856 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18857
18858 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18859 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18860 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18861 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18862 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18863
18864 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18865 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18866 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18867 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18868 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18869 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18870 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18871 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18872 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18873 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18874
18875 @smallexample
18876 compile code k = 3;
18877 @end smallexample
18878
18879 @noindent
18880 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18881 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18882 @code{compile} command changes it.
18883
18884 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18885 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18886 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18887 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18888 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18889
18890 @smallexample
18891 compile code j = 3;
18892 @end smallexample
18893
18894 @noindent
18895 will result in a compilation error message.
18896
18897 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18898 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18899 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18900
18901 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18902 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18903 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18904 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18905
18906 @smallexample
18907 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18908 @end smallexample
18909
18910 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18911 command has completed:
18912
18913 @smallexample
18914 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18915 @end smallexample
18916
18917 @noindent
18918 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18919 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18920 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18921 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18922 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18923
18924 @smallexample
18925 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18926 @end smallexample
18927
18928 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18929 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18930 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18931 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18932 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18933 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18934 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18935 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18936
18937 @smallexample
18938 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18939 @end smallexample
18940
18941 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18942 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18943 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18944 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18945 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18946 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18947 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18948
18949 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18950 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18951 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18952 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18953 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18954 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18955
18956 @smallexample
18957 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18958 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18959 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18960 Compilation failed.
18961 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18962 42
18963 @end smallexample
18964
18965 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18966 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18967 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18968 will print to the console.
18969 @end table
18970
18971 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18972
18973 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18974 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18975 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18976 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18977 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18978 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18979 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18980 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18981
18982
18983 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18984 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18985 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18986 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18987 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18988 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18989 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18990
18991 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18992 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18993 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18994 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18995 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18996 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18997 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18998
18999 @table @code
19000 @item set compile-gcc
19001 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19002 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19003 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19004 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19005 default.
19006
19007 @item show compile-gcc
19008 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19009 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19010 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19011 @end table
19012
19013 @node GDB Files
19014 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19015
19016 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19017 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19018 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19019 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19020
19021 @menu
19022 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19023 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19024 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19025 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19026 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19027 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19028 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19029 @end menu
19030
19031 @node Files
19032 @section Commands to Specify Files
19033
19034 @cindex symbol table
19035 @cindex core dump file
19036
19037 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19038 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19039 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19040 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19041
19042 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19043 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19044 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19045 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19046 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19047 new files are useful.
19048
19049 @table @code
19050 @cindex executable file
19051 @kindex file
19052 @item file @var{filename}
19053 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19054 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19055 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19056 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19057 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19058 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19059 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19060 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19061
19062 @cindex unlinked object files
19063 @cindex patching object files
19064 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19065 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19066 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19067 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19068 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19069 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19070 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19071 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19072
19073 @item file
19074 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19075 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19076
19077 @kindex exec-file
19078 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19079 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19080 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19081 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19082 discard information on the executable file.
19083
19084 @kindex symbol-file
19085 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19086 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19087 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19088 table and program to run from the same file.
19089
19090 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19091 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19092 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19093 enabled.
19094
19095 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19096 program's symbol table.
19097
19098 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19099 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19100 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19101 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19102 @value{GDBN}.
19103
19104 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19105 executing it once.
19106
19107 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19108 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19109 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19110 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19111 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19112 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19113 optimized code.
19114
19115 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19116 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19117 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19118 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19119 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19120
19121 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19122 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19123 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19124 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19125 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19126 Warnings and Messages}.)
19127
19128 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19129 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19130 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19131 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19132 in stabs format.
19133
19134 @kindex readnow
19135 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19136 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19137 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19138 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19139 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19140 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19141 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19142 entire symbol table available.
19143
19144 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19145 @cindex never read symbols
19146 @cindex symbols, never read
19147 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19148 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19149 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19150 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19151 @xref{--readnever}.
19152
19153 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19154 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19155 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19156 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19157 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19158 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19159 @c files.
19160
19161 @kindex core-file
19162 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19163 @itemx core
19164 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19165 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19166 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19167 executable file itself for other parts.
19168
19169 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19170 to be used.
19171
19172 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19173 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19174 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19175 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19176 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19177
19178 @kindex add-symbol-file
19179 @cindex dynamic linking
19180 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19181 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19182 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19183 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19184 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19185 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19186 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19187 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19188 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19189 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19190 can be given as an expression.
19191
19192 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19193 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19194 specified explicitly.
19195
19196 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19197 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19198 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19199 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19200
19201 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19202
19203 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19204 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19205 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19206 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19207 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19208 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19209 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19210 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19211 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19212
19213 @itemize @bullet
19214 @item
19215 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19216 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19217 @item
19218 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19219 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19220 @item
19221 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19222 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19223 @end itemize
19224
19225 @noindent
19226 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19227 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19228 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19229 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19230 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19231 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19232 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19233 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19234 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19235 way.
19236
19237 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19238
19239 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19240 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19241 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19242 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19243 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19244 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19245
19246 @smallexample
19247 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19248 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19249 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19250 (y or n) y
19251 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19252 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19253 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19254 (gdb)
19255 @end smallexample
19256
19257
19258 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19259
19260 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19261 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19262 @cindex load symbols from memory
19263 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19264 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19265 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19266 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19267 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19268 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19269 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19270 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19271 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19272
19273 @kindex section
19274 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19275 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19276 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19277 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19278 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19279 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19280 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19281 their addresses.
19282
19283 @kindex info files
19284 @kindex info target
19285 @item info files
19286 @itemx info target
19287 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19288 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19289 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19290 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19291 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19292 current ones.
19293
19294 @kindex maint info sections
19295 @item maint info sections
19296 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19297 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19298 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19299 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19300 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19301 may be arbitrarily combined):
19302
19303 @table @code
19304 @item ALLOBJ
19305 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19306 @item @var{sections}
19307 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19308 @item @var{section-flags}
19309 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19310 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19311 @table @code
19312 @item ALLOC
19313 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19314 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19315 @item LOAD
19316 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19317 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19318 @item RELOC
19319 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19320 @item READONLY
19321 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19322 @item CODE
19323 Section contains executable code only.
19324 @item DATA
19325 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19326 @item ROM
19327 Section will reside in ROM.
19328 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19329 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19330 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19331 Section is not empty.
19332 @item NEVER_LOAD
19333 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19334 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19335 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19336 COFF shared library information.
19337 @item IS_COMMON
19338 Section contains common symbols.
19339 @end table
19340 @end table
19341 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19342 @cindex read-only sections
19343 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19344 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19345 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19346 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19347 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19348 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19349 enhancement to debugging performance.
19350
19351 The default is off.
19352
19353 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19354 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19355 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19356 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19357
19358 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19359 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19360 @end table
19361
19362 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19363 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19364 name and remembers it that way.
19365
19366 @cindex shared libraries
19367 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19368 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19369 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19370 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19371
19372 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19373 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19374
19375 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19376 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19377 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19378 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19379 debugging a core file).
19380
19381 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19382 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19383 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19384
19385 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19386 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19387 particularly large or there are many of them.
19388
19389 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19390 commands:
19391
19392 @table @code
19393 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19394 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19395 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19396 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19397 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19398 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19399 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19400 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19401
19402 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19403 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19404 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19405 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19406 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19407 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19408 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19409 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19410 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19411
19412 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19413 @item show auto-solib-add
19414 Display the current autoloading mode.
19415 @end table
19416
19417 @cindex load shared library
19418 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19419 command:
19420
19421 @table @code
19422 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19423 @kindex info share
19424 @item info share @var{regex}
19425 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19426 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19427 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19428 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19429
19430 @kindex info dll
19431 @item info dll @var{regex}
19432 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19433
19434 @kindex sharedlibrary
19435 @kindex share
19436 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19437 @itemx share @var{regex}
19438 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19439 Unix regular expression.
19440 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19441 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19442 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19443 loaded.
19444
19445 @item nosharedlibrary
19446 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19447 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19448 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19449 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19450 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19451 discarded.
19452 @end table
19453
19454 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19455 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19456 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19457 Catchpoints}).
19458
19459 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19460 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19461 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19462 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19463
19464 @table @code
19465 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19466 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19467 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19468 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19469 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19470 shared library.
19471
19472 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19473 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19474 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19475 library events happen.
19476 @end table
19477
19478 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19479 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19480 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19481 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19482 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19483 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19484 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19485 not.
19486
19487 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19488 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19489 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19490 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19491 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19492
19493 @table @code
19494 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19495 @cindex system root, alternate
19496 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19497 @kindex set sysroot
19498 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19499 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19500 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19501 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19502 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19503 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19504 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19505 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19506 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19507 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19508 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19509 @var{path}.
19510
19511 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19512 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19513 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19514 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19515 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19516 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19517 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19518 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19519 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19520 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19521 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19522 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19523 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19524 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19525
19526 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19527 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19528 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19529 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19530 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19531
19532 @smallexample
19533 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19534 @end smallexample
19535
19536 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19537 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19538 system:
19539
19540 @smallexample
19541 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19542 @end smallexample
19543
19544 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19545 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19546 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19547 colons:
19548
19549 @smallexample
19550 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19551 @end smallexample
19552
19553 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19554 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19555 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19556 @samp{z}):
19557
19558 @smallexample
19559 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19560 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19561 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19562 @end smallexample
19563
19564 @noindent
19565 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19566 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19567 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19568
19569 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19570 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19571
19572 @smallexample
19573 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19574 @end smallexample
19575
19576 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19577 if you don't want or need to.
19578
19579 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19580 sysroot}.
19581
19582 @cindex default system root
19583 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19584 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19585 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19586 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19587 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19588 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19589 location.
19590
19591 @kindex show sysroot
19592 @item show sysroot
19593 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19594
19595 @kindex set solib-search-path
19596 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19597 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19598 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19599 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19600 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19601 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19602 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19603 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19604 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19605 of shared library symbols.
19606
19607 @kindex show solib-search-path
19608 @item show solib-search-path
19609 Display the current shared library search path.
19610
19611 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19612 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19613 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19614 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19615 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19616
19617 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19618 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19619 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19620 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19621 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19622 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19623 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19624 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19625 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19626 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19627 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19628 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19629 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19630 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19631 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19632 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19633 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19634 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19635 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19636 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19637 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19638 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19639
19640 @table @code
19641 @item unix
19642 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19643 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19644 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19645 the forward slash.
19646
19647 @item dos-based
19648 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19649 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19650 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19651 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19652 considered directory separators.
19653
19654 @item auto
19655 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19656 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19657 This is the default.
19658 @end table
19659 @end table
19660
19661 @cindex file name canonicalization
19662 @cindex base name differences
19663 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19664 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19665 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19666 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19667 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19668 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19669 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19670 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19671 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19672 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19673 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19674 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19675 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19676 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19677 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19678
19679 @table @code
19680 @item set basenames-may-differ
19681 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19682 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19683
19684 @item show basenames-may-differ
19685 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19686 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19687 @end table
19688
19689 @node File Caching
19690 @section File Caching
19691 @cindex caching of opened files
19692 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19693
19694 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19695 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19696 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19697 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19698
19699 @table @code
19700 @kindex maint info bfds
19701 @item maint info bfds
19702 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19703 @value{GDBN}.
19704
19705 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19706 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19707 @kindex bfd caching
19708 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19709 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19710 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19711 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19712 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19713 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19714 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19715 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19716 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19717
19718 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19719 @kindex bfd caching
19720 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19721 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19722
19723 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19724 @kindex bfd caching
19725 @item show debug bfd-cache
19726 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19727 @end table
19728
19729 @node Separate Debug Files
19730 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19731 @cindex separate debugging information files
19732 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19733 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19734 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19735 @cindex global debugging information directories
19736 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19737 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19738
19739 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19740 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19741 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19742 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19743 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19744 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19745 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19746
19747 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19748 file:
19749
19750 @itemize @bullet
19751 @item
19752 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19753 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19754 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19755 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19756 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19757 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19758 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19759 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19760
19761 @item
19762 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19763 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19764 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19765 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19766 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19767 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19768 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19769 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19770 below.
19771 @end itemize
19772
19773 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19774 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19775
19776 @itemize @bullet
19777 @item
19778 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19779 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19780 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19781 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19782 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19783
19784 @item
19785 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19786 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19787 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19788 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19789 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19790 hex characters, not 10.)
19791 @end itemize
19792
19793 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19794 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19795 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19796 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19797 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19798 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19799
19800 @itemize @minus
19801 @item
19802 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19803 @item
19804 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19805 @item
19806 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19807 @item
19808 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19809 @end itemize
19810
19811 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19812 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19813 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19814 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19815 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19816
19817 @table @code
19818
19819 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19820 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19821 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19822 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19823 concatenating them by a path separator.
19824
19825 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19826 @item show debug-file-directory
19827 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19828 information files.
19829
19830 @end table
19831
19832 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19833 @cindex debug link sections
19834 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19835 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19836
19837 @itemize
19838 @item
19839 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19840 a zero byte,
19841 @item
19842 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19843 boundary within the section, and
19844 @item
19845 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19846 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19847 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19848 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19849 @end itemize
19850
19851 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19852 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19853 described above.
19854
19855 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19856 @cindex build ID sections
19857 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19858 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19859 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19860 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19861 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19862 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19863 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19864 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19865 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19866
19867 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19868 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19869 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19870 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19871 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19872 in an ordinary executable.
19873
19874 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19875 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19876 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19877 following commands:
19878
19879 @smallexample
19880 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19881 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19882 @end smallexample
19883
19884 @noindent
19885 These commands remove the debugging
19886 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19887 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19888 two files:
19889
19890 @itemize @bullet
19891 @item
19892 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19893 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19894
19895 @smallexample
19896 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19897 @end smallexample
19898
19899 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19900 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19901 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19902 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19903
19904 @item
19905 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19906 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19907 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19908 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19909 @end itemize
19910
19911 @noindent
19912
19913 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19914 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19915 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19916
19917 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19918 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19919 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19920 @c different ways!
19921 @ifhtml
19922 @display
19923 @html
19924 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19925 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19926 @end html
19927 @end display
19928 @end ifhtml
19929 @ifnothtml
19930 @display
19931 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19932 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19933 @end display
19934 @end ifnothtml
19935
19936 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19937 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19938 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19939 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19940 CRC.
19941
19942 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19943 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19944 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19945 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19946 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19947
19948 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19949 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19950 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19951 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19952 @code{0xffffffff}.
19953
19954 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19955 @smallexample
19956 unsigned long
19957 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19958 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19959 @{
19960 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19961 @{
19962 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19963 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19964 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19965 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19966 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19967 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19968 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19969 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19970 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19971 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19972 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19973 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19974 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19975 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19976 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19977 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19978 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19979 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19980 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19981 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19982 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19983 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19984 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19985 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19986 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19987 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19988 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19989 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19990 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19991 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19992 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19993 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19994 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19995 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19996 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19997 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19998 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19999 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20000 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20001 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20002 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20003 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20004 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20005 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20006 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20007 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20008 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20009 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20010 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20011 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20012 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20013 0x2d02ef8d
20014 @};
20015 unsigned char *end;
20016
20017 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20018 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20019 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20020 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20021 @}
20022 @end smallexample
20023
20024 @noindent
20025 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20026
20027 @node MiniDebugInfo
20028 @section Debugging information in a special section
20029 @cindex separate debug sections
20030 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20031
20032 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20033 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20034 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20035 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20036
20037 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20038 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20039 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20040 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20041 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20042 debugging information might be included in the section.
20043
20044 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20045 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20046 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20047
20048 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20049 standard utilities:
20050
20051 @smallexample
20052 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20053 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20054 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20055 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20056
20057 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20058 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20059 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20060 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20061 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20062 | sort > funcsyms
20063
20064 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20065 # table.
20066 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20067
20068 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20069 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20070
20071 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20072 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20073 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20074 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20075
20076 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20077 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20078
20079 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20080 # original binary.
20081 xz mini_debuginfo
20082 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20083 @end smallexample
20084
20085 @node Index Files
20086 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20087 @cindex index files
20088 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20089
20090 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20091 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20092 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20093 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20094 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20095 startup.
20096
20097 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20098 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20099 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20100
20101 @smallexample
20102 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20103 @end smallexample
20104
20105 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20106
20107 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20108 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20109
20110 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20111 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20112 using @command{objcopy}.
20113
20114 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20115
20116 @table @code
20117 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20118 @kindex save gdb-index
20119 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20120 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20121 default creates it produces a single file
20122 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20123 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20124 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20125 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20126 given @var{directory}.
20127 @end table
20128
20129 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20130 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20131
20132 @smallexample
20133 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20134 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20135 @end smallexample
20136
20137 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20138
20139 @smallexample
20140 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20141 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20142 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20143 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20144 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20145 @end smallexample
20146
20147 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20148 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20149 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20150 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20151 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20152 The default is @code{off}.
20153 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20154 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20155
20156 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20157 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20158
20159 @smallexample
20160 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20161 @end smallexample
20162
20163 Instead you must do, for example,
20164
20165 @smallexample
20166 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20167 @end smallexample
20168
20169 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20170 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20171 currently work for programs using Ada.
20172
20173 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20174
20175 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20176 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20177 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20178 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20179
20180 @table @code
20181
20182 @item set index-cache on
20183 @itemx set index-cache off
20184 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20185
20186 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20187 @itemx show index-cache directory
20188 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20189
20190 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20191 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20192 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20193 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20194 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20195 differ according to local convention.
20196
20197 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20198 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20199
20200 @item show index-cache stats
20201 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20202
20203 @end table
20204
20205 @node Symbol Errors
20206 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20207
20208 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20209 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20210 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20211 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20212 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20213 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20214 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20215 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20216 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20217 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20218 Messages}).
20219
20220 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20221
20222 @table @code
20223 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20224
20225 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20226 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20227 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20228 in its outer scope blocks.
20229
20230 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20231 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20232 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20233 function.
20234
20235 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20236
20237 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20238 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20239 do so.
20240
20241 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20242 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20243 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20244 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20245 Messages}.)
20246
20247 @item bad block start address patched
20248
20249 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20250 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20251 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20252
20253 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20254 starting on the previous source line.
20255
20256 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20257
20258 @cindex foo
20259 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20260 larger than the size of the string table.
20261
20262 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20263 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20264 with this name.
20265
20266 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20267
20268 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20269 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20270 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20271
20272 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20273 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20274 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20275 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20276 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20277 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20278
20279 @item stub type has NULL name
20280
20281 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20282
20283 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20284 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20285 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20286 it.
20287
20288 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20289
20290 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20291
20292 @end table
20293
20294 @node Data Files
20295 @section GDB Data Files
20296
20297 @cindex prefix for data files
20298 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20299 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20300
20301 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20302 is currently using.
20303
20304 @table @code
20305 @kindex set data-directory
20306 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20307 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20308 to @var{directory}.
20309
20310 @kindex show data-directory
20311 @item show data-directory
20312 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20313 @end table
20314
20315 @cindex default data directory
20316 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20317 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20318 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20319 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20320 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20321 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20322 location.
20323
20324 The data directory may also be specified with the
20325 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20326 @xref{Mode Options}.
20327
20328 @node Targets
20329 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20330
20331 @cindex debugging target
20332 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20333
20334 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20335 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20336 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20337 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20338 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20339 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20340 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20341 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20342
20343 @cindex target architecture
20344 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20345 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20346 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20347 command.
20348
20349 @table @code
20350 @kindex set architecture
20351 @kindex show architecture
20352 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20353 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20354 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20355 supported architectures.
20356
20357 @item show architecture
20358 Show the current target architecture.
20359
20360 @item set processor
20361 @itemx processor
20362 @kindex set processor
20363 @kindex show processor
20364 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20365 and @code{show architecture}.
20366 @end table
20367
20368 @menu
20369 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20370 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20371 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20372 @end menu
20373
20374 @node Active Targets
20375 @section Active Targets
20376
20377 @cindex stacking targets
20378 @cindex active targets
20379 @cindex multiple targets
20380
20381 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20382 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20383 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20384 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20385 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20386 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20387 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20388 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20389 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20390
20391 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20392 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20393 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20394 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20395
20396 @node Target Commands
20397 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20398
20399 @table @code
20400 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20401 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20402 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20403 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20404 protocol of the target machine.
20405
20406 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20407 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20408 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20409
20410 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20411 after executing the command.
20412
20413 @kindex help target
20414 @item help target
20415 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20416 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20417 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20418
20419 @item help target @var{name}
20420 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20421 select it.
20422
20423 @kindex set gnutarget
20424 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20425 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20426 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20427 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20428 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20429 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20430
20431 @quotation
20432 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20433 you must know the actual BFD name.
20434 @end quotation
20435
20436 @noindent
20437 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20438
20439 @kindex show gnutarget
20440 @item show gnutarget
20441 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20442 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20443 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20444 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20445 @end table
20446
20447 @cindex common targets
20448 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20449 configuration):
20450
20451 @table @code
20452 @kindex target
20453 @item target exec @var{program}
20454 @cindex executable file target
20455 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20456 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20457
20458 @item target core @var{filename}
20459 @cindex core dump file target
20460 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20461 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20462
20463 @item target remote @var{medium}
20464 @cindex remote target
20465 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20466 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20467 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20468
20469 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20470 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20471
20472 @smallexample
20473 target remote /dev/ttya
20474 @end smallexample
20475
20476 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20477 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20478 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20479 clobbered by the download.
20480
20481 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20482 @cindex built-in simulator target
20483 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20484 In general,
20485 @smallexample
20486 target sim
20487 load
20488 run
20489 @end smallexample
20490 @noindent
20491 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20492 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20493 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20494 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20495 Processors}.
20496
20497 @item target native
20498 @cindex native target
20499 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20500 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20501 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20502 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20503
20504 @end table
20505
20506 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20507 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20508
20509 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20510 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20511 various aspects of this process.
20512
20513 @table @code
20514
20515 @item set hash
20516 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20517 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20518 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20519 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20520 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20521 monitor.
20522
20523 @item show hash
20524 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20525 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20526
20527 @item set debug monitor
20528 @kindex set debug monitor
20529 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20530 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20531 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20532
20533 @item show debug monitor
20534 @kindex show debug monitor
20535 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20536 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20537 @end table
20538
20539 @table @code
20540
20541 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20542 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20543 @anchor{load}
20544 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20545 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20546 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20547 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20548 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20549 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20550
20551 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20552 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20553 target is @dots{}}''
20554
20555 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20556 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20557 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20558 specifies a fixed address.
20559 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20560
20561 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20562 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20563 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20564
20565 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20566 load programs into flash memory.
20567
20568 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20569 @end table
20570
20571 @table @code
20572
20573 @kindex flash-erase
20574 @item flash-erase
20575 @anchor{flash-erase}
20576
20577 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20578
20579 @end table
20580
20581 @node Byte Order
20582 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20583
20584 @cindex choosing target byte order
20585 @cindex target byte order
20586
20587 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20588 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20589 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20590 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20591 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20592 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20593
20594 @table @code
20595 @kindex set endian
20596 @item set endian big
20597 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20598
20599 @item set endian little
20600 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20601
20602 @item set endian auto
20603 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20604 executable.
20605
20606 @item show endian
20607 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20608
20609 @end table
20610
20611 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20612 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20613 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20614 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20615 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20616 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20617 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20618 and @code{big} otherwise.
20619
20620 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20621 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20622 target system.
20623
20624
20625 @node Remote Debugging
20626 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20627 @cindex remote debugging
20628
20629 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20630 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20631 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20632 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20633 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20634
20635 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20636 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20637 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20638 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20639 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20640 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20641
20642 Other remote targets may be available in your
20643 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20644
20645 @menu
20646 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20647 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20648 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20649 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20650 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20651 @end menu
20652
20653 @node Connecting
20654 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20655 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20656 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20657 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20658 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20659 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20660 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20661
20662 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20663 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20664 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20665 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20666
20667 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20668
20669 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20670 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20671 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20672 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20673
20674 @table @asis
20675
20676 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20677 @item Result of detach or program exit
20678 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20679 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20680 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20681
20682 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20683 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20684 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20685 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20686
20687 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20688 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20689 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20690 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20691
20692 @item Specifying the program to debug
20693 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20694 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20695 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20696 target.
20697
20698 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20699 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20700 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20701
20702 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20703 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20704 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20705 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20706
20707 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20708 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20709 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20710 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20711 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20712 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20713 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20714 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20715 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20716
20717 @item The @code{run} command
20718 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20719 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20720 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20721 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20722 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20723
20724 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20725 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20726 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20727 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20728 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20729
20730 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20731 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20732 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20733 @code{target remote} mode.
20734
20735 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20736 @item Attaching
20737 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20738 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20739 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20740
20741 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20742 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20743 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20744 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20745 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20746
20747 @end table
20748
20749 @anchor{Host and target files}
20750 @subsection Host and Target Files
20751 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20752 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20753
20754 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20755 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20756 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20757 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20758 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20759
20760 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20761 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20762 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20763 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20764 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20765
20766 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20767 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20768 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20769 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20770 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20771 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20772 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20773 target libraries.
20774
20775 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20776 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20777 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20778 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20779 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20780 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20781 programs.
20782
20783 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20784 @cindex remote connection commands
20785 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20786 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20787 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20788 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20789 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20790 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20791 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20792
20793 @table @code
20794
20795 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20796 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20797 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20798 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20799 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20800
20801 @smallexample
20802 target remote /dev/ttyb
20803 @end smallexample
20804
20805 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20806 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20807 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20808 @code{target} command.
20809
20810 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20811 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20812 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20813 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20814 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20815 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20816 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20817 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20818 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20819 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20820 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20821 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20822 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20823 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20824 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20825 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20826 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20827 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20828 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20829 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20830 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20831 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20832
20833 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20834 @code{manyfarms}:
20835
20836 @smallexample
20837 target remote manyfarms:2828
20838 @end smallexample
20839
20840 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20841 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20842 square bracket syntax:
20843
20844 @smallexample
20845 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20846 @end smallexample
20847
20848 @noindent
20849 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20850
20851 @smallexample
20852 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20853 @end smallexample
20854
20855 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
20856 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
20857 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
20858 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
20859 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
20860 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
20861
20862 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20863 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20864 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20865 port 1234 on your local machine:
20866
20867 @smallexample
20868 target remote :1234
20869 @end smallexample
20870 @noindent
20871
20872 Note that the colon is still required here.
20873
20874 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20875 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20876 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20877 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20878 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20879 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20880 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20881 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20882 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20883 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20884 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20885 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20886 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20887
20888 @smallexample
20889 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20890 @end smallexample
20891
20892 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20893 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20894 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20895 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20896
20897 @item target remote | @var{command}
20898 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20899 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20900 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20901 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20902 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20903 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20904 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20905 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20906 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20907
20908 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20909 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20910 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20911
20912 @end table
20913
20914 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20915 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20916 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20917 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20918 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20919 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20920 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20921
20922 @smallexample
20923 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20924 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20925 @end smallexample
20926
20927 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20928 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20929 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20930 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20931
20932 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20933 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20934
20935 @table @code
20936 @kindex detach (remote)
20937 @item detach
20938 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20939 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20940 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20941 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20942 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20943 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20944 still connected to the target.
20945
20946 @kindex disconnect
20947 @item disconnect
20948 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20949 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20950 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20951 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20952 another target.
20953
20954 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20955 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20956 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20957 @kindex monitor
20958 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20959 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20960 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20961 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20962 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20963 and implement.
20964 @end table
20965
20966 @node File Transfer
20967 @section Sending files to a remote system
20968 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20969 @cindex file transfer
20970 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20971
20972 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20973 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20974 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20975 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20976 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20977 the only way to upload or download files.
20978
20979 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20980
20981 @table @code
20982 @kindex remote put
20983 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20984 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20985 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20986
20987 @kindex remote get
20988 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20989 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20990 on the host system.
20991
20992 @kindex remote delete
20993 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20994 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20995
20996 @end table
20997
20998 @node Server
20999 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21000
21001 @kindex gdbserver
21002 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21003 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21004 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21005 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21006 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21007
21008 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21009 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21010 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21011 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21012 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21013 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21014 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21015 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21016 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21017 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21018 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21019 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21020 choice for debugging.
21021
21022 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21023 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21024 protocol.
21025
21026 @quotation
21027 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21028 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21029 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21030 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21031 @code{gdbserver}.
21032 @end quotation
21033
21034 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21035 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21036 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21037 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21038
21039 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21040 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21041 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21042 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21043 system does all the symbol handling.
21044
21045 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21046 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21047 syntax is:
21048
21049 @smallexample
21050 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21051 @end smallexample
21052
21053 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21054 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21055 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21056 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21057 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21058 @file{/dev/com1}:
21059
21060 @smallexample
21061 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21062 @end smallexample
21063
21064 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21065 with it.
21066
21067 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21068
21069 @smallexample
21070 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21071 @end smallexample
21072
21073 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21074 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21075 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21076 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21077 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21078 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21079 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21080 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21081 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21082 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21083 @code{target remote} command.
21084
21085 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21086 with ssh:
21087
21088 @smallexample
21089 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21090 @end smallexample
21091
21092 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21093 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21094 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21095 You could elide it if you want to.
21096
21097 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21098 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21099 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21100 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21101
21102 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21103 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21104 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21105 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21106
21107 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21108 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21109
21110 @smallexample
21111 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21112 @end smallexample
21113
21114 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21115 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21116
21117 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21118 @value{GDBN} attach command
21119 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21120
21121 @pindex pidof
21122 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21123 @code{pidof} utility:
21124
21125 @smallexample
21126 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21127 @end smallexample
21128
21129 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21130 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21131 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21132
21133 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21134
21135 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21136 port.
21137
21138 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21139 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21140 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21141 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21142 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21143 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21144 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21145 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21146
21147 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21148 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21149 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21150
21151 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21152 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21153 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21154 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21155 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21156 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21157 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21158 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21159 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21160 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21161 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21162 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21163
21164 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21165 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21166
21167 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21168 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21169 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21170 program. For more information,
21171 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21172
21173 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21174 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21175 status information about the debugging process.
21176 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21177 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21178 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21179 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21180
21181 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21182 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21183 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21184 Possible options are:
21185
21186 @table @code
21187 @item none
21188 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21189 @item all
21190 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21191 @item timestamps
21192 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21193 @end table
21194
21195 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21196 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21197
21198 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21199 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21200 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21201 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21202 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21203
21204 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21205 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21206 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21207 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21208
21209 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21210 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21211 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21212 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21213
21214 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21215 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21216 environment:
21217
21218 @smallexample
21219 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21220 @end smallexample
21221
21222 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21223 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21224
21225 @smallexample
21226 $ gdbserver --selftest
21227 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21228 @end smallexample
21229
21230 These tests are disabled in release.
21231 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21232
21233 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21234 @itemize
21235
21236 @item
21237 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21238
21239 @item
21240 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21241 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21242 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21243 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21244 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21245 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21246
21247 @item
21248 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21249 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21250 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21251 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21252 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21253 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21254 program is already on the target.
21255
21256 @end itemize
21257
21258 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21259 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21260 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21261
21262 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21263 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21264 Here are the available commands.
21265
21266 @table @code
21267 @item monitor help
21268 List the available monitor commands.
21269
21270 @item monitor set debug 0
21271 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21272 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21273
21274 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21275 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21276 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21277 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21278
21279 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21280 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21281 Possible options are:
21282
21283 @table @code
21284 @item none
21285 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21286 @item all
21287 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21288 @item timestamps
21289 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21290 @end table
21291
21292 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21293 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21294
21295 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21296 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21297 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21298 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21299 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21300 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21301
21302 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21303 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21304
21305 @item monitor exit
21306 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21307 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21308 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21309 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21310 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21311
21312 @end table
21313
21314 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21315 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21316
21317 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21318 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21319
21320 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21321 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21322 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21323 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21324 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21325 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21326 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21327 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21328 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21329 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21330 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21331 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21332
21333 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21334
21335 @table @code
21336 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21337
21338 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21339 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21340 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21341
21342 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21343
21344 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21345 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21346 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21347 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21348 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21349 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21350
21351 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21352
21353 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21354 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21355 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21356 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21357 command for that. For example:
21358
21359 @smallexample
21360 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21361 @end smallexample
21362
21363 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21364 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21365 @end table
21366
21367 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21368 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21369 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21370 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21371 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21372 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21373 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21374 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21375 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21376 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21377
21378 @smallexample
21379 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21380 @end smallexample
21381
21382 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21383
21384 @smallexample
21385 $ gdb myprogram
21386 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21387 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21388 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21389 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21390 @end smallexample
21391
21392 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21393 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21394 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21395 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21396 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21397 tracing.
21398
21399 @node Remote Configuration
21400 @section Remote Configuration
21401
21402 @kindex set remote
21403 @kindex show remote
21404 This section documents the configuration options available when
21405 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21406 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21407 system-call-allowed}.
21408
21409 @table @code
21410 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21411 @cindex address size for remote targets
21412 @cindex bits in remote address
21413 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21414 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21415 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21416 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21417
21418 @item show remoteaddresssize
21419 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21420
21421 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21422 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21423 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21424 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21425 remote targets.
21426
21427 @item show serial baud
21428 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21429
21430 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21431 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21432 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21433
21434 @item show serial parity
21435 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21436
21437 @item set remotebreak
21438 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21439 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21440 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21441 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21442 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21443 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21444 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21445 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21446
21447 @item show remotebreak
21448 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21449 interrupt the remote program.
21450
21451 @item set remoteflow on
21452 @itemx set remoteflow off
21453 @kindex set remoteflow
21454 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21455 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21456
21457 @item show remoteflow
21458 @kindex show remoteflow
21459 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21460
21461 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21462 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21463 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21464 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21465 @code{ascii}.
21466
21467 @item show remotelogbase
21468 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21469 protocol.
21470
21471 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21472 @cindex record serial communications on file
21473 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21474 default is not to record at all.
21475
21476 @item show remotelogfile.
21477 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21478 serial communications.
21479
21480 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21481 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21482 @cindex remote timeout
21483 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21484 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21485
21486 @item show remotetimeout
21487 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21488 responses.
21489
21490 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21491 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21492 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21493 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21494 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21495 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21496 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21497 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21498 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21499 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21500
21501 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21502 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21503 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21504 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21505
21506 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21507 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21508 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21509 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21510 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21511 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21512 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21513 length.
21514
21515 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21516 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21517 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21518
21519 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21520 @itemx show remote exec-file
21521 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21522 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21523 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21524 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21525 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21526 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21527
21528 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21529 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21530 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21531 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21532 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21533 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21534 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21535 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21536 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21537 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21538
21539 @item show interrupt-sequence
21540 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21541 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21542 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21543 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21544
21545 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21546 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21547 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21548 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21549 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21550 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21551
21552 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21553 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21554 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21555
21556 @kindex set tcp
21557 @kindex show tcp
21558 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21559 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21560 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21561 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21562 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21563 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21564 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21565 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21566 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21567
21568 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21569 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21570
21571 @item show tcp auto-retry
21572 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21573
21574 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21575 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21576 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21577 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21578 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21579 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21580 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21581 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21582 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21583 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21584 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21585
21586 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21587 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21588 @end table
21589
21590 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21591 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21592 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21593 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21594 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21595 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21596 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21597 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21598 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21599
21600 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21601 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21602 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21603 @value{GDBN} developers.
21604
21605 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21606 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21607 are:
21608
21609 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21610 @item Command Name
21611 @tab Remote Packet
21612 @tab Related Features
21613
21614 @item @code{fetch-register}
21615 @tab @code{p}
21616 @tab @code{info registers}
21617
21618 @item @code{set-register}
21619 @tab @code{P}
21620 @tab @code{set}
21621
21622 @item @code{binary-download}
21623 @tab @code{X}
21624 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21625
21626 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21627 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21628 @tab @code{info auxv}
21629
21630 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21631 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21632 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21633
21634 @item @code{attach}
21635 @tab @code{vAttach}
21636 @tab @code{attach}
21637
21638 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21639 @tab @code{vCont}
21640 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21641
21642 @item @code{run}
21643 @tab @code{vRun}
21644 @tab @code{run}
21645
21646 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21647 @tab @code{Z0}
21648 @tab @code{break}
21649
21650 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21651 @tab @code{Z1}
21652 @tab @code{hbreak}
21653
21654 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21655 @tab @code{Z2}
21656 @tab @code{watch}
21657
21658 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21659 @tab @code{Z3}
21660 @tab @code{rwatch}
21661
21662 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21663 @tab @code{Z4}
21664 @tab @code{awatch}
21665
21666 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21667 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21668 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21669
21670 @item @code{target-features}
21671 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21672 @tab @code{set architecture}
21673
21674 @item @code{library-info}
21675 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21676 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21677
21678 @item @code{memory-map}
21679 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21680 @tab @code{info mem}
21681
21682 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21683 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21684 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21685
21686 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21687 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21688 @tab @code{info spu}
21689
21690 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21691 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21692 @tab @code{info spu}
21693
21694 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21695 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21696 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21697
21698 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21699 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21700 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21701
21702 @item @code{threads}
21703 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21704 @tab @code{info threads}
21705
21706 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21707 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21708 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21709
21710 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21711 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21712 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21713
21714 @item @code{search-memory}
21715 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21716 @tab @code{find}
21717
21718 @item @code{supported-packets}
21719 @tab @code{qSupported}
21720 @tab Remote communications parameters
21721
21722 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21723 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21724 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21725
21726 @item @code{pass-signals}
21727 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21728 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21729
21730 @item @code{program-signals}
21731 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21732 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21733
21734 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21735 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21736 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21737
21738 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21739 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21740 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21741
21742 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21743 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21744 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21745
21746 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21747 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21748 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21749
21750 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21751 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21752 @tab @code{remote delete}
21753
21754 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21755 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21756 @tab Host I/O
21757
21758 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21759 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21760 @tab Host I/O
21761
21762 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21763 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21764 @tab Host I/O
21765
21766 @item @code{noack-packet}
21767 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21768 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21769
21770 @item @code{osdata}
21771 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21772 @tab @code{info os}
21773
21774 @item @code{query-attached}
21775 @tab @code{qAttached}
21776 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21777
21778 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21779 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21780 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21781
21782 @item @code{trace-status}
21783 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21784 @tab @code{tstatus}
21785
21786 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21787 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21788 @tab Traceframe info
21789
21790 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21791 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21792 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21793
21794 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21795 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21796 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21797
21798 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21799 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21800 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21801
21802 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21803 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21804 @tab @code{set environment}
21805
21806 @item @code{environment-unset}
21807 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21808 @tab @code{unset environment}
21809
21810 @item @code{environment-reset}
21811 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21812 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21813
21814 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21815 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21816 @tab @code{set cwd}
21817
21818 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21819 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21820 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21821
21822 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21823 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21824 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21825
21826 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21827 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21828 @tab @code{break}
21829
21830 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21831 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21832 @tab @code{hbreak}
21833
21834 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21835 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21836 @tab @code{fork}
21837
21838 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21839 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21840 @tab @code{vfork}
21841
21842 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21843 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21844 @tab @code{exec}
21845
21846 @item @code{thread-events}
21847 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21848 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21849
21850 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21851 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21852 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21853
21854 @end multitable
21855
21856 @node Remote Stub
21857 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21858
21859 @cindex debugging stub, example
21860 @cindex remote stub, example
21861 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21862 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21863 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21864 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21865 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21866 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21867 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21868 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21869
21870 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21871 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21872 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21873 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21874 program, you need:
21875
21876 @enumerate
21877 @item
21878 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21879 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21880 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21881
21882 @item
21883 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21884 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21885
21886 @item
21887 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21888 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21889 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21890 documentation.
21891 @end enumerate
21892
21893 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21894 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21895 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21896
21897 @table @emph
21898 @item On the host,
21899 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21900 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21901 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21902
21903 @item On the target,
21904 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21905 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21906 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21907
21908 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21909 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21910 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21911 @end table
21912
21913 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21914 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21915 @sc{sparc} boards.
21916
21917 @cindex remote serial stub list
21918 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21919
21920 @table @code
21921
21922 @item i386-stub.c
21923 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21924 @cindex Intel
21925 @cindex i386
21926 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21927
21928 @item m68k-stub.c
21929 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21930 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21931 @cindex m680x0
21932 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21933
21934 @item sh-stub.c
21935 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21936 @cindex Renesas
21937 @cindex SH
21938 For Renesas SH architectures.
21939
21940 @item sparc-stub.c
21941 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21942 @cindex Sparc
21943 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21944
21945 @item sparcl-stub.c
21946 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21947 @cindex Fujitsu
21948 @cindex SparcLite
21949 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21950
21951 @end table
21952
21953 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21954 recently added stubs.
21955
21956 @menu
21957 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21958 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21959 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21960 @end menu
21961
21962 @node Stub Contents
21963 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21964
21965 @cindex remote serial stub
21966 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21967 subroutines:
21968
21969 @table @code
21970 @item set_debug_traps
21971 @findex set_debug_traps
21972 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21973 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21974 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21975 program's startup code.
21976
21977 @item handle_exception
21978 @findex handle_exception
21979 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21980 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21981 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21982 run when a trap is triggered.
21983
21984 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21985 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21986 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21987 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21988 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21989 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21990 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21991 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21992 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21993 machine.
21994
21995 @item breakpoint
21996 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21997 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21998 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21999 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22000 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22001 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22002 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22003 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22004 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22005 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22006 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22007
22008 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22009 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22010 start of your debugging session.
22011 @end table
22012
22013 @node Bootstrapping
22014 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22015
22016 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22017 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22018 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22019 debugging target machine.
22020
22021 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22022 serial port.
22023
22024 @table @code
22025 @item int getDebugChar()
22026 @findex getDebugChar
22027 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22028 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22029 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22030
22031 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22032 @findex putDebugChar
22033 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22034 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22035 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22036 @end table
22037
22038 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22039 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22040 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22041 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22042 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22043 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22044 remote system to stop.
22045
22046 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22047 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22048 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22049 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22050
22051 Other routines you need to supply are:
22052
22053 @table @code
22054 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22055 @findex exceptionHandler
22056 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22057 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22058 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22059 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22060 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22061 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22062 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22063 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22064 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22065 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22066 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22067 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22068 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22069
22070 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22071 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22072 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22073 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22074 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22075
22076 @item void flush_i_cache()
22077 @findex flush_i_cache
22078 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22079 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22080 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22081
22082 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22083 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22084 @end table
22085
22086 @noindent
22087 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22088
22089 @table @code
22090 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22091 @findex memset
22092 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22093 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22094 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22095 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22096 @end table
22097
22098 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22099 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22100 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22101 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22102
22103
22104 @node Debug Session
22105 @subsection Putting it All Together
22106
22107 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22108 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22109 steps.
22110
22111 @enumerate
22112 @item
22113 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22114 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22115 @display
22116 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22117 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22118 @end display
22119
22120 @item
22121 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22122 procedure is called:
22123
22124 @smallexample
22125 set_debug_traps();
22126 breakpoint();
22127 @end smallexample
22128
22129 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22130 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22131 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22132 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22133 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22134 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22135 progress.
22136
22137 @item
22138 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22139 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22140
22141 @smallexample
22142 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22143 @end smallexample
22144
22145 @noindent
22146 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22147 function in your program, that function is called when
22148 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22149 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22150 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22151
22152 @item
22153 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22154 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22155
22156 @item
22157 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22158 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22159
22160 @item
22161 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22162 @c document that. FIXME.
22163 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22164 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22165
22166 @item
22167 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22168 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22169
22170 @end enumerate
22171
22172 @node Configurations
22173 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22174
22175 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22176 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22177 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22178
22179 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22180 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22181 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22182 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22183 are quite different from each other.
22184
22185 @menu
22186 * Native::
22187 * Embedded OS::
22188 * Embedded Processors::
22189 * Architectures::
22190 @end menu
22191
22192 @node Native
22193 @section Native
22194
22195 This section describes details specific to particular native
22196 configurations.
22197
22198 @menu
22199 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22200 * Process Information:: Process information
22201 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22202 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22203 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22204 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22205 @end menu
22206
22207 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22208 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22209
22210 @cindex libkvm
22211 @cindex kernel memory image
22212 @cindex kernel crash dump
22213
22214 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22215 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22216 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22217 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22218 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22219 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22220 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22221 @code{kvm} target:
22222
22223 @smallexample
22224 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22225 @end smallexample
22226
22227 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22228 argument:
22229
22230 @smallexample
22231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22232 @end smallexample
22233
22234 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22235 available:
22236
22237 @table @code
22238 @kindex kvm
22239 @item kvm pcb
22240 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22241
22242 @item kvm proc
22243 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22244 modern FreeBSD systems.
22245 @end table
22246
22247 @node Process Information
22248 @subsection Process Information
22249 @cindex /proc
22250 @cindex examine process image
22251 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22252
22253 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22254 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22255 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22256 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22257 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22258 any process running on your system.
22259
22260 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22261 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22262 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22263 systems.
22264
22265 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22266 information.
22267
22268 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22269 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22270 information available from a live process. Process information is
22271 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22272 systems.
22273
22274 @table @code
22275 @kindex info proc
22276 @cindex process ID
22277 @item info proc
22278 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22279 Summarize available information about a process. If a
22280 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22281 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22282 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22283 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22284 executable file's absolute file name.
22285
22286 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22287 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22288 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22289 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22290 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22291 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22292
22293 @item info proc cmdline
22294 @cindex info proc cmdline
22295 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22296 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22297
22298 @item info proc cwd
22299 @cindex info proc cwd
22300 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22301 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22302
22303 @item info proc exe
22304 @cindex info proc exe
22305 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22306 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22307
22308 @item info proc files
22309 @cindex info proc files
22310 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22311 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22312 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22313 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22314 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22315 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22316 FreeBSD.
22317
22318 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22319 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22320
22321 @smallexample
22322 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22323 process 22136
22324 Open files:
22325
22326 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22327 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22328 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22329 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22330 root dir - r-------- /
22331 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22332 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22333 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22334 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22335 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22336 @end smallexample
22337
22338 @item info proc mappings
22339 @cindex memory address space mappings
22340 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
22341 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22342 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22343 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22344 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22345
22346 @item info proc stat
22347 @itemx info proc status
22348 @cindex process detailed status information
22349 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22350 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22351 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22352 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22353 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22354
22355 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22356 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22357
22358 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22359 proc status}.
22360
22361 @item info proc all
22362 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22363 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22364
22365 @ignore
22366 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22367 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22368 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22369 @kindex info proc times
22370 @item info proc times
22371 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22372 its children.
22373
22374 @kindex info proc id
22375 @item info proc id
22376 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22377 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22378 @end ignore
22379
22380 @item set procfs-trace
22381 @kindex set procfs-trace
22382 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22383 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22384
22385 @item show procfs-trace
22386 @kindex show procfs-trace
22387 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22388
22389 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22390 @kindex set procfs-file
22391 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22392 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22393 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22394 standard output.
22395
22396 @item show procfs-file
22397 @kindex show procfs-file
22398 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22399
22400 @item proc-trace-entry
22401 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22402 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22403 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22404 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22405 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22406 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22407 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22408 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22409 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22410
22411 @item info pidlist
22412 @kindex info pidlist
22413 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22414 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22415 processes and all the threads within each process.
22416
22417 @item info meminfo
22418 @kindex info meminfo
22419 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22420 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22421 @end table
22422
22423 @node DJGPP Native
22424 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22425 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22426 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22427 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22428
22429 @cindex DPMI
22430 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22431 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22432 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22433 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22434
22435 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22436 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22437 subsection describes those commands.
22438
22439 @table @code
22440 @kindex info dos
22441 @item info dos
22442 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22443 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22444
22445 @kindex sysinfo
22446 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22447 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22448 @item info dos sysinfo
22449 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22450 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22451 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22452
22453 @cindex GDT
22454 @cindex LDT
22455 @cindex IDT
22456 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22457 @cindex descriptor tables display
22458 @item info dos gdt
22459 @itemx info dos ldt
22460 @itemx info dos idt
22461 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22462 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22463 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22464 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22465 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22466 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22467 rights.
22468
22469 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22470 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22471 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22472 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22473 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22474
22475 @cindex garbled pointers
22476 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22477 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22478 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22479 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22480 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22481 debugged program's data segment:
22482
22483 @smallexample
22484 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22485 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22486 @end smallexample
22487
22488 @noindent
22489 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22490 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22491
22492 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22493 @item info dos pde
22494 @itemx info dos pte
22495 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22496 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22497 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22498 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22499 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22500 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22501 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22502 that is currently in use.
22503
22504 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22505 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22506 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22507 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22508 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22509 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22510 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22511
22512 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22513 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22514 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22515 controller.
22516
22517 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22518
22519 @cindex physical address from linear address
22520 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22521 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22522 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22523 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22524 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22525 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22526 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22527
22528 @smallexample
22529 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22530 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22531 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22532 @end smallexample
22533
22534 @noindent
22535 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22536 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22537 attributes of that page.
22538
22539 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22540 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22541 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22542 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22543 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22544 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22545
22546 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22547 transfer buffer:
22548
22549 @smallexample
22550 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22551 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22552 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22553 @end smallexample
22554
22555 @noindent
22556 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22557 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22558 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22559 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22560 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22561
22562 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22563 @end table
22564
22565 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22566 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22567 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22568 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22569
22570 @table @code
22571 @kindex set com1base
22572 @kindex set com1irq
22573 @kindex set com2base
22574 @kindex set com2irq
22575 @kindex set com3base
22576 @kindex set com3irq
22577 @kindex set com4base
22578 @kindex set com4irq
22579 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22580 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22581 port.
22582
22583 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22584 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22585 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22586
22587 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22588 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22589 other 3 COM ports.
22590
22591 @kindex show com1base
22592 @kindex show com1irq
22593 @kindex show com2base
22594 @kindex show com2irq
22595 @kindex show com3base
22596 @kindex show com3irq
22597 @kindex show com4base
22598 @kindex show com4irq
22599 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22600 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22601 lines used by the COM ports.
22602
22603 @item info serial
22604 @kindex info serial
22605 @cindex DOS serial port status
22606 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22607 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22608 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22609 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22610 @end table
22611
22612
22613 @node Cygwin Native
22614 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22615 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22616 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22617 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22618
22619 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22620 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22621
22622 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22623 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22624 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22625 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22626 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22627 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22628 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22629 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22630
22631 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22632 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22633 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22634
22635 @table @code
22636 @kindex info w32
22637 @item info w32
22638 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22639 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22640
22641 @item info w32 selector
22642 This command displays information returned by
22643 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22644 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22645 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22646 Without argument, this command displays information
22647 about the six segment registers.
22648
22649 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22650 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22651 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22652 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22653
22654 @kindex signal-event
22655 @item signal-event @var{id}
22656 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22657 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22658
22659 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22660 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22661 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22662 (for x86_64 versions):
22663
22664 @itemize @minus
22665 @item
22666 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22667 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22668 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22669
22670 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22671 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22672 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22673 to attach.
22674
22675 @item
22676 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22677 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22678 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22679 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22680 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22681 @end itemize
22682
22683 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22684 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22685 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22686 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22687 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22688 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22689 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22690 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22691 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22692 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22693 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22694
22695 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22696 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22697 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22698 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22699
22700 @kindex set new-console
22701 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22702 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22703 be started in a new console on next start.
22704 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22705 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22706
22707 @kindex show new-console
22708 @item show new-console
22709 Displays whether a new console is used
22710 when the debuggee is started.
22711
22712 @kindex set new-group
22713 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22714 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22715 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22716 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22717 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22718
22719 @kindex show new-group
22720 @item show new-group
22721 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22722
22723 @kindex set debugevents
22724 @item set debugevents
22725 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22726 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22727 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22728 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22729 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22730
22731 @kindex set debugexec
22732 @item set debugexec
22733 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22734 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22735
22736 @kindex set debugexceptions
22737 @item set debugexceptions
22738 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22739 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22740
22741 @kindex set debugmemory
22742 @item set debugmemory
22743 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22744 and writes by the debugger.
22745
22746 @kindex set shell
22747 @item set shell
22748 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22749 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22750
22751 @kindex show shell
22752 @item show shell
22753 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22754
22755 @end table
22756
22757 @menu
22758 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22759 @end menu
22760
22761 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22762 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22763 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22764 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22765
22766 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22767 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22768 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22769 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22770 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22771 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22772 ``minimal symbols''.
22773
22774 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22775 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22776 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22777 program run once to completion.
22778
22779 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22780
22781 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22782 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22783 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22784 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22785 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22786 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22787 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22788 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22789 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22790
22791 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22792 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22793 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22794 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22795 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22796 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22797
22798 @smallexample
22799 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22800 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22801
22802 Non-debugging symbols:
22803 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22804 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22805 @end smallexample
22806
22807 @smallexample
22808 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22809 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22810
22811 Non-debugging symbols:
22812 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22813 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22814 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22815 [etc...]
22816 @end smallexample
22817
22818 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22819
22820 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22821 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22822 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22823 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22824 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22825 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22826 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22827
22828 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22829 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22830 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22831 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22832 problem:
22833
22834 @smallexample
22835 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22836 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22837 @end smallexample
22838
22839 @smallexample
22840 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22841 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22842 @end smallexample
22843
22844 And two possible solutions:
22845
22846 @smallexample
22847 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22848 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22849 @end smallexample
22850
22851 @smallexample
22852 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22853 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22854 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22855 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22856 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22857 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22858 @end smallexample
22859
22860 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22861 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22862 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22863 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22864 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22865
22866 @smallexample
22867 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22868 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22869 @end smallexample
22870
22871 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22872 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22873 safe.
22874
22875 @node Hurd Native
22876 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22877 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22878
22879 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22880 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22881
22882 @table @code
22883 @item set signals
22884 @itemx set sigs
22885 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22886 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22887 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22888 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22889 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22890 @code{signals}.
22891
22892 @item show signals
22893 @itemx show sigs
22894 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22895 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22896 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22897
22898 @item set signal-thread
22899 @itemx set sigthread
22900 @kindex set signal-thread
22901 @kindex set sigthread
22902 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22903 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22904 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22905 signal-thread}.
22906
22907 @item show signal-thread
22908 @itemx show sigthread
22909 @kindex show signal-thread
22910 @kindex show sigthread
22911 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22912 delivered a signal.
22913
22914 @item set stopped
22915 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22916 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22917 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22918 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22919
22920 @item show stopped
22921 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22922 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22923 stopped.
22924
22925 @item set exceptions
22926 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22927 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22928 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22929 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22930 trapping on.
22931
22932 @item show exceptions
22933 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22934 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22935
22936 @item set task pause
22937 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22938 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22939 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22940 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22941 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22942 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22943 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22944 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22945 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22946
22947 @item show task pause
22948 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22949 Show the current state of task suspension.
22950
22951 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22952 @cindex task suspend count
22953 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22954 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22955 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22956
22957 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22958 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22959
22960 @item set task exception-port
22961 @itemx set task excp
22962 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22963 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22964 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22965 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22966
22967 @item set noninvasive
22968 @cindex noninvasive task options
22969 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22970 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22971 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22972 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22973
22974 @item info send-rights
22975 @itemx info receive-rights
22976 @itemx info port-rights
22977 @itemx info port-sets
22978 @itemx info dead-names
22979 @itemx info ports
22980 @itemx info psets
22981 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22982 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22983 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22984 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22985 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22986 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22987 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22988 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22989 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22990
22991 @item set thread pause
22992 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22993 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22994 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22995 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22996 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22997 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22998 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22999 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23000 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23001 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23002 only the current thread.
23003
23004 @item show thread pause
23005 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23006 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23007
23008 @item set thread run
23009 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23010
23011 @item show thread run
23012 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23013
23014 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23015 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23016 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23017 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23018 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23019 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23020 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23021
23022 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23023 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23024 detaching.
23025
23026 @item set thread exception-port
23027 @itemx set thread excp
23028 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23029 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23030 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23031
23032 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23033 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23034 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23035 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23036
23037 @item set thread default
23038 @itemx show thread default
23039 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23040 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23041 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23042 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23043 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23044 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23045 the non-default commands.
23046 @end table
23047
23048 @node Darwin
23049 @subsection Darwin
23050 @cindex Darwin
23051
23052 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23053
23054 @table @code
23055 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23056 @kindex set debug darwin
23057 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23058 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23059
23060 @item show debug darwin
23061 @kindex show debug darwin
23062 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23063
23064 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23065 @kindex set debug mach-o
23066 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23067 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23068 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23069 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23070 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23071 usage.
23072
23073 @item show debug mach-o
23074 @kindex show debug mach-o
23075 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23076
23077 @item set mach-exceptions on
23078 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23079 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23080 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23081 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23082 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23083 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23084
23085 @item show mach-exceptions
23086 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23087 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23088 @end table
23089
23090
23091 @node Embedded OS
23092 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23093
23094 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23095 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23096 architectures.
23097
23098 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23099 various real-time operating systems.
23100
23101 @node Embedded Processors
23102 @section Embedded Processors
23103
23104 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23105 configurations.
23106
23107 @cindex send command to simulator
23108 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23109 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23110
23111 @table @code
23112 @item sim @var{command}
23113 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23114 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23115 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23116 acceptable commands.
23117 @end table
23118
23119
23120 @menu
23121 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23122 * ARM:: ARM
23123 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23124 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23125 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23126 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23127 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23128 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23129 * CRIS:: CRIS
23130 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23131 @end menu
23132
23133 @node ARC
23134 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23135 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23136 @cindex ARC specific commands
23137 @cindex ARC600
23138 @cindex ARC700
23139 @cindex ARC EM
23140 @cindex ARC HS
23141
23142 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23143
23144 @table @code
23145 @item set debug arc
23146 @kindex set debug arc
23147 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23148 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23149
23150 @item show debug arc
23151 @kindex show debug arc
23152 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23153
23154 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23155 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23156 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23157
23158 @end table
23159
23160 @node ARM
23161 @subsection ARM
23162
23163 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23164
23165 @table @code
23166 @item set arm disassembler
23167 @kindex set arm
23168 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23169 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23170
23171 @item show arm disassembler
23172 @kindex show arm
23173 Show the current disassembly style.
23174
23175 @item set arm apcs32
23176 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23177 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23178
23179 @item show arm apcs32
23180 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23181
23182 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23183 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23184 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23185
23186 @table @code
23187 @item auto
23188 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23189 @item softfpa
23190 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23191 processors.
23192 @item fpa
23193 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23194 @item softvfp
23195 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23196 @item vfp
23197 VFP co-processor.
23198 @end table
23199
23200 @item show arm fpu
23201 Show the current type of the FPU.
23202
23203 @item set arm abi
23204 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23205
23206 @item show arm abi
23207 Show the currently used ABI.
23208
23209 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23210 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23211 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23212 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23213 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23214 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23215 register).
23216
23217 @item show arm fallback-mode
23218 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23219
23220 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23221 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23222 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23223 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23224 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23225
23226 @item show arm force-mode
23227 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23228
23229 @item set debug arm
23230 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23231 target support subsystem.
23232
23233 @item show debug arm
23234 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23235 @end table
23236
23237 @table @code
23238 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23239 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23240
23241 @table @code
23242 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23243 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23244 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23245 The default value is @code{all}.
23246
23247 @table @code
23248 @item none
23249 @item demon
23250 @item angel
23251 @item redboot
23252 @item all
23253 @end table
23254 @end table
23255 @end table
23256
23257 @node M68K
23258 @subsection M68k
23259
23260 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23261
23262 @node MicroBlaze
23263 @subsection MicroBlaze
23264 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23265 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23266
23267 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23268 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23269 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23270 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23271 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23272 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23273 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23274 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23275 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23276 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23277 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23278
23279 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23280
23281 @table @code
23282 @item target remote :1234
23283 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23284 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23285
23286 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23287 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23288 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23289
23290 @item load
23291 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23292
23293 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23294 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23295
23296 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23297 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23298 @end table
23299
23300 @node MIPS Embedded
23301 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23302
23303 @noindent
23304 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23305
23306 @table @code
23307 @item set mipsfpu double
23308 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23309 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23310 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23311 @itemx show mipsfpu
23312 @kindex set mipsfpu
23313 @kindex show mipsfpu
23314 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23315 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23316 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23317 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23318 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23319 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23320 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23321 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23322 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23323 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23324 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23325 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23326 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23327
23328 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23329 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23330 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23331
23332 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23333 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23334 @end table
23335
23336 @node OpenRISC 1000
23337 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23338 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23339
23340 @noindent
23341 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23342 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23343 FPGA's.
23344
23345 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23346 a target:
23347
23348 @table @code
23349
23350 @kindex target sim
23351 @item target sim
23352
23353 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23354 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23355 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23356 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23357
23358 Example: @code{target sim}
23359
23360 @item set debug or1k
23361 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23362 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23363
23364 @item show debug or1k
23365 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23366 @end table
23367
23368 @node PowerPC Embedded
23369 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23370
23371 @cindex DVC register
23372 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23373 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23374
23375 @smallexample
23376 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23377 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23378 @end smallexample
23379
23380 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23381 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23382 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23383 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23384 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23385 or newer.
23386
23387 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23388 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23389 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23390 watching variables of scalar types.
23391
23392 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23393 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23394
23395 @smallexample
23396 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23397 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23398 @end smallexample
23399
23400 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23401 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23402
23403 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23404 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23405 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23406 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23407 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23408 use the @code{break-range} command.
23409
23410 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23411
23412 @table @code
23413 @kindex break-range
23414 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23415 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23416 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23417 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23418 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23419 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23420 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23421 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23422 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23423
23424 @kindex set powerpc
23425 @item set powerpc soft-float
23426 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23427 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23428 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23429 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23430
23431 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23432 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23433 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23434 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23435 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23436 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23437 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23438 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23439
23440 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23441 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23442 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23443 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23444 address of its first byte.
23445
23446 @end table
23447
23448 @node AVR
23449 @subsection Atmel AVR
23450 @cindex AVR
23451
23452 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23453 following AVR-specific commands:
23454
23455 @table @code
23456 @item info io_registers
23457 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23458 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23459 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23460 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23461 @end table
23462
23463 @node CRIS
23464 @subsection CRIS
23465 @cindex CRIS
23466
23467 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23468 following CRIS-specific commands:
23469
23470 @table @code
23471 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23472 @cindex CRIS version
23473 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23474 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23475 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23476
23477 @item show cris-version
23478 Show the current CRIS version.
23479
23480 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23481 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23482 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23483 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23484 @code{R59}.
23485
23486 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23487 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23488
23489 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23490 @cindex CRIS mode
23491 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23492 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23493 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23494
23495 @item show cris-mode
23496 Show the current CRIS mode.
23497 @end table
23498
23499 @node Super-H
23500 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23501 @cindex Super-H
23502
23503 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23504 commands:
23505
23506 @table @code
23507 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23508 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23509 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23510 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23511 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23512 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23513 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23514 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23515 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23516 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23517 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23518 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23519
23520 @item show sh calling-convention
23521 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23522 Show the current calling convention setting.
23523
23524 @end table
23525
23526
23527 @node Architectures
23528 @section Architectures
23529
23530 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23531 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23532
23533 @menu
23534 * AArch64::
23535 * i386::
23536 * Alpha::
23537 * MIPS::
23538 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23539 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23540 * PowerPC::
23541 * Nios II::
23542 * Sparc64::
23543 @end menu
23544
23545 @node AArch64
23546 @subsection AArch64
23547 @cindex AArch64 support
23548
23549 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23550 following special commands:
23551
23552 @table @code
23553 @item set debug aarch64
23554 @kindex set debug aarch64
23555 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23556 messages are to be displayed.
23557
23558 @item show debug aarch64
23559 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23560
23561 @end table
23562
23563 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23564 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23565
23566 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23567 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23568 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23569 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23570 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23571 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23572
23573 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23574 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23575 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23576 target process.
23577
23578
23579 @node i386
23580 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23581
23582 @table @code
23583 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23584 @kindex set struct-convention
23585 @cindex struct return convention
23586 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23587 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23588 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23589 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23590 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23591 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23592 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23593 be returned in a register.
23594
23595 @item show struct-convention
23596 @kindex show struct-convention
23597 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23598 from functions.
23599 @end table
23600
23601
23602 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23603 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23604
23605 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23606 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23607 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23608 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23609 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23610 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23611 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23612
23613 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23614 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23615 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23616 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23617 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23618 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23619
23620 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23621 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23622 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23623
23624 @smallexample
23625 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23626 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23627 @end smallexample
23628
23629 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23630 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23631 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23632 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23633 the pointer.
23634
23635 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23636 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23637 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23638 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23639 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23640
23641 @table @code
23642 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23643 @kindex show mpx bound
23644 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23645
23646 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23647 @kindex set mpx bound
23648 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23649 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23650 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23651 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23652 @end table
23653
23654 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23655 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23656 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23657 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23658
23659 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23660 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23661 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23662 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23663 function.
23664
23665 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23666 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23667 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23668 continuing the execution. For example:
23669
23670 @smallexample
23671 $ break *upper
23672 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23673 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23674 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23675 $ print $bnd0
23676 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23677 @end smallexample
23678
23679 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23680 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23681 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23682
23683 @node Alpha
23684 @subsection Alpha
23685
23686 See the following section.
23687
23688 @node MIPS
23689 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23690
23691 @cindex stack on Alpha
23692 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23693 @cindex Alpha stack
23694 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23695 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23696 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23697 find the beginning of a function.
23698
23699 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23700 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23701 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23702 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23703 commands:
23704
23705 @table @code
23706 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23707 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23708 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23709 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23710 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23711 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23712 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23713 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23714
23715 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23716 Display the current limit.
23717 @end table
23718
23719 @noindent
23720 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23721 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23722
23723 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23724 programs:
23725
23726 @table @code
23727 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23728 @kindex set mips abi
23729 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23730 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23731 values of @var{arg} are:
23732
23733 @table @samp
23734 @item auto
23735 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23736 default).
23737 @item o32
23738 @item o64
23739 @item n32
23740 @item n64
23741 @item eabi32
23742 @item eabi64
23743 @end table
23744
23745 @item show mips abi
23746 @kindex show mips abi
23747 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23748
23749 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23750 @kindex set mips compression
23751 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23752 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23753 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23754 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23755 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23756 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23757 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23758 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23759 provided by the executable.
23760
23761 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23762 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23763 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23764 identified as such.
23765
23766 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23767 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23768 implicitly from an executable.
23769
23770 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23771 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23772 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23773 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23774 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23775
23776 @item show mips compression
23777 @kindex show mips compression
23778 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23779 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23780
23781 @item set mipsfpu
23782 @itemx show mipsfpu
23783 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23784
23785 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23786 @kindex set mips mask-address
23787 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23788 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23789 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23790 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23791 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23792
23793 @item show mips mask-address
23794 @kindex show mips mask-address
23795 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23796 not.
23797
23798 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23799 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23800 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23801 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23802 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23803 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23804
23805 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23806 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23807 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23808
23809 @item set debug mips
23810 @kindex set debug mips
23811 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23812 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23813
23814 @item show debug mips
23815 @kindex show debug mips
23816 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23817 @end table
23818
23819
23820 @node HPPA
23821 @subsection HPPA
23822 @cindex HPPA support
23823
23824 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23825 following special commands:
23826
23827 @table @code
23828 @item set debug hppa
23829 @kindex set debug hppa
23830 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23831 messages are to be displayed.
23832
23833 @item show debug hppa
23834 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23835
23836 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23837 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23838 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23839 given @var{address}.
23840
23841 @end table
23842
23843
23844 @node SPU
23845 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23846 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23847 @cindex SPU
23848
23849 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23850 it provides the following special commands:
23851
23852 @table @code
23853 @item info spu event
23854 @kindex info spu
23855 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23856 and pending event status.
23857
23858 @item info spu signal
23859 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23860 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23861 notification channels.
23862
23863 @item info spu mailbox
23864 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23865 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23866 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23867
23868 @item info spu dma
23869 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23870 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23871 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23872
23873 @item info spu proxydma
23874 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23875 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23876 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23877
23878 @end table
23879
23880 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23881 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23882 special commands:
23883
23884 @table @code
23885 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23886 @kindex set spu
23887 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23888 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23889 function. The default is @code{off}.
23890
23891 @item show spu stop-on-load
23892 @kindex show spu
23893 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23894
23895 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23896 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23897 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23898 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23899 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23900 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23901
23902 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23903 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23904
23905 @end table
23906
23907 @node PowerPC
23908 @subsection PowerPC
23909 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23910
23911 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23912 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23913 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23914 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23915 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23916
23917 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23918 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23919 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23920
23921 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23922 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23923
23924 @node Nios II
23925 @subsection Nios II
23926 @cindex Nios II architecture
23927
23928 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23929 it provides the following special commands:
23930
23931 @table @code
23932
23933 @item set debug nios2
23934 @kindex set debug nios2
23935 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23936 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23937
23938 @item show debug nios2
23939 @kindex show debug nios2
23940 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23941 @end table
23942
23943 @node Sparc64
23944 @subsection Sparc64
23945 @cindex Sparc64 support
23946 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23947 @subsubsection ADI Support
23948
23949 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23950 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23951 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23952 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23953 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23954 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23955 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23956 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23957 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23958 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23959 signal.
23960
23961 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23962 ADI-enabled.
23963
23964 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23965 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23966
23967
23968 @table @code
23969 @kindex adi examine
23970 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23971
23972 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23973 cacheline.
23974
23975 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23976 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23977 block size, to display.
23978
23979 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23980 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23981
23982 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23983
23984 @smallexample
23985 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23986 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23987 @end smallexample
23988
23989 @kindex adi assign
23990 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23991
23992 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23993 to an address.
23994
23995 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23996 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23997 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23998
23999 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24000 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24001
24002 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24003
24004 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24005 variable "shmaddr":
24006
24007 @smallexample
24008 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24009 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24010 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24011 @end smallexample
24012
24013 @end table
24014
24015 @node Controlling GDB
24016 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24017
24018 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24019 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24020 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24021 described here.
24022
24023 @menu
24024 * Prompt:: Prompt
24025 * Editing:: Command editing
24026 * Command History:: Command history
24027 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24028 * Numbers:: Numbers
24029 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24030 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24031 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24032 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24033 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24034 @end menu
24035
24036 @node Prompt
24037 @section Prompt
24038
24039 @cindex prompt
24040
24041 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24042 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24043 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24044 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24045 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24046 which one you are talking to.
24047
24048 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24049 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24050 or a prompt that does not.
24051
24052 @table @code
24053 @kindex set prompt
24054 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24055 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24056
24057 @kindex show prompt
24058 @item show prompt
24059 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24060 @end table
24061
24062 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24063 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24064 are:
24065
24066 @table @code
24067 @kindex set extended-prompt
24068 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24069 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24070 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24071 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24072 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24073 is displayed.
24074
24075 For example:
24076
24077 @smallexample
24078 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24079 @end smallexample
24080
24081 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24082 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24083
24084 @kindex show extended-prompt
24085 @item show extended-prompt
24086 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24087 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24088 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24089 @end table
24090
24091 @node Editing
24092 @section Command Editing
24093 @cindex readline
24094 @cindex command line editing
24095
24096 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24097 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24098 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24099 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24100 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24101 debugging sessions.
24102
24103 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24104 command @code{set}.
24105
24106 @table @code
24107 @kindex set editing
24108 @cindex editing
24109 @item set editing
24110 @itemx set editing on
24111 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24112
24113 @item set editing off
24114 Disable command line editing.
24115
24116 @kindex show editing
24117 @item show editing
24118 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24119 @end table
24120
24121 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24122 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24123 @end ifset
24124 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24125 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24126 @end ifclear
24127 for more details about the Readline
24128 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24129 encouraged to read that chapter.
24130
24131 @node Command History
24132 @section Command History
24133 @cindex command history
24134
24135 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24136 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24137 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24138 history facility.
24139
24140 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24141 package, to provide the history facility.
24142 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24143 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24144 @end ifset
24145 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24146 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24147 @end ifclear
24148 for the detailed description of the History library.
24149
24150 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24151 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24152 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24153 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24154 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24155 pressed on a line by itself.
24156
24157 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24158 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24159 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24160 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24161
24162 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24163 history.
24164
24165 @table @code
24166 @cindex history substitution
24167 @cindex history file
24168 @kindex set history filename
24169 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24170 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24171 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24172 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24173 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24174 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24175 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24176 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24177 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24178 is not set.
24179
24180 @cindex save command history
24181 @kindex set history save
24182 @item set history save
24183 @itemx set history save on
24184 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24185 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24186
24187 @item set history save off
24188 Stop recording command history in a file.
24189
24190 @cindex history size
24191 @kindex set history size
24192 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24193 @item set history size @var{size}
24194 @itemx set history size unlimited
24195 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24196 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24197 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24198 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24199 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24200 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24201
24202 @cindex remove duplicate history
24203 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24204 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24205 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24206 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24207 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24208 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24209 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24210 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24211 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24212
24213 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24214 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24215
24216 @end table
24217
24218 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24219 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24220 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24221 @end ifset
24222 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24223 @xref{Event Designators},
24224 @end ifclear
24225 for more details.
24226
24227 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24228 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24229 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24230 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24231 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24232 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24233 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24234 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24235
24236 The commands to control history expansion are:
24237
24238 @table @code
24239 @item set history expansion on
24240 @itemx set history expansion
24241 @kindex set history expansion
24242 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24243
24244 @item set history expansion off
24245 Disable history expansion.
24246
24247 @c @group
24248 @kindex show history
24249 @item show history
24250 @itemx show history filename
24251 @itemx show history save
24252 @itemx show history size
24253 @itemx show history expansion
24254 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24255 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24256 @c @end group
24257 @end table
24258
24259 @table @code
24260 @kindex show commands
24261 @cindex show last commands
24262 @cindex display command history
24263 @item show commands
24264 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24265
24266 @item show commands @var{n}
24267 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24268
24269 @item show commands +
24270 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24271 @end table
24272
24273 @node Screen Size
24274 @section Screen Size
24275 @cindex size of screen
24276 @cindex screen size
24277 @cindex pagination
24278 @cindex page size
24279 @cindex pauses in output
24280
24281 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24282 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24283 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24284 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24285 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24286 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24287 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24288 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24289 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24290 following line.
24291
24292 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24293 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24294 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24295 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24296 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24297 width} commands:
24298
24299 @table @code
24300 @kindex set height
24301 @kindex set width
24302 @kindex show width
24303 @kindex show height
24304 @item set height @var{lpp}
24305 @itemx set height unlimited
24306 @itemx show height
24307 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24308 @itemx set width unlimited
24309 @itemx show width
24310 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24311 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24312 commands display the current settings.
24313
24314 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24315 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24316 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24317 buffer.
24318
24319 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24320 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24321
24322 @item set pagination on
24323 @itemx set pagination off
24324 @kindex set pagination
24325 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24326 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24327 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24328 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24329
24330 @item show pagination
24331 @kindex show pagination
24332 Show the current pagination mode.
24333 @end table
24334
24335 @node Numbers
24336 @section Numbers
24337 @cindex number representation
24338 @cindex entering numbers
24339
24340 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24341 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24342 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24343 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24344 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24345 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24346 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24347 both input and output with the commands described below.
24348
24349 @table @code
24350 @kindex set input-radix
24351 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24352 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24353 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24354 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24355 example, any of
24356
24357 @smallexample
24358 set input-radix 012
24359 set input-radix 10.
24360 set input-radix 0xa
24361 @end smallexample
24362
24363 @noindent
24364 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24365 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24366 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24367 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24368 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24369 change the radix.
24370
24371 @kindex set output-radix
24372 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24373 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24374 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24375 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24376
24377 @kindex show input-radix
24378 @item show input-radix
24379 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24380
24381 @kindex show output-radix
24382 @item show output-radix
24383 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24384
24385 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24386 @itemx show radix
24387 @kindex set radix
24388 @kindex show radix
24389 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24390 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24391 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24392 default value of 10.
24393
24394 @end table
24395
24396 @node ABI
24397 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24398
24399 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24400 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24401 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24402 current ABI.
24403
24404 @cindex OS ABI
24405 @kindex set osabi
24406 @kindex show osabi
24407 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24408
24409 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24410 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24411 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24412 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24413 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24414 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24415 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24416 platform provides.
24417
24418 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24419 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24420 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24421 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24422
24423 @table @code
24424 @item show osabi
24425 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24426
24427 @item set osabi
24428 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24429
24430 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24431 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24432 @end table
24433
24434 @cindex float promotion
24435
24436 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24437 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24438 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24439 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24440 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24441 @code{double} and then passed.
24442
24443 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24444 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24445 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24446
24447 @table @code
24448 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24449 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24450 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24451 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24452 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24453
24454 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24455 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24456 functions.
24457
24458 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24459 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24460 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24461 @end table
24462
24463 @kindex set cp-abi
24464 @kindex show cp-abi
24465 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24466 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24467 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24468 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24469 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24470 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24471 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24472 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24473 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24474 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24475 ``auto''.
24476
24477 @table @code
24478 @item show cp-abi
24479 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24480
24481 @item set cp-abi
24482 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24483
24484 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24485 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24486 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24487 @end table
24488
24489 @node Auto-loading
24490 @section Automatically loading associated files
24491 @cindex auto-loading
24492
24493 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24494 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24495 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24496 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24497 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24498 sources).
24499
24500 @menu
24501 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24502 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24503
24504 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24505 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24506 @end menu
24507
24508 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24509 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24510 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24511
24512 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24513 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24514 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24515
24516 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24517 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24518
24519 @table @code
24520 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24521 @kindex set auto-load off
24522 @item set auto-load off
24523 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24524 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24525 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24526 @smallexample
24527 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24528 @end smallexample
24529
24530 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24531 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24532 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24533 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24534 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24535 @code{set auto-load no}.
24536
24537 @anchor{show auto-load}
24538 @kindex show auto-load
24539 @item show auto-load
24540 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24541 or disabled.
24542
24543 @smallexample
24544 (gdb) show auto-load
24545 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24546 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24547 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24548 is on.
24549 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24550 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24551 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24552 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24553 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24554 @end smallexample
24555
24556 @anchor{info auto-load}
24557 @kindex info auto-load
24558 @item info auto-load
24559 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24560 not.
24561
24562 @smallexample
24563 (gdb) info auto-load
24564 gdb-scripts:
24565 Loaded Script
24566 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24567 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24568 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24569 loaded.
24570 python-scripts:
24571 Loaded Script
24572 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24573 @end smallexample
24574 @end table
24575
24576 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24577
24578 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24579 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24580 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24581 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24582 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24583 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24584 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24585 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24586 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24587 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24588 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24589 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24590 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24591 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24592 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24593 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24594 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24595 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24596 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24597 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24598 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24599 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24600 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24601 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24602 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24603 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24604 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24605 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24606 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24607 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24608 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24609 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24610 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24611 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24612 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24613 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24614 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24615 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24616 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24617 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24618 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24619 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24620 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24621 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24622 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24623 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24624 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24625 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24626 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24627 @end multitable
24628
24629 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24630 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24631 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24632
24633 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24634 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24635 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24636
24637 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24638 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24639
24640 @table @code
24641 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24642 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24643 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24644 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24645 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24646
24647 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24648 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24649 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24650 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24651 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24652
24653 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24654 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24655 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24656 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24657 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24658 @end table
24659
24660 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24661 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24662 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24663
24664 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24665
24666 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24667 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24668
24669 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24670 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24671 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24672 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24673 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24674 library.
24675
24676 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24677 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24678
24679 @table @code
24680 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24681 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24682 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24683 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24684
24685 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24686 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24687 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24688 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24689 enabled or disabled.
24690
24691 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24692 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24693 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24694 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24695 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24696 @end table
24697
24698 @node Auto-loading safe path
24699 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24700 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24701
24702 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24703 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24704 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24705 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24706 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24707
24708 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24709 get loaded:
24710
24711 @smallexample
24712 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24713 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24714 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24715 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24716 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24717 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24718 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24719 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24720 @end smallexample
24721
24722 @noindent
24723 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24724 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24725
24726 @smallexample
24727 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24728 @end smallexample
24729
24730 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24731
24732 @table @code
24733 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24734 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24735 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24736 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24737 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24738 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24739 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24740 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24741 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24742 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24743
24744 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24745 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24746 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24747
24748 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24749 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24750 @item show auto-load safe-path
24751 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24752 scripts.
24753
24754 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24755 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24756 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24757 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24758 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24759 by the host platform path separator in use.
24760 @end table
24761
24762 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24763 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24764 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24765 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24766 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24767
24768 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24769 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24770 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24771 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24772 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24773 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24774 init file in the current directory
24775 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24776
24777 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24778 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24779
24780 @table @asis
24781 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24782 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24783 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24784 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24785
24786 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24787 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24788 @value{GDBN} session.
24789
24790 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24791 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24792 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24793 from trusted sources.
24794
24795 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24796 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24797 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24798 trusted sources.
24799 @end table
24800
24801 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24802 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24803
24804 @table @asis
24805 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24806 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24807
24808 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24809 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24810 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24811 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24812 @end table
24813
24814 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24815 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24816 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24817 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24818 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24819 recommended to be entered.
24820
24821 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24822 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24823 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24824
24825 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24826 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24827 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24828 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24829 be printed.
24830
24831 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24832 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24833 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24834
24835 @smallexample
24836 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24837 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24838 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24839 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24840 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24841 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24842 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24843 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24844 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24845 @end smallexample
24846
24847 @table @code
24848 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24849 @kindex set debug auto-load
24850 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24851 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24852
24853 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24854 @kindex show debug auto-load
24855 @item show debug auto-load
24856 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24857 on or off.
24858 @end table
24859
24860 @node Messages/Warnings
24861 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24862
24863 @cindex verbose operation
24864 @cindex optional warnings
24865 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24866 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24867 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24868 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24869
24870 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24871 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24872 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24873
24874 @table @code
24875 @kindex set verbose
24876 @item set verbose on
24877 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24878
24879 @item set verbose off
24880 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24881
24882 @kindex show verbose
24883 @item show verbose
24884 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24885 @end table
24886
24887 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24888 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24889 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24890 Symbol Files}).
24891
24892 @table @code
24893
24894 @kindex set complaints
24895 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24896 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24897 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24898 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24899 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24900
24901 @kindex show complaints
24902 @item show complaints
24903 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24904
24905 @end table
24906
24907 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24908 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24909 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24910 you try to run a program which is already running:
24911
24912 @smallexample
24913 (@value{GDBP}) run
24914 The program being debugged has been started already.
24915 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24916 @end smallexample
24917
24918 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24919 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24920
24921 @table @code
24922
24923 @kindex set confirm
24924 @cindex flinching
24925 @cindex confirmation
24926 @cindex stupid questions
24927 @item set confirm off
24928 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24929 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24930 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24931
24932 @item set confirm on
24933 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24934
24935 @kindex show confirm
24936 @item show confirm
24937 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24938
24939 @end table
24940
24941 @cindex command tracing
24942 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24943 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24944 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24945 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24946
24947 @table @code
24948 @kindex set trace-commands
24949 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24950 @item set trace-commands on
24951 Enable command tracing.
24952 @item set trace-commands off
24953 Disable command tracing.
24954 @item show trace-commands
24955 Display the current state of command tracing.
24956 @end table
24957
24958 @node Debugging Output
24959 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24960 @cindex optional debugging messages
24961
24962 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24963 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24964 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24965 section documents those commands.
24966
24967 @table @code
24968 @kindex set exec-done-display
24969 @item set exec-done-display
24970 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24971 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24972 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24973 @kindex show exec-done-display
24974 @item show exec-done-display
24975 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24976 notification.
24977 @kindex set debug
24978 @cindex ARM AArch64
24979 @item set debug aarch64
24980 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24981 The default is off.
24982 @kindex show debug
24983 @item show debug aarch64
24984 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24985 ARM AArch64.
24986 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24987 @cindex architecture debugging info
24988 @item set debug arch
24989 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24990 @item show debug arch
24991 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24992 @item set debug aix-solib
24993 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24994 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24995 support module. The default is off.
24996 @item show debug aix-thread
24997 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24998 @item set debug aix-thread
24999 @cindex AIX threads
25000 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25001 module.
25002 @item show debug aix-thread
25003 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25004 @item set debug check-physname
25005 @cindex physname
25006 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25007 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25008 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25009 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25010 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25011 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25012 @item show debug check-physname
25013 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25014 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25015 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25016 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25017 exported symbols. The default is off.
25018 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25019 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25020 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25021 @item set debug dwarf-die
25022 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25023 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25024 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25025 A value of zero turns off the display.
25026 @item show debug dwarf-die
25027 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25028 @item set debug dwarf-line
25029 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25030 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25031 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25032 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25033 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25034 @item show debug dwarf-line
25035 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25036 @item set debug dwarf-read
25037 @cindex DWARF Reading
25038 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25039 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25040 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25041 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25042 @item show debug dwarf-read
25043 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25044 @item set debug displaced
25045 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25046 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25047 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25048 @item show debug displaced
25049 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25050 related to displaced stepping.
25051 @item set debug event
25052 @cindex event debugging info
25053 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
25054 default is off.
25055 @item show debug event
25056 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25057 info.
25058 @item set debug expression
25059 @cindex expression debugging info
25060 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25061 expression parsing. The default is off.
25062 @item show debug expression
25063 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25064 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25065 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25066 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25067 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25068 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25069 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25070 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25071 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25072 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25073 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25074 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25075 @item set debug frame
25076 @cindex frame debugging info
25077 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25078 default is off.
25079 @item show debug frame
25080 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25081 info.
25082 @item set debug gnu-nat
25083 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25084 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25085 @item show debug gnu-nat
25086 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25087 @item set debug infrun
25088 @cindex inferior debugging info
25089 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25090 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25091 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25092 @item show debug infrun
25093 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25094 @item set debug jit
25095 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25096 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25097 @item show debug jit
25098 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25099 @item set debug lin-lwp
25100 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25101 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25102 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25103 @item show debug lin-lwp
25104 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25105 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25106 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25107 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25108 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25109 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25110 @item set debug mach-o
25111 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25112 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25113 processing. The default is off.
25114 @item show debug mach-o
25115 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25116 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25117 @item set debug notification
25118 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25119 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25120 The default is off.
25121 @item show debug notification
25122 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25123 @item set debug observer
25124 @cindex observer debugging info
25125 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25126 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25127 @item show debug observer
25128 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25129 @item set debug overload
25130 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25131 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25132 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25133 is off.
25134 @item show debug overload
25135 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25136 debugging info.
25137 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25138 @cindex debug expression parser
25139 @item set debug parser
25140 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25141 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25142 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25143 details. The default is off.
25144 @item show debug parser
25145 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25146 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25147 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25148 @cindex debug remote protocol
25149 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25150 @cindex display remote packets
25151 @item set debug remote
25152 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25153 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25154 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25155 @item show debug remote
25156 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25157
25158 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25159 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25160 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25161 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25162
25163 @item set debug serial
25164 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25165 default is off.
25166 @item show debug serial
25167 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25168 info.
25169 @item set debug solib-frv
25170 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25171 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25172 @item show debug solib-frv
25173 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25174 messages.
25175 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25176 @cindex symbol lookup
25177 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25178 The default is 0 (off).
25179 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25180 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25181 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25182 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25183 @item set debug symfile
25184 @cindex symbol file functions
25185 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25186 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25187 @item show debug symfile
25188 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25189 @item set debug symtab-create
25190 @cindex symbol table creation
25191 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25192 The default is 0 (off).
25193 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25194 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25195 @item show debug symtab-create
25196 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25197 @item set debug target
25198 @cindex target debugging info
25199 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25200 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25201 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25202 value of large memory transfers.
25203 @item show debug target
25204 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25205 info.
25206 @item set debug timestamp
25207 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25208 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25209 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25210 message.
25211 @item show debug timestamp
25212 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25213 debugging info.
25214 @item set debug varobj
25215 @cindex variable object debugging info
25216 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25217 info. The default is off.
25218 @item show debug varobj
25219 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25220 debugging info.
25221 @item set debug xml
25222 @cindex XML parser debugging
25223 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25224 @item show debug xml
25225 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25226 @end table
25227
25228 @node Other Misc Settings
25229 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25230 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25231
25232 @table @code
25233 @kindex set interactive-mode
25234 @item set interactive-mode
25235 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25236 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25237 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25238 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25239 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25240 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25241 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25242 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25243
25244 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25245 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25246 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25247 inside a cygwin window.
25248
25249 @kindex show interactive-mode
25250 @item show interactive-mode
25251 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25252 @end table
25253
25254 @node Extending GDB
25255 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25256 @cindex extending GDB
25257
25258 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25259 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25260 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25261 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25262 being debugged.
25263
25264 @menu
25265 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25266 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25267 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25268 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25269 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25270 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25271 @end menu
25272
25273 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25274 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25275 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25276 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25277 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25278 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25279
25280 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25281 setting:
25282
25283 @table @code
25284 @kindex set script-extension
25285 @kindex show script-extension
25286 @item set script-extension off
25287 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25288
25289 @item set script-extension soft
25290 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25291 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25292 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25293 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25294
25295 @item set script-extension strict
25296 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25297 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25298 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25299
25300 @item show script-extension
25301 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25302
25303 @end table
25304
25305 @node Sequences
25306 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25307
25308 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25309 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25310 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25311 files.
25312
25313 @menu
25314 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25315 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25316 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25317 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25318 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25319 @end menu
25320
25321 @node Define
25322 @subsection User-defined Commands
25323
25324 @cindex user-defined command
25325 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25326 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25327 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25328 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25329 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25330 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25331
25332 @smallexample
25333 define adder
25334 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25335 end
25336 @end smallexample
25337
25338 @noindent
25339 To execute the command use:
25340
25341 @smallexample
25342 adder 1 2 3
25343 @end smallexample
25344
25345 @noindent
25346 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25347 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25348 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25349 functions calls.
25350
25351 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25352 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25353 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25354 been passed.
25355
25356 @smallexample
25357 define adder
25358 if $argc == 2
25359 print $arg0 + $arg1
25360 end
25361 if $argc == 3
25362 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25363 end
25364 end
25365 @end smallexample
25366
25367 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25368 to process a variable number of arguments:
25369
25370 @smallexample
25371 define adder
25372 set $i = 0
25373 set $sum = 0
25374 while $i < $argc
25375 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25376 set $i = $i + 1
25377 end
25378 print $sum
25379 end
25380 @end smallexample
25381
25382 @table @code
25383
25384 @kindex define
25385 @item define @var{commandname}
25386 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25387 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25388 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25389 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25390 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25391 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25392
25393 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25394 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25395 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25396
25397 @kindex document
25398 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25399 @item document @var{commandname}
25400 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25401 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25402 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25403 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25404 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25405 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25406
25407 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25408 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25409 does not change the documentation.
25410
25411 @kindex dont-repeat
25412 @cindex don't repeat command
25413 @item dont-repeat
25414 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25415 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25416 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25417
25418 @kindex help user-defined
25419 @item help user-defined
25420 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25421 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25422 included (if any).
25423
25424 @kindex show user
25425 @item show user
25426 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25427 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25428 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25429 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25430 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25431
25432 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25433 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25434 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25435 @item show max-user-call-depth
25436 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25437 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25438 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25439 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25440 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25441 @end table
25442
25443 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25444 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25445
25446 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25447 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25448 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25449
25450 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25451 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25452 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25453 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25454
25455 @node Hooks
25456 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25457 @cindex command hooks
25458 @cindex hooks, for commands
25459 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25460
25461 @kindex hook
25462 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25463 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25464 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25465 before that command.
25466
25467 @cindex hooks, post-command
25468 @kindex hookpost
25469 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25470 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25471 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25472 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25473 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25474
25475 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25476 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25477
25478 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25479 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25480
25481 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25482 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25483 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25484 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25485 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25486
25487 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25488 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25489 you could define:
25490
25491 @smallexample
25492 define hook-stop
25493 handle SIGALRM nopass
25494 end
25495
25496 define hook-run
25497 handle SIGALRM pass
25498 end
25499
25500 define hook-continue
25501 handle SIGALRM pass
25502 end
25503 @end smallexample
25504
25505 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25506 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25507 you could define:
25508
25509 @smallexample
25510 define hook-echo
25511 echo <<<---
25512 end
25513
25514 define hookpost-echo
25515 echo --->>>\n
25516 end
25517
25518 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25519 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25520 (@value{GDBP})
25521
25522 @end smallexample
25523
25524 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25525 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25526 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25527 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25528 @c or not?
25529 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25530 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25531 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25532
25533 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25534 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25535 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25536
25537 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25538 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25539
25540 @node Command Files
25541 @subsection Command Files
25542
25543 @cindex command files
25544 @cindex scripting commands
25545 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25546 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25547 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25548 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25549 terminal.
25550
25551 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25552 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25553 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25554 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25555 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25556
25557 @table @code
25558 @kindex source
25559 @cindex execute commands from a file
25560 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25561 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25562 @end table
25563
25564 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25565 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25566 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25567 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25568 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25569
25570 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25571 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25572 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25573 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25574 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25575 is not relevant to scripts.
25576
25577 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25578 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25579 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25580 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25581 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25582 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25583 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25584 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25585 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25586 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25587 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25588 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25589 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25590 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25591
25592 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25593 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25594 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25595
25596 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25597 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25598 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25599 when called from command files.
25600
25601 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25602 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25603 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25604 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25605 the next command.
25606
25607 @smallexample
25608 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25609 @end smallexample
25610
25611 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25612 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25613 would be directed to @file{log}.
25614
25615 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25616 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25617 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25618 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25619 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25620 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25621 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25622 conditionally, etc.
25623
25624 @table @code
25625 @kindex if
25626 @kindex else
25627 @item if
25628 @itemx else
25629 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25630 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25631 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25632 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25633 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25634 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25635 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25636
25637 @kindex while
25638 @item while
25639 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25640 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25641 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25642 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25643 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25644 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25645
25646 @kindex loop_break
25647 @item loop_break
25648 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25649 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25650 line.
25651
25652 @kindex loop_continue
25653 @item loop_continue
25654 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25655 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25656 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25657 the controlling expression.
25658
25659 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25660 @item end
25661 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25662 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25663 @end table
25664
25665
25666 @node Output
25667 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25668
25669 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25670 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25671 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25672 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25673 want.
25674
25675 @table @code
25676 @kindex echo
25677 @item echo @var{text}
25678 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25679 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25680 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25681 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25682 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25683 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25684 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25685 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25686 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25687 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25688 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25689
25690 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25691 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25692
25693 @smallexample
25694 echo This is some text\n\
25695 which is continued\n\
25696 onto several lines.\n
25697 @end smallexample
25698
25699 produces the same output as
25700
25701 @smallexample
25702 echo This is some text\n
25703 echo which is continued\n
25704 echo onto several lines.\n
25705 @end smallexample
25706
25707 @kindex output
25708 @item output @var{expression}
25709 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25710 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25711 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25712 on expressions.
25713
25714 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25715 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25716 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25717 Formats}, for more information.
25718
25719 @kindex printf
25720 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25721 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25722 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25723 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25724 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25725 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25726 executing the code below:
25727
25728 @smallexample
25729 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25730 @end smallexample
25731
25732 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25733 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25734 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25735 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25736 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25737 printed.
25738
25739 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25740
25741 @smallexample
25742 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25743 @end smallexample
25744
25745 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25746 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25747 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25748
25749 @itemize @bullet
25750 @item
25751 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25752
25753 @item
25754 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25755 width.
25756
25757 @item
25758 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25759 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25760
25761 @item
25762 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25763 supported.
25764
25765 @item
25766 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25767
25768 @item
25769 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25770 @end itemize
25771
25772 @noindent
25773 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25774 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25775 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25776 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25777
25778 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25779 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25780 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25781 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25782 supported.
25783
25784 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25785 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25786 together with a floating point specifier.
25787 letters:
25788
25789 @itemize @bullet
25790 @item
25791 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25792
25793 @item
25794 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25795
25796 @item
25797 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25798 @end itemize
25799
25800 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25801 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25802 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25803
25804 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25805 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25806
25807 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25808 @smallexample
25809 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25810 @end smallexample
25811
25812 @anchor{eval}
25813 @kindex eval
25814 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25815 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25816 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25817
25818 @end table
25819
25820 @node Auto-loading sequences
25821 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25822 @cindex native script auto-loading
25823
25824 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25825 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25826 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25827 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25828
25829 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25830 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25831
25832 @table @code
25833 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25834 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25835 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25836 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25837
25838 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25839 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25840 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25841 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25842 disabled.
25843
25844 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25845 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25846 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25847 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25848 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25849 auto-loaded.
25850 @end table
25851
25852 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25853 matching names are printed.
25854
25855 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25856 @include python.texi
25857
25858 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25859 @include guile.texi
25860
25861 @node Auto-loading extensions
25862 @section Auto-loading extensions
25863 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25864
25865 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25866 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25867 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25868 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25869 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25870
25871 @menu
25872 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25873 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25874 * Which flavor to choose?::
25875 @end menu
25876
25877 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25878 debugging commands and features.
25879
25880 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25881 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25882 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25883 for more information.
25884 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25885 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25886
25887 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25888 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25889
25890 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25891 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25892 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25893 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25894 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25895
25896 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25897 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25898 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25899 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25900
25901 @table @code
25902 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25903 GDB's own command language
25904 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25905 Python
25906 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25907 Guile
25908 @end table
25909
25910 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25911 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25912 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25913 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25914 script in the specified extension language.
25915
25916 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25917 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25918
25919 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25920 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25921
25922 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25923 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25924 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25925 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25926 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25927 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25928
25929 @table @code
25930 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25931 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25932 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25933 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25934 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25935 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25936
25937 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25938 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25939
25940 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25941 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25942 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25943 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25944
25945 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25946 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25947 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25948 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25949 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25950 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25951 platform.
25952
25953 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25954 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25955 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25956
25957 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25958 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25959 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25960 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25961
25962 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25963 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25964 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25965 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25966 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25967 @end table
25968
25969 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25970 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25971 @var{objfile} is opened.
25972 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25973 is evaluated more than once.
25974
25975 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25976 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25977 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25978
25979 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25980 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25981 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25982 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25983 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25984 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25985 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25986
25987 The following entries are supported:
25988
25989 @table @code
25990 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25991 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25992 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25993 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25994 @end table
25995
25996 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25997
25998 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25999 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26000 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26001 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26002 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26003
26004 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26005 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26006
26007 @example
26008 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26009 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26010 asm("\
26011 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26012 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26013 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26014 .popsection \n\
26015 ");
26016 @end example
26017
26018 @noindent
26019 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26020 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26021
26022 @example
26023 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26024 @end example
26025
26026 The script name may include directories if desired.
26027
26028 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26029 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26030
26031 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26032 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26033 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26034 will remove duplicates.
26035
26036 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26037
26038 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26039 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26040 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26041 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26042 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26043 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26044 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26045 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26046 on its name.
26047
26048 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26049 testsuite.
26050
26051 @example
26052 #include "symcat.h"
26053 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
26054 asm(
26055 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
26056 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26057 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26058 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26059 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26060 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26061 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26062 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26063 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26064 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26065 ".byte 0\n"
26066 ".popsection\n"
26067 );
26068 @end example
26069
26070 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26071 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26072 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26073 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26074
26075 @node Which flavor to choose?
26076 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26077
26078 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26079 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26080
26081 @noindent
26082 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26083
26084 @itemize @bullet
26085 @item
26086 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26087
26088 @item
26089 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26090
26091 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26092 in the source search path.
26093 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26094 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26095
26096 @item
26097 Doesn't require source code additions.
26098 @end itemize
26099
26100 @noindent
26101 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26102
26103 @itemize @bullet
26104 @item
26105 Works with static linking.
26106
26107 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26108 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26109 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26110 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26111 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26112
26113 @item
26114 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26115
26116 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26117 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26118
26119 @item
26120 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26121
26122 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26123 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26124 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26125 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26126 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26127 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26128 @end itemize
26129
26130 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26131 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26132
26133 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26134 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26135 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26136
26137 @subsection Python comes first
26138
26139 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26140 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26141 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26142 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26143 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26144 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26145 pretty-printed form of a value).
26146 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26147 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26148 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26149
26150 @node Aliases
26151 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26152 @cindex aliases for commands
26153
26154 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26155 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26156 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26157 that involves less typing.
26158
26159 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26160 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26161 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26162
26163 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26164 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26165 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26166
26167 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26168
26169 @table @code
26170
26171 @kindex alias
26172 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26173
26174 @end table
26175
26176 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26177 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26178 underscores.
26179
26180 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26181 that is being aliased.
26182
26183 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26184 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26185 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26186
26187 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26188 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26189
26190 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26191 of a command so that there is less to type.
26192 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26193 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26194 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26195 The following will accomplish this.
26196
26197 @smallexample
26198 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26199 @end smallexample
26200
26201 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26202 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26203 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26204 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26205
26206 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26207 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26208 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26209 of a command.
26210
26211 @smallexample
26212 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26213 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26214 (gdb) set p elms 20
26215 (gdb) show p elms
26216 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26217 @end smallexample
26218
26219 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26220 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26221 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26222
26223 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26224 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26225
26226 @smallexample
26227 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26228 @end smallexample
26229
26230 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26231 alias for a more complex command.
26232 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26233
26234 @smallexample
26235 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26236 (gdb) spe 20
26237 @end smallexample
26238
26239 @node Interpreters
26240 @chapter Command Interpreters
26241 @cindex command interpreters
26242
26243 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26244 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26245 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26246
26247 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26248 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26249 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26250 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26251
26252 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26253 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26254 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26255 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26256
26257 @table @code
26258 @item console
26259 @cindex console interpreter
26260 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26261 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26262 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26263
26264 @item mi
26265 @cindex mi interpreter
26266 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26267 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26268 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26269 Interface}.
26270
26271 @item mi2
26272 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26273 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26274
26275 @item mi1
26276 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26277 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26278
26279 @end table
26280
26281 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26282
26283 @kindex interpreter-exec
26284 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26285 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26286 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26287
26288 @smallexample
26289 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26290 @end smallexample
26291
26292 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26293 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26294
26295 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26296 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26297 permanently.
26298
26299 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26300
26301 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26302 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26303 device (usually a tty).
26304
26305 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26306 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26307 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26308 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26309 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26310 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26311 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26312 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26313 the separate MI interpreter.
26314
26315 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26316 @code{new-ui} command:
26317
26318 @kindex new-ui
26319 @cindex new user interface
26320 @smallexample
26321 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26322 @end smallexample
26323
26324 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26325 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26326 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26327 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26328 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26329 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26330
26331 @smallexample
26332 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26333 @end smallexample
26334
26335 @noindent
26336 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26337
26338 @node TUI
26339 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26340 @cindex TUI
26341 @cindex Text User Interface
26342
26343 @menu
26344 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26345 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26346 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26347 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26348 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26349 @end menu
26350
26351 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26352 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26353 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26354 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26355 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26356 is available.
26357
26358 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26359 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26360 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26361 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26362 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26363 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26364
26365 @node TUI Overview
26366 @section TUI Overview
26367
26368 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26369
26370 @table @emph
26371 @item command
26372 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26373 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26374 managed using readline.
26375
26376 @item source
26377 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26378 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26379
26380 @item assembly
26381 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26382
26383 @item register
26384 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26385 when their values change.
26386 @end table
26387
26388 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26389 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26390 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26391 indicates the breakpoint type:
26392
26393 @table @code
26394 @item B
26395 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26396
26397 @item b
26398 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26399
26400 @item H
26401 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26402
26403 @item h
26404 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26405 @end table
26406
26407 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26408
26409 @table @code
26410 @item +
26411 Breakpoint is enabled.
26412
26413 @item -
26414 Breakpoint is disabled.
26415 @end table
26416
26417 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26418 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26419 changes.
26420
26421 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26422 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26423 layouts:
26424
26425 @itemize @bullet
26426 @item
26427 source only,
26428
26429 @item
26430 assembly only,
26431
26432 @item
26433 source and assembly,
26434
26435 @item
26436 source and registers, or
26437
26438 @item
26439 assembly and registers.
26440 @end itemize
26441
26442 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26443
26444 @table @emph
26445 @item target
26446 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26447 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26448
26449 @item process
26450 Gives the current process or thread number.
26451 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26452
26453 @item function
26454 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26455 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26456 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26457 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26458
26459 @item line
26460 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26461 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26462
26463 @item pc
26464 Indicates the current program counter address.
26465 @end table
26466
26467 @node TUI Keys
26468 @section TUI Key Bindings
26469 @cindex TUI key bindings
26470
26471 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26472 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26473 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26474 @end ifset
26475 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26476 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26477 @end ifclear
26478 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26479 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26480
26481 @table @kbd
26482 @kindex C-x C-a
26483 @item C-x C-a
26484 @kindex C-x a
26485 @itemx C-x a
26486 @kindex C-x A
26487 @itemx C-x A
26488 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26489 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26490 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26491 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26492 The screen is then refreshed.
26493
26494 @kindex C-x 1
26495 @item C-x 1
26496 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26497 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26498 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26499
26500 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26501
26502 @kindex C-x 2
26503 @item C-x 2
26504 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26505 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26506 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26507 previous layout and the new one.
26508
26509 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26510
26511 @kindex C-x o
26512 @item C-x o
26513 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26514 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26515 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26516
26517 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26518
26519 @kindex C-x s
26520 @item C-x s
26521 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26522 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26523 @end table
26524
26525 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26526
26527 @table @asis
26528 @kindex PgUp
26529 @item @key{PgUp}
26530 Scroll the active window one page up.
26531
26532 @kindex PgDn
26533 @item @key{PgDn}
26534 Scroll the active window one page down.
26535
26536 @kindex Up
26537 @item @key{Up}
26538 Scroll the active window one line up.
26539
26540 @kindex Down
26541 @item @key{Down}
26542 Scroll the active window one line down.
26543
26544 @kindex Left
26545 @item @key{Left}
26546 Scroll the active window one column left.
26547
26548 @kindex Right
26549 @item @key{Right}
26550 Scroll the active window one column right.
26551
26552 @kindex C-L
26553 @item @kbd{C-L}
26554 Refresh the screen.
26555 @end table
26556
26557 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26558 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26559 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26560 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26561 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26562
26563 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26564 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26565 @cindex TUI single key mode
26566
26567 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26568 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26569 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26570
26571 @table @kbd
26572 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26573 @item c
26574 continue
26575
26576 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26577 @item d
26578 down
26579
26580 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26581 @item f
26582 finish
26583
26584 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26585 @item n
26586 next
26587
26588 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26589 @item o
26590 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26591
26592 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26593 @item q
26594 exit the SingleKey mode.
26595
26596 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26597 @item r
26598 run
26599
26600 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26601 @item s
26602 step
26603
26604 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26605 @item i
26606 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26607
26608 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26609 @item u
26610 up
26611
26612 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26613 @item v
26614 info locals
26615
26616 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26617 @item w
26618 where
26619 @end table
26620
26621 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26622 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26623 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26624 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26625 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26626 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26627
26628
26629 @node TUI Commands
26630 @section TUI-specific Commands
26631 @cindex TUI commands
26632
26633 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26634 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26635 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26636 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26637
26638 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26639 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26640 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26641 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26642 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26643
26644 @table @code
26645 @item tui enable
26646 @kindex tui enable
26647 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26648 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26649 otherwise a default layout is used.
26650
26651 @item tui disable
26652 @kindex tui disable
26653 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26654
26655 @item info win
26656 @kindex info win
26657 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26658
26659 @item layout @var{name}
26660 @kindex layout
26661 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26662 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26663 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26664
26665 @table @code
26666 @item next
26667 Display the next layout.
26668
26669 @item prev
26670 Display the previous layout.
26671
26672 @item src
26673 Display the source and command windows.
26674
26675 @item asm
26676 Display the assembly and command windows.
26677
26678 @item split
26679 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26680
26681 @item regs
26682 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26683 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26684 register, assembler, and command windows.
26685 @end table
26686
26687 @item focus @var{name}
26688 @kindex focus
26689 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26690 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26691
26692 @table @code
26693 @item next
26694 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26695
26696 @item prev
26697 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26698
26699 @item src
26700 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26701
26702 @item asm
26703 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26704
26705 @item regs
26706 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26707
26708 @item cmd
26709 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26710 @end table
26711
26712 @item refresh
26713 @kindex refresh
26714 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26715
26716 @item tui reg @var{group}
26717 @kindex tui reg
26718 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26719 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26720 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26721 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26722 following groups are available on most targets:
26723 @table @code
26724 @item next
26725 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26726 through all of the available register groups.
26727
26728 @item prev
26729 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26730 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26731 @var{next}.
26732
26733 @item general
26734 Display the general registers.
26735 @item float
26736 Display the floating point registers.
26737 @item system
26738 Display the system registers.
26739 @item vector
26740 Display the vector registers.
26741 @item all
26742 Display all registers.
26743 @end table
26744
26745 @item update
26746 @kindex update
26747 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26748
26749 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26750 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26751 @kindex winheight
26752 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26753 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26754 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26755 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26756 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26757
26758 @item tabset @var{nchars}
26759 @kindex tabset
26760 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26761 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26762 assembly windows.
26763 @end table
26764
26765 @node TUI Configuration
26766 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26767 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26768
26769 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26770
26771 @table @code
26772 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26773 @kindex set tui border-kind
26774 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26775 The possible values are the following:
26776 @table @code
26777 @item space
26778 Use a space character to draw the border.
26779
26780 @item ascii
26781 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26782
26783 @item acs
26784 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26785 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26786 @end table
26787
26788 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26789 @kindex set tui border-mode
26790 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26791 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26792 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26793 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26794 @table @code
26795 @item normal
26796 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26797
26798 @item standout
26799 Use standout mode.
26800
26801 @item reverse
26802 Use reverse video mode.
26803
26804 @item half
26805 Use half bright mode.
26806
26807 @item half-standout
26808 Use half bright and standout mode.
26809
26810 @item bold
26811 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26812
26813 @item bold-standout
26814 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26815 @end table
26816 @end table
26817
26818 @node Emacs
26819 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26820
26821 @cindex Emacs
26822 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26823 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26824 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26825 @value{GDBN}.
26826
26827 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26828 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26829 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26830 created Emacs buffer.
26831 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26832
26833 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26834 things:
26835
26836 @itemize @bullet
26837 @item
26838 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26839 the GUD buffer.
26840
26841 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26842 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26843
26844 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26845 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26846 in this way.
26847
26848 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26849 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26850 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26851 stop.
26852
26853 @item
26854 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26855
26856 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26857 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26858 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26859 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26860 and the source.
26861
26862 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26863 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26864 @end itemize
26865
26866 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26867 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26868 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26869 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26870
26871 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26872 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26873 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26874 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26875 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26876 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26877 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26878 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26879 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26880
26881 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26882 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26883 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26884 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26885
26886 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26887 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26888 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26889 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26890 one you want.
26891
26892 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26893 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26894
26895 @table @kbd
26896 @item C-h m
26897 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26898
26899 @item C-c C-s
26900 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26901 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26902
26903 @item C-c C-n
26904 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26905 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26906 to show the current file and location.
26907
26908 @item C-c C-i
26909 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26910 display window accordingly.
26911
26912 @item C-c C-f
26913 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26914 @code{finish} command.
26915
26916 @item C-c C-r
26917 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26918 command.
26919
26920 @item C-c <
26921 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26922 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26923 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26924
26925 @item C-c >
26926 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26927 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26928 @end table
26929
26930 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26931 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26932
26933 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26934 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26935 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26936 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26937 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26938 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26939 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26940
26941 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26942 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26943 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26944 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26945 frame.
26946
26947 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26948 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26949 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26950 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26951 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26952 to correspond properly with the code.
26953
26954 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26955 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26956 Emacs Manual}).
26957
26958 @node GDB/MI
26959 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26960
26961 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26962
26963 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26964 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26965 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26966 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26967 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26968 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26969
26970 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26971 in the form of a reference manual.
26972
26973 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26974 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26975 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26976
26977 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26978
26979 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26980 This chapter uses the following notation:
26981
26982 @itemize @bullet
26983 @item
26984 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26985
26986 @item
26987 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26988 it may or may not be given.
26989
26990 @item
26991 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26992 may repeat zero or more times.
26993
26994 @item
26995 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26996 may repeat one or more times.
26997
26998 @item
26999 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27000 @end itemize
27001
27002 @ignore
27003 @heading Dependencies
27004 @end ignore
27005
27006 @menu
27007 * GDB/MI General Design::
27008 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27009 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27010 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27011 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27012 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27013 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27014 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27015 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27016 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27017 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27018 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27019 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27020 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27021 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27022 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27023 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27024 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27025 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27026 @ignore
27027 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27028 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27029 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27030 @end ignore
27031 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27032 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27033 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27034 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27035 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27036 @end menu
27037
27038 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27039 @node GDB/MI General Design
27040 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27041 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27042
27043 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27044 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27045 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27046 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27047 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27048 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27049 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27050 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27051 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27052 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27053
27054 The important examples of notifications are:
27055 @itemize @bullet
27056
27057 @item
27058 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27059 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27060 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27061 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27062 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27063 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27064 command itself was successfully executed.
27065
27066 @item
27067 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27068 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27069 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27070 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27071 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27072 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27073
27074 @item
27075 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27076 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27077 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27078 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27079 orthogonal frontend design.
27080
27081 @end itemize
27082
27083 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27084 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27085 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27086 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27087 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27088 the user interface.
27089
27090
27091 @menu
27092 * Context management::
27093 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27094 * Thread groups::
27095 @end menu
27096
27097 @node Context management
27098 @subsection Context management
27099
27100 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27101
27102 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27103 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27104 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27105 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27106 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27107 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27108 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27109 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27110 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27111
27112 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27113 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27114 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27115 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27116 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27117 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27118 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27119 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27120 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27121 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27122 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27123
27124 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27125 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27126 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27127 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27128 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27129 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27130 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27131 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27132 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27133 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27134
27135 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27136 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27137 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27138 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27139 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27140 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27141 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27142 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27143 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27144 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27145 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27146 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27147 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27148 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27149 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27150 @samp{--frame} options.
27151
27152 @subsubsection Language
27153
27154 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27155 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27156 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27157 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27158 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27159 For instance:
27160
27161 @smallexample
27162 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27163 ^done,value="4"
27164 (gdb)
27165 @end smallexample
27166
27167 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27168 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27169 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27170
27171 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27172 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27173
27174 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27175 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27176 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27177 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27178 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27179 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27180 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27181 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27182 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27183
27184 @table @code
27185 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27186 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27187 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27188
27189 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27190 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27191 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27192
27193 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27194 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27195 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27196 MI commands even while the target is running.
27197
27198 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27199 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27200 @end table
27201
27202 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27203 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27204 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27205 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27206 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27207 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27208
27209 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27210 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27211 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27212 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27213 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27214 are running.
27215
27216 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27217 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27218 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27219 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27220 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27221 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27222 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27223 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27224 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27225 @samp{--thread} option).
27226
27227 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27228 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27229 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27230 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27231
27232 @node Thread groups
27233 @subsection Thread groups
27234 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27235 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27236 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27237 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27238 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27239
27240 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27241 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27242 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27243 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27244 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27245 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27246 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27247 into processes.
27248
27249 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27250 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27251 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27252 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27253 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27254 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27255 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27256 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27257 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27258 the members of specific thread group.
27259
27260 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27261 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27262 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27263 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27264 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27265 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27266 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27267 after attaching to that thread group.
27268
27269 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27270 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27271 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27272 such thread groups.
27273
27274 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27275 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27276 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27277
27278 @menu
27279 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27280 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27281 @end menu
27282
27283 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27284 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27285
27286 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27287 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27288 @table @code
27289 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27290 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27291
27292 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27293 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27294 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27295
27296 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27297 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27298 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27299
27300 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27301 "any sequence of digits"
27302
27303 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27304 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27305
27306 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27307 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27308
27309 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27310 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27311
27312 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27313 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27314 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27315
27316 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27317 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27318
27319 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27320 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27321 @end table
27322
27323 @noindent
27324 Notes:
27325
27326 @itemize @bullet
27327 @item
27328 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27329 output is described below.
27330
27331 @item
27332 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27333 finishes.
27334
27335 @item
27336 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27337 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27338 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27339 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27340 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27341 @end itemize
27342
27343 Pragmatics:
27344
27345 @itemize @bullet
27346 @item
27347 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27348
27349 @item
27350 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27351 @end itemize
27352
27353 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27354 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27355
27356 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27357 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27358 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27359 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27360 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27361 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27362
27363 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27364 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27365 @var{token}.
27366
27367 @table @code
27368 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27369 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27370
27371 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27372 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27373
27374 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27375 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27376
27377 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27378 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27379
27380 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27381 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27382
27383 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27384 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27385
27386 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27387 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27388
27389 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27390 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27391
27392 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27393 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27394
27395 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27396 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27397 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27398
27399 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27400 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27401
27402 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27403 @code{ @var{string} }
27404
27405 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27406 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27407
27408 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27409 @code{@var{c-string}}
27410
27411 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27412 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27413
27414 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27415 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27416 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27417
27418 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27419 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27420
27421 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27422 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27423
27424 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27425 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27426
27427 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27428 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27429
27430 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27431 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27432
27433 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27434 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27435 @end table
27436
27437 @noindent
27438 Notes:
27439
27440 @itemize @bullet
27441 @item
27442 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27443
27444 @item
27445 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27446 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27447 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27448 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27449 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27450 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27451 prior command.
27452
27453 @item
27454 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27455 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27456 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27457 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27458
27459 @item
27460 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27461 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27462 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27463 @samp{*}.
27464
27465 @item
27466 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27467 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27468 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27469 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27470
27471 @item
27472 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27473 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27474 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27475 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27476
27477 @item
27478 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27479 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27480 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27481
27482 @item
27483 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27484 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27485 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27486 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27487
27488 @item
27489 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27490 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27491 @var{values}.
27492
27493
27494 @end itemize
27495
27496 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27497 details about the various output records.
27498
27499 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27500 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27501 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27502
27503 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27504 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27505
27506 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27507 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27508 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27509 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27510 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27511 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27512
27513 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27514 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27515 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27516
27517 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27518 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27519 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27520 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27521
27522 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27523 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27524
27525 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27526 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27527 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27528 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27529 might change.
27530
27531 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27532 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27533 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27534 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27535
27536 @itemize @bullet
27537 @item
27538 New MI commands may be added.
27539
27540 @item
27541 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27542
27543 @item
27544 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27545 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27546
27547 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27548 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27549
27550 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27551 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27552 @end itemize
27553
27554 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27555 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27556 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27557 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27558 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27559
27560 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27561 @c version?
27562
27563 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27564 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27565 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27566 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27567 @cindex mailing lists
27568
27569 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27570 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27571 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27572
27573 @menu
27574 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27575 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27576 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27577 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27578 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27579 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27580 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27581 @end menu
27582
27583 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27584 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27585
27586 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27587 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27588 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27589 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27590
27591 @table @code
27592 @findex ^done
27593 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27594 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27595 values.
27596
27597 @item "^running"
27598 @findex ^running
27599 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27600 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27601 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27602 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27603 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27604 which threads are resumed.
27605
27606 @item "^connected"
27607 @findex ^connected
27608 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27609
27610 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27611 @findex ^error
27612 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27613 the corresponding error message.
27614
27615 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27616 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27617 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27618
27619 @table @samp
27620 @item "undefined-command"
27621 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27622 @end table
27623
27624 @item "^exit"
27625 @findex ^exit
27626 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27627
27628 @end table
27629
27630 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27631 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27632
27633 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27634 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27635 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27636 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27637 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27638
27639 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27640 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27641 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27642 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27643 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27644
27645 @table @code
27646 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27647 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27648 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27649
27650 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27651 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27652 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27653 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27654
27655 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27656 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27657 internals.
27658 @end table
27659
27660 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27661 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27662
27663 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27664 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27665 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27666 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27667 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27668 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27669
27670 The following is the list of possible async records:
27671
27672 @table @code
27673
27674 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27675 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27676 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27677 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27678 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27679 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27680 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27681 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27682 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27683 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27684 it run freely.
27685
27686 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27687 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27688 following values:
27689
27690 @table @code
27691 @item breakpoint-hit
27692 A breakpoint was reached.
27693 @item watchpoint-trigger
27694 A watchpoint was triggered.
27695 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27696 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27697 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27698 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27699 @item function-finished
27700 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27701 @item location-reached
27702 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27703 @item watchpoint-scope
27704 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27705 @item end-stepping-range
27706 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27707 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27708 @item exited-signalled
27709 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27710 @item exited
27711 The inferior exited.
27712 @item exited-normally
27713 The inferior exited normally.
27714 @item signal-received
27715 A signal was received by the inferior.
27716 @item solib-event
27717 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27718 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27719 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27720 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27721 @item fork
27722 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27723 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27724 @item vfork
27725 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27726 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27727 @item syscall-entry
27728 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27729 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27730 @item syscall-return
27731 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27732 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27733 @item exec
27734 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27735 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27736 @end table
27737
27738 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27739 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27740 Depending on whether all-stop
27741 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27742 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27743 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27744 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27745 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27746 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27747 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27748 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27749 if such information is not available.
27750
27751 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27752 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27753 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27754 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27755 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27756 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27757 cannot be used in any way.
27758
27759 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27760 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27761 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27762 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27763 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27764 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27765
27766 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27767 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27768 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27769 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27770 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27771 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27772
27773 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27774 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27775 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27776 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27777 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27778
27779 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27780 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27781 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27782 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27783 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27784 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27785 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27786 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27787 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27788
27789 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27790 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27791
27792 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27793 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27794 that thread.
27795
27796 @item =library-loaded,...
27797 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27798 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27799 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27800 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27801 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27802 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27803 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27804 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27805 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27806 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27807 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27808 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27809 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27810 to this library.
27811
27812 @item =library-unloaded,...
27813 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27814 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27815 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27816 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27817 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27818 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27819 thread groups.
27820
27821 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27822 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27823 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27824 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27825 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27826
27827 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27828 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27829 initial value @var{initial}.
27830
27831 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27832 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27833 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27834 trace state variables are deleted.
27835
27836 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27837 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27838 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27839 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27840 value of trace state variable is known.
27841
27842 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27843 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27844 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27845 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27846 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27847 user.
27848
27849 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27850 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27851 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27852
27853 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27854 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27855
27856 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27857 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27858 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27859 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27860 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27861
27862 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27863 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27864 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27865 for existing method and format values.
27866
27867 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27868 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27869 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27870 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27871 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27872 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27873
27874 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27875 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27876 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27877 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27878 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27879 executable code.
27880 @end table
27881
27882 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27883 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27884
27885 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27886 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27887 following fields:
27888
27889 @table @code
27890 @item number
27891 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27892 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27893 @samp{1.2}.
27894
27895 @item type
27896 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27897 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27898
27899 @item catch-type
27900 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27901 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27902
27903 @item disp
27904 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27905 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27906 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27907
27908 @item enabled
27909 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27910 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27911 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27912
27913 @item addr
27914 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27915 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27916 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27917 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27918 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27919
27920 @item func
27921 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27922 If not known, this field is not present.
27923
27924 @item filename
27925 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27926 If not known, this field is not present.
27927
27928 @item fullname
27929 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27930 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27931
27932 @item line
27933 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27934 If not known, this field is not present.
27935
27936 @item at
27937 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27938 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27939 by a symbol name.
27940
27941 @item pending
27942 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27943 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27944
27945 @item evaluated-by
27946 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27947 @samp{target}.
27948
27949 @item thread
27950 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27951 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27952
27953 @item task
27954 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27955 field will hold the task identifier.
27956
27957 @item cond
27958 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27959
27960 @item ignore
27961 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27962
27963 @item enable
27964 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27965
27966 @item traceframe-usage
27967 FIXME.
27968
27969 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27970 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27971
27972 @item mask
27973 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27974
27975 @item pass
27976 A tracepoint's pass count.
27977
27978 @item original-location
27979 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27980 This field is optional.
27981
27982 @item times
27983 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27984
27985 @item installed
27986 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27987 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27988 is not.
27989
27990 @item what
27991 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27992
27993 @end table
27994
27995 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27996 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27997
27998 @smallexample
27999 -> -break-insert main
28000 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28001 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28002 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28003 times="0"@}
28004 <- (gdb)
28005 @end smallexample
28006
28007 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
28008 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
28009
28010 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
28011 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
28012 fields:
28013
28014 @table @code
28015 @item level
28016 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
28017 zero. This field is always present.
28018
28019 @item func
28020 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
28021 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
28022
28023 @item addr
28024 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
28025
28026 @item file
28027 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
28028 address. This field may be absent.
28029
28030 @item line
28031 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
28032 may be absent.
28033
28034 @item from
28035 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
28036 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
28037
28038 @end table
28039
28040 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
28041 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
28042
28043 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
28044 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
28045 stated otherwise.
28046
28047 @table @code
28048 @item id
28049 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
28050
28051 @item target-id
28052 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
28053
28054 @item details
28055 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
28056 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28057 frontend. This field is optional.
28058
28059 @item name
28060 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28061 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28062 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28063 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28064 field is omitted.
28065
28066 @item state
28067 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28068 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28069
28070 @item frame
28071 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28072 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28073 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28074
28075 @item core
28076 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28077 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28078 @end table
28079
28080 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28081 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28082
28083 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28084 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28085 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28086 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28087 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28088 the @code{exception-message} field.
28089
28090 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28091 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28092 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28093 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28094
28095 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28096 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28097 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28098 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28099
28100 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28101 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28102
28103 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28104
28105 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28106 information of the breakpoint.
28107
28108 @smallexample
28109 -> -break-insert main
28110 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28111 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28112 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28113 times="0"@}
28114 <- (gdb)
28115 @end smallexample
28116
28117 @subheading Program Execution
28118
28119 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28120 reason that execution stopped.
28121
28122 @smallexample
28123 -> -exec-run
28124 <- ^running
28125 <- (gdb)
28126 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28127 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28128 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28129 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28130 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28131 <- (gdb)
28132 -> -exec-continue
28133 <- ^running
28134 <- (gdb)
28135 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28136 <- (gdb)
28137 @end smallexample
28138
28139 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28140
28141 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28142
28143 @smallexample
28144 -> (gdb)
28145 <- -gdb-exit
28146 <- ^exit
28147 @end smallexample
28148
28149 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28150 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28151 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28152 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28153 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28154 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28155
28156 @subheading A Bad Command
28157
28158 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28159
28160 @smallexample
28161 -> -rubbish
28162 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28163 <- (gdb)
28164 @end smallexample
28165
28166
28167 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28168 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28169 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28170
28171 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28172 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28173
28174 @subheading Motivation
28175
28176 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28177
28178 @subheading Introduction
28179
28180 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28181
28182 @subheading Commands
28183
28184 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28185
28186 @subsubheading Synopsis
28187
28188 @smallexample
28189 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28190 @end smallexample
28191
28192 @subsubheading Result
28193
28194 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28195
28196 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28197
28198 @subsubheading Example
28199
28200 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28201 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28202
28203
28204 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28205 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28206 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28207
28208 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28209 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28210 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28211 breakpoints.
28212
28213 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28214 @findex -break-after
28215
28216 @subsubheading Synopsis
28217
28218 @smallexample
28219 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28220 @end smallexample
28221
28222 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28223 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28224 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28225 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28226
28227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28228
28229 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28230
28231 @subsubheading Example
28232
28233 @smallexample
28234 (gdb)
28235 -break-insert main
28236 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28237 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28238 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28239 times="0"@}
28240 (gdb)
28241 -break-after 1 3
28242 ~
28243 ^done
28244 (gdb)
28245 -break-list
28246 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28247 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28248 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28249 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28250 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28251 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28252 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28253 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28254 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28255 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28256 (gdb)
28257 @end smallexample
28258
28259 @ignore
28260 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28261 @findex -break-catch
28262 @end ignore
28263
28264 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28265 @findex -break-commands
28266
28267 @subsubheading Synopsis
28268
28269 @smallexample
28270 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28271 @end smallexample
28272
28273 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28274 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28275 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28276 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28277 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28278 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28279
28280 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28281
28282 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28283
28284 @subsubheading Example
28285
28286 @smallexample
28287 (gdb)
28288 -break-insert main
28289 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28290 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28291 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28292 times="0"@}
28293 (gdb)
28294 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28295 ^done
28296 (gdb)
28297 @end smallexample
28298
28299 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28300 @findex -break-condition
28301
28302 @subsubheading Synopsis
28303
28304 @smallexample
28305 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28306 @end smallexample
28307
28308 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28309 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28310 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28311 command below).
28312
28313 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28314
28315 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28316
28317 @subsubheading Example
28318
28319 @smallexample
28320 (gdb)
28321 -break-condition 1 1
28322 ^done
28323 (gdb)
28324 -break-list
28325 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28326 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28327 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28328 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28329 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28330 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28331 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28332 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28333 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28334 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28335 (gdb)
28336 @end smallexample
28337
28338 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28339 @findex -break-delete
28340
28341 @subsubheading Synopsis
28342
28343 @smallexample
28344 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28345 @end smallexample
28346
28347 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28348 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28349
28350 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28351
28352 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28353
28354 @subsubheading Example
28355
28356 @smallexample
28357 (gdb)
28358 -break-delete 1
28359 ^done
28360 (gdb)
28361 -break-list
28362 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28363 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28364 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28365 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28366 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28367 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28368 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28369 body=[]@}
28370 (gdb)
28371 @end smallexample
28372
28373 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28374 @findex -break-disable
28375
28376 @subsubheading Synopsis
28377
28378 @smallexample
28379 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28380 @end smallexample
28381
28382 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28383 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28384
28385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28386
28387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28388
28389 @subsubheading Example
28390
28391 @smallexample
28392 (gdb)
28393 -break-disable 2
28394 ^done
28395 (gdb)
28396 -break-list
28397 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28398 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28399 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28400 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28401 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28402 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28403 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28404 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28405 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28406 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28407 (gdb)
28408 @end smallexample
28409
28410 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28411 @findex -break-enable
28412
28413 @subsubheading Synopsis
28414
28415 @smallexample
28416 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28417 @end smallexample
28418
28419 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28420
28421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28422
28423 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28424
28425 @subsubheading Example
28426
28427 @smallexample
28428 (gdb)
28429 -break-enable 2
28430 ^done
28431 (gdb)
28432 -break-list
28433 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28434 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28435 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28436 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28437 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28438 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28439 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28440 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28441 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28442 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28443 (gdb)
28444 @end smallexample
28445
28446 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28447 @findex -break-info
28448
28449 @subsubheading Synopsis
28450
28451 @smallexample
28452 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28453 @end smallexample
28454
28455 @c REDUNDANT???
28456 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28457
28458 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28459 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28460 table.
28461
28462 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28463
28464 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28465
28466 @subsubheading Example
28467 N.A.
28468
28469 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28470 @findex -break-insert
28471 @anchor{-break-insert}
28472
28473 @subsubheading Synopsis
28474
28475 @smallexample
28476 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28477 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28478 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28479 @end smallexample
28480
28481 @noindent
28482 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28483
28484 @table @var
28485 @item linespec location
28486 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28487
28488 @item explicit location
28489 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28490 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28491 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28492
28493 @table @samp
28494 @item --source @var{filename}
28495 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28496 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28497
28498 @item --function @var{function}
28499 The name of a function or method.
28500
28501 @item --label @var{label}
28502 The name of a label.
28503
28504 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28505 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28506 @end table
28507
28508 @item address location
28509 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28510 @end table
28511
28512 @noindent
28513 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28514
28515 @table @samp
28516 @item -t
28517 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28518 @item -h
28519 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28520 @item -f
28521 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28522 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28523 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28524 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28525 cannot be parsed.
28526 @item -d
28527 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28528 @item -a
28529 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28530 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28531 @item -c @var{condition}
28532 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28533 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28534 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28535 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28536 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28537 @var{thread-id}.
28538 @end table
28539
28540 @subsubheading Result
28541
28542 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28543 resulting breakpoint.
28544
28545 Note: this format is open to change.
28546 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28547
28548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28549
28550 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28551 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28552
28553 @subsubheading Example
28554
28555 @smallexample
28556 (gdb)
28557 -break-insert main
28558 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28559 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28560 times="0"@}
28561 (gdb)
28562 -break-insert -t foo
28563 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28564 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28565 times="0"@}
28566 (gdb)
28567 -break-list
28568 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28569 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28570 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28571 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28572 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28573 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28574 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28575 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28576 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28577 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28578 times="0"@},
28579 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28580 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28581 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28582 times="0"@}]@}
28583 (gdb)
28584 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28585 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28586 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28587 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28588 @c times="0"@}
28589 @c (gdb)
28590 @end smallexample
28591
28592 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28593 @findex -dprintf-insert
28594
28595 @subsubheading Synopsis
28596
28597 @smallexample
28598 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28599 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28600 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28601 [ @var{argument} ]
28602 @end smallexample
28603
28604 @noindent
28605 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28606 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28607
28608 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28609
28610 @table @samp
28611 @item -t
28612 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28613 @item -f
28614 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28615 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28616 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28617 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28618 cannot be parsed.
28619 @item -d
28620 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28621 @item -c @var{condition}
28622 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28623 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28624 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28625 to @var{ignore-count}.
28626 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28627 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28628 @var{thread-id}.
28629 @end table
28630
28631 @subsubheading Result
28632
28633 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28634 resulting breakpoint.
28635
28636 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28637
28638 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28639
28640 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28641
28642 @subsubheading Example
28643
28644 @smallexample
28645 (gdb)
28646 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28647 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28648 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28649 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28650 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28651 original-location="foo"@}
28652 (gdb)
28653 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28654 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28655 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28656 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28657 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28658 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28659 (gdb)
28660 @end smallexample
28661
28662 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28663 @findex -break-list
28664
28665 @subsubheading Synopsis
28666
28667 @smallexample
28668 -break-list
28669 @end smallexample
28670
28671 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28672
28673 @table @samp
28674 @item Number
28675 number of the breakpoint
28676 @item Type
28677 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28678 @item Disposition
28679 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28680 or @samp{nokeep}
28681 @item Enabled
28682 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28683 @item Address
28684 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28685 @item What
28686 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28687 name, line number
28688 @item Thread-groups
28689 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28690 @item Times
28691 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28692 @end table
28693
28694 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28695 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28696
28697 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28698
28699 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28700
28701 @subsubheading Example
28702
28703 @smallexample
28704 (gdb)
28705 -break-list
28706 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28707 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28708 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28709 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28710 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28711 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28712 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28713 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28714 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28715 times="0"@},
28716 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28717 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28718 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28719 (gdb)
28720 @end smallexample
28721
28722 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28723
28724 @smallexample
28725 (gdb)
28726 -break-list
28727 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28728 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28729 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28730 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28731 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28732 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28733 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28734 body=[]@}
28735 (gdb)
28736 @end smallexample
28737
28738 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28739 @findex -break-passcount
28740
28741 @subsubheading Synopsis
28742
28743 @smallexample
28744 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28745 @end smallexample
28746
28747 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28748 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28749 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28750 command @samp{passcount}.
28751
28752 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28753 @findex -break-watch
28754
28755 @subsubheading Synopsis
28756
28757 @smallexample
28758 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28759 @end smallexample
28760
28761 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28762 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28763 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28764 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28765 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28766 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28767 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28768 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28769
28770 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28771 breakpoints inserted.
28772
28773 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28774
28775 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28776 @samp{rwatch}.
28777
28778 @subsubheading Example
28779
28780 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28781
28782 @smallexample
28783 (gdb)
28784 -break-watch x
28785 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28786 (gdb)
28787 -exec-continue
28788 ^running
28789 (gdb)
28790 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28791 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28792 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28793 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28794 (gdb)
28795 @end smallexample
28796
28797 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28798 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28799 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28800
28801 @smallexample
28802 (gdb)
28803 -break-watch C
28804 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28805 (gdb)
28806 -exec-continue
28807 ^running
28808 (gdb)
28809 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28810 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28811 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28812 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28813 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28814 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28815 (gdb)
28816 -exec-continue
28817 ^running
28818 (gdb)
28819 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28820 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28821 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28822 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28823 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28824 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28825 (gdb)
28826 @end smallexample
28827
28828 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28829 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28830 deleted.
28831
28832 @smallexample
28833 (gdb)
28834 -break-watch C
28835 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28836 (gdb)
28837 -break-list
28838 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28839 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28840 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28841 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28842 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28843 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28844 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28845 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28846 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28847 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28848 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28849 times="1"@},
28850 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28851 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28852 (gdb)
28853 -exec-continue
28854 ^running
28855 (gdb)
28856 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28857 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28858 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28859 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28860 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28861 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28862 (gdb)
28863 -break-list
28864 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28865 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28866 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28867 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28868 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28869 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28870 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28871 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28872 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28873 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28874 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28875 times="1"@},
28876 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28877 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28878 (gdb)
28879 -exec-continue
28880 ^running
28881 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28882 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28883 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28884 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28885 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28886 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28887 (gdb)
28888 -break-list
28889 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28890 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28891 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28892 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28893 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28894 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28895 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28896 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28897 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28898 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28899 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28900 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28901 (gdb)
28902 @end smallexample
28903
28904
28905 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28906 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28907 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28908
28909 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28910 catchpoints.
28911
28912 @menu
28913 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28914 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28915 @end menu
28916
28917 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28918 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28919
28920 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28921 @findex -catch-load
28922
28923 @subsubheading Synopsis
28924
28925 @smallexample
28926 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28927 @end smallexample
28928
28929 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28930 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28931 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28932 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28933 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28934
28935
28936 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28937
28938 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28939
28940 @subsubheading Example
28941
28942 @smallexample
28943 -catch-load -t foo.so
28944 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28945 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28946 (gdb)
28947 @end smallexample
28948
28949
28950 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28951 @findex -catch-unload
28952
28953 @subsubheading Synopsis
28954
28955 @smallexample
28956 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28957 @end smallexample
28958
28959 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28960 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28961 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28962 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28963 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28964
28965 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28966
28967 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28968
28969 @subsubheading Example
28970
28971 @smallexample
28972 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28973 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28974 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28975 (gdb)
28976 @end smallexample
28977
28978 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28979 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28980
28981 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28982 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28983
28984 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28985 @findex -catch-assert
28986
28987 @subsubheading Synopsis
28988
28989 @smallexample
28990 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28991 @end smallexample
28992
28993 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28994
28995 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28996
28997 @table @samp
28998 @item -c @var{condition}
28999 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29000 @item -d
29001 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29002 @item -t
29003 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29004 @end table
29005
29006 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29007
29008 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
29009
29010 @subsubheading Example
29011
29012 @smallexample
29013 -catch-assert
29014 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29015 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
29016 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
29017 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
29018 (gdb)
29019 @end smallexample
29020
29021 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
29022 @findex -catch-exception
29023
29024 @subsubheading Synopsis
29025
29026 @smallexample
29027 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29028 [ -t ] [ -u ]
29029 @end smallexample
29030
29031 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
29032 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29033 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29034 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29035 catchpoints.
29036
29037 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29038
29039 @table @samp
29040 @item -c @var{condition}
29041 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29042 @item -d
29043 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29044 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29045 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
29046 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
29047 @item -t
29048 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29049 @item -u
29050 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
29051 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
29052 @end table
29053
29054 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29055
29056 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29057 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29058
29059 @subsubheading Example
29060
29061 @smallexample
29062 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29063 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29064 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29065 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29066 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29067 (gdb)
29068 @end smallexample
29069
29070 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29071 @findex -catch-handlers
29072
29073 @subsubheading Synopsis
29074
29075 @smallexample
29076 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29077 [ -t ]
29078 @end smallexample
29079
29080 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29081 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29082 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29083 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29084 catchpoints.
29085
29086 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29087
29088 @table @samp
29089 @item -c @var{condition}
29090 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29091 @item -d
29092 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29093 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29094 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29095 @item -t
29096 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29097 @end table
29098
29099 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29100
29101 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29102
29103 @subsubheading Example
29104
29105 @smallexample
29106 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29107 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29108 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29109 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29110 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29111 (gdb)
29112 @end smallexample
29113
29114 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29115 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29116 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29117
29118 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29119 @findex -exec-arguments
29120
29121
29122 @subsubheading Synopsis
29123
29124 @smallexample
29125 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29126 @end smallexample
29127
29128 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29129 @samp{-exec-run}.
29130
29131 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29132
29133 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29134
29135 @subsubheading Example
29136
29137 @smallexample
29138 (gdb)
29139 -exec-arguments -v word
29140 ^done
29141 (gdb)
29142 @end smallexample
29143
29144
29145 @ignore
29146 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29147 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29148
29149 @subsubheading Synopsis
29150
29151 @smallexample
29152 -exec-show-arguments
29153 @end smallexample
29154
29155 Print the arguments of the program.
29156
29157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29158
29159 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29160
29161 @subsubheading Example
29162 N.A.
29163 @end ignore
29164
29165
29166 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29167 @findex -environment-cd
29168
29169 @subsubheading Synopsis
29170
29171 @smallexample
29172 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29173 @end smallexample
29174
29175 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29176
29177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29178
29179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29180
29181 @subsubheading Example
29182
29183 @smallexample
29184 (gdb)
29185 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29186 ^done
29187 (gdb)
29188 @end smallexample
29189
29190
29191 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29192 @findex -environment-directory
29193
29194 @subsubheading Synopsis
29195
29196 @smallexample
29197 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29198 @end smallexample
29199
29200 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29201 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29202 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29203 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29204 occurs as normal.
29205 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29206 multiple directories in a single command
29207 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29208 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29209 If blanks are needed as
29210 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29211 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29212 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29213 character must not be used
29214 in any directory name.
29215 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29216
29217 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29218
29219 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29220
29221 @subsubheading Example
29222
29223 @smallexample
29224 (gdb)
29225 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29226 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29227 (gdb)
29228 -environment-directory ""
29229 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29230 (gdb)
29231 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29232 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29233 (gdb)
29234 -environment-directory -r
29235 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29236 (gdb)
29237 @end smallexample
29238
29239
29240 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29241 @findex -environment-path
29242
29243 @subsubheading Synopsis
29244
29245 @smallexample
29246 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29247 @end smallexample
29248
29249 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29250 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29251 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29252 supplied in addition to the
29253 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29254 occurs as normal.
29255 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29256 multiple directories in a single command
29257 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29258 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29259 If blanks are needed as
29260 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29261 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29262 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29263 character must not be used
29264 in any directory name.
29265 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29266
29267
29268 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29269
29270 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29271
29272 @subsubheading Example
29273
29274 @smallexample
29275 (gdb)
29276 -environment-path
29277 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29278 (gdb)
29279 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29280 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29281 (gdb)
29282 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29283 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29284 (gdb)
29285 @end smallexample
29286
29287
29288 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29289 @findex -environment-pwd
29290
29291 @subsubheading Synopsis
29292
29293 @smallexample
29294 -environment-pwd
29295 @end smallexample
29296
29297 Show the current working directory.
29298
29299 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29300
29301 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29302
29303 @subsubheading Example
29304
29305 @smallexample
29306 (gdb)
29307 -environment-pwd
29308 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29309 (gdb)
29310 @end smallexample
29311
29312 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29313 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29314 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29315
29316
29317 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29318 @findex -thread-info
29319
29320 @subsubheading Synopsis
29321
29322 @smallexample
29323 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29324 @end smallexample
29325
29326 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29327 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29328 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29329 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29330 current thread.
29331
29332 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29333
29334 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29335 about all threads.
29336
29337 @subsubheading Result
29338
29339 The result contains the following attributes:
29340
29341 @table @samp
29342 @item threads
29343 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29344 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29345
29346 @item current-thread-id
29347 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29348 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29349 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29350 the command.
29351
29352 @end table
29353
29354 @subsubheading Example
29355
29356 @smallexample
29357 -thread-info
29358 ^done,threads=[
29359 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29360 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29361 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29362 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29363 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29364 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29365 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29366 state="running"@}],
29367 current-thread-id="1"
29368 (gdb)
29369 @end smallexample
29370
29371 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29372 @findex -thread-list-ids
29373
29374 @subsubheading Synopsis
29375
29376 @smallexample
29377 -thread-list-ids
29378 @end smallexample
29379
29380 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29381 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29382 threads.
29383
29384 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29385 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29386
29387 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29388
29389 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29390
29391 @subsubheading Example
29392
29393 @smallexample
29394 (gdb)
29395 -thread-list-ids
29396 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29397 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29398 (gdb)
29399 @end smallexample
29400
29401
29402 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29403 @findex -thread-select
29404
29405 @subsubheading Synopsis
29406
29407 @smallexample
29408 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29409 @end smallexample
29410
29411 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29412 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29413 topmost frame for that thread.
29414
29415 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29416 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29417
29418 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29419
29420 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29421
29422 @subsubheading Example
29423
29424 @smallexample
29425 (gdb)
29426 -exec-next
29427 ^running
29428 (gdb)
29429 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29430 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29431 (gdb)
29432 -thread-list-ids
29433 ^done,
29434 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29435 number-of-threads="3"
29436 (gdb)
29437 -thread-select 3
29438 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29439 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29440 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29441 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29442 (gdb)
29443 @end smallexample
29444
29445 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29446 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29447 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29448
29449 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29450 @findex -ada-task-info
29451
29452 @subsubheading Synopsis
29453
29454 @smallexample
29455 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29456 @end smallexample
29457
29458 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29459 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29460
29461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29462
29463 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29464 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29465
29466 @subsubheading Result
29467
29468 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29469 defined for each Ada task:
29470
29471 @table @samp
29472 @item current
29473 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29474
29475 @item id
29476 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29477
29478 @item task-id
29479 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29480
29481 @item thread-id
29482 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29483 task.
29484
29485 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29486 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29487 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29488
29489 @item parent-id
29490 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29491 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29492
29493 @item priority
29494 The base priority of the task.
29495
29496 @item state
29497 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29498 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29499
29500 @item name
29501 The name of the task.
29502
29503 @end table
29504
29505 @subsubheading Example
29506
29507 @smallexample
29508 -ada-task-info
29509 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29510 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29511 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29512 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29513 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29514 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29515 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29516 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29517 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29518 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29519 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29520 (gdb)
29521 @end smallexample
29522
29523 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29524 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29525 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29526
29527 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29528 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29529 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29530 other cases.
29531
29532 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29533 @findex -exec-continue
29534
29535 @subsubheading Synopsis
29536
29537 @smallexample
29538 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29539 @end smallexample
29540
29541 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29542 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29543 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29544 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29545 @itemize @bullet
29546 @item
29547 breakpoints or watchpoints
29548 @item
29549 signals or exceptions
29550 @item
29551 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29552 @item
29553 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29554 @end itemize
29555 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29556 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29557 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29558 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29559 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29560 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29561
29562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29563
29564 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29565
29566 @subsubheading Example
29567
29568 @smallexample
29569 -exec-continue
29570 ^running
29571 (gdb)
29572 @@Hello world
29573 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29574 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29575 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29576 (gdb)
29577 @end smallexample
29578
29579
29580 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29581 @findex -exec-finish
29582
29583 @subsubheading Synopsis
29584
29585 @smallexample
29586 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29587 @end smallexample
29588
29589 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29590 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29591 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29592 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29593 function was called.
29594
29595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29596
29597 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29598
29599 @subsubheading Example
29600
29601 Function returning @code{void}.
29602
29603 @smallexample
29604 -exec-finish
29605 ^running
29606 (gdb)
29607 @@hello from foo
29608 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29609 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29610 (gdb)
29611 @end smallexample
29612
29613 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29614 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29615 value itself.
29616
29617 @smallexample
29618 -exec-finish
29619 ^running
29620 (gdb)
29621 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29622 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29623 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
29624 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29625 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29626 (gdb)
29627 @end smallexample
29628
29629
29630 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29631 @findex -exec-interrupt
29632
29633 @subsubheading Synopsis
29634
29635 @smallexample
29636 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29637 @end smallexample
29638
29639 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29640 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29641 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29642 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29643 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29644
29645 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29646 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29647 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29648 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29649
29650 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29651 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29652 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29653 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29654
29655 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29656
29657 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29658
29659 @subsubheading Example
29660
29661 @smallexample
29662 (gdb)
29663 111-exec-continue
29664 111^running
29665
29666 (gdb)
29667 222-exec-interrupt
29668 222^done
29669 (gdb)
29670 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29671 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29672 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29673 (gdb)
29674
29675 (gdb)
29676 -exec-interrupt
29677 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29678 (gdb)
29679 @end smallexample
29680
29681 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29682 @findex -exec-jump
29683
29684 @subsubheading Synopsis
29685
29686 @smallexample
29687 -exec-jump @var{location}
29688 @end smallexample
29689
29690 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29691 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29692 different forms of @var{location}.
29693
29694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29695
29696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29697
29698 @subsubheading Example
29699
29700 @smallexample
29701 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29702 *running,thread-id="all"
29703 ^running
29704 @end smallexample
29705
29706
29707 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29708 @findex -exec-next
29709
29710 @subsubheading Synopsis
29711
29712 @smallexample
29713 -exec-next [--reverse]
29714 @end smallexample
29715
29716 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29717 of the next source line is reached.
29718
29719 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29720 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29721 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29722 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29723 source line where the function was called.
29724
29725
29726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29727
29728 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29729
29730 @subsubheading Example
29731
29732 @smallexample
29733 -exec-next
29734 ^running
29735 (gdb)
29736 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29737 (gdb)
29738 @end smallexample
29739
29740
29741 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29742 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29743
29744 @subsubheading Synopsis
29745
29746 @smallexample
29747 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29748 @end smallexample
29749
29750 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29751 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29752 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29753 printed as well.
29754
29755 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29756 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29757 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29758 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29759 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29760
29761 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29762
29763 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29764
29765 @subsubheading Example
29766
29767 @smallexample
29768 (gdb)
29769 -exec-next-instruction
29770 ^running
29771
29772 (gdb)
29773 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29774 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29775 (gdb)
29776 @end smallexample
29777
29778
29779 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29780 @findex -exec-return
29781
29782 @subsubheading Synopsis
29783
29784 @smallexample
29785 -exec-return
29786 @end smallexample
29787
29788 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29789 Displays the new current frame.
29790
29791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29792
29793 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29794
29795 @subsubheading Example
29796
29797 @smallexample
29798 (gdb)
29799 200-break-insert callee4
29800 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29801 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29802 (gdb)
29803 000-exec-run
29804 000^running
29805 (gdb)
29806 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29807 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29808 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29809 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29810 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29811 (gdb)
29812 205-break-delete
29813 205^done
29814 (gdb)
29815 111-exec-return
29816 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29817 args=[@{name="strarg",
29818 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29819 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29820 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29821 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29822 (gdb)
29823 @end smallexample
29824
29825
29826 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29827 @findex -exec-run
29828
29829 @subsubheading Synopsis
29830
29831 @smallexample
29832 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29833 @end smallexample
29834
29835 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29836 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29837 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29838 the program has exited exceptionally.
29839
29840 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29841 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29842 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29843 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29844 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29845
29846 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29847 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29848 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29849 (@pxref{Starting}).
29850
29851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29852
29853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29854
29855 @subsubheading Examples
29856
29857 @smallexample
29858 (gdb)
29859 -break-insert main
29860 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29861 (gdb)
29862 -exec-run
29863 ^running
29864 (gdb)
29865 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29866 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29867 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29868 (gdb)
29869 @end smallexample
29870
29871 @noindent
29872 Program exited normally:
29873
29874 @smallexample
29875 (gdb)
29876 -exec-run
29877 ^running
29878 (gdb)
29879 x = 55
29880 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29881 (gdb)
29882 @end smallexample
29883
29884 @noindent
29885 Program exited exceptionally:
29886
29887 @smallexample
29888 (gdb)
29889 -exec-run
29890 ^running
29891 (gdb)
29892 x = 55
29893 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29894 (gdb)
29895 @end smallexample
29896
29897 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29898 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29899
29900 @smallexample
29901 (gdb)
29902 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29903 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29904 @end smallexample
29905
29906
29907 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29908
29909
29910 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29911 @findex -exec-step
29912
29913 @subsubheading Synopsis
29914
29915 @smallexample
29916 -exec-step [--reverse]
29917 @end smallexample
29918
29919 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29920 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29921 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29922 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29923 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29924 previously executed source line.
29925
29926 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29927
29928 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29929
29930 @subsubheading Example
29931
29932 Stepping into a function:
29933
29934 @smallexample
29935 -exec-step
29936 ^running
29937 (gdb)
29938 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29939 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29940 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29941 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29942 (gdb)
29943 @end smallexample
29944
29945 Regular stepping:
29946
29947 @smallexample
29948 -exec-step
29949 ^running
29950 (gdb)
29951 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29952 (gdb)
29953 @end smallexample
29954
29955
29956 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29957 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29958
29959 @subsubheading Synopsis
29960
29961 @smallexample
29962 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29963 @end smallexample
29964
29965 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29966 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29967 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29968 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29969 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29970 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29971 as well.
29972
29973 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29974
29975 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29976
29977 @subsubheading Example
29978
29979 @smallexample
29980 (gdb)
29981 -exec-step-instruction
29982 ^running
29983
29984 (gdb)
29985 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29986 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29987 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29988 (gdb)
29989 -exec-step-instruction
29990 ^running
29991
29992 (gdb)
29993 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29994 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29995 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29996 (gdb)
29997 @end smallexample
29998
29999
30000 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
30001 @findex -exec-until
30002
30003 @subsubheading Synopsis
30004
30005 @smallexample
30006 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
30007 @end smallexample
30008
30009 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
30010 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
30011 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
30012 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
30013
30014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30015
30016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
30017
30018 @subsubheading Example
30019
30020 @smallexample
30021 (gdb)
30022 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
30023 ^running
30024 (gdb)
30025 x = 55
30026 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30027 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
30028 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30029 (gdb)
30030 @end smallexample
30031
30032 @ignore
30033 @subheading -file-clear
30034 Is this going away????
30035 @end ignore
30036
30037 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30038 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
30039 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
30040
30041 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
30042 @findex -enable-frame-filters
30043
30044 @smallexample
30045 -enable-frame-filters
30046 @end smallexample
30047
30048 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
30049 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
30050 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30051 request that this functionality be enabled.
30052
30053 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30054
30055 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30056 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30057
30058 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30059 @findex -stack-info-frame
30060
30061 @subsubheading Synopsis
30062
30063 @smallexample
30064 -stack-info-frame
30065 @end smallexample
30066
30067 Get info on the selected frame.
30068
30069 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30070
30071 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30072 (without arguments).
30073
30074 @subsubheading Example
30075
30076 @smallexample
30077 (gdb)
30078 -stack-info-frame
30079 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30080 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30081 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30082 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30083 (gdb)
30084 @end smallexample
30085
30086 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30087 @findex -stack-info-depth
30088
30089 @subsubheading Synopsis
30090
30091 @smallexample
30092 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30093 @end smallexample
30094
30095 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30096 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30097
30098 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30099
30100 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30101
30102 @subsubheading Example
30103
30104 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30105
30106 @smallexample
30107 (gdb)
30108 -stack-info-depth
30109 ^done,depth="12"
30110 (gdb)
30111 -stack-info-depth 4
30112 ^done,depth="4"
30113 (gdb)
30114 -stack-info-depth 12
30115 ^done,depth="12"
30116 (gdb)
30117 -stack-info-depth 11
30118 ^done,depth="11"
30119 (gdb)
30120 -stack-info-depth 13
30121 ^done,depth="12"
30122 (gdb)
30123 @end smallexample
30124
30125 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30126 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30127 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30128
30129 @subsubheading Synopsis
30130
30131 @smallexample
30132 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30133 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30134 @end smallexample
30135
30136 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30137 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30138 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30139 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30140 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30141 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30142 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30143 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30144
30145 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30146 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30147 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30148 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30149 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30150 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30151
30152 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30153 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30154 are still displayed, however.
30155
30156 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30157 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30158
30159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30160
30161 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30162 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30163 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30164
30165 @subsubheading Example
30166
30167 @smallexample
30168 (gdb)
30169 -stack-list-frames
30170 ^done,
30171 stack=[
30172 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30173 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30174 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30175 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30176 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30177 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30178 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30179 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30180 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30181 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30182 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30183 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30184 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30185 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30186 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30187 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30188 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30189 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30190 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30191 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30192 (gdb)
30193 -stack-list-arguments 0
30194 ^done,
30195 stack-args=[
30196 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30197 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30198 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30199 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30200 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30201 (gdb)
30202 -stack-list-arguments 1
30203 ^done,
30204 stack-args=[
30205 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30206 frame=@{level="1",
30207 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30208 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30209 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30210 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30211 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30212 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30213 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30214 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30215 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30216 (gdb)
30217 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30218 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30219 (gdb)
30220 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30221 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30222 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30223 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30224 (gdb)
30225 @end smallexample
30226
30227 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30228
30229
30230 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30231 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30232 @findex -stack-list-frames
30233
30234 @subsubheading Synopsis
30235
30236 @smallexample
30237 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30238 @end smallexample
30239
30240 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30241 following info:
30242
30243 @table @samp
30244 @item @var{level}
30245 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30246 @item @var{addr}
30247 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30248 @item @var{func}
30249 Function name.
30250 @item @var{file}
30251 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30252 @item @var{fullname}
30253 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30254 @item @var{line}
30255 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30256 @item @var{from}
30257 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30258 if the frame's function is not known.
30259 @item @var{arch}
30260 Frame's architecture.
30261 @end table
30262
30263 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30264 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30265 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30266 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30267 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30268 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30269 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30270 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30271 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30272
30273 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30274
30275 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30276
30277 @subsubheading Example
30278
30279 Full stack backtrace:
30280
30281 @smallexample
30282 (gdb)
30283 -stack-list-frames
30284 ^done,stack=
30285 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30286 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30287 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30288 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30289 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30290 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30291 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30292 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30293 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30294 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30295 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30296 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30297 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30298 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30299 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30300 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30301 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30302 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30303 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30304 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30305 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30306 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30307 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30308 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30309 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30310 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30311 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30312 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30313 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30314 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30315 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30316 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30317 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30318 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30319 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30320 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30321 (gdb)
30322 @end smallexample
30323
30324 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30325
30326 @smallexample
30327 (gdb)
30328 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30329 ^done,stack=
30330 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30331 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30332 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30333 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30334 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30335 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30336 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30337 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30338 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30339 (gdb)
30340 @end smallexample
30341
30342 Show a single frame:
30343
30344 @smallexample
30345 (gdb)
30346 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30347 ^done,stack=
30348 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30349 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30350 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30351 (gdb)
30352 @end smallexample
30353
30354
30355 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30356 @findex -stack-list-locals
30357 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30358
30359 @subsubheading Synopsis
30360
30361 @smallexample
30362 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30363 @end smallexample
30364
30365 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30366 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30367 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30368 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30369 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30370 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30371 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30372 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30373 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30374 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30375
30376 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30377 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30378 variables are still displayed, however.
30379
30380 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30381 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30382
30383 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30384
30385 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30386
30387 @subsubheading Example
30388
30389 @smallexample
30390 (gdb)
30391 -stack-list-locals 0
30392 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30393 (gdb)
30394 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30395 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30396 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30397 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30398 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30399 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30400 (gdb)
30401 @end smallexample
30402
30403 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30404 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30405 @findex -stack-list-variables
30406
30407 @subsubheading Synopsis
30408
30409 @smallexample
30410 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30411 @end smallexample
30412
30413 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30414 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30415 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30416 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30417 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30418 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30419 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30420
30421 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30422 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30423 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30424
30425 @subsubheading Example
30426
30427 @smallexample
30428 (gdb)
30429 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30430 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30431 (gdb)
30432 @end smallexample
30433
30434
30435 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30436 @findex -stack-select-frame
30437
30438 @subsubheading Synopsis
30439
30440 @smallexample
30441 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30442 @end smallexample
30443
30444 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30445 the stack.
30446
30447 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30448 option to every command.
30449
30450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30451
30452 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30453 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30454
30455 @subsubheading Example
30456
30457 @smallexample
30458 (gdb)
30459 -stack-select-frame 2
30460 ^done
30461 (gdb)
30462 @end smallexample
30463
30464 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30465 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30466 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30467
30468 @ignore
30469
30470 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30471
30472 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30473 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30474 used by @code{Insight}.
30475
30476 The two main reasons for that are:
30477
30478 @enumerate 1
30479 @item
30480 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30481
30482 @item
30483 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30484 now).
30485 @end enumerate
30486
30487 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30488 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30489 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30490 hints about their use.
30491
30492 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30493 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30494 least, the following operations:
30495
30496 @itemize @bullet
30497 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30498 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30499 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30500 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30501 @end itemize
30502
30503 @end ignore
30504
30505 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30506
30507 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30508
30509 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30510 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30511 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30512 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30513 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30514 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30515 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30516 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30517 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30518 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30519 object, or to change display format.
30520
30521 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30522 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30523 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30524 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30525 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30526 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30527 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30528 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30529 child will be created.
30530
30531 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30532 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30533 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30534 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30535 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30536
30537 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30538 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30539 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30540 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30541 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30542 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30543 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30544 variables that frontend has created.
30545
30546 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30547 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30548 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30549 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30550 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30551 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30552 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30553 implicitly updated.
30554
30555 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30556 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30557 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30558 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30559 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30560 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30561 frame. Consider this example:
30562
30563 @smallexample
30564 void do_work(...)
30565 @{
30566 struct work_state state;
30567
30568 if (...)
30569 do_work(...);
30570 @}
30571 @end smallexample
30572
30573 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30574 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30575 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30576 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30577 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30578
30579 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30580 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30581 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30582 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30583 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30584 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30585
30586 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30587 access this functionality:
30588
30589 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30590 @item @strong{Operation}
30591 @tab @strong{Description}
30592
30593 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30594 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30595 @item @code{-var-create}
30596 @tab create a variable object
30597 @item @code{-var-delete}
30598 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30599 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30600 @tab set the display format of this variable
30601 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30602 @tab show the display format of this variable
30603 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30604 @tab tells how many children this object has
30605 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30606 @tab return a list of the object's children
30607 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30608 @tab show the type of this variable object
30609 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30610 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30611 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30612 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30613 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30614 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30615 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30616 @tab get the value of this variable
30617 @item @code{-var-assign}
30618 @tab set the value of this variable
30619 @item @code{-var-update}
30620 @tab update the variable and its children
30621 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30622 @tab set frozeness attribute
30623 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30624 @tab set range of children to display on update
30625 @end multitable
30626
30627 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30628 how it can be used.
30629
30630 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30631
30632 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30633 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30634
30635 @smallexample
30636 -enable-pretty-printing
30637 @end smallexample
30638
30639 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30640 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30641 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30642 request that this functionality be enabled.
30643
30644 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30645
30646 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30647 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30648
30649 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30650 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30651
30652 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30653 @findex -var-create
30654
30655 @subsubheading Synopsis
30656
30657 @smallexample
30658 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30659 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30660 @end smallexample
30661
30662 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30663 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30664 register.
30665
30666 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30667 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30668 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30669 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30670 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30671
30672 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30673 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30674 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30675 object must be created.
30676
30677 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30678 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30679
30680 @itemize @bullet
30681 @item
30682 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30683
30684 @item
30685 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30686
30687 @item
30688 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30689 @end itemize
30690
30691 @cindex dynamic varobj
30692 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30693 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30694 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30695 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30696 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30697 compatibility for existing clients.
30698
30699 @subsubheading Result
30700
30701 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30702 are:
30703
30704 @table @samp
30705 @item name
30706 The name of the varobj.
30707
30708 @item numchild
30709 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30710 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30711 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30712
30713 @item value
30714 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30715 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30716 will not be interesting.
30717
30718 @item type
30719 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30720 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30721 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30722 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30723 @emph{declared} one.
30724
30725 @item thread-id
30726 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30727 thread's global identifier.
30728
30729 @item has_more
30730 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30731 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30732
30733 @item dynamic
30734 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30735 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30736 then this attribute will not be present.
30737
30738 @item displayhint
30739 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30740 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30741 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30742 @end table
30743
30744 Typical output will look like this:
30745
30746 @smallexample
30747 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30748 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30749 @end smallexample
30750
30751
30752 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30753 @findex -var-delete
30754
30755 @subsubheading Synopsis
30756
30757 @smallexample
30758 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30759 @end smallexample
30760
30761 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30762 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30763
30764 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30765
30766
30767 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30768 @findex -var-set-format
30769
30770 @subsubheading Synopsis
30771
30772 @smallexample
30773 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30774 @end smallexample
30775
30776 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30777 @var{format-spec}.
30778
30779 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30780 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30781
30782 @smallexample
30783 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30784 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30785 @end smallexample
30786
30787 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30788 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30789 for pointers, etc.).
30790
30791 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30792 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30793 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30794 zero-hexadecimal format.
30795
30796 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30797 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30798
30799 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30800 @findex -var-show-format
30801
30802 @subsubheading Synopsis
30803
30804 @smallexample
30805 -var-show-format @var{name}
30806 @end smallexample
30807
30808 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30809
30810 @smallexample
30811 @var{format} @expansion{}
30812 @var{format-spec}
30813 @end smallexample
30814
30815
30816 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30817 @findex -var-info-num-children
30818
30819 @subsubheading Synopsis
30820
30821 @smallexample
30822 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30823 @end smallexample
30824
30825 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30826
30827 @smallexample
30828 numchild=@var{n}
30829 @end smallexample
30830
30831 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30832 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30833 be available.
30834
30835
30836 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30837 @findex -var-list-children
30838
30839 @subsubheading Synopsis
30840
30841 @smallexample
30842 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30843 @end smallexample
30844 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30845
30846 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30847 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30848 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30849 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30850 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30851 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30852 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30853 and unions.
30854
30855 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30856 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30857 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30858 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30859 reported.
30860
30861 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30862 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30863 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30864 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30865 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30866 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30867 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30868 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30869 the visible items.
30870
30871 For each child the following results are returned:
30872
30873 @table @var
30874
30875 @item name
30876 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30877
30878 @item exp
30879 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30880 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30881
30882 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30883 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30884
30885 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30886 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30887 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30888 type and value are not present.
30889
30890 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30891 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30892 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30893
30894 @item numchild
30895 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30896 0.
30897
30898 @item type
30899 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30900 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30901 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30902 @emph{declared} one.
30903
30904 @item value
30905 If values were requested, this is the value.
30906
30907 @item thread-id
30908 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
30909 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
30910
30911 @item frozen
30912 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30913
30914 @item displayhint
30915 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30916 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30917 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30918
30919 @item dynamic
30920 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30921 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30922 then this attribute will not be present.
30923
30924 @end table
30925
30926 The result may have its own attributes:
30927
30928 @table @samp
30929 @item displayhint
30930 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30931 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30932 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30933
30934 @item has_more
30935 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30936 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30937 @end table
30938
30939 @subsubheading Example
30940
30941 @smallexample
30942 (gdb)
30943 -var-list-children n
30944 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30945 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30946 (gdb)
30947 -var-list-children --all-values n
30948 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30949 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30950 @end smallexample
30951
30952
30953 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
30954 @findex -var-info-type
30955
30956 @subsubheading Synopsis
30957
30958 @smallexample
30959 -var-info-type @var{name}
30960 @end smallexample
30961
30962 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30963 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30964 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30965
30966 @smallexample
30967 type=@var{typename}
30968 @end smallexample
30969
30970
30971 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30972 @findex -var-info-expression
30973
30974 @subsubheading Synopsis
30975
30976 @smallexample
30977 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30978 @end smallexample
30979
30980 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30981 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30982 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30983
30984 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30985 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30986
30987 @smallexample
30988 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30989 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30990 @end smallexample
30991
30992 @noindent
30993 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30994 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30995
30996 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30997 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30998 is of limited use.
30999
31000 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
31001 @findex -var-info-path-expression
31002
31003 @subsubheading Synopsis
31004
31005 @smallexample
31006 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
31007 @end smallexample
31008
31009 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
31010 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
31011 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
31012 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
31013 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
31014 watchpoint from a variable object.
31015
31016 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
31017 and will give an error when invoked on one.
31018
31019 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
31020 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
31021 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
31022 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
31023 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
31024 @smallexample
31025 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
31026 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
31027 @end smallexample
31028
31029 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
31030 @findex -var-show-attributes
31031
31032 @subsubheading Synopsis
31033
31034 @smallexample
31035 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
31036 @end smallexample
31037
31038 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
31039
31040 @smallexample
31041 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
31042 @end smallexample
31043
31044 @noindent
31045 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
31046
31047 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
31048 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
31049
31050 @subsubheading Synopsis
31051
31052 @smallexample
31053 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
31054 @end smallexample
31055
31056 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31057 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31058 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31059 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31060 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31061 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31062 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31063
31064 @smallexample
31065 value=@var{value}
31066 @end smallexample
31067
31068 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31069 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31070
31071 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31072 @findex -var-assign
31073
31074 @subsubheading Synopsis
31075
31076 @smallexample
31077 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31078 @end smallexample
31079
31080 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31081 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31082 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31083 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31084
31085 @subsubheading Example
31086
31087 @smallexample
31088 (gdb)
31089 -var-assign var1 3
31090 ^done,value="3"
31091 (gdb)
31092 -var-update *
31093 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31094 (gdb)
31095 @end smallexample
31096
31097 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31098 @findex -var-update
31099
31100 @subsubheading Synopsis
31101
31102 @smallexample
31103 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31104 @end smallexample
31105
31106 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31107 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31108 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31109 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31110 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31111 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31112 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31113 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31114 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31115 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31116 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31117 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31118 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31119
31120 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31121 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31122 diagnostic.
31123
31124 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31125 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31126
31127 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31128 @samp{changelist}.
31129
31130 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31131
31132 @table @samp
31133 @item name
31134 The name of the varobj.
31135
31136 @item value
31137 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31138 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31139
31140 @item in_scope
31141 @anchor{-var-update}
31142 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31143
31144 @table @code
31145 @item "true"
31146 The variable object's current value is valid.
31147
31148 @item "false"
31149 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31150 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31151 scope.
31152
31153 @item "invalid"
31154 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31155 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31156 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31157 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31158 objects.
31159 @end table
31160
31161 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31162 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31163
31164 @item type_changed
31165 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31166 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31167 be @samp{false}.
31168
31169 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31170 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31171 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31172 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31173 unset.
31174
31175 @item new_type
31176 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31177 hold the new type.
31178
31179 @item new_num_children
31180 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31181 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31182
31183 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31184 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31185 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31186 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31187 children which may be available.
31188
31189 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31190 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31191 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31192 only happen at the end of the update range).
31193
31194 @item displayhint
31195 The display hint, if any.
31196
31197 @item has_more
31198 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31199 available outside the varobj's update range.
31200
31201 @item dynamic
31202 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31203 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31204 then this attribute will not be present.
31205
31206 @item new_children
31207 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31208 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31209 be listed in this attribute.
31210 @end table
31211
31212 @subsubheading Example
31213
31214 @smallexample
31215 (gdb)
31216 -var-assign var1 3
31217 ^done,value="3"
31218 (gdb)
31219 -var-update --all-values var1
31220 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31221 type_changed="false"@}]
31222 (gdb)
31223 @end smallexample
31224
31225 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31226 @findex -var-set-frozen
31227 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31228
31229 @subsubheading Synopsis
31230
31231 @smallexample
31232 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31233 @end smallexample
31234
31235 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31236 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31237 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31238 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31239 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31240 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31241 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31242 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31243 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31244 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31245 @code{-var-update} does.
31246
31247 @subsubheading Example
31248
31249 @smallexample
31250 (gdb)
31251 -var-set-frozen V 1
31252 ^done
31253 (gdb)
31254 @end smallexample
31255
31256 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31257 @findex -var-set-update-range
31258 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31259
31260 @subsubheading Synopsis
31261
31262 @smallexample
31263 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31264 @end smallexample
31265
31266 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31267 @code{-var-update}.
31268
31269 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31270 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31271 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31272 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31273
31274 @subsubheading Example
31275
31276 @smallexample
31277 (gdb)
31278 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31279 ^done
31280 @end smallexample
31281
31282 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31283 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31284 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31285
31286 @subsubheading Synopsis
31287
31288 @smallexample
31289 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31290 @end smallexample
31291
31292 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31293
31294 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31295 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31296
31297 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31298 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31299 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31300 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31301 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31302 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31303 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31304
31305 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31306 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31307 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31308 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31309
31310 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31311 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31312 can be used to check this.
31313
31314 @subsubheading Example
31315
31316 Resetting the visualizer:
31317
31318 @smallexample
31319 (gdb)
31320 -var-set-visualizer V None
31321 ^done
31322 @end smallexample
31323
31324 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31325
31326 @smallexample
31327 (gdb)
31328 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31329 ^done
31330 @end smallexample
31331
31332 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31333 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31334
31335 @smallexample
31336 (gdb)
31337 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31338 ^done
31339 @end smallexample
31340
31341 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31342 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31343 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31344
31345 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31346 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31347 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31348 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31349
31350 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31351 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31352
31353 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31354 @c @subheading -data-assign
31355 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31356 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31357 @c set variable
31358 @c @subsubheading Example
31359 @c N.A.
31360
31361 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31362 @findex -data-disassemble
31363
31364 @subsubheading Synopsis
31365
31366 @smallexample
31367 -data-disassemble
31368 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31369 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31370 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31371 -- @var{mode}
31372 @end smallexample
31373
31374 @noindent
31375 Where:
31376
31377 @table @samp
31378 @item @var{start-addr}
31379 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31380 @item @var{end-addr}
31381 is the end address
31382 @item @var{addr}
31383 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31384 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31385 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31386 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31387 @item @var{filename}
31388 is the name of the file to disassemble
31389 @item @var{linenum}
31390 is the line number to disassemble around
31391 @item @var{lines}
31392 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31393 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31394 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31395 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31396 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31397 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31398 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31399 are displayed.
31400 @item @var{mode}
31401 is one of:
31402 @itemize @bullet
31403 @item 0 disassembly only
31404 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31405 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31406 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31407 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31408 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31409 @end itemize
31410
31411 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31412 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31413 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31414 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31415 @end table
31416
31417 @subsubheading Result
31418
31419 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31420 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31421 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31422
31423 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31424 following fields:
31425
31426 @table @code
31427 @item address
31428 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31429
31430 @item func-name
31431 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31432
31433 @item offset
31434 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31435
31436 @item inst
31437 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31438
31439 @item opcodes
31440 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31441 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31442
31443 @end table
31444
31445 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31446 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31447
31448 @table @code
31449 @item line
31450 The line number within @samp{file}.
31451
31452 @item file
31453 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31454 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31455 used.
31456
31457 @item fullname
31458 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31459 using the source file search path
31460 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31461 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31462
31463 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31464 present in the debug information.
31465
31466 @item line_asm_insn
31467 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31468 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31469 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31470 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31471 @samp{opcodes}.
31472
31473 @end table
31474
31475 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31476 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31477 adjust its format.
31478
31479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31480
31481 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31482
31483 @subsubheading Example
31484
31485 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31486
31487 @smallexample
31488 (gdb)
31489 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31490 ^done,
31491 asm_insns=[
31492 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31493 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31494 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31495 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31496 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31497 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31498 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31499 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31500 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31501 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31502 (gdb)
31503 @end smallexample
31504
31505 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31506 @code{main}.
31507
31508 @smallexample
31509 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31510 ^done,asm_insns=[
31511 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31512 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31513 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31514 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31515 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31516 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31517 [@dots{}]
31518 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31519 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31520 (gdb)
31521 @end smallexample
31522
31523 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31524
31525 @smallexample
31526 (gdb)
31527 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31528 ^done,asm_insns=[
31529 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31530 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31531 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31532 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31533 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31534 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31535 (gdb)
31536 @end smallexample
31537
31538 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31539
31540 @smallexample
31541 (gdb)
31542 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31543 ^done,asm_insns=[
31544 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31545 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31546 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31547 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31548 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31549 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31550 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31551 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31552 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31553 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31554 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31555 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31556 (gdb)
31557 @end smallexample
31558
31559
31560 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31561 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31562
31563 @subsubheading Synopsis
31564
31565 @smallexample
31566 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31567 @end smallexample
31568
31569 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31570 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31571 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31572
31573 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31574
31575 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31576 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31577 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31578
31579 @subsubheading Example
31580
31581 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31582 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31583 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31584 output.
31585
31586 @smallexample
31587 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31588 211^done,value="1"
31589 (gdb)
31590 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31591 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31592 (gdb)
31593 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31594 411^done,value="4"
31595 (gdb)
31596 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31597 511^done,value="4"
31598 (gdb)
31599 @end smallexample
31600
31601
31602 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31603 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31604
31605 @subsubheading Synopsis
31606
31607 @smallexample
31608 -data-list-changed-registers
31609 @end smallexample
31610
31611 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31612
31613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31614
31615 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31616 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31617
31618 @subsubheading Example
31619
31620 On a PPC MBX board:
31621
31622 @smallexample
31623 (gdb)
31624 -exec-continue
31625 ^running
31626
31627 (gdb)
31628 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31629 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31630 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
31631 (gdb)
31632 -data-list-changed-registers
31633 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31634 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31635 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31636 (gdb)
31637 @end smallexample
31638
31639
31640 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31641 @findex -data-list-register-names
31642
31643 @subsubheading Synopsis
31644
31645 @smallexample
31646 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31647 @end smallexample
31648
31649 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31650 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31651 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31652 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31653 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31654 include empty register names.
31655
31656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31657
31658 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31659 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31660 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31661
31662 @subsubheading Example
31663
31664 For the PPC MBX board:
31665 @smallexample
31666 (gdb)
31667 -data-list-register-names
31668 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31669 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31670 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31671 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31672 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31673 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31674 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31675 (gdb)
31676 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31677 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31678 (gdb)
31679 @end smallexample
31680
31681 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31682 @findex -data-list-register-values
31683
31684 @subsubheading Synopsis
31685
31686 @smallexample
31687 -data-list-register-values
31688 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31689 @end smallexample
31690
31691 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31692 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31693 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31694 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31695 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31696 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31697
31698 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31699
31700 @table @code
31701 @item x
31702 Hexadecimal
31703 @item o
31704 Octal
31705 @item t
31706 Binary
31707 @item d
31708 Decimal
31709 @item r
31710 Raw
31711 @item N
31712 Natural
31713 @end table
31714
31715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31716
31717 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31718 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31719
31720 @subsubheading Example
31721
31722 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31723 don't appear in the actual output):
31724
31725 @smallexample
31726 (gdb)
31727 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31728 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31729 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31730 (gdb)
31731 -data-list-register-values x
31732 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31733 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31734 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31735 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31736 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31737 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31738 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31739 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31740 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31741 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31742 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31743 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31744 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31745 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31746 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31747 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31748 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31749 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31750 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31751 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31752 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31753 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31754 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31755 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31756 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31757 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31758 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31759 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31760 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31761 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31762 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31763 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31764 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31765 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31766 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31767 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31768 (gdb)
31769 @end smallexample
31770
31771
31772 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31773 @findex -data-read-memory
31774
31775 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31776
31777 @subsubheading Synopsis
31778
31779 @smallexample
31780 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31781 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31782 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31783 @end smallexample
31784
31785 @noindent
31786 where:
31787
31788 @table @samp
31789 @item @var{address}
31790 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31791 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31792 quoted using the C convention.
31793
31794 @item @var{word-format}
31795 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31796 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31797 ,Output Formats}).
31798
31799 @item @var{word-size}
31800 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31801
31802 @item @var{nr-rows}
31803 The number of rows in the output table.
31804
31805 @item @var{nr-cols}
31806 The number of columns in the output table.
31807
31808 @item @var{aschar}
31809 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31810 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31811 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31812 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31813
31814 @item @var{byte-offset}
31815 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31816 @end table
31817
31818 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31819 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31820 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31821 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31822 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31823 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31824 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31825 @samp{addr}.
31826
31827 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31828 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31829 @samp{prev-page}.
31830
31831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31832
31833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31834 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31835
31836 @subsubheading Example
31837
31838 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31839 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31840 word. Display each word in hex.
31841
31842 @smallexample
31843 (gdb)
31844 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31845 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31846 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31847 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31848 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31849 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31850 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31851 (gdb)
31852 @end smallexample
31853
31854 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31855 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31856
31857 @smallexample
31858 (gdb)
31859 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31860 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31861 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31862 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31863 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31864 (gdb)
31865 @end smallexample
31866
31867 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31868 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31869 used as the non-printable character.
31870
31871 @smallexample
31872 (gdb)
31873 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31874 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31875 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31876 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31877 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31878 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31879 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31880 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31881 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31882 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31883 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31884 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31885 (gdb)
31886 @end smallexample
31887
31888 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31889 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31890
31891 @subsubheading Synopsis
31892
31893 @smallexample
31894 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
31895 @var{address} @var{count}
31896 @end smallexample
31897
31898 @noindent
31899 where:
31900
31901 @table @samp
31902 @item @var{address}
31903 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31904 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31905 quoted using the C convention.
31906
31907 @item @var{count}
31908 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
31909 literal.
31910
31911 @item @var{offset}
31912 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
31913 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
31914 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
31915 arithmetics itself.
31916
31917 @end table
31918
31919 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31920 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31921 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31922 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31923 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31924 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31925
31926 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
31927 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
31928 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31929 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
31930 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31931 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31932 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31933 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31934
31935 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31936 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31937 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31938 and has the following fields:
31939
31940 @table @code
31941 @item begin
31942 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31943
31944 @item end
31945 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31946
31947 @item offset
31948 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31949 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31950
31951 @item contents
31952 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
31953
31954 @end table
31955
31956
31957
31958 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31959
31960 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
31961
31962 @subsubheading Example
31963
31964 @smallexample
31965 (gdb)
31966 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31967 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31968 end="0xbffff15e",
31969 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31970 (gdb)
31971 @end smallexample
31972
31973
31974 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31975 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31976
31977 @subsubheading Synopsis
31978
31979 @smallexample
31980 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31981 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
31982 @end smallexample
31983
31984 @noindent
31985 where:
31986
31987 @table @samp
31988 @item @var{address}
31989 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31990 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31991 be quoted using the C convention.
31992
31993 @item @var{contents}
31994 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31995 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31996
31997 @item @var{count}
31998 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31999 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
32000 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
32001 @var{count} memory units.
32002
32003 @end table
32004
32005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32006
32007 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32008
32009 @subsubheading Example
32010
32011 @smallexample
32012 (gdb)
32013 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
32014 ^done
32015 (gdb)
32016 @end smallexample
32017
32018 @smallexample
32019 (gdb)
32020 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
32021 ^done
32022 (gdb)
32023 @end smallexample
32024
32025 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32026 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
32027 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
32028
32029 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
32030 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
32031
32032 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
32033 @findex -trace-find
32034
32035 @subsubheading Synopsis
32036
32037 @smallexample
32038 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
32039 @end smallexample
32040
32041 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
32042 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
32043 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
32044
32045 @table @samp
32046
32047 @item none
32048 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
32049
32050 @item frame-number
32051 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
32052 that index.
32053
32054 @item tracepoint-number
32055 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
32056 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32057
32058 @item pc
32059 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32060 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32061 address.
32062
32063 @item pc-inside-range
32064 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32065 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32066 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32067
32068 @item pc-outside-range
32069 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32070 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32071 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32072
32073 @item line
32074 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32075 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32076 the specified location.
32077
32078 @end table
32079
32080 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32081 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32082
32083 @table @samp
32084 @item found
32085 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32086 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32087
32088 @item traceframe
32089 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32090 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32091
32092 @item tracepoint
32093 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32094 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32095
32096 @item frame
32097 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32098 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32099 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32100
32101 @end table
32102
32103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32104
32105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32106
32107 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32108 @findex -trace-define-variable
32109
32110 @subsubheading Synopsis
32111
32112 @smallexample
32113 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32114 @end smallexample
32115
32116 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32117 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32118 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32119 with the @samp{$} character.
32120
32121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32122
32123 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32124
32125 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32126 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32127
32128 @subsubheading Synopsis
32129
32130 @smallexample
32131 -trace-frame-collected
32132 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32133 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32134 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32135 [--memory-contents]
32136 @end smallexample
32137
32138 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32139 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32140 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32141 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32142 See the output description table below for more details.
32143
32144 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32145 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32146 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32147 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32148 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32149
32150 For instance, if the actions were
32151 @smallexample
32152 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32153 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32154 @end smallexample
32155
32156 @noindent
32157 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32158 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32159 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32160 objects would be computed expressions.
32161
32162 An example output would be:
32163
32164 @smallexample
32165 (gdb)
32166 -trace-frame-collected
32167 ^done,
32168 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32169 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32170 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32171 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32172 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32173 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32174 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32175 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32176 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32177 ...
32178 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32179 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32180 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32181 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32182 (gdb)
32183 @end smallexample
32184
32185 Where:
32186
32187 @table @code
32188 @item explicit-variables
32189 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32190 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32191 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32192 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32193 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32194 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32195 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32196 arrays, structures and unions.
32197
32198 @item computed-expressions
32199 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32200 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32201 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32202 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32203
32204 @item registers
32205 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32206 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32207 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32208 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32209 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32210
32211 @item tvars
32212 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32213 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32214 current value are returned.
32215
32216 @item memory
32217 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32218 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32219 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32220
32221 @table @code
32222 @item address
32223 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32224
32225 @item length
32226 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32227
32228 @item contents
32229 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32230 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32231
32232 @end table
32233
32234 @end table
32235
32236 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32237
32238 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32239
32240 @subsubheading Example
32241
32242 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32243 @findex -trace-list-variables
32244
32245 @subsubheading Synopsis
32246
32247 @smallexample
32248 -trace-list-variables
32249 @end smallexample
32250
32251 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32252 table has the following fields:
32253
32254 @table @samp
32255 @item name
32256 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32257
32258 @item initial
32259 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32260 field is always present.
32261
32262 @item current
32263 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32264 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32265 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32266 presently running.
32267
32268 @end table
32269
32270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32271
32272 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32273
32274 @subsubheading Example
32275
32276 @smallexample
32277 (gdb)
32278 -trace-list-variables
32279 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32280 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32281 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32282 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32283 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32284 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32285 (gdb)
32286 @end smallexample
32287
32288 @subheading -trace-save
32289 @findex -trace-save
32290
32291 @subsubheading Synopsis
32292
32293 @smallexample
32294 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32295 @end smallexample
32296
32297 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32298 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32299 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32300 to perform the save.
32301
32302 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32303 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32304 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32305
32306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32307
32308 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32309
32310
32311 @subheading -trace-start
32312 @findex -trace-start
32313
32314 @subsubheading Synopsis
32315
32316 @smallexample
32317 -trace-start
32318 @end smallexample
32319
32320 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32321 have any fields.
32322
32323 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32324
32325 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32326
32327 @subheading -trace-status
32328 @findex -trace-status
32329
32330 @subsubheading Synopsis
32331
32332 @smallexample
32333 -trace-status
32334 @end smallexample
32335
32336 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32337 the following fields:
32338
32339 @table @samp
32340
32341 @item supported
32342 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32343 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32344 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32345 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32346 started. This field is always present.
32347
32348 @item running
32349 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32350 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32351 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32352
32353 @item stop-reason
32354 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32355 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32356 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32357 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32358 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32359 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32360 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32361 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32362 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32363
32364 @item stopping-tracepoint
32365 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32366 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32367 @samp{passcount}.
32368
32369 @item frames
32370 @itemx frames-created
32371 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32372 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32373 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32374 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32375
32376 @item buffer-size
32377 @itemx buffer-free
32378 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32379 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32380
32381 @item circular
32382 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32383 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32384 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32385 and may fill up.
32386
32387 @item disconnected
32388 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32389 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32390 that the trace run will stop.
32391
32392 @item trace-file
32393 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32394 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32395
32396 @end table
32397
32398 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32399
32400 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32401
32402 @subheading -trace-stop
32403 @findex -trace-stop
32404
32405 @subsubheading Synopsis
32406
32407 @smallexample
32408 -trace-stop
32409 @end smallexample
32410
32411 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32412 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32413 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32414
32415 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32416
32417 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32418
32419
32420 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32421 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32422 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32423
32424
32425 @ignore
32426 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32427 @findex -symbol-info-address
32428
32429 @subsubheading Synopsis
32430
32431 @smallexample
32432 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32433 @end smallexample
32434
32435 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32436
32437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32438
32439 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32440
32441 @subsubheading Example
32442 N.A.
32443
32444
32445 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32446 @findex -symbol-info-file
32447
32448 @subsubheading Synopsis
32449
32450 @smallexample
32451 -symbol-info-file
32452 @end smallexample
32453
32454 Show the file for the symbol.
32455
32456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32457
32458 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32459 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32460
32461 @subsubheading Example
32462 N.A.
32463
32464
32465 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32466 @findex -symbol-info-function
32467
32468 @subsubheading Synopsis
32469
32470 @smallexample
32471 -symbol-info-function
32472 @end smallexample
32473
32474 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32475
32476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32477
32478 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32479
32480 @subsubheading Example
32481 N.A.
32482
32483
32484 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32485 @findex -symbol-info-line
32486
32487 @subsubheading Synopsis
32488
32489 @smallexample
32490 -symbol-info-line
32491 @end smallexample
32492
32493 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32494
32495 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32496
32497 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32498 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32499
32500 @subsubheading Example
32501 N.A.
32502
32503
32504 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32505 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32506
32507 @subsubheading Synopsis
32508
32509 @smallexample
32510 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32511 @end smallexample
32512
32513 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32514
32515 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32516
32517 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32518
32519 @subsubheading Example
32520 N.A.
32521
32522
32523 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32524 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32525
32526 @subsubheading Synopsis
32527
32528 @smallexample
32529 -symbol-list-functions
32530 @end smallexample
32531
32532 List the functions in the executable.
32533
32534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32535
32536 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32537 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32538
32539 @subsubheading Example
32540 N.A.
32541 @end ignore
32542
32543
32544 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32545 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32546
32547 @subsubheading Synopsis
32548
32549 @smallexample
32550 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32551 @end smallexample
32552
32553 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32554 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32555 ascending PC order.
32556
32557 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32558
32559 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32560
32561 @subsubheading Example
32562 @smallexample
32563 (gdb)
32564 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32565 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32566 (gdb)
32567 @end smallexample
32568
32569
32570 @ignore
32571 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32572 @findex -symbol-list-types
32573
32574 @subsubheading Synopsis
32575
32576 @smallexample
32577 -symbol-list-types
32578 @end smallexample
32579
32580 List all the type names.
32581
32582 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32583
32584 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32585 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32586
32587 @subsubheading Example
32588 N.A.
32589
32590
32591 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32592 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32593
32594 @subsubheading Synopsis
32595
32596 @smallexample
32597 -symbol-list-variables
32598 @end smallexample
32599
32600 List all the global and static variable names.
32601
32602 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32603
32604 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32605
32606 @subsubheading Example
32607 N.A.
32608
32609
32610 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32611 @findex -symbol-locate
32612
32613 @subsubheading Synopsis
32614
32615 @smallexample
32616 -symbol-locate
32617 @end smallexample
32618
32619 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32620
32621 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32622
32623 @subsubheading Example
32624 N.A.
32625
32626
32627 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32628 @findex -symbol-type
32629
32630 @subsubheading Synopsis
32631
32632 @smallexample
32633 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32634 @end smallexample
32635
32636 Show type of @var{variable}.
32637
32638 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32639
32640 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32641 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32642
32643 @subsubheading Example
32644 N.A.
32645 @end ignore
32646
32647
32648 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32649 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32650 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32651
32652 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32653 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32654
32655 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32656 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32657
32658 @subsubheading Synopsis
32659
32660 @smallexample
32661 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32662 @end smallexample
32663
32664 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32665 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32666 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32667 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32668 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32669 notification.
32670
32671 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32672
32673 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32674
32675 @subsubheading Example
32676
32677 @smallexample
32678 (gdb)
32679 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32680 ^done
32681 (gdb)
32682 @end smallexample
32683
32684
32685 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32686 @findex -file-exec-file
32687
32688 @subsubheading Synopsis
32689
32690 @smallexample
32691 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32692 @end smallexample
32693
32694 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32695 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32696 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32697 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32698 notification.
32699
32700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32701
32702 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32703
32704 @subsubheading Example
32705
32706 @smallexample
32707 (gdb)
32708 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32709 ^done
32710 (gdb)
32711 @end smallexample
32712
32713
32714 @ignore
32715 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32716 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32717
32718 @subsubheading Synopsis
32719
32720 @smallexample
32721 -file-list-exec-sections
32722 @end smallexample
32723
32724 List the sections of the current executable file.
32725
32726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32727
32728 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32729 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32730 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32731
32732 @subsubheading Example
32733 N.A.
32734 @end ignore
32735
32736
32737 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32738 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32739
32740 @subsubheading Synopsis
32741
32742 @smallexample
32743 -file-list-exec-source-file
32744 @end smallexample
32745
32746 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32747 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32748 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32749 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32750
32751 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32752
32753 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32754
32755 @subsubheading Example
32756
32757 @smallexample
32758 (gdb)
32759 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32760 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32761 (gdb)
32762 @end smallexample
32763
32764
32765 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32766 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32767
32768 @subsubheading Synopsis
32769
32770 @smallexample
32771 -file-list-exec-source-files
32772 @end smallexample
32773
32774 List the source files for the current executable.
32775
32776 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32777 name) of a source file.
32778
32779 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32780
32781 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32782 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32783
32784 @subsubheading Example
32785 @smallexample
32786 (gdb)
32787 -file-list-exec-source-files
32788 ^done,files=[
32789 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32790 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32791 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32792 (gdb)
32793 @end smallexample
32794
32795 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32796 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32797
32798 @subsubheading Synopsis
32799
32800 @smallexample
32801 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32802 @end smallexample
32803
32804 List the shared libraries in the program.
32805 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32806 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32807
32808 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32809
32810 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32811 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32812 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32813 library. Each range has the following fields:
32814
32815 @table @samp
32816 @item from
32817 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32818 @item to
32819 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32820 @end table
32821
32822 @subsubheading Example
32823 @smallexample
32824 (gdb)
32825 -file-list-exec-source-files
32826 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32827 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32828 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32829 (gdb)
32830 @end smallexample
32831
32832
32833 @ignore
32834 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32835 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32836
32837 @subsubheading Synopsis
32838
32839 @smallexample
32840 -file-list-symbol-files
32841 @end smallexample
32842
32843 List symbol files.
32844
32845 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32846
32847 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32848
32849 @subsubheading Example
32850 N.A.
32851 @end ignore
32852
32853
32854 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32855 @findex -file-symbol-file
32856
32857 @subsubheading Synopsis
32858
32859 @smallexample
32860 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32861 @end smallexample
32862
32863 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32864 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32865 produced, except for a completion notification.
32866
32867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32868
32869 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32870
32871 @subsubheading Example
32872
32873 @smallexample
32874 (gdb)
32875 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32876 ^done
32877 (gdb)
32878 @end smallexample
32879
32880 @ignore
32881 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32882 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32883 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32884
32885 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32886
32887 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32888
32889 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32890
32891 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32892
32893 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32894
32895 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32896
32897 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32898
32899 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32900
32901 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32902 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32903 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32904
32905 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32906
32907 @c @subheading -signal-handle
32908
32909 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
32910
32911 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
32912 @end ignore
32913
32914
32915 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32916 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
32917 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32918
32919
32920 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32921 @findex -target-attach
32922
32923 @subsubheading Synopsis
32924
32925 @smallexample
32926 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32927 @end smallexample
32928
32929 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32930 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32931 group, the id previously returned by
32932 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32933
32934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32935
32936 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32937
32938 @subsubheading Example
32939 @smallexample
32940 (gdb)
32941 -target-attach 34
32942 =thread-created,id="1"
32943 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32944 ^done
32945 (gdb)
32946 @end smallexample
32947
32948 @ignore
32949 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32950 @findex -target-compare-sections
32951
32952 @subsubheading Synopsis
32953
32954 @smallexample
32955 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
32956 @end smallexample
32957
32958 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
32959 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
32960
32961 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32962
32963 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
32964
32965 @subsubheading Example
32966 N.A.
32967 @end ignore
32968
32969
32970 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32971 @findex -target-detach
32972
32973 @subsubheading Synopsis
32974
32975 @smallexample
32976 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32977 @end smallexample
32978
32979 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32980 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32981 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32982
32983 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32984
32985 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32986
32987 @subsubheading Example
32988
32989 @smallexample
32990 (gdb)
32991 -target-detach
32992 ^done
32993 (gdb)
32994 @end smallexample
32995
32996
32997 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32998 @findex -target-disconnect
32999
33000 @subsubheading Synopsis
33001
33002 @smallexample
33003 -target-disconnect
33004 @end smallexample
33005
33006 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33007 generally not resumed.
33008
33009 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33010
33011 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33012
33013 @subsubheading Example
33014
33015 @smallexample
33016 (gdb)
33017 -target-disconnect
33018 ^done
33019 (gdb)
33020 @end smallexample
33021
33022
33023 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33024 @findex -target-download
33025
33026 @subsubheading Synopsis
33027
33028 @smallexample
33029 -target-download
33030 @end smallexample
33031
33032 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33033 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33034
33035 @table @samp
33036 @item section
33037 The name of the section.
33038 @item section-sent
33039 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33040 @item section-size
33041 The size of the section.
33042 @item total-sent
33043 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33044 @item total-size
33045 The size of the overall executable to download.
33046 @end table
33047
33048 @noindent
33049 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33050 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33051
33052 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33053 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33054
33055 @table @samp
33056 @item section
33057 The name of the section.
33058 @item section-size
33059 The size of the section.
33060 @item total-size
33061 The size of the overall executable to download.
33062 @end table
33063
33064 @noindent
33065 At the end, a summary is printed.
33066
33067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33068
33069 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33070
33071 @subsubheading Example
33072
33073 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33074 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33075
33076 @smallexample
33077 (gdb)
33078 -target-download
33079 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33080 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33081 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33082 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33083 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33084 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33085 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33086 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33087 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33088 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33089 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33090 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33091 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33092 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33093 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33094 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33095 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33096 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33097 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33098 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33099 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33100 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33101 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33102 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33103 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33104 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33105 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33106 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33107 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33108 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33109 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33110 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33111 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33112 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33113 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33114 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33115 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33116 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33117 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33118 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33119 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33120 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33121 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33122 write-rate="429"
33123 (gdb)
33124 @end smallexample
33125
33126
33127 @ignore
33128 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33129 @findex -target-exec-status
33130
33131 @subsubheading Synopsis
33132
33133 @smallexample
33134 -target-exec-status
33135 @end smallexample
33136
33137 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33138 not, for instance).
33139
33140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33141
33142 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33143
33144 @subsubheading Example
33145 N.A.
33146
33147
33148 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33149 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33150
33151 @subsubheading Synopsis
33152
33153 @smallexample
33154 -target-list-available-targets
33155 @end smallexample
33156
33157 List the possible targets to connect to.
33158
33159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33160
33161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33162
33163 @subsubheading Example
33164 N.A.
33165
33166
33167 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33168 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33169
33170 @subsubheading Synopsis
33171
33172 @smallexample
33173 -target-list-current-targets
33174 @end smallexample
33175
33176 Describe the current target.
33177
33178 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33179
33180 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33181 other things).
33182
33183 @subsubheading Example
33184 N.A.
33185
33186
33187 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33188 @findex -target-list-parameters
33189
33190 @subsubheading Synopsis
33191
33192 @smallexample
33193 -target-list-parameters
33194 @end smallexample
33195
33196 @c ????
33197 @end ignore
33198
33199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33200
33201 No equivalent.
33202
33203 @subsubheading Example
33204 N.A.
33205
33206 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33207 @findex -target-flash-erase
33208
33209 @subsubheading Synopsis
33210
33211 @smallexample
33212 -target-flash-erase
33213 @end smallexample
33214
33215 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33216
33217 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33218
33219 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33220 addresses and memory region sizes.
33221
33222 @smallexample
33223 (gdb)
33224 -target-flash-erase
33225 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33226 (gdb)
33227 @end smallexample
33228
33229 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33230 @findex -target-select
33231
33232 @subsubheading Synopsis
33233
33234 @smallexample
33235 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33236 @end smallexample
33237
33238 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33239
33240 @table @samp
33241 @item @var{type}
33242 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33243 @item @var{parameters}
33244 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33245 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33246 @end table
33247
33248 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33249 which the target program is, in the following form:
33250
33251 @smallexample
33252 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33253 args=[@var{arg list}]
33254 @end smallexample
33255
33256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33257
33258 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33259
33260 @subsubheading Example
33261
33262 @smallexample
33263 (gdb)
33264 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33265 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33266 (gdb)
33267 @end smallexample
33268
33269 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33270 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33271 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33272
33273
33274 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33275 @findex -target-file-put
33276
33277 @subsubheading Synopsis
33278
33279 @smallexample
33280 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33281 @end smallexample
33282
33283 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33284 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33285
33286 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33287
33288 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33289
33290 @subsubheading Example
33291
33292 @smallexample
33293 (gdb)
33294 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33295 ^done
33296 (gdb)
33297 @end smallexample
33298
33299
33300 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33301 @findex -target-file-get
33302
33303 @subsubheading Synopsis
33304
33305 @smallexample
33306 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33307 @end smallexample
33308
33309 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33310 on the host system.
33311
33312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33313
33314 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33315
33316 @subsubheading Example
33317
33318 @smallexample
33319 (gdb)
33320 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33321 ^done
33322 (gdb)
33323 @end smallexample
33324
33325
33326 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33327 @findex -target-file-delete
33328
33329 @subsubheading Synopsis
33330
33331 @smallexample
33332 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33333 @end smallexample
33334
33335 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33336
33337 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33338
33339 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33340
33341 @subsubheading Example
33342
33343 @smallexample
33344 (gdb)
33345 -target-file-delete remotefile
33346 ^done
33347 (gdb)
33348 @end smallexample
33349
33350
33351 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33352 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33353 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33354
33355 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33356 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33357
33358 @subsubheading Synopsis
33359
33360 @smallexample
33361 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33362 @end smallexample
33363
33364 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33365 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33366 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33367
33368 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33369
33370 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33371
33372 @subsubheading Result
33373
33374 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33375 defined for each exception:
33376
33377 @table @samp
33378 @item name
33379 The name of the exception.
33380
33381 @item address
33382 The address of the exception.
33383
33384 @end table
33385
33386 @subsubheading Example
33387
33388 @smallexample
33389 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33390 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33391 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33392 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33393 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33394 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33395 @end smallexample
33396
33397 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33398
33399 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33400 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33401 Catchpoint Commands}.
33402
33403
33404 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33405 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33406 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33407
33408 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33409 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33410 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33411 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33412
33413 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33414 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33415 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33416
33417 @subsubheading Synopsis
33418
33419 @smallexample
33420 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33421 @end smallexample
33422
33423 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33424
33425 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33426 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33427 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33428 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33429 dash.
33430
33431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33432
33433 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33434
33435 @subsubheading Result
33436
33437 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33438
33439 @table @samp
33440 @item exists
33441 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33442 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33443
33444 @end table
33445
33446 @subsubheading Example
33447
33448 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33449
33450 @smallexample
33451 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33452 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33453 @end smallexample
33454
33455 @noindent
33456 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33457 to the debugger:
33458
33459 @smallexample
33460 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33461 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33462 @end smallexample
33463
33464 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33465 @findex -list-features
33466 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33467
33468 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33469 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33470 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33471 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33472 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33473 startup.
33474
33475 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33476 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33477 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33478 is given below.
33479
33480 Example output:
33481
33482 @smallexample
33483 (gdb) -list-features
33484 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33485 @end smallexample
33486
33487 The current list of features is:
33488
33489 @ftable @samp
33490 @item frozen-varobjs
33491 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33492 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33493 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33494 @item pending-breakpoints
33495 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33496 command.
33497 @item python
33498 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33499 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33500 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33501 @item thread-info
33502 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33503 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33504 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33505 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33506 @item breakpoint-notifications
33507 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33508 CLI will be announced via async records.
33509 @item ada-task-info
33510 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33511 @item language-option
33512 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33513 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33514 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33515 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33516 @item undefined-command-error-code
33517 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33518 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33519 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33520 @item exec-run-start-option
33521 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33522 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33523 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33524 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33525 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33526 @end ftable
33527
33528 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33529 @findex -list-target-features
33530
33531 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33532 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33533 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33534 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33535 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33536 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33537 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33538 Example output:
33539
33540 @smallexample
33541 (gdb) -list-target-features
33542 ^done,result=["async"]
33543 @end smallexample
33544
33545 The current list of features is:
33546
33547 @table @samp
33548 @item async
33549 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33550 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33551 while the target is running.
33552
33553 @item reverse
33554 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33555 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33556
33557 @end table
33558
33559 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33560 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33561 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33562
33563 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33564
33565 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33566 @findex -gdb-exit
33567
33568 @subsubheading Synopsis
33569
33570 @smallexample
33571 -gdb-exit
33572 @end smallexample
33573
33574 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33575
33576 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33577
33578 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33579
33580 @subsubheading Example
33581
33582 @smallexample
33583 (gdb)
33584 -gdb-exit
33585 ^exit
33586 @end smallexample
33587
33588
33589 @ignore
33590 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33591 @findex -exec-abort
33592
33593 @subsubheading Synopsis
33594
33595 @smallexample
33596 -exec-abort
33597 @end smallexample
33598
33599 Kill the inferior running program.
33600
33601 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33602
33603 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33604
33605 @subsubheading Example
33606 N.A.
33607 @end ignore
33608
33609
33610 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33611 @findex -gdb-set
33612
33613 @subsubheading Synopsis
33614
33615 @smallexample
33616 -gdb-set
33617 @end smallexample
33618
33619 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33620 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33621
33622 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33623
33624 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33625
33626 @subsubheading Example
33627
33628 @smallexample
33629 (gdb)
33630 -gdb-set $foo=3
33631 ^done
33632 (gdb)
33633 @end smallexample
33634
33635
33636 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33637 @findex -gdb-show
33638
33639 @subsubheading Synopsis
33640
33641 @smallexample
33642 -gdb-show
33643 @end smallexample
33644
33645 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33646
33647 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33648
33649 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33650
33651 @subsubheading Example
33652
33653 @smallexample
33654 (gdb)
33655 -gdb-show annotate
33656 ^done,value="0"
33657 (gdb)
33658 @end smallexample
33659
33660 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33661
33662
33663 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33664 @findex -gdb-version
33665
33666 @subsubheading Synopsis
33667
33668 @smallexample
33669 -gdb-version
33670 @end smallexample
33671
33672 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33673
33674 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33675
33676 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33677 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33678
33679 @subsubheading Example
33680
33681 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33682 @c box in TeX.
33683 @smallexample
33684 (gdb)
33685 -gdb-version
33686 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33687 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33688 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33689 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33690 ~ certain conditions.
33691 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33692 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33693 ~ details.
33694 ~This GDB was configured as
33695 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33696 ^done
33697 (gdb)
33698 @end smallexample
33699
33700 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33701 @findex -list-thread-groups
33702
33703 @subheading Synopsis
33704
33705 @smallexample
33706 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33707 @end smallexample
33708
33709 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33710 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33711 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33712 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33713 top-level thread groups.
33714
33715 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33716 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33717 available on the target.
33718
33719 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33720 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33721 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33722 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33723 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33724 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33725 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33726 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33727
33728 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33729 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33730 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33731 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33732 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33733 @samp{threads} field.
33734
33735 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33736 the following caveats:
33737
33738 @itemize @bullet
33739 @item
33740 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33741 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33742 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33743
33744 @item
33745 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33746 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33747 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33748 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33749 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33750 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33751
33752 @end itemize
33753
33754 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33755 have the following fields:
33756
33757 @table @code
33758 @item id
33759 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33760 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33761 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33762
33763 @item type
33764 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33765 valid type.
33766
33767 @item pid
33768 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33769 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33770
33771 @item exit-code
33772 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33773 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33774 only if the process is not running.
33775
33776 @item num_children
33777 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33778 absent for an available thread group.
33779
33780 @item threads
33781 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33782 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33783 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33784
33785 @item cores
33786 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33787 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33788 such information is not available.
33789
33790 @item executable
33791 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33792 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33793 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33794
33795 @end table
33796
33797 @subheading Example
33798
33799 @smallexample
33800 @value{GDBP}
33801 -list-thread-groups
33802 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33803 -list-thread-groups 17
33804 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33805 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33806 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33807 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33808 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
33809 -list-thread-groups --available
33810 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33811 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33812 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33813 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33814 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33815 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33816 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33817 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33818 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33819 @end smallexample
33820
33821 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33822 @findex -info-os
33823
33824 @subsubheading Synopsis
33825
33826 @smallexample
33827 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33828 @end smallexample
33829
33830 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33831 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33832 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33833 of data of that type.
33834
33835 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33836 system.
33837
33838 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33839
33840 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33841
33842 @subsubheading Example
33843
33844 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33845 like this:
33846
33847 @smallexample
33848 @value{GDBP}
33849 -info-os
33850 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33851 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33852 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33853 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33854 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33855 col2="CPUs"@},
33856 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
33857 col2="File descriptors"@},
33858 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
33859 col2="Kernel modules"@},
33860 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
33861 col2="Message queues"@},
33862 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
33863 col2="Processes"@},
33864 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
33865 col2="Process groups"@},
33866 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
33867 col2="Semaphores"@},
33868 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
33869 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
33870 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
33871 col2="Sockets"@},
33872 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
33873 col2="Threads"@}]
33874 @value{GDBP}
33875 -info-os processes
33876 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
33877 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
33878 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
33879 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
33880 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
33881 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
33882 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
33883 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
33884 ...
33885 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
33886 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
33887 (gdb)
33888 @end smallexample
33889
33890 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
33891 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
33892 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
33893 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
33894 @code{info os} omits it.)
33895
33896 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
33897 @findex -add-inferior
33898
33899 @subheading Synopsis
33900
33901 @smallexample
33902 -add-inferior
33903 @end smallexample
33904
33905 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
33906 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
33907 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
33908 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
33909 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
33910 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
33911
33912 @subheading Example
33913
33914 @smallexample
33915 @value{GDBP}
33916 -add-inferior
33917 ^done,inferior="i3"
33918 @end smallexample
33919
33920 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
33921 @findex -interpreter-exec
33922
33923 @subheading Synopsis
33924
33925 @smallexample
33926 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
33927 @end smallexample
33928 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
33929
33930 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
33931
33932 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33933
33934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
33935
33936 @subheading Example
33937
33938 @smallexample
33939 (gdb)
33940 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
33941 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
33942 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
33943 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
33944 ^done
33945 (gdb)
33946 @end smallexample
33947
33948 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
33949 @findex -inferior-tty-set
33950
33951 @subheading Synopsis
33952
33953 @smallexample
33954 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33955 @end smallexample
33956
33957 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
33958
33959 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33960
33961 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
33962
33963 @subheading Example
33964
33965 @smallexample
33966 (gdb)
33967 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33968 ^done
33969 (gdb)
33970 @end smallexample
33971
33972 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33973 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33974
33975 @subheading Synopsis
33976
33977 @smallexample
33978 -inferior-tty-show
33979 @end smallexample
33980
33981 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33982
33983 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33984
33985 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33986
33987 @subheading Example
33988
33989 @smallexample
33990 (gdb)
33991 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33992 ^done
33993 (gdb)
33994 -inferior-tty-show
33995 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33996 (gdb)
33997 @end smallexample
33998
33999 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34000 @findex -enable-timings
34001
34002 @subheading Synopsis
34003
34004 @smallexample
34005 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34006 @end smallexample
34007
34008 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34009 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34010 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34011 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34012
34013 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34014
34015 No equivalent.
34016
34017 @subheading Example
34018
34019 @smallexample
34020 (gdb)
34021 -enable-timings
34022 ^done
34023 (gdb)
34024 -break-insert main
34025 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34026 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34027 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34028 times="0"@},
34029 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34030 (gdb)
34031 -enable-timings no
34032 ^done
34033 (gdb)
34034 -exec-run
34035 ^running
34036 (gdb)
34037 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34038 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34039 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34040 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
34041 (gdb)
34042 @end smallexample
34043
34044 @node Annotations
34045 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34046
34047 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34048 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34049 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34050 relatively high level.
34051
34052 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34053 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
34054
34055 @ignore
34056 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34057 @end ignore
34058
34059 @menu
34060 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34061 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34062 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34063 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34064 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34065 * Annotations for Running::
34066 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34067 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34068 @end menu
34069
34070 @node Annotations Overview
34071 @section What is an Annotation?
34072 @cindex annotations
34073
34074 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34075 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34076 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34077 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34078 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34079 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34080 cannot contain newline characters.
34081
34082 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34083 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34084 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34085 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34086 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34087 means those three characters as output.
34088
34089 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34090 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34091 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34092 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34093 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34094 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34095 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34096 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34097 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34098
34099 @table @code
34100 @kindex set annotate
34101 @item set annotate @var{level}
34102 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34103 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34104
34105 @item show annotate
34106 @kindex show annotate
34107 Show the current annotation level.
34108 @end table
34109
34110 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34111
34112 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34113
34114 @smallexample
34115 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34116 GNU gdb 6.0
34117 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34118 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34119 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34120 under certain conditions.
34121 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34122 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34123 for details.
34124 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34125
34126 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34127 (@value{GDBP})
34128 ^Z^Zprompt
34129 @kbd{quit}
34130
34131 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34132 $
34133 @end smallexample
34134
34135 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34136 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34137 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34138 output from @value{GDBN}.
34139
34140 @node Server Prefix
34141 @section The Server Prefix
34142 @cindex server prefix
34143
34144 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34145 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34146 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34147 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34148 a transparent manner.
34149
34150 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34151 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34152 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34153 @code{print} command.
34154
34155 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34156 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34157
34158 @node Prompting
34159 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34160
34161 @cindex annotations for prompts
34162 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34163 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34164 over, etc.
34165
34166 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34167 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34168 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34169 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34170 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34171 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34172 features the following annotations:
34173
34174 @smallexample
34175 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34176 ^Z^Zprompt
34177 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34178 @end smallexample
34179
34180 The input types are
34181
34182 @table @code
34183 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34184 @findex prompt annotation
34185 @findex post-prompt annotation
34186 @item prompt
34187 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34188
34189 @findex pre-commands annotation
34190 @findex commands annotation
34191 @findex post-commands annotation
34192 @item commands
34193 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34194 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34195
34196 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34197 @findex overload-choice annotation
34198 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34199 @item overload-choice
34200 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34201
34202 @findex pre-query annotation
34203 @findex query annotation
34204 @findex post-query annotation
34205 @item query
34206 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34207
34208 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34209 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34210 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34211 @item prompt-for-continue
34212 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34213 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34214 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34215 presence of annotations.
34216 @end table
34217
34218 @node Errors
34219 @section Errors
34220 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34221
34222 @findex quit annotation
34223 @smallexample
34224 ^Z^Zquit
34225 @end smallexample
34226
34227 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34228
34229 @findex error annotation
34230 @smallexample
34231 ^Z^Zerror
34232 @end smallexample
34233
34234 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34235
34236 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34237 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34238 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34239 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34240 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34241 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34242 to the top level.
34243
34244 @findex error-begin annotation
34245 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34246
34247 @smallexample
34248 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34249 @end smallexample
34250
34251 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34252 message.
34253
34254 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34255 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34256 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34257
34258 @node Invalidation
34259 @section Invalidation Notices
34260
34261 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34262 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34263 changed.
34264
34265 @table @code
34266 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34267 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34268
34269 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34270 have changed.
34271
34272 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34273 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34274
34275 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34276 deleted a breakpoint.
34277 @end table
34278
34279 @node Annotations for Running
34280 @section Running the Program
34281 @cindex annotations for running programs
34282
34283 @findex starting annotation
34284 @findex stopping annotation
34285 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34286 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34287
34288 @smallexample
34289 ^Z^Zstarting
34290 @end smallexample
34291
34292 is output. When the program stops,
34293
34294 @smallexample
34295 ^Z^Zstopped
34296 @end smallexample
34297
34298 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34299 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34300
34301 @table @code
34302 @findex exited annotation
34303 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34304 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34305 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34306
34307 @findex signalled annotation
34308 @findex signal-name annotation
34309 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34310 @findex signal-string annotation
34311 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34312 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34313 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34314 annotation continues:
34315
34316 @smallexample
34317 @var{intro-text}
34318 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34319 @var{name}
34320 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34321 @var{middle-text}
34322 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34323 @var{string}
34324 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34325 @var{end-text}
34326 @end smallexample
34327
34328 @noindent
34329 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34330 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34331 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34332 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34333 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34334
34335 @findex signal annotation
34336 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34337 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34338 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34339 terminated with it.
34340
34341 @findex breakpoint annotation
34342 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34343 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34344
34345 @findex watchpoint annotation
34346 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34347 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34348 @end table
34349
34350 @node Source Annotations
34351 @section Displaying Source
34352 @cindex annotations for source display
34353
34354 @findex source annotation
34355 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34356
34357 @smallexample
34358 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34359 @end smallexample
34360
34361 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34362 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34363 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34364 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34365 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34366 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34367 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34368 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34369 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34370 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34371 depend on the language).
34372
34373 @node JIT Interface
34374 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34375 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34376 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34377
34378 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34379 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34380 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34381 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34382
34383 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34384 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34385 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34386 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34387 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34388 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34389
34390 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34391 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34392 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34393 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34394 LLVM JIT.
34395
34396 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34397 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34398 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34399 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34400 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34401 out about additional code.
34402
34403 @menu
34404 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34405 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34406 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34407 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34408 @end menu
34409
34410 @node Declarations
34411 @section JIT Declarations
34412
34413 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34414 implement the interface:
34415
34416 @smallexample
34417 typedef enum
34418 @{
34419 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34420 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34421 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34422 @} jit_actions_t;
34423
34424 struct jit_code_entry
34425 @{
34426 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34427 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34428 const char *symfile_addr;
34429 uint64_t symfile_size;
34430 @};
34431
34432 struct jit_descriptor
34433 @{
34434 uint32_t version;
34435 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34436 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34437 uint32_t action_flag;
34438 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34439 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34440 @};
34441
34442 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34443 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34444
34445 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34446 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34447 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34448 @end smallexample
34449
34450 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34451 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34452 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34453
34454 @node Registering Code
34455 @section Registering Code
34456
34457 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34458
34459 @itemize @bullet
34460 @item
34461 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34462 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34463
34464 @item
34465 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34466 file.
34467
34468 @item
34469 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34470
34471 @item
34472 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34473
34474 @item
34475 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34476 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34477 @end itemize
34478
34479 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34480 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34481 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34482 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34483
34484 @node Unregistering Code
34485 @section Unregistering Code
34486
34487 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34488
34489 @itemize @bullet
34490 @item
34491 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34492
34493 @item
34494 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34495
34496 @item
34497 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34498 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34499 @end itemize
34500
34501 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34502 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34503
34504 @node Custom Debug Info
34505 @section Custom Debug Info
34506 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34507 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34508
34509 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34510 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34511 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34512 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34513 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34514 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34515 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34516 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34517 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34518
34519 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34520 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34521 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34522 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34523 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34524 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34525 compiler.
34526
34527 @menu
34528 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34529 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34530 @end menu
34531
34532 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34533 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34534 @kindex jit-reader-load
34535 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34536
34537 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34538 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34539
34540 @table @code
34541 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34542 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34543 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34544 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34545 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34546 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34547 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34548
34549 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34550 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34551 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34552 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34553 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34554
34555 @item jit-reader-unload
34556 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34557
34558 @end table
34559
34560 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34561 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34562 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34563
34564 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34565 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34566
34567 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34568 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34569 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34570 the system include directory.
34571
34572 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34573 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34574 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34575
34576 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34577 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34578
34579 @findex gdb_init_reader
34580 @smallexample
34581 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34582 @end smallexample
34583
34584 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34585
34586 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34587 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34588 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34589 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34590 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34591 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34592
34593 @smallexample
34594 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34595 @{
34596 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34597 int reader_version;
34598
34599 /* For use by the reader. */
34600 void *priv_data;
34601
34602 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34603 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34604 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34605 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34606 @};
34607 @end smallexample
34608
34609 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34610 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34611
34612 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34613 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34614 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34615 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34616 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34617 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34618 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34619 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34620 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34621 target's address space.
34622
34623 @node In-Process Agent
34624 @chapter In-Process Agent
34625 @cindex debugging agent
34626 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34627 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34628 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34629 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34630 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34631 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34632 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34633 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34634 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34635 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34636 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34637 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34638 behavior without interrupting it.
34639
34640 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34641 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34642 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34643 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34644 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34645 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34646 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34647 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34648 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34649
34650 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34651 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34652 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34653 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34654
34655 @anchor{Control Agent}
34656 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34657 debugging with the following commands:
34658
34659 @table @code
34660 @kindex set agent on
34661 @item set agent on
34662 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34663 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34664 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34665 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34666 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34667 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34668
34669 @kindex set agent off
34670 @item set agent off
34671 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34672 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34673
34674 @kindex show agent
34675 @item show agent
34676 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34677 the in-process agent.
34678 @end table
34679
34680 @menu
34681 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34682 @end menu
34683
34684 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34685 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34686 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34687
34688 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34689 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34690 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34691 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34692 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34693 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34694 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34695 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34696 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34697
34698 @menu
34699 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34700 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34701 @end menu
34702
34703 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34704 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34705 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34706
34707 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34708 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34709
34710 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34711 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34712 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34713 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34714
34715 @enumerate
34716 @item
34717 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34718 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34719 @item
34720 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34721 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34722 the other one.
34723 @end enumerate
34724
34725 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34726
34727 @enumerate
34728 @item
34729 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34730 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34731 @anchor{agent expression object}
34732 @item
34733 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34734 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34735 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34736 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34737 @item
34738 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34739 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34740
34741 @end enumerate
34742
34743 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34744 object:
34745
34746 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34747 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34748 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34749 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34750 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34751 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34752 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34753 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34754 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34755 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34756 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34757 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34758 memory address for collecting.
34759 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34760 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34761 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34762 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34763 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34764 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34765 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34766 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34767 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34768 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34769 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34770 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34771 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34772 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34773 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34774 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34775 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34776 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34777 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34778 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34779 @ref{agent expression object}
34780 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34781 @ref{agent expression object}
34782 @item actions @tab variable
34783 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34784 @end multitable
34785
34786 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34787 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34788 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34789
34790 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34791 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34792
34793 @table @samp
34794
34795 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34796 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34797 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34798 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34799 in IPA finally.
34800
34801 Replies:
34802 @table @samp
34803 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34804 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34805 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34806 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34807 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34808 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34809 @item E @var{NN}
34810 for an error
34811
34812 @end table
34813
34814 @item close
34815 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34816 is about to kill inferiors.
34817
34818 @item qTfSTM
34819 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34820 @item qTsSTM
34821 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34822 @item qTSTMat
34823 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34824 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34825 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34826
34827 Replies:
34828 @table @samp
34829 @item E @var{NN}
34830 for an error
34831 @end table
34832 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34833 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34834 @end table
34835
34836 @node GDB Bugs
34837 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34838 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34839 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34840
34841 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34842
34843 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34844 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34845 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34846 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34847
34848 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34849 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34850
34851 @menu
34852 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34853 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34854 @end menu
34855
34856 @node Bug Criteria
34857 @section Have You Found a Bug?
34858 @cindex bug criteria
34859
34860 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
34861
34862 @itemize @bullet
34863 @cindex fatal signal
34864 @cindex debugger crash
34865 @cindex crash of debugger
34866 @item
34867 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
34868 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
34869
34870 @cindex error on valid input
34871 @item
34872 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
34873 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
34874 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
34875
34876 @cindex invalid input
34877 @item
34878 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
34879 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
34880 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
34881 for traditional practice''.
34882
34883 @item
34884 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
34885 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
34886 @end itemize
34887
34888 @node Bug Reporting
34889 @section How to Report Bugs
34890 @cindex bug reports
34891 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
34892
34893 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
34894 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
34895 contact that organization first.
34896
34897 You can find contact information for many support companies and
34898 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
34899 distribution.
34900 @c should add a web page ref...
34901
34902 @ifset BUGURL
34903 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
34904 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34905 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
34906 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
34907 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
34908 be used.
34909
34910 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
34911 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
34912 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
34913 @samp{bug-gdb}.
34914
34915 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
34916 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
34917 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
34918 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
34919 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
34920 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
34921 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
34922 bug reports to the mailing list.
34923 @end ifset
34924 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
34925 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34926 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
34927 @end ifclear
34928 @end ifset
34929
34930 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
34931 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
34932 fact or leave it out, state it!
34933
34934 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
34935 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
34936 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
34937 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
34938 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
34939 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
34940 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
34941 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
34942 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
34943
34944 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
34945 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
34946 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
34947 self-contained.
34948
34949 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
34950 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
34951 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
34952 bugs properly.
34953
34954 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
34955
34956 @itemize @bullet
34957 @item
34958 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
34959 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
34960 version}.
34961
34962 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
34963 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
34964
34965 @item
34966 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
34967 version number.
34968
34969 @item
34970 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
34971 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
34972 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
34973 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
34974
34975 @item
34976 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
34977 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
34978
34979 @item
34980 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
34981 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34982 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34983 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34984 those compilers.
34985
34986 @item
34987 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34988 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34989 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34990 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34991
34992 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34993 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34994
34995 @item
34996 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34997 reproduce the bug.
34998
34999 @item
35000 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35001 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35002
35003 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35004 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35005 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35006 a chance to make a mistake.
35007
35008 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35009 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35010 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35011 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35012 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35013 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35014 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35015 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35016
35017 @pindex script
35018 @cindex recording a session script
35019 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35020 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35021 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35022 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35023
35024 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35025 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35026
35027 @item
35028 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35029 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35030 it by context, not by line number.
35031
35032 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35033 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35034
35035 @end itemize
35036
35037 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35038
35039 @itemize @bullet
35040 @item
35041 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35042
35043 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35044 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35045 changes will not affect it.
35046
35047 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35048 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35049 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35050 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35051
35052 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35053 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35054 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35055 less time, and so on.
35056
35057 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35058 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35059
35060 @item
35061 A patch for the bug.
35062
35063 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35064 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35065 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35066 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35067
35068 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35069 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35070 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35071 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35072
35073 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35074 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35075 help us to understand.
35076
35077 @item
35078 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35079
35080 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35081 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35082 @end itemize
35083
35084 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35085 @c and consists of the two following files:
35086 @c rluser.texi
35087 @c hsuser.texi
35088 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35089 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35090 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35091 @include rluser.texi
35092 @include hsuser.texi
35093 @end ifclear
35094
35095 @node In Memoriam
35096 @appendix In Memoriam
35097
35098 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35099 contributors:
35100
35101 @table @code
35102 @item Fred Fish
35103 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35104 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35105 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35106
35107 @item Michael Snyder
35108 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35109 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35110 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35111 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35112 @end table
35113
35114 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35115 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35116
35117 @node Formatting Documentation
35118 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35119
35120 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35121 @cindex reference card
35122 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35123 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35124 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35125 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35126 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35127 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35128
35129 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35130 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35131
35132 @smallexample
35133 make refcard.dvi
35134 @end smallexample
35135
35136 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35137 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35138 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35139 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35140 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35141
35142 @cindex documentation
35143
35144 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35145 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35146 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35147 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35148 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35149 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35150
35151 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35152 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35153 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35154 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35155 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35156 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35157 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35158 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35159
35160 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35161 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35162 @code{makeinfo}.
35163
35164 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35165 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35166 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35167
35168 @smallexample
35169 cd gdb
35170 make gdb.info
35171 @end smallexample
35172
35173 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35174 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35175 Texinfo definitions file.
35176
35177 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35178 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35179 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35180 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35181 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35182 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35183 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35184
35185 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35186 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35187 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35188 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35189 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35190 directory.
35191
35192 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35193 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35194 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35195 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35196
35197 @smallexample
35198 make gdb.dvi
35199 @end smallexample
35200
35201 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35202
35203 @node Installing GDB
35204 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35205 @cindex installation
35206
35207 @menu
35208 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35209 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35210 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35211 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35212 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35213 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35214 @end menu
35215
35216 @node Requirements
35217 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35218 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35219
35220 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35221 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35222
35223 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35224 @table @asis
35225 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
35226 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
35227 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35228
35229 @item GNU make
35230 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
35231 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
35232 @end table
35233
35234 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35235 @table @asis
35236 @item Expat
35237 @anchor{Expat}
35238 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35239 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35240 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35241 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35242 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35243 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35244
35245 Expat is used for:
35246
35247 @itemize @bullet
35248 @item
35249 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35250 @item
35251 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35252 @item
35253 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35254 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35255 @item
35256 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35257 @item
35258 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35259 @item
35260 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35261 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35262 @end itemize
35263
35264 @item Guile
35265 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
35266 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
35267 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35268 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
35269 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
35270 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
35271
35272 @item iconv
35273 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35274 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35275 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35276 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35277
35278 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35279 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
35280 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
35281 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
35282 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
35283
35284 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
35285 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
35286 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
35287 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
35288 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
35289
35290 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35291 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35292 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35293 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35294 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35295 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35296 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
35297 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
35298 code to @samp{libiconv}.
35299
35300 @item lzma
35301 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
35302 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
35303 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
35304 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
35305 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
35306 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
35307 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
35308
35309 @item MPFR
35310 @anchor{MPFR}
35311 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35312 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35313 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35314 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35315 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35316 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35317 option to specify its location.
35318
35319 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35320 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35321 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35322 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35323
35324 @item Python
35325 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
35326 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
35327 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35328 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
35329 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
35330 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
35331 installation of Python.
35332
35333 @item zlib
35334 @cindex compressed debug sections
35335 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35336 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35337 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35338 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35339 information in such binaries.
35340
35341 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35342 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35343 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35344 @end table
35345
35346 @node Running Configure
35347 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35348 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35349 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35350 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35351 build the @code{gdb} program.
35352 @iftex
35353 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35354 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35355 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35356 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35357 @end iftex
35358
35359 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35360 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35361 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35362
35363 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35364 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35365
35366 @table @code
35367 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35368 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35369
35370 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35371 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35372
35373 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35374 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35375
35376 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35377 @sc{gnu} include files
35378
35379 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35380 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35381
35382 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35383 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35384
35385 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35386 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35387 @end table
35388
35389 There may be other subdirectories as well.
35390
35391 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35392 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35393 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35394
35395 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35396 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35397 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35398 argument.
35399
35400 For example:
35401
35402 @smallexample
35403 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35404 ./configure
35405 make
35406 @end smallexample
35407
35408 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
35409 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
35410 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
35411 directories.
35412
35413 @need 750
35414 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35415 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35416 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35417
35418 @smallexample
35419 sh configure
35420 @end smallexample
35421
35422 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35423 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35424 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35425 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35426 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35427 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35428 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35429 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35430 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35431
35432 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
35433 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
35434 install it with @code{make install}.
35435
35436 @node Separate Objdir
35437 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35438
35439 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35440 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35441 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35442 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35443 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35444 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35445 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35446 program specified there.
35447
35448 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35449 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35450 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35451 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35452 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35453 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35454
35455 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35456 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35457
35458 @smallexample
35459 @group
35460 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35461 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35462 cd ../gdb-sun4
35463 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
35464 make
35465 @end group
35466 @end smallexample
35467
35468 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35469 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35470 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35471 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35472 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35473 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35474
35475 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35476 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35477 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35478 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35479 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35480
35481 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35482 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35483 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35484 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35485 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35486 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35487
35488 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35489 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35490 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35491
35492 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35493 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35494 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35495 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35496 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35497
35498 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35499 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35500 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35501 with each other.
35502
35503 @node Config Names
35504 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35505
35506 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35507 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35508 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35509 of information in the following pattern:
35510
35511 @smallexample
35512 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35513 @end smallexample
35514
35515 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35516 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35517 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35518
35519 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35520 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35521 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35522 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35523 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35524 abbreviations---for example:
35525
35526 @smallexample
35527 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35528 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35529 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35530 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35531 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35532 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35533 % sh config.sub sun4
35534 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35535 % sh config.sub sun3
35536 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35537 % sh config.sub i986v
35538 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35539 @end smallexample
35540
35541 @noindent
35542 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35543 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35544
35545 @node Configure Options
35546 @section @file{configure} Options
35547
35548 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35549 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
35550 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
35551 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
35552 explanation of @file{configure}.
35553
35554 @smallexample
35555 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35556 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35557 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35558 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35559 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35560 @end smallexample
35561
35562 @noindent
35563 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35564 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35565 @samp{--}.
35566
35567 @table @code
35568 @item --help
35569 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35570
35571 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35572 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35573 @file{@var{dir}}.
35574
35575 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35576 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35577 @file{@var{dir}}.
35578
35579 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35580 @need 2000
35581 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35582 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35583 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35584 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35585 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35586 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35587 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35588 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35589 @var{dirname}.
35590
35591 @item --target=@var{target}
35592 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35593 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35594 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35595
35596 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
35597 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
35598 @end table
35599
35600 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
35601 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
35602 options not described here.
35603
35604 @table @code
35605 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
35606 @itemx --enable-targets=all
35607 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
35608 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
35609 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
35610
35611 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
35612 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
35613 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
35614 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
35615 @code{--datadir}).
35616
35617 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
35618 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
35619 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
35620 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
35621 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
35622 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
35623 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
35624 after it is built.
35625
35626 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
35627 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
35628
35629 @item --disable-gdbmi
35630 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
35631 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35632
35633 @item --enable-tui
35634 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
35635 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
35636 supported).
35637
35638 @item --with-curses
35639 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
35640 terminal operations.
35641
35642 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
35643 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
35644 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
35645 details.
35646
35647 @item --with-system-readline
35648 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
35649 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35650
35651 @item --with-system-zlib
35652 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
35653 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35654
35655 @item --with-expat
35656 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
35657 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
35658 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
35659 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
35660 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
35661 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
35662 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
35663 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
35664
35665 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
35666
35667 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
35668 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
35669 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
35670 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
35671 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
35672
35673 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
35674 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
35675
35676 @item --with-lzma
35677 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
35678 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
35679 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
35680 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
35681 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
35682 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
35683
35684 @item --with-mpfr
35685 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
35686 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
35687 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
35688 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
35689 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
35690 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
35691 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
35692 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
35693 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
35694
35695 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
35696 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
35697 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
35698 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
35699 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
35700 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
35701 of Python supported by GDB is 2.4. The optional argument @var{python}
35702 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
35703 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
35704 Python is installed.
35705
35706 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
35707 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
35708 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
35709 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
35710 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
35711 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
35712 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
35713 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
35714 compile and link against Guile.
35715
35716 @item --without-included-regex
35717 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
35718 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
35719 the GNU C library.
35720
35721 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
35722 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
35723 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
35724 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
35725 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
35726 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
35727 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
35728 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
35729
35730 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35731 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
35732 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
35733 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
35734 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
35735 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
35736
35737 @item --enable-build-warnings
35738 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
35739 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
35740 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
35741 compiler you are using.
35742
35743 @item --enable-werror
35744 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
35745 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
35746 outputs any warning messages.
35747 @end table
35748
35749 @node System-wide configuration
35750 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35751 @cindex system-wide init file
35752
35753 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35754 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35755 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35756
35757 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35758
35759 @table @code
35760 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35761 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35762 @var{file}.
35763 @end table
35764
35765 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35766 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35767
35768 @itemize @bullet
35769 @item
35770 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35771 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35772 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35773 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35774 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35775 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35776
35777 @item
35778 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35779 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35780 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35781 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35782 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35783 @end itemize
35784
35785 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35786 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35787 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35788 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35789 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35790 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35791 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35792 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35793 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35794 reread.
35795
35796 @menu
35797 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35798 @end menu
35799
35800 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35801 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35802 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35803
35804 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35805 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35806 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35807 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35808 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35809 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35810
35811 The following scripts are currently available:
35812 @itemize @bullet
35813
35814 @item @file{elinos.py}
35815 @pindex elinos.py
35816 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35817 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35818 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35819 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35820 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35821 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35822
35823 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35824 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35825 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35826 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35827 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35828 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35829
35830 @end itemize
35831
35832 @node Maintenance Commands
35833 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35834 @cindex maintenance commands
35835 @cindex internal commands
35836
35837 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35838 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35839 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35840 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35841 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35842
35843 @table @code
35844 @kindex maint agent
35845 @kindex maint agent-eval
35846 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35847 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35848 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
35849 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
35850 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
35851 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
35852 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
35853 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
35854 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
35855 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
35856 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
35857 addition and return the sum.
35858 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
35859 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
35860
35861 @kindex maint agent-printf
35862 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
35863 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
35864 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
35865 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
35866 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
35867
35868 @kindex maint info breakpoints
35869 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
35870 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
35871 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
35872 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
35873 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
35874 is shown:
35875
35876 @table @code
35877 @item breakpoint
35878 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
35879
35880 @item watchpoint
35881 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
35882
35883 @item longjmp
35884 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
35885 @code{longjmp} calls.
35886
35887 @item longjmp resume
35888 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
35889
35890 @item until
35891 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
35892
35893 @item finish
35894 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
35895
35896 @item shlib events
35897 Shared library events.
35898
35899 @end table
35900
35901 @kindex maint info btrace
35902 @item maint info btrace
35903 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
35904
35905 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
35906 @item maint btrace packet-history
35907 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
35908 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
35909 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
35910 recording format.
35911
35912 @table @code
35913 @item bts
35914 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
35915 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
35916
35917 @table @asis
35918 @item Block number
35919 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
35920 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
35921 @item Highest @samp{PC}
35922 @end table
35923
35924 @item pt
35925 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
35926 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
35927 information is printed:
35928
35929 @table @asis
35930 @item Packet number
35931 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
35932 @item Trace offset
35933 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
35934 @item Packet opcode and payload
35935 @end table
35936 @end table
35937
35938 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
35939 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
35940 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
35941 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
35942 needed.
35943
35944 @kindex maint btrace clear
35945 @item maint btrace clear
35946 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
35947 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
35948
35949 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
35950 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
35951 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
35952 buffer.
35953
35954 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35955 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35956 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35957 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35958 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
35959 packet history.
35960
35961 @kindex set displaced-stepping
35962 @kindex show displaced-stepping
35963 @cindex displaced stepping support
35964 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
35965 @item set displaced-stepping
35966 @itemx show displaced-stepping
35967 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
35968 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
35969 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
35970 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
35971 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
35972
35973 @table @code
35974 @item set displaced-stepping on
35975 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
35976 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
35977
35978 @item set displaced-stepping off
35979 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
35980 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
35981
35982 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
35983 @item set displaced-stepping auto
35984 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
35985 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
35986 architecture supports displaced stepping.
35987 @end table
35988
35989 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
35990 @item maint check-psymtabs
35991 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
35992 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
35993
35994 @kindex maint check-symtabs
35995 @item maint check-symtabs
35996 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
35997
35998 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
35999 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36000 Expand symbol tables.
36001 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36002 names matching @var{regexp}.
36003
36004 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
36005 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36006 @cindex demangler crashes
36007 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
36008 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36009 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
36010 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
36011 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
36012 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
36013 option to terminate the current session.
36014
36015 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36016 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36017 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36018
36019 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36020 @item maint cplus namespace
36021 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36022
36023 @kindex maint deprecate
36024 @kindex maint undeprecate
36025 @cindex deprecated commands
36026 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36027 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36028 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36029 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36030 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36031 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36032 the replacement as part of the warning.
36033
36034 @kindex maint dump-me
36035 @item maint dump-me
36036 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36037 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36038 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36039 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36040
36041 @kindex maint internal-error
36042 @kindex maint internal-warning
36043 @kindex maint demangler-warning
36044 @cindex demangler crashes
36045 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36046 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36047 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36048
36049 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
36050 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
36051 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
36052 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
36053 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
36054 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
36055 @value{GDBN} session.
36056
36057 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36058 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36059
36060 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36061
36062 @smallexample
36063 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36064 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36065 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36066 debugging may prove unreliable.
36067 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36068 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36069 (@value{GDBP})
36070 @end smallexample
36071
36072 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36073 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36074 @cindex demangler crashes
36075
36076 @kindex maint set internal-error
36077 @kindex maint show internal-error
36078 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36079 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36080 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
36081 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
36082 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36083 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36084 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36085 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36086 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36087 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
36088 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36089 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36090 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36091 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36092 described in the table below.
36093
36094 @table @samp
36095 @item quit
36096 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36097 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36098
36099 @item corefile
36100 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36101 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
36102 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
36103 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
36104 disabled.
36105 @end table
36106
36107 @kindex maint packet
36108 @item maint packet @var{text}
36109 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36110 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36111 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36112 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36113 checksum.
36114
36115 @kindex maint print architecture
36116 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36117 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36118 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36119
36120 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36121 @item maint print c-tdesc
36122 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36123 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
36124 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
36125 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
36126 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
36127 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
36128 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
36129 modify XML target descriptions.
36130
36131 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
36132 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
36133 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
36134 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
36135
36136 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
36137 @kindex maint check libthread-db
36138 @item maint check libthread-db
36139 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
36140 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
36141 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
36142 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
36143 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
36144 on some platforms when debugging core files.
36145
36146 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36147 @item maint print dummy-frames
36148 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36149
36150 @smallexample
36151 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36152 @dots{}
36153 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36154 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36155 58 return (a + b);
36156 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36157 @dots{}
36158 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36159 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
36160 (@value{GDBP})
36161 @end smallexample
36162
36163 Takes an optional file parameter.
36164
36165 @kindex maint print registers
36166 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36167 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36168 @kindex maint print register-groups
36169 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36170 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36171 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36172 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36173 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36174 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36175 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36176
36177 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36178 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36179 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36180 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36181 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36182 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36183 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36184 and offsets in the `G' packets.
36185
36186 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36187 write the information.
36188
36189 @kindex maint print reggroups
36190 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36191 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36192 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36193 information.
36194
36195 The register groups info looks like this:
36196
36197 @smallexample
36198 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36199 Group Type
36200 general user
36201 float user
36202 all user
36203 vector user
36204 system user
36205 save internal
36206 restore internal
36207 @end smallexample
36208
36209 @kindex flushregs
36210 @item flushregs
36211 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36212
36213 @kindex maint print objfiles
36214 @cindex info for known object files
36215 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36216 Print a dump of all known object files.
36217 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36218 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36219 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36220
36221 @kindex maint print user-registers
36222 @cindex user registers
36223 @item maint print user-registers
36224 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36225 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36226 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36227 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36228 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36229 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36230 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36231
36232 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36233 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36234 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36235 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36236 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36237 matching @var{regexp}.
36238 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36239 and the full path if known.
36240 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36241
36242 @kindex maint print statistics
36243 @cindex bcache statistics
36244 @item maint print statistics
36245 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36246 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36247 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36248 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36249 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36250 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36251 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36252 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36253 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36254 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36255 lengths.
36256
36257 @kindex maint print target-stack
36258 @cindex target stack description
36259 @item maint print target-stack
36260 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36261 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36262 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36263 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36264 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36265 address.
36266
36267 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36268 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36269
36270 @kindex maint print type
36271 @cindex type chain of a data type
36272 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36273 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36274 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36275 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36276 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36277 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36278
36279 @kindex maint selftest
36280 @cindex self tests
36281 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36282 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36283 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36284 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36285 name will by ran.
36286
36287 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36288 @cindex self tests
36289 @item maint info selftests
36290 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36291
36292 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36293 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36294 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36295 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36296 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36297 information.
36298
36299 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36300 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36301 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36302 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36303 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36304 always see the disassembly form.
36305
36306 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36307
36308 @smallexample
36309 (gdb) info addr argc
36310 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36311 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36312 @end smallexample
36313
36314 For more information on these expressions, see
36315 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36316
36317 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36318 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36319 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36320 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36321 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36322
36323 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36324 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36325 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36326 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36327 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36328 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36329 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36330 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36331 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36332
36333 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36334 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36335 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36336 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36337 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36338
36339 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36340 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36341 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36342 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36343 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36344 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36345
36346 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36347 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36348 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36349
36350 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36351 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36352 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36353 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36354
36355 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36356 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36357 @kindex maint set profile
36358 @kindex maint show profile
36359 @cindex profiling GDB
36360 @item maint set profile
36361 @itemx maint show profile
36362 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36363
36364 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36365 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36366 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36367 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36368 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36369 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36370 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36371
36372 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36373 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36374
36375 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36376 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36377 @cindex hardware debug registers
36378 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36379 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36380 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36381 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36382 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36383 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36384 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36385
36386 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36387 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36388 @item maint set show-all-tib
36389 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36390 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36391 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36392 command.
36393
36394 @kindex maint set target-async
36395 @kindex maint show target-async
36396 @item maint set target-async
36397 @itemx maint show target-async
36398 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36399 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36400 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36401 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36402
36403 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36404 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36405 @item maint set target-non-stop
36406 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36407
36408 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36409 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36410 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36411 if supported by the target.
36412
36413 @table @code
36414 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36415 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36416 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36417
36418 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36419 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36420 does not indicate support.
36421
36422 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36423 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36424 target supports it.
36425 @end table
36426
36427 @kindex maint set per-command
36428 @kindex maint show per-command
36429 @item maint set per-command
36430 @itemx maint show per-command
36431 @cindex resources used by commands
36432
36433 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36434 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36435
36436 @table @code
36437 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36438 @itemx maint show per-command space
36439 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36440 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36441 took, following the command's own output.
36442 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36443 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36444
36445 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36446 @itemx maint show per-command time
36447 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36448 for each command.
36449 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36450 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36451 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36452 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36453 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36454 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36455 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36456 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36457 spent by the program been debugged.
36458 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36459 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36460
36461 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36462 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36463 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36464 for each command.
36465 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36466
36467 @enumerate a
36468 @item
36469 number of symbol tables
36470 @item
36471 number of primary symbol tables
36472 @item
36473 number of blocks in the blockvector
36474 @end enumerate
36475 @end table
36476
36477 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36478 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36479 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36480 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36481 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36482 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36483 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36484 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36485 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36486 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36487
36488 @kindex maint space
36489 @cindex memory used by commands
36490 @item maint space @var{value}
36491 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36492 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36493
36494 @kindex maint time
36495 @cindex time of command execution
36496 @item maint time @var{value}
36497 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36498 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36499
36500 @kindex maint translate-address
36501 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36502 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36503 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36504 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36505 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36506 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36507 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36508
36509 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36510 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36511 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36512
36513 @end table
36514
36515 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36516 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36517
36518 @table @code
36519 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36520 @kindex set watchdog
36521 @cindex watchdog timer
36522 @cindex timeout for commands
36523 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36524 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36525 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36526
36527 @item show watchdog
36528 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36529 @end table
36530
36531 @node Remote Protocol
36532 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36533
36534 @menu
36535 * Overview::
36536 * Packets::
36537 * Stop Reply Packets::
36538 * General Query Packets::
36539 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36540 * Tracepoint Packets::
36541 * Host I/O Packets::
36542 * Interrupts::
36543 * Notification Packets::
36544 * Remote Non-Stop::
36545 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36546 * Examples::
36547 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36548 * Library List Format::
36549 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36550 * Memory Map Format::
36551 * Thread List Format::
36552 * Traceframe Info Format::
36553 * Branch Trace Format::
36554 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36555 @end menu
36556
36557 @node Overview
36558 @section Overview
36559
36560 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36561 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36562 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36563 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36564
36565 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36566 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36567
36568 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36569 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36570 @cindex remote serial protocol
36571 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36572 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36573 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36574 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36575 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36576
36577 @smallexample
36578 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36579 @end smallexample
36580 @noindent
36581
36582 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36583 @noindent
36584 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36585 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36586 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36587
36588 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36589 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36590
36591 @smallexample
36592 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36593 @end smallexample
36594
36595 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36596 @noindent
36597 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36598 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36599 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36600
36601 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36602 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36603 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36604 retransmission):
36605
36606 @smallexample
36607 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36608 <- @code{+}
36609 @end smallexample
36610 @noindent
36611
36612 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36613 once a connection is established.
36614 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36615
36616 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36617 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36618 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36619 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36620 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36621 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36622 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36623
36624 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36625 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36626 exceptions).
36627
36628 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36629 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36630 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36631 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36632
36633 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36634 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36635 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36636
36637 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36638 @anchor{Binary Data}
36639 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36640 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36641 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36642 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36643 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36644 binary data.
36645
36646 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36647 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36648 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36649 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36650 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36651 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36652 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36653 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36654 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36655 (described next).
36656
36657 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36658 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36659 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36660 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36661 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36662 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36663 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36664 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36665 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36666 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36667 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36668 3}} more times.
36669
36670 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36671 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36672 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36673 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36674 @samp{0*"00}.
36675
36676 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36677 error number. That number is not well defined.
36678
36679 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36680 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36681 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36682 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36683 on that response.
36684
36685 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36686 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36687 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36688 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36689 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36690 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36691
36692 @node Packets
36693 @section Packets
36694
36695 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36696 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36697 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36698 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36699
36700 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36701 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36702 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36703 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36704 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36705 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36706 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36707 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36708 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36709 @var{baz}.
36710
36711 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36712 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36713 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36714 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36715 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36716 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36717 pick any thread.
36718
36719 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36720 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36721 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36722 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36723 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36724 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36725 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36726 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36727 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36728 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36729 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36730 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
36731 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
36732
36733 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
36734 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
36735 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
36736 more information.
36737
36738 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
36739 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
36740
36741 Here are the packet descriptions.
36742
36743 @table @samp
36744
36745 @item !
36746 @cindex @samp{!} packet
36747 @anchor{extended mode}
36748 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
36749 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
36750 debugged.
36751
36752 Reply:
36753 @table @samp
36754 @item OK
36755 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36756 @end table
36757
36758 @item ?
36759 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36760 @anchor{? packet}
36761 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36762 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36763 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36764
36765 Reply:
36766 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36767
36768 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36769 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36770 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36771 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36772 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36773
36774 Reply:
36775 @table @samp
36776 @item OK
36777 The arguments were set.
36778 @item E @var{NN}
36779 An error occurred.
36780 @end table
36781
36782 @item b @var{baud}
36783 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36784 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36785 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36786
36787 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36788 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36789 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36790
36791 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36792 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36793 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36794 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36795 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36796
36797 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36798 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36799 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36800 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36801
36802 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36803 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36804
36805 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36806 @anchor{bc}
36807 @item bc
36808 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36809 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36810
36811 Reply:
36812 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36813
36814 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36815 @anchor{bs}
36816 @item bs
36817 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36818 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36819
36820 Reply:
36821 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36822
36823 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36824 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36825 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36826 is omitted, resume at current address.
36827
36828 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36829 packet}.
36830
36831 Reply:
36832 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36833
36834 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36835 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36836 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36837 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36838
36839 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36840 packet}.
36841
36842 Reply:
36843 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36844
36845 @item d
36846 @cindex @samp{d} packet
36847 Toggle debug flag.
36848
36849 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
36850 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
36851
36852 @item D
36853 @itemx D;@var{pid}
36854 @cindex @samp{D} packet
36855 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
36856 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
36857 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
36858
36859 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
36860 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
36861 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
36862 big-endian hex string.
36863
36864 Reply:
36865 @table @samp
36866 @item OK
36867 for success
36868 @item E @var{NN}
36869 for an error
36870 @end table
36871
36872 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
36873 @cindex @samp{F} packet
36874 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
36875 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
36876 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
36877
36878 @item g
36879 @anchor{read registers packet}
36880 @cindex @samp{g} packet
36881 Read general registers.
36882
36883 Reply:
36884 @table @samp
36885 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36886 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
36887 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
36888 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
36889 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
36890 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
36891
36892 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
36893 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
36894 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
36895 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
36896 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
36897 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
36898 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
36899 have been collected, and both have zero value:
36900
36901 @smallexample
36902 -> @code{g}
36903 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
36904 @end smallexample
36905
36906 @item E @var{NN}
36907 for an error.
36908 @end table
36909
36910 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
36911 @cindex @samp{G} packet
36912 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
36913 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
36914
36915 Reply:
36916 @table @samp
36917 @item OK
36918 for success
36919 @item E @var{NN}
36920 for an error
36921 @end table
36922
36923 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
36924 @cindex @samp{H} packet
36925 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
36926 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
36927 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
36928 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
36929 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
36930 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
36931 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36932
36933 Reply:
36934 @table @samp
36935 @item OK
36936 for success
36937 @item E @var{NN}
36938 for an error
36939 @end table
36940
36941 @c FIXME: JTC:
36942 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
36943 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
36944 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
36945 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
36946 @c described. For example:
36947 @c
36948 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36949 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
36950 @c otherwise returns current registers.
36951 @c
36952 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36953 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
36954 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
36955
36956 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
36957 @anchor{cycle step packet}
36958 @cindex @samp{i} packet
36959 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
36960 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
36961 step starting at that address.
36962
36963 @item I
36964 @cindex @samp{I} packet
36965 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
36966 step packet}.
36967
36968 @item k
36969 @cindex @samp{k} packet
36970 Kill request.
36971
36972 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
36973
36974 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
36975 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
36976
36977 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
36978
36979 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
36980 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
36981 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
36982
36983 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
36984 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
36985 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
36986
36987 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
36988 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
36989 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
36990 (@pxref{? packet}).
36991
36992 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
36993 @cindex @samp{m} packet
36994 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36995 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
36996 any particular boundary.
36997
36998 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
36999 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37000 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37001 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37002 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37003 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37004 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37005 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37006
37007 Reply:
37008 @table @samp
37009 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37010 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37011 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
37012 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37013 @item E @var{NN}
37014 @var{NN} is errno
37015 @end table
37016
37017 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37018 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37019 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37020 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
37021 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37022
37023 Reply:
37024 @table @samp
37025 @item OK
37026 for success
37027 @item E @var{NN}
37028 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37029 written).
37030 @end table
37031
37032 @item p @var{n}
37033 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37034 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37035 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37036 register value is encoded.
37037
37038 Reply:
37039 @table @samp
37040 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37041 the register's value
37042 @item E @var{NN}
37043 for an error
37044 @item @w{}
37045 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37046 @end table
37047
37048 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37049 @anchor{write register packet}
37050 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37051 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37052 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37053 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37054
37055 Reply:
37056 @table @samp
37057 @item OK
37058 for success
37059 @item E @var{NN}
37060 for an error
37061 @end table
37062
37063 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37064 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37065 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37066 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37067 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37068 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37069
37070 @item r
37071 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37072 Reset the entire system.
37073
37074 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37075
37076 @item R @var{XX}
37077 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37078 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37079 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37080
37081 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37082
37083 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37084 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37085 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
37086 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37087
37088 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37089 packet}.
37090
37091 Reply:
37092 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37093
37094 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37095 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37096 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37097 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37098 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37099
37100 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37101 packet}.
37102
37103 Reply:
37104 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37105
37106 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37107 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37108 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37109 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
37110 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
37111
37112 @item T @var{thread-id}
37113 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37114 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37115
37116 Reply:
37117 @table @samp
37118 @item OK
37119 thread is still alive
37120 @item E @var{NN}
37121 thread is dead
37122 @end table
37123
37124 @item v
37125 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37126 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37127
37128 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37129 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37130 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37131 The process ID is a
37132 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37133 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37134 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37135
37136 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37137 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37138 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37139 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37140 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37141 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37142 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37143 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37144
37145 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37146
37147 Reply:
37148 @table @samp
37149 @item E @var{nn}
37150 for an error
37151 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37152 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37153 @item OK
37154 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37155 @end table
37156
37157 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37158 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37159 @anchor{vCont packet}
37160 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37161
37162 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
37163 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
37164 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
37165 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
37166 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
37167 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
37168 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
37169 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
37170 error.
37171
37172 Currently supported actions are:
37173
37174 @table @samp
37175 @item c
37176 Continue.
37177 @item C @var{sig}
37178 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37179 @item s
37180 Step.
37181 @item S @var{sig}
37182 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37183 @item t
37184 Stop.
37185 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37186 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37187 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37188 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37189 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37190 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37191
37192 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37193 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37194 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37195 jumps to @var{start}).
37196
37197 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37198 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37199 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37200
37201 @end table
37202
37203 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37204 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37205 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37206
37207 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37208 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37209 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37210 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37211 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37212 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37213 as an implementation detail.
37214
37215 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37216 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37217 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37218 stopped.
37219
37220 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37221 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37222 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37223
37224 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37225 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37226
37227 Reply:
37228 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37229
37230 @item vCont?
37231 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37232 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37233
37234 Reply:
37235 @table @samp
37236 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37237 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37238 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37239 @item @w{}
37240 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37241 @end table
37242
37243 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37244 @item vCtrlC
37245 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37246 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37247 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37248 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37249 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37250 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37251 variant.
37252
37253 Reply:
37254 @table @samp
37255 @item E @var{nn}
37256 for an error
37257 @item OK
37258 for success
37259 @end table
37260
37261 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37262 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37263 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37264 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37265
37266 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37267 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37268 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37269 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37270 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37271 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37272 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37273 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37274 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37275 packet is received.
37276
37277 Reply:
37278 @table @samp
37279 @item OK
37280 for success
37281 @item E @var{NN}
37282 for an error
37283 @end table
37284
37285 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37286 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37287 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37288 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37289 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37290 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37291 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37292 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37293 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37294 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37295 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37296 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37297
37298
37299 Reply:
37300 @table @samp
37301 @item OK
37302 for success
37303 @item E.memtype
37304 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37305 @item E @var{NN}
37306 for an error
37307 @end table
37308
37309 @item vFlashDone
37310 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37311 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37312 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37313 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37314 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37315 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37316 request is completed.
37317
37318 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37319 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37320 @anchor{vKill packet}
37321 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37322 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37323 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37324 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37325
37326 Reply:
37327 @table @samp
37328 @item E @var{nn}
37329 for an error
37330 @item OK
37331 for success
37332 @end table
37333
37334 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37335 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37336 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37337 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37338 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37339
37340 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37341 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37342 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37343 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37344 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37345 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37346
37347 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37348 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37349 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37350 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37351 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37352 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37353 state.
37354
37355 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37356
37357 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37358
37359 Reply:
37360 @table @samp
37361 @item E @var{nn}
37362 for an error
37363 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37364 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37365 @end table
37366
37367 @item vStopped
37368 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37369 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37370
37371 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37372 @anchor{X packet}
37373 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37374 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37375 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37376 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37377 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37378
37379 Reply:
37380 @table @samp
37381 @item OK
37382 for success
37383 @item E @var{NN}
37384 for an error
37385 @end table
37386
37387 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37388 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37389 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37390 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37391 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37392 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37393 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37394
37395 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37396 separately.
37397
37398 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37399 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37400 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37401 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37402 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37403 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37404
37405 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37406 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37407 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37408 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37409 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37410 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37411
37412 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37413 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37414 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37415 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37416 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37417 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37418 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37419 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37420 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37421 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37422 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37423 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37424 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37425
37426 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37427 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37428
37429 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37430 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37431
37432 @table @samp
37433
37434 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37435 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37436 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37437
37438 @end table
37439
37440 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37441 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37442 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37443 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37444 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37445 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37446 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37447
37448 @table @samp
37449
37450 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37451 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37452 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37453
37454 @end table
37455
37456 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37457 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37458 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37459 target, is not defined.}
37460
37461 Reply:
37462 @table @samp
37463 @item OK
37464 success
37465 @item @w{}
37466 not supported
37467 @item E @var{NN}
37468 for an error
37469 @end table
37470
37471 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37472 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37473 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37474 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37475 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37476 address @var{addr}.
37477
37478 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37479 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37480 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37481 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37482
37483 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37484 movement.}
37485
37486 Reply:
37487 @table @samp
37488 @item OK
37489 success
37490 @item @w{}
37491 not supported
37492 @item E @var{NN}
37493 for an error
37494 @end table
37495
37496 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37497 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37498 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37499 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37500 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37501 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37502
37503 Reply:
37504 @table @samp
37505 @item OK
37506 success
37507 @item @w{}
37508 not supported
37509 @item E @var{NN}
37510 for an error
37511 @end table
37512
37513 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37514 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37515 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37516 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37517 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37518 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37519
37520 Reply:
37521 @table @samp
37522 @item OK
37523 success
37524 @item @w{}
37525 not supported
37526 @item E @var{NN}
37527 for an error
37528 @end table
37529
37530 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37531 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37532 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37533 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37534 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37535 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37536
37537 Reply:
37538 @table @samp
37539 @item OK
37540 success
37541 @item @w{}
37542 not supported
37543 @item E @var{NN}
37544 for an error
37545 @end table
37546
37547 @end table
37548
37549 @node Stop Reply Packets
37550 @section Stop Reply Packets
37551 @cindex stop reply packets
37552
37553 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37554 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37555 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37556 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37557 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37558 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37559 @value{GDBN} source code.
37560
37561 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37562 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37563 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37564
37565 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37566 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37567 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37568 components.
37569
37570 @table @samp
37571
37572 @item S @var{AA}
37573 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37574 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37575 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37576
37577 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37578 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37579 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37580 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37581 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37582 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37583 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37584 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37585
37586 @itemize @bullet
37587 @item
37588 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37589 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37590 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37591 two-digit hex number.
37592
37593 @item
37594 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37595 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37596
37597 @item
37598 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37599 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37600
37601 @item
37602 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37603 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37604 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37605 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37606
37607 @item
37608 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37609 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37610 future.
37611 @end itemize
37612
37613 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37614
37615 @table @samp
37616 @item watch
37617 @itemx rwatch
37618 @itemx awatch
37619 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37620 hex.
37621
37622 @item syscall_entry
37623 @itemx syscall_return
37624 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37625 syscall number, in hex.
37626
37627 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37628 @item library
37629 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37630 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37631 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37632
37633 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37634 @item replaylog
37635 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37636 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37637 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37638 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37639 for more information.
37640
37641 @item swbreak
37642 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37643 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37644 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37645 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37646 part must be left empty.
37647
37648 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37649 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37650 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37651 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37652 address.
37653
37654 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37655 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37656 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37657 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37658 indicating support.
37659
37660 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37661
37662 @item hwbreak
37663 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37664 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37665
37666 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37667 apply.
37668
37669 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37670 @item fork
37671 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37672 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37673 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37674 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37675 fork events.
37676
37677 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37678 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37679 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37680 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37681 indicating support.
37682
37683 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37684 @item vfork
37685 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37686 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37687 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37688 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37689 vfork events.
37690
37691 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37692 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37693 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37694 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37695 indicating support.
37696
37697 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37698 @item vforkdone
37699 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37700 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37701 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37702 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37703 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37704
37705 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37706 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37707 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37708 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37709 indicating support.
37710
37711 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37712 @item exec
37713 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37714 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37715 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37716
37717 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37718 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37719 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37720 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37721 indicating support.
37722
37723 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37724 @anchor{thread create event}
37725 @item create
37726 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37727 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37728 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37729 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37730 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
37731 @var{r} part is ignored.
37732
37733 @end table
37734
37735 @item W @var{AA}
37736 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37737 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37738 applicable to certain targets.
37739
37740 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37741 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37742 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37743 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37744 hex strings.
37745
37746 @item X @var{AA}
37747 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37748 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37749
37750 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37751 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37752 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37753 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37754 hex strings.
37755
37756 @anchor{thread exit event}
37757 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37758 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37759
37760 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37761 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37762 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37763 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37764
37765 @item N
37766 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37767 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37768 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37769 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37770 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37771 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37772 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37773 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37774 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37775 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37776 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37777 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37778 support.
37779
37780 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37781 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37782 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37783 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37784 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37785
37786 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37787 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37788 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37789 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37790 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37791 system calls.
37792
37793 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37794 this very system call.
37795
37796 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37797 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37798 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37799 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37800 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37801 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37802
37803 @end table
37804
37805 @node General Query Packets
37806 @section General Query Packets
37807 @cindex remote query requests
37808
37809 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37810 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37811 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37812 sending information to and from the stub.
37813
37814 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37815 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37816 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37817 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37818 conventions:
37819
37820 @itemize @bullet
37821 @item
37822 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37823 @item
37824 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37825 letter.
37826 @item
37827 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37828 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37829 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37830 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37831 @end itemize
37832
37833 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37834 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37835 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37836 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37837 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37838 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37839 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37840 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37841 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37842 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37843 packet.}.
37844
37845 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37846 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
37847 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
37848 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
37849 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
37850
37851 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
37852
37853 @table @samp
37854
37855 @item QAgent:1
37856 @itemx QAgent:0
37857 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
37858 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
37859
37860 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
37861 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
37862 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
37863 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
37864 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
37865 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
37866 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
37867 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
37868 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
37869 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
37870 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
37871
37872 @item qC
37873 @cindex current thread, remote request
37874 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
37875 Return the current thread ID.
37876
37877 Reply:
37878 @table @samp
37879 @item QC @var{thread-id}
37880 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
37881 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37882 @item @r{(anything else)}
37883 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
37884 @end table
37885
37886 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
37887 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
37888 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
37889 @anchor{qCRC packet}
37890 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
37891 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
37892 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
37893 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
37894
37895 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
37896 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
37897 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
37898 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
37899 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
37900 detect trailing zeros.
37901
37902 Reply:
37903 @table @samp
37904 @item E @var{NN}
37905 An error (such as memory fault)
37906 @item C @var{crc32}
37907 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
37908 @end table
37909
37910 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
37911 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
37912 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
37913 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
37914 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
37915 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
37916 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
37917 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
37918 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
37919 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
37920 randomization.
37921
37922 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37923
37924 Reply:
37925 @table @samp
37926 @item OK
37927 The request succeeded.
37928
37929 @item E @var{nn}
37930 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37931
37932 @item @w{}
37933 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
37934 by the stub.
37935 @end table
37936
37937 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37938 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37939 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
37940 address space randomization.
37941
37942 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
37943 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
37944 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
37945 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
37946 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
37947 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
37948 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
37949 inferior using a shell or not.
37950
37951 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
37952 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
37953 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
37954 values are considered an error.
37955
37956 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37957 mode}).
37958
37959 Reply:
37960 @table @samp
37961 @item OK
37962 The request succeeded.
37963
37964 @item E @var{nn}
37965 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37966 @end table
37967
37968 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37969 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37970 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37971 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
37972
37973 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
37974 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
37975
37976 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
37977 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37978 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
37979 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
37980 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
37981 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
37982 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
37983 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
37984 environment}).
37985
37986 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37987 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
37988 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
37989 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
37990 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
37991 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
37992 not be present.
37993
37994 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37995 mode}).
37996
37997 Reply:
37998 @table @samp
37999 @item OK
38000 The request succeeded.
38001 @end table
38002
38003 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38004 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38005 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38006 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38007 inferior.
38008
38009 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
38010 @pxref{set environment}.
38011
38012 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
38013 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
38014 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
38015 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
38016 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
38017 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
38018 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
38019 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
38020
38021 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38022 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
38023
38024 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38025 mode}).
38026
38027 Reply:
38028 @table @samp
38029 @item OK
38030 The request succeeded.
38031 @end table
38032
38033 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38034 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38035 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38036 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38037 inferior.
38038
38039 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
38040 @pxref{unset environment}.
38041
38042 @item QEnvironmentReset
38043 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
38044 @cindex reset environment, remote request
38045 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
38046 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
38047 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
38048 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
38049 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
38050 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
38051 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38052 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
38053 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
38054
38055 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38056 mode}).
38057
38058 Reply:
38059 @table @samp
38060 @item OK
38061 The request succeeded.
38062 @end table
38063
38064 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38065 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38066 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38067 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38068 inferior.
38069
38070 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
38071 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
38072 @cindex set working directory, remote request
38073 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
38074 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
38075 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
38076
38077 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
38078 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
38079 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
38080 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
38081 directory to its original, empty value.
38082
38083 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38084 mode}).
38085
38086 Reply:
38087 @table @samp
38088 @item OK
38089 The request succeeded.
38090 @end table
38091
38092 @item qfThreadInfo
38093 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38094 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38095 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38096 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38097 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38098 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38099 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38100 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38101 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38102 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38103
38104 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38105
38106 Reply:
38107 @table @samp
38108 @item m @var{thread-id}
38109 A single thread ID
38110 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38111 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38112 @item l
38113 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38114 @end table
38115
38116 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38117 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38118 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38119 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38120 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38121 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38122 fields.
38123
38124 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
38125 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
38126 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
38127 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
38128 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
38129
38130 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38131 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38132 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38133 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38134 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38135
38136 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38137 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38138
38139 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38140 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38141 information associated with the variable.)
38142
38143 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38144 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38145 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38146 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38147 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38148 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38149
38150 Reply:
38151 @table @samp
38152 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38153 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38154 local storage requested.
38155
38156 @item E @var{nn}
38157 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38158
38159 @item @w{}
38160 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38161 @end table
38162
38163 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38164 @cindex get thread information block address
38165 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38166 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38167
38168 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38169
38170 Reply:
38171 @table @samp
38172 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38173 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38174 thread information block.
38175
38176 @item E @var{nn}
38177 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38178 address could not be retrieved.
38179
38180 @item @w{}
38181 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38182 @end table
38183
38184 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38185 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38186 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38187 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38188 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38189 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38190 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38191
38192 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38193
38194 Reply:
38195 @table @samp
38196 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38197 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38198 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38199 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38200 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38201 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
38202 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38203 @end table
38204
38205 @item qOffsets
38206 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38207 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38208 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38209 image.
38210
38211 Reply:
38212 @table @samp
38213 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38214 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38215 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38216 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38217 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38218 segments by the supplied offsets.
38219
38220 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38221 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38222 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38223
38224 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38225 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38226 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38227 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38228 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38229 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38230 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38231 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38232 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38233 @end table
38234
38235 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38236 @cindex thread information, remote request
38237 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38238 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38239 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38240 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38241
38242 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38243 (see below).
38244
38245 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38246
38247 @item QNonStop:1
38248 @itemx QNonStop:0
38249 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38250 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38251 @anchor{QNonStop}
38252 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38253 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38254
38255 Reply:
38256 @table @samp
38257 @item OK
38258 The request succeeded.
38259
38260 @item E @var{nn}
38261 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38262
38263 @item @w{}
38264 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38265 the stub.
38266 @end table
38267
38268 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38269 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38270 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38271 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38272
38273 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38274 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38275 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38276 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38277 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38278 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38279 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38280
38281 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38282 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38283 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38284
38285 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38286 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38287 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38288 report the requested syscalls.
38289
38290 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38291 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38292
38293 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38294 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38295 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38296 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38297
38298 Reply:
38299 @table @samp
38300 @item OK
38301 The request succeeded.
38302
38303 @item E @var{nn}
38304 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38305
38306 @item @w{}
38307 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38308 the stub.
38309 @end table
38310
38311 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38312 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38313 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38314 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38315
38316 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38317 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38318 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38319 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38320 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38321 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38322 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38323 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38324 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38325 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38326 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38327 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38328 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38329
38330 Reply:
38331 @table @samp
38332 @item OK
38333 The request succeeded.
38334
38335 @item E @var{nn}
38336 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38337
38338 @item @w{}
38339 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38340 the stub.
38341 @end table
38342
38343 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38344 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38345 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38346 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38347
38348 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38349 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38350 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38351 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38352 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38353 Others should be silently discarded.
38354
38355 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38356 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38357 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38358 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38359 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38360 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38361 signals.
38362
38363 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38364 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38365
38366 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38367 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38368 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38369 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38370 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38371
38372 Reply:
38373 @table @samp
38374 @item OK
38375 The request succeeded.
38376
38377 @item E @var{nn}
38378 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38379
38380 @item @w{}
38381 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38382 by the stub.
38383 @end table
38384
38385 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38386 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38387 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38388 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38389
38390 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38391 @item QThreadEvents:1
38392 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38393 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38394 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38395
38396 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38397 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38398 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38399 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38400 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38401 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38402 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38403 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38404 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38405 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38406
38407 Reply:
38408 @table @samp
38409 @item OK
38410 The request succeeded.
38411
38412 @item E @var{nn}
38413 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38414
38415 @item @w{}
38416 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38417 the stub.
38418 @end table
38419
38420 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38421 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38422
38423 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38424 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38425 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38426 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38427 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38428 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38429 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38430 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38431 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38432
38433 Reply:
38434 @table @samp
38435 @item OK
38436 A command response with no output.
38437 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38438 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38439 @item E @var{NN}
38440 Indicate a badly formed request.
38441 @item @w{}
38442 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38443 @end table
38444
38445 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38446 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38447 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38448 packets.)
38449
38450 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38451 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38452 @ifnotinfo
38453 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38454 @end ifnotinfo
38455 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38456 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38457 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38458 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38459 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38460
38461 Reply:
38462 @table @samp
38463 @item 0
38464 The pattern was not found.
38465 @item 1,address
38466 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38467 @item E @var{NN}
38468 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38469 @item @w{}
38470 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38471 @end table
38472
38473 @item QStartNoAckMode
38474 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38475 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38476 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38477 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38478
38479 Reply:
38480 @table @samp
38481 @item OK
38482 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38483 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38484 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38485 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38486 @item @w{}
38487 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38488 @end table
38489
38490 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38491 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38492 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38493 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38494 @anchor{qSupported}
38495 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38496 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38497 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38498 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38499 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38500 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38501 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38502 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38503 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38504 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38505 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38506 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38507 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38508 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38509
38510 Reply:
38511 @table @samp
38512 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38513 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38514 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38515 possible forms).
38516 @item @w{}
38517 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38518 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38519 @end table
38520
38521 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38522 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38523 are:
38524
38525 @table @samp
38526 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38527 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38528 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38529 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38530 @item @var{name}+
38531 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38532 need an associated value.
38533 @item @var{name}-
38534 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38535 @item @var{name}?
38536 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38537 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38538 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38539 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38540 @end table
38541
38542 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38543 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38544 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38545 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38546 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38547
38548 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38549 are defined:
38550
38551 @table @samp
38552 @item multiprocess
38553 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38554 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38555 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38556 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38557 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38558
38559 @item xmlRegisters
38560 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38561 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38562 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38563 description.
38564
38565 @item qRelocInsn
38566 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38567 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38568 instruction reply packet}).
38569
38570 @item swbreak
38571 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38572 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38573
38574 @item hwbreak
38575 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38576 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38577
38578 @item fork-events
38579 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38580 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38581 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38582 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38583
38584 @item vfork-events
38585 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38586 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38587 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38588 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38589
38590 @item exec-events
38591 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38592 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38593 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38594 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38595
38596 @item vContSupported
38597 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38598 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38599 @end table
38600
38601 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38602 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38603 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38604 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38605 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38606 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38607 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38608 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38609 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38610 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38611 all the features it supports.
38612
38613 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38614 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38615
38616 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38617 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38618 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38619 form response.
38620
38621 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38622 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38623 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38624 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38625
38626 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38627 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38628 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38629 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38630 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38631
38632 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38633
38634 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38635 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38636 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38637 @item Feature Name
38638 @tab Value Required
38639 @tab Default
38640 @tab Probe Allowed
38641
38642 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38643 @tab Yes
38644 @tab @samp{-}
38645 @tab No
38646
38647 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38648 @tab No
38649 @tab @samp{-}
38650 @tab Yes
38651
38652 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38653 @tab No
38654 @tab @samp{-}
38655 @tab Yes
38656
38657 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38658 @tab No
38659 @tab @samp{-}
38660 @tab Yes
38661
38662 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38663 @tab No
38664 @tab @samp{-}
38665 @tab Yes
38666
38667 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38668 @tab No
38669 @tab @samp{-}
38670 @tab Yes
38671
38672 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38673 @tab No
38674 @tab @samp{-}
38675 @tab Yes
38676
38677 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38678 @tab No
38679 @tab @samp{-}
38680 @tab Yes
38681
38682 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38683 @tab No
38684 @tab @samp{-}
38685 @tab No
38686
38687 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38688 @tab No
38689 @tab @samp{-}
38690 @tab Yes
38691
38692 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38693 @tab No
38694 @tab @samp{-}
38695 @tab Yes
38696
38697 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38698 @tab No
38699 @tab @samp{-}
38700 @tab Yes
38701
38702 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38703 @tab No
38704 @tab @samp{-}
38705 @tab Yes
38706
38707 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38708 @tab No
38709 @tab @samp{-}
38710 @tab Yes
38711
38712 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38713 @tab No
38714 @tab @samp{-}
38715 @tab Yes
38716
38717 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38718 @tab No
38719 @tab @samp{-}
38720 @tab Yes
38721
38722 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38723 @tab No
38724 @tab @samp{-}
38725 @tab Yes
38726
38727 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38728 @tab No
38729 @tab @samp{-}
38730 @tab Yes
38731
38732 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38733 @tab No
38734 @tab @samp{-}
38735 @tab Yes
38736
38737 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38738 @tab Yes
38739 @tab @samp{-}
38740 @tab Yes
38741
38742 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38743 @tab Yes
38744 @tab @samp{-}
38745 @tab Yes
38746
38747 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
38748 @tab Yes
38749 @tab @samp{-}
38750 @tab Yes
38751
38752 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38753 @tab Yes
38754 @tab @samp{-}
38755 @tab Yes
38756
38757 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38758 @tab Yes
38759 @tab @samp{-}
38760 @tab Yes
38761
38762 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38763 @tab No
38764 @tab @samp{-}
38765 @tab Yes
38766
38767 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38768 @tab No
38769 @tab @samp{-}
38770 @tab Yes
38771
38772 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38773 @tab No
38774 @tab @samp{-}
38775 @tab Yes
38776
38777 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38778 @tab No
38779 @tab @samp{-}
38780 @tab Yes
38781
38782 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38783 @tab No
38784 @tab @samp{-}
38785 @tab No
38786
38787 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38788 @tab No
38789 @tab @samp{-}
38790 @tab No
38791
38792 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38793 @tab No
38794 @tab @samp{-}
38795 @tab No
38796
38797 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38798 @tab No
38799 @tab @samp{-}
38800 @tab No
38801
38802 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38803 @tab No
38804 @tab @samp{-}
38805 @tab No
38806
38807 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38808 @tab No
38809 @tab @samp{-}
38810 @tab No
38811
38812 @item @samp{QAgent}
38813 @tab No
38814 @tab @samp{-}
38815 @tab No
38816
38817 @item @samp{QAllow}
38818 @tab No
38819 @tab @samp{-}
38820 @tab No
38821
38822 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38823 @tab No
38824 @tab @samp{-}
38825 @tab No
38826
38827 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38828 @tab No
38829 @tab @samp{-}
38830 @tab No
38831
38832 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38833 @tab No
38834 @tab @samp{-}
38835 @tab No
38836
38837 @item @samp{tracenz}
38838 @tab No
38839 @tab @samp{-}
38840 @tab No
38841
38842 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38843 @tab No
38844 @tab @samp{-}
38845 @tab No
38846
38847 @item @samp{swbreak}
38848 @tab No
38849 @tab @samp{-}
38850 @tab No
38851
38852 @item @samp{hwbreak}
38853 @tab No
38854 @tab @samp{-}
38855 @tab No
38856
38857 @item @samp{fork-events}
38858 @tab No
38859 @tab @samp{-}
38860 @tab No
38861
38862 @item @samp{vfork-events}
38863 @tab No
38864 @tab @samp{-}
38865 @tab No
38866
38867 @item @samp{exec-events}
38868 @tab No
38869 @tab @samp{-}
38870 @tab No
38871
38872 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
38873 @tab No
38874 @tab @samp{-}
38875 @tab No
38876
38877 @item @samp{no-resumed}
38878 @tab No
38879 @tab @samp{-}
38880 @tab No
38881
38882 @end multitable
38883
38884 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
38885
38886 @table @samp
38887 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
38888 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
38889 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
38890 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
38891 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
38892 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
38893 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
38894 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
38895 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
38896 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
38897
38898 @item qXfer:auxv:read
38899 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
38900 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
38901
38902 @item qXfer:btrace:read
38903 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38904 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
38905
38906 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
38907 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38908 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
38909
38910 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
38911 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
38912 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
38913
38914 @item qXfer:features:read
38915 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
38916 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
38917
38918 @item qXfer:libraries:read
38919 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
38920 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
38921
38922 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
38923 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38924 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38925
38926 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
38927 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
38928 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38929 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38930
38931 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
38932 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
38933 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
38934
38935 @item qXfer:sdata:read
38936 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
38937 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
38938
38939 @item qXfer:spu:read
38940 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
38941 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
38942
38943 @item qXfer:spu:write
38944 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
38945 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
38946
38947 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
38948 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
38949 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
38950
38951 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
38952 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
38953 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
38954
38955 @item qXfer:threads:read
38956 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38957 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
38958
38959 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
38960 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38961 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
38962
38963 @item qXfer:uib:read
38964 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38965 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
38966
38967 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
38968 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38969 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
38970
38971 @item QNonStop
38972 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
38973 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
38974
38975 @item QCatchSyscalls
38976 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38977 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
38978
38979 @item QPassSignals
38980 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38981 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
38982
38983 @item QStartNoAckMode
38984 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
38985 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
38986
38987 @item multiprocess
38988 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
38989 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
38990 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
38991 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
38992 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
38993 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
38994 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
38995 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
38996 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
38997 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
38998 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
38999
39000 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39001 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39002 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39003
39004 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39005 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39006 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39007 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39008
39009 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39010 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39011 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39012
39013 @item ReverseContinue
39014 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39015 (@pxref{bc}).
39016
39017 @item ReverseStep
39018 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39019 (@pxref{bs}).
39020
39021 @item TracepointSource
39022 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39023 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39024
39025 @item QAgent
39026 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39027
39028 @item QAllow
39029 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39030
39031 @item QDisableRandomization
39032 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39033
39034 @item StaticTracepoint
39035 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39036 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39037
39038 @item InstallInTrace
39039 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39040 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39041
39042 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39043 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39044 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39045 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39046
39047 @item QTBuffer:size
39048 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39049 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39050
39051 @item tracenz
39052 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39053 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39054 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39055
39056 @item BreakpointCommands
39057 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39058 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39059 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39060
39061 @item Qbtrace:off
39062 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39063
39064 @item Qbtrace:bts
39065 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39066
39067 @item Qbtrace:pt
39068 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
39069
39070 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
39071 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
39072
39073 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
39074 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
39075
39076 @item swbreak
39077 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
39078 breakpoints.
39079
39080 @item hwbreak
39081 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
39082 breakpoints.
39083
39084 @item fork-events
39085 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
39086
39087 @item vfork-events
39088 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
39089 and vforkdone events.
39090
39091 @item exec-events
39092 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
39093
39094 @item vContSupported
39095 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
39096 @samp{vCont?} packet.
39097
39098 @item QThreadEvents
39099 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
39100
39101 @item no-resumed
39102 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
39103
39104 @end table
39105
39106 @item qSymbol::
39107 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39108 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39109 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39110 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39111
39112 Reply:
39113 @table @samp
39114 @item OK
39115 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39116 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39117 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39118 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39119 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39120 below.
39121 @end table
39122
39123 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39124 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39125
39126 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39127 target has previously requested.
39128
39129 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39130 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39131 will be empty.
39132
39133 Reply:
39134 @table @samp
39135 @item OK
39136 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39137 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39138 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39139 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39140 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39141 @end table
39142
39143 @item qTBuffer
39144 @itemx QTBuffer
39145 @itemx QTDisconnected
39146 @itemx QTDP
39147 @itemx QTDPsrc
39148 @itemx QTDV
39149 @itemx qTfP
39150 @itemx qTfV
39151 @itemx QTFrame
39152 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39153
39154 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39155
39156 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39157 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39158 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39159 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
39160 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
39161 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
39162 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39163 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39164 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39165 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39166 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39167
39168 Reply:
39169 @table @samp
39170 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39171 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39172 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39173 the thread's attributes.
39174 @end table
39175
39176 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39177 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39178 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39179 packets.)
39180
39181 @item QTNotes
39182 @itemx qTP
39183 @itemx QTSave
39184 @itemx qTsP
39185 @itemx qTsV
39186 @itemx QTStart
39187 @itemx QTStop
39188 @itemx QTEnable
39189 @itemx QTDisable
39190 @itemx QTinit
39191 @itemx QTro
39192 @itemx qTStatus
39193 @itemx qTV
39194 @itemx qTfSTM
39195 @itemx qTsSTM
39196 @itemx qTSTMat
39197 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39198
39199 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39200 @cindex read special object, remote request
39201 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39202 @anchor{qXfer read}
39203 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39204 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39205 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39206 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39207 additional details about what data to access.
39208
39209 Reply:
39210 @table @samp
39211 @item m @var{data}
39212 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39213 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39214 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39215 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39216 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39217 request.
39218
39219 @item l @var{data}
39220 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39221 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39222 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39223
39224 @item l
39225 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39226 There is no more data to be read.
39227
39228 @item E00
39229 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39230
39231 @item E @var{nn}
39232 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39233 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39234
39235 @item @w{}
39236 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39237 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39238 @end table
39239
39240 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39241 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39242 formats, listed above.
39243
39244 @table @samp
39245 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39246 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39247 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39248 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39249
39250 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39251 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39252
39253 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39254 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39255
39256 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39257 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39258 packet may have one of the following values:
39259
39260 @table @code
39261 @item all
39262 Returns all available branch trace.
39263
39264 @item new
39265 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39266 the last read request.
39267
39268 @item delta
39269 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39270 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39271 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39272 used to stitch traces together.
39273
39274 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39275 @end table
39276
39277 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39278 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39279
39280 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39281 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39282
39283 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39284 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39285
39286 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39287 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39288
39289 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39290 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39291 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39292 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39293 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39294 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39295 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39296
39297 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39298 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39299
39300 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39301 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39302 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39303 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39304 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39305
39306 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39307 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39308
39309 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39310 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39311 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39312 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39313 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39314
39315 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39316 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39317 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39318
39319 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39320 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39321
39322 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39323 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39324 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39325 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39326 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39327 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39328 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39329 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39330
39331 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39332 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39333
39334 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39335 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39336
39337 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39338 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39339 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39340 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39341
39342 @table @code
39343 @item start=@var{address}
39344 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39345 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39346 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39347 chosen as the starting point.
39348
39349 @item prev=@var{address}
39350 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39351 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39352 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39353 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39354 exists prior to the starting point.
39355
39356 @end table
39357
39358 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39359 ignored.
39360
39361 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39362 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39363 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39364 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39365 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39366
39367 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39368 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39369
39370 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39371 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39372
39373 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39374 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39375 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39376 Action Lists}.
39377
39378 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39379 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39380 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39381
39382 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39383 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39384 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39385 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39386 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39387
39388 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39389 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39390 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39391
39392 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39393 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39394 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39395 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39396 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39397 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39398 in that context to be accessed.
39399
39400 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39401 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39402 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39403
39404 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39405 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39406 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39407 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39408 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39409
39410 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39411 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39412
39413 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39414 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39415
39416 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39417 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39418 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39419
39420 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39421 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39422
39423 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39424 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39425
39426 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39427 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39428
39429 This packet is not probed by default.
39430
39431 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39432 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39433 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39434 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39435 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39436
39437 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39438 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39439
39440 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39441 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39442 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39443 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39444
39445 @end table
39446
39447 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39448 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39449 @anchor{qXfer write}
39450 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39451 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39452 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39453 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39454 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39455 to access.
39456
39457 Reply:
39458 @table @samp
39459 @item @var{nn}
39460 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39461 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39462
39463 @item E00
39464 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39465
39466 @item E @var{nn}
39467 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39468 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39469
39470 @item @w{}
39471 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39472 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39473 @end table
39474
39475 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39476 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39477 formats, listed above.
39478
39479 @table @samp
39480 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39481 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39482 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39483 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39484 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39485
39486 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39487 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39488 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39489
39490 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39491 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39492 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39493 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39494 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39495 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39496 in that context to be accessed.
39497
39498 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39499 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39500 @end table
39501
39502 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39503 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39504 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39505 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39506 must respond with an empty packet.
39507
39508 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39509 @cindex query attached, remote request
39510 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39511 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39512 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39513 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39514 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39515 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39516 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39517
39518 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39519 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39520 the @code{quit} command.
39521
39522 Reply:
39523 @table @samp
39524 @item 1
39525 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39526 @item 0
39527 The remote server created a new process.
39528 @item E @var{NN}
39529 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39530 @end table
39531
39532 @item Qbtrace:bts
39533 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39534
39535 Reply:
39536 @table @samp
39537 @item OK
39538 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39539 @item E.errtext
39540 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39541 @end table
39542
39543 @item Qbtrace:pt
39544 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39545
39546 Reply:
39547 @table @samp
39548 @item OK
39549 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39550 @item E.errtext
39551 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39552 @end table
39553
39554 @item Qbtrace:off
39555 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39556
39557 Reply:
39558 @table @samp
39559 @item OK
39560 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39561 @item E.errtext
39562 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39563 @end table
39564
39565 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39566 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39567 btrace recording method in bts format.
39568
39569 Reply:
39570 @table @samp
39571 @item OK
39572 The ring buffer size has been set.
39573 @item E.errtext
39574 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39575 @end table
39576
39577 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39578 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39579 btrace recording method in pt format.
39580
39581 Reply:
39582 @table @samp
39583 @item OK
39584 The ring buffer size has been set.
39585 @item E.errtext
39586 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39587 @end table
39588
39589 @end table
39590
39591 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39592 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39593
39594 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39595 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39596 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39597
39598 @menu
39599 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39600 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39601 @end menu
39602
39603 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39604 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39605
39606 @menu
39607 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39608 @end menu
39609
39610 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39611 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39612 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39613
39614 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39615
39616 @table @r
39617
39618 @item 2
39619 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39620
39621 @item 3
39622 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39623
39624 @item 4
39625 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39626
39627 @end table
39628
39629 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39630 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39631
39632 @menu
39633 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39634 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39635 @end menu
39636
39637 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39638 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39639 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39640
39641 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39642 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39643 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39644 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39645 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39646 most-significant -- least-significant.
39647
39648 @table @r
39649
39650 @item MIPS32
39651 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39652 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39653 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39654
39655 @item MIPS64
39656 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39657 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39658 as @code{MIPS32}.
39659
39660 @end table
39661
39662 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39663 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39664 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39665
39666 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39667
39668 @table @r
39669
39670 @item 2
39671 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39672
39673 @item 3
39674 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39675
39676 @item 4
39677 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39678
39679 @item 5
39680 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39681
39682 @end table
39683
39684 @node Tracepoint Packets
39685 @section Tracepoint Packets
39686 @cindex tracepoint packets
39687 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39688
39689 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39690 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39691
39692 @table @samp
39693
39694 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39695 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39696 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39697 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39698 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39699 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39700 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39701 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39702 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39703 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39704 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39705 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39706 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39707 actions.
39708
39709 Replies:
39710 @table @samp
39711 @item OK
39712 The packet was understood and carried out.
39713 @item qRelocInsn
39714 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39715 @item @w{}
39716 The packet was not recognized.
39717 @end table
39718
39719 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39720 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39721 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39722 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39723 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39724 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39725 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39726
39727 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39728 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39729 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39730 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39731 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39732 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39733 tracepoint actions.
39734
39735 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39736 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39737 following forms:
39738
39739 @table @samp
39740
39741 @item R @var{mask}
39742 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
39743 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39744 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39745 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39746 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39747
39748 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39749 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39750 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39751 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39752 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39753 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39754 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39755
39756 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39757 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39758 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39759 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39760 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39761 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39762 packet).
39763
39764 @end table
39765
39766 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39767 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39768 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39769 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39770 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39771 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39772 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39773 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39774
39775 Replies:
39776 @table @samp
39777 @item OK
39778 The packet was understood and carried out.
39779 @item qRelocInsn
39780 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39781 @item @w{}
39782 The packet was not recognized.
39783 @end table
39784
39785 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39786 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39787 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39788 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39789 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39790 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39791 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39792 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39793
39794 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39795 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39796 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39797 fit in a single packet.
39798 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39799 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39800
39801 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39802 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39803 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39804 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39805
39806 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39807 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39808 query packets.
39809
39810 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39811 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39812 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39813 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39814 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39815 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39816 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39817 be found.
39818
39819 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39820 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39821 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39822 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39823 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39824 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39825 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39826 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39827 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39828 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39829 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39830 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39831 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39832 variable.
39833
39834 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39835 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39836 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39837 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39838 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39839
39840 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39841 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39842 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39843 one of the following forms:
39844
39845 @table @samp
39846 @item F @var{f}
39847 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
39848 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
39849 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
39850
39851 @item T @var{t}
39852 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
39853 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
39854
39855 @end table
39856
39857 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
39858 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39859 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
39860 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
39861
39862 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
39863 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39864 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
39865 is a hexadecimal number.
39866
39867 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
39868 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39869 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
39870 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
39871 numbers.
39872
39873 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
39874 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
39875 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
39876
39877 @item qTMinFTPILen
39878 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
39879 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
39880 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
39881 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
39882 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
39883 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
39884 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
39885 arrange for that.
39886
39887 Replies:
39888
39889 @table @samp
39890 @item 0
39891 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
39892 @item @var{length}
39893 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
39894 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
39895 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
39896 regardless of size.
39897 @item E
39898 An error has occurred.
39899 @item @w{}
39900 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
39901 @end table
39902
39903 @item QTStart
39904 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
39905 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
39906 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
39907 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39908 instruction reply packet}).
39909
39910 @item QTStop
39911 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
39912 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
39913
39914 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39915 @anchor{QTEnable}
39916 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
39917 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39918 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
39919 of data from it will resume.
39920
39921 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39922 @anchor{QTDisable}
39923 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
39924 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39925 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
39926 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
39927
39928 @item QTinit
39929 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
39930 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
39931
39932 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
39933 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
39934 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
39935 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
39936 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
39937
39938 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
39939 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
39940 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
39941 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
39942
39943 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
39944 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
39945 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
39946 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
39947 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
39948 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
39949
39950 @item qTStatus
39951 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
39952 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
39953
39954 The reply has the form:
39955
39956 @table @samp
39957
39958 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
39959 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
39960 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
39961 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
39962
39963 @end table
39964
39965 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
39966 explanations as one of the optional fields:
39967
39968 @table @samp
39969
39970 @item tnotrun:0
39971 No trace has been run yet.
39972
39973 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
39974 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
39975 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
39976 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
39977 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
39978
39979 @item tfull:0
39980 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
39981
39982 @item tdisconnected:0
39983 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
39984
39985 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
39986 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
39987
39988 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
39989 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
39990 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
39991 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
39992 is hex encoded.
39993
39994 @item tunknown:0
39995 The trace stopped for some other reason.
39996
39997 @end table
39998
39999 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40000 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40001 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40002 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40003 trace.
40004
40005 @table @samp
40006
40007 @item tframes:@var{n}
40008 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40009
40010 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40011 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40012 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40013
40014 @item tsize:@var{n}
40015 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40016
40017 @item tfree:@var{n}
40018 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40019
40020 @item circular:@var{n}
40021 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40022 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40023 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40024 and may fill up.
40025
40026 @item disconn:@var{n}
40027 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40028 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40029 that the trace run will stop.
40030
40031 @end table
40032
40033 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40034 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40035 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40036 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40037 address @var{addr}.
40038
40039 Replies:
40040 @table @samp
40041 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40042 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40043 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40044 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40045 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40046
40047 @end table
40048
40049 @item qTV:@var{var}
40050 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40051 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40052 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40053
40054 Replies:
40055 @table @samp
40056 @item V@var{value}
40057 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40058 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40059 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40060 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40061 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40062 program is running.
40063
40064 @item U
40065 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40066 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40067 was not collected.
40068 @end table
40069
40070 @item qTfP
40071 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40072 @itemx qTsP
40073 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40074 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40075 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40076 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40077 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40078 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40079
40080 @item qTfV
40081 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40082 @itemx qTsV
40083 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40084 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40085 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40086 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40087 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40088 trace state variables.
40089
40090 @item qTfSTM
40091 @itemx qTsSTM
40092 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40093 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40094 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40095 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40096 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40097 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40098 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40099 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40100
40101 Reply:
40102 @table @samp
40103 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40104 A single marker
40105 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40106 a comma-separated list of markers
40107 @item l
40108 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40109 @item E @var{nn}
40110 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40111 @item @w{}
40112 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40113 stub.
40114 @end table
40115
40116 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
40117 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40118
40119 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40120 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40121 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40122 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40123 @dfn{last}).
40124
40125 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40126 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40127 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40128 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40129 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40130 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40131 tracepoint markers.
40132
40133 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40134 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40135 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40136 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
40137 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40138 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40139
40140 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40141 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40142 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40143 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40144 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40145 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40146 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40147 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40148 available.
40149
40150 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40151 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40152 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40153
40154 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40155 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40156 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40157 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40158 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40159 use whatever size it prefers.
40160
40161 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40162 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40163 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40164 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40165 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40166
40167 @end table
40168
40169 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40170 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40171 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40172 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40173 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40174 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40175 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40176 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40177 it had executed in the original location.
40178
40179 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40180 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40181 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40182 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40183 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40184 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40185 format of the request is:
40186
40187 @table @samp
40188 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40189
40190 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40191 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40192 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40193 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40194 memory starting at @var{to}.
40195 @end table
40196
40197 Replies:
40198 @table @samp
40199 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40200 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
40201 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40202 @item E @var{NN}
40203 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40204 relocating the instruction.
40205 @end table
40206
40207 @node Host I/O Packets
40208 @section Host I/O Packets
40209 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40210 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40211
40212 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40213 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40214 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40215 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40216 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40217 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40218 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40219 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40220 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40221 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40222
40223 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40224 its arguments. They have this format:
40225
40226 @table @samp
40227
40228 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40229 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40230 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40231 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40232 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40233 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40234 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40235 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40236 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40237
40238 @end table
40239
40240 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40241
40242 @table @samp
40243
40244 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40245 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40246 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40247 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40248 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40249 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40250 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40251 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40252 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40253 @var{attachment}.
40254
40255 @item @w{}
40256 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40257
40258 @end table
40259
40260 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40261
40262 @table @samp
40263 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40264 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40265 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40266 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40267 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40268 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40269 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40270
40271 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40272 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40273 -1 if an error occurs.
40274
40275 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40276 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40277 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40278 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40279 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40280 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40281 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40282 @var{count} was zero.
40283
40284 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40285 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40286 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40287 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40288 some characters were escaped.
40289
40290 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40291 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40292 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40293 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40294 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40295 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40296 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40297 error occurred.
40298
40299 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40300 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40301 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40302 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40303 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40304 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40305
40306 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40307 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40308 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40309
40310 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40311 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40312 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40313
40314 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40315 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40316 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40317 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40318 some characters were escaped.
40319
40320 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40321 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40322 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40323 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40324 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40325 inferior(s).
40326
40327 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40328 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40329 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40330 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40331 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40332 operation.
40333
40334 @end table
40335
40336 @node Interrupts
40337 @section Interrupts
40338 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40339 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40340
40341 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40342 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40343 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40344 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40345
40346 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40347 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40348 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40349 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40350 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40351
40352 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40353 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40354 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40355 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40356 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40357 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40358 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40359 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40360
40361 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40362 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40363 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40364
40365 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40366 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40367 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40368 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40369 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40370 @code{0x03}.
40371
40372 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40373 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40374 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40375 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40376 currently-executing threads and processes.
40377 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40378 running program, it should send one of the stop
40379 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40380 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40381 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40382 Interrupts received while the
40383 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40384 it is resumed next time.
40385
40386 @node Notification Packets
40387 @section Notification Packets
40388 @cindex notification packets
40389 @cindex packets, notification
40390
40391 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40392 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40393 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40394 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40395 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40396 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40397 is not a problem.
40398
40399 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40400 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40401 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40402 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40403 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40404 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40405 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40406
40407 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40408 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40409
40410 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40411 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40412 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40413 not they understand it.
40414
40415 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40416 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40417 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40418 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40419 recipients.
40420
40421 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40422 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40423 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40424 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40425 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40426
40427 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40428 @table @samp
40429 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40430 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40431 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40432 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40433 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40434 @item @var{ack}
40435 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40436 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40437 @end table
40438
40439 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40440 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40441
40442 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40443 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40444 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40445 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40446 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40447 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40448 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40449 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40450 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40451 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40452
40453 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40454 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40455 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40456 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40457 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40458 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40459
40460 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40461 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40462 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40463 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40464 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40465
40466 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40467 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40468 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40469 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40470 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40471 normally.
40472
40473 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40474 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40475 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40476 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40477 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40478 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40479 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40480 the process shall be repeated.
40481
40482 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40483 following example:
40484 @smallexample
40485 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40486 @code{...}
40487 -> @code{vStopped}
40488 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40489 -> @code{vStopped}
40490 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40491 -> @code{vStopped}
40492 <- @code{OK}
40493 @end smallexample
40494
40495 The following notifications are defined:
40496 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40497
40498 @item Notification
40499 @tab Ack
40500 @tab Event
40501 @tab Description
40502
40503 @item Stop
40504 @tab vStopped
40505 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40506 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40507 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40508 @value{GDBN}.
40509 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40510
40511 @end multitable
40512
40513 @node Remote Non-Stop
40514 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40515
40516 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40517 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40518 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40519 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40520
40521 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40522 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40523 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40524 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40525 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40526 probe the target state after a mode change.
40527
40528 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40529 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40530 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40531 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40532 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40533 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40534 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40535 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40536 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40537 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40538 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40539
40540 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40541 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40542 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40543 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40544 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40545 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40546 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40547 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40548 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40549 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40550 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40551 @samp{OK}.
40552
40553 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40554 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40555 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40556 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40557 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40558 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40559 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40560 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40561 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40562 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40563 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40564 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40565 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40566
40567 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40568 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40569
40570 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40571 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40572 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40573 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40574 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40575 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40576 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40577
40578 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40579 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40580 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40581 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40582 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40583
40584 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40585 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40586 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40587 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40588
40589 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40590 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40591 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40592 @pxref{qSupported}.
40593 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40594 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40595 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40596 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40597 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40598 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40599 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40600
40601 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40602 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40603 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40604 connection.
40605 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40606 new connection is established,
40607 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40608 for the current connection, once disabled.
40609
40610 @node Examples
40611 @section Examples
40612
40613 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40614 does not get any direct output:
40615
40616 @smallexample
40617 -> @code{R00}
40618 <- @code{+}
40619 @emph{target restarts}
40620 -> @code{?}
40621 <- @code{+}
40622 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40623 -> @code{+}
40624 @end smallexample
40625
40626 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40627
40628 @smallexample
40629 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40630 <- @code{+}
40631 -> @code{s}
40632 <- @code{+}
40633 @emph{time passes}
40634 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40635 -> @code{+}
40636 -> @code{g}
40637 <- @code{+}
40638 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40639 -> @code{+}
40640 @end smallexample
40641
40642 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40643 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40644 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40645
40646 @menu
40647 * File-I/O Overview::
40648 * Protocol Basics::
40649 * The F Request Packet::
40650 * The F Reply Packet::
40651 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40652 * Console I/O::
40653 * List of Supported Calls::
40654 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40655 * Constants::
40656 * File-I/O Examples::
40657 @end menu
40658
40659 @node File-I/O Overview
40660 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40661 @cindex file-i/o overview
40662
40663 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40664 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40665 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40666 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40667 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40668 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40669
40670 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40671 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40672 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40673 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40674 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40675
40676 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40677 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40678 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40679 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40680 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40681 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40682 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40683
40684 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40685 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40686 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40687 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40688 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40689
40690 @smallexample
40691 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40692 <- target requests 'system call X'
40693 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40694 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40695 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40696 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40697 @end smallexample
40698
40699 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40700 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40701 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40702 system are not supported by this protocol.
40703
40704 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40705
40706 @node Protocol Basics
40707 @subsection Protocol Basics
40708 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40709
40710 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40711 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40712 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40713 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40714 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40715 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40716 to call the appropriate host system call:
40717
40718 @itemize @bullet
40719 @item
40720 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40721
40722 @item
40723 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40724 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40725 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40726 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40727
40728 @end itemize
40729
40730 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40731
40732 @itemize @bullet
40733 @item
40734 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40735 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40736 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40737 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40738 packet.
40739
40740 @item
40741 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40742 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40743
40744 @item
40745 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40746
40747 @item
40748 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40749
40750 @item
40751 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40752 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40753 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40754 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40755 packet.
40756
40757 @end itemize
40758
40759 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40760 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40761
40762 @itemize @bullet
40763 @item
40764 Return value.
40765
40766 @item
40767 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40768
40769 @item
40770 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40771
40772 @end itemize
40773
40774 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40775 the latest continue or step action.
40776
40777 @node The F Request Packet
40778 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40779 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40780 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40781
40782 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40783
40784 @table @samp
40785 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40786
40787 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40788 This is just the name of the function.
40789
40790 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40791 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40792 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40793 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40794 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40795 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40796 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40797
40798 @end table
40799
40800
40801
40802 @node The F Reply Packet
40803 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40804 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40805 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40806
40807 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40808
40809 @table @samp
40810
40811 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40812
40813 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40814
40815 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40816 representation.
40817 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40818
40819 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40820 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40821 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40822
40823 @smallexample
40824 F0,0,C
40825 @end smallexample
40826
40827 @noindent
40828 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40829
40830 @smallexample
40831 F-1,4,C
40832 @end smallexample
40833
40834 @noindent
40835 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40836
40837 @end table
40838
40839
40840 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40841 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40842 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40843
40844 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40845 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40846 the target should behave as if it had
40847 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
40848 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
40849 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
40850 packet.
40851
40852 It's important for the target to know in which
40853 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
40854
40855 @itemize @bullet
40856 @item
40857 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
40858
40859 @item
40860 The system call on the host has been finished.
40861
40862 @end itemize
40863
40864 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
40865 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
40866 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
40867 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
40868 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
40869 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
40870
40871 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
40872 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
40873 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
40874 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
40875 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
40876 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
40877 or the full action has been completed.
40878
40879 @node Console I/O
40880 @subsection Console I/O
40881 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
40882
40883 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
40884 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
40885 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
40886 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
40887 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
40888 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
40889 conditions is met:
40890
40891 @itemize @bullet
40892 @item
40893 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
40894 @code{read}
40895 system call is treated as finished.
40896
40897 @item
40898 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
40899 newline.
40900
40901 @item
40902 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
40903 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
40904
40905 @end itemize
40906
40907 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
40908 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
40909 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
40910 is stopped at the user's request.
40911
40912
40913 @node List of Supported Calls
40914 @subsection List of Supported Calls
40915 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
40916
40917 @menu
40918 * open::
40919 * close::
40920 * read::
40921 * write::
40922 * lseek::
40923 * rename::
40924 * unlink::
40925 * stat/fstat::
40926 * gettimeofday::
40927 * isatty::
40928 * system::
40929 @end menu
40930
40931 @node open
40932 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
40933 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
40934
40935 @table @asis
40936 @item Synopsis:
40937 @smallexample
40938 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
40939 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
40940 @end smallexample
40941
40942 @item Request:
40943 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
40944
40945 @noindent
40946 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40947
40948 @table @code
40949 @item O_CREAT
40950 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
40951 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
40952 are concerned.
40953
40954 @item O_EXCL
40955 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
40956 an error and open() fails.
40957
40958 @item O_TRUNC
40959 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
40960 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
40961 truncated to zero length.
40962
40963 @item O_APPEND
40964 The file is opened in append mode.
40965
40966 @item O_RDONLY
40967 The file is opened for reading only.
40968
40969 @item O_WRONLY
40970 The file is opened for writing only.
40971
40972 @item O_RDWR
40973 The file is opened for reading and writing.
40974 @end table
40975
40976 @noindent
40977 Other bits are silently ignored.
40978
40979
40980 @noindent
40981 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40982
40983 @table @code
40984 @item S_IRUSR
40985 User has read permission.
40986
40987 @item S_IWUSR
40988 User has write permission.
40989
40990 @item S_IRGRP
40991 Group has read permission.
40992
40993 @item S_IWGRP
40994 Group has write permission.
40995
40996 @item S_IROTH
40997 Others have read permission.
40998
40999 @item S_IWOTH
41000 Others have write permission.
41001 @end table
41002
41003 @noindent
41004 Other bits are silently ignored.
41005
41006
41007 @item Return value:
41008 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41009 occurred.
41010
41011 @item Errors:
41012
41013 @table @code
41014 @item EEXIST
41015 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41016
41017 @item EISDIR
41018 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41019
41020 @item EACCES
41021 The requested access is not allowed.
41022
41023 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41024 @var{pathname} was too long.
41025
41026 @item ENOENT
41027 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41028
41029 @item ENODEV
41030 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41031
41032 @item EROFS
41033 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41034 write access was requested.
41035
41036 @item EFAULT
41037 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41038
41039 @item ENOSPC
41040 No space on device to create the file.
41041
41042 @item EMFILE
41043 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41044
41045 @item ENFILE
41046 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41047 has been reached.
41048
41049 @item EINTR
41050 The call was interrupted by the user.
41051 @end table
41052
41053 @end table
41054
41055 @node close
41056 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41057 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41058
41059 @table @asis
41060 @item Synopsis:
41061 @smallexample
41062 int close(int fd);
41063 @end smallexample
41064
41065 @item Request:
41066 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41067
41068 @item Return value:
41069 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41070
41071 @item Errors:
41072
41073 @table @code
41074 @item EBADF
41075 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41076
41077 @item EINTR
41078 The call was interrupted by the user.
41079 @end table
41080
41081 @end table
41082
41083 @node read
41084 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41085 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41086
41087 @table @asis
41088 @item Synopsis:
41089 @smallexample
41090 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41091 @end smallexample
41092
41093 @item Request:
41094 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41095
41096 @item Return value:
41097 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41098 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41099 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41100
41101 @item Errors:
41102
41103 @table @code
41104 @item EBADF
41105 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41106 reading.
41107
41108 @item EFAULT
41109 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41110
41111 @item EINTR
41112 The call was interrupted by the user.
41113 @end table
41114
41115 @end table
41116
41117 @node write
41118 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41119 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41120
41121 @table @asis
41122 @item Synopsis:
41123 @smallexample
41124 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41125 @end smallexample
41126
41127 @item Request:
41128 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41129
41130 @item Return value:
41131 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41132 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41133 is returned.
41134
41135 @item Errors:
41136
41137 @table @code
41138 @item EBADF
41139 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41140 writing.
41141
41142 @item EFAULT
41143 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41144
41145 @item EFBIG
41146 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41147 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41148
41149 @item ENOSPC
41150 No space on device to write the data.
41151
41152 @item EINTR
41153 The call was interrupted by the user.
41154 @end table
41155
41156 @end table
41157
41158 @node lseek
41159 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41160 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41161
41162 @table @asis
41163 @item Synopsis:
41164 @smallexample
41165 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41166 @end smallexample
41167
41168 @item Request:
41169 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41170
41171 @var{flag} is one of:
41172
41173 @table @code
41174 @item SEEK_SET
41175 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41176
41177 @item SEEK_CUR
41178 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41179 bytes.
41180
41181 @item SEEK_END
41182 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41183 bytes.
41184 @end table
41185
41186 @item Return value:
41187 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41188 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41189 value of -1 is returned.
41190
41191 @item Errors:
41192
41193 @table @code
41194 @item EBADF
41195 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41196
41197 @item ESPIPE
41198 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41199
41200 @item EINVAL
41201 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41202
41203 @item EINTR
41204 The call was interrupted by the user.
41205 @end table
41206
41207 @end table
41208
41209 @node rename
41210 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41211 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41212
41213 @table @asis
41214 @item Synopsis:
41215 @smallexample
41216 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41217 @end smallexample
41218
41219 @item Request:
41220 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41221
41222 @item Return value:
41223 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41224
41225 @item Errors:
41226
41227 @table @code
41228 @item EISDIR
41229 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41230 directory.
41231
41232 @item EEXIST
41233 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41234
41235 @item EBUSY
41236 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41237 process.
41238
41239 @item EINVAL
41240 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41241 of itself.
41242
41243 @item ENOTDIR
41244 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41245 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41246 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41247
41248 @item EFAULT
41249 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41250
41251 @item EACCES
41252 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41253
41254 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41255
41256 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41257
41258 @item ENOENT
41259 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41260
41261 @item EROFS
41262 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41263
41264 @item ENOSPC
41265 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41266 directory entry.
41267
41268 @item EINTR
41269 The call was interrupted by the user.
41270 @end table
41271
41272 @end table
41273
41274 @node unlink
41275 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41276 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41277
41278 @table @asis
41279 @item Synopsis:
41280 @smallexample
41281 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41282 @end smallexample
41283
41284 @item Request:
41285 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41286
41287 @item Return value:
41288 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41289
41290 @item Errors:
41291
41292 @table @code
41293 @item EACCES
41294 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41295
41296 @item EPERM
41297 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41298
41299 @item EBUSY
41300 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41301 being used by another process.
41302
41303 @item EFAULT
41304 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41305
41306 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41307 @var{pathname} was too long.
41308
41309 @item ENOENT
41310 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41311
41312 @item ENOTDIR
41313 A component of the path is not a directory.
41314
41315 @item EROFS
41316 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41317
41318 @item EINTR
41319 The call was interrupted by the user.
41320 @end table
41321
41322 @end table
41323
41324 @node stat/fstat
41325 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41326 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41327 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41328
41329 @table @asis
41330 @item Synopsis:
41331 @smallexample
41332 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41333 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41334 @end smallexample
41335
41336 @item Request:
41337 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41338 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41339
41340 @item Return value:
41341 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41342
41343 @item Errors:
41344
41345 @table @code
41346 @item EBADF
41347 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41348
41349 @item ENOENT
41350 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41351 path is an empty string.
41352
41353 @item ENOTDIR
41354 A component of the path is not a directory.
41355
41356 @item EFAULT
41357 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41358
41359 @item EACCES
41360 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41361
41362 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41363 @var{pathname} was too long.
41364
41365 @item EINTR
41366 The call was interrupted by the user.
41367 @end table
41368
41369 @end table
41370
41371 @node gettimeofday
41372 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41373 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41374
41375 @table @asis
41376 @item Synopsis:
41377 @smallexample
41378 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41379 @end smallexample
41380
41381 @item Request:
41382 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41383
41384 @item Return value:
41385 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41386
41387 @item Errors:
41388
41389 @table @code
41390 @item EINVAL
41391 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41392
41393 @item EFAULT
41394 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41395 @end table
41396
41397 @end table
41398
41399 @node isatty
41400 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41401 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41402
41403 @table @asis
41404 @item Synopsis:
41405 @smallexample
41406 int isatty(int fd);
41407 @end smallexample
41408
41409 @item Request:
41410 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41411
41412 @item Return value:
41413 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41414
41415 @item Errors:
41416
41417 @table @code
41418 @item EINTR
41419 The call was interrupted by the user.
41420 @end table
41421
41422 @end table
41423
41424 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41425 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41426 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41427 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41428 needed.
41429
41430
41431 @node system
41432 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41433 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41434
41435 @table @asis
41436 @item Synopsis:
41437 @smallexample
41438 int system(const char *command);
41439 @end smallexample
41440
41441 @item Request:
41442 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41443
41444 @item Return value:
41445 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41446 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41447 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41448 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41449 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41450 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41451 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41452
41453 @item Errors:
41454
41455 @table @code
41456 @item EINTR
41457 The call was interrupted by the user.
41458 @end table
41459
41460 @end table
41461
41462 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41463 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41464 the host is simplified before it's returned
41465 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41466 is discarded, and the return value consists
41467 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41468
41469 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41470 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41471 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41472
41473 @table @code
41474 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41475 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41476 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41477 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41478
41479 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41480 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41481 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41482 protocol.
41483 @end table
41484
41485 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41486 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41487 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41488
41489 @menu
41490 * Integral Datatypes::
41491 * Pointer Values::
41492 * Memory Transfer::
41493 * struct stat::
41494 * struct timeval::
41495 @end menu
41496
41497 @node Integral Datatypes
41498 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41499 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41500
41501 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41502 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41503 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41504
41505 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41506 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41507
41508 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41509
41510 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41511 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41512
41513 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41514
41515 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41516 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41517 byte order.
41518
41519 @node Pointer Values
41520 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41521 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41522
41523 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41524 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41525 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41526 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41527
41528 @smallexample
41529 @code{1aaf/12}
41530 @end smallexample
41531
41532 @noindent
41533 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41534 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41535 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41536 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41537
41538 @smallexample
41539 @code{123456/d}
41540 @end smallexample
41541
41542 @node Memory Transfer
41543 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41544 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41545
41546 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41547 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41548 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41549 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41550 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41551 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41552 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41553
41554
41555 @node struct stat
41556 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41557 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41558
41559 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41560 is defined as follows:
41561
41562 @smallexample
41563 struct stat @{
41564 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41565 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41566 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41567 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41568 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41569 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41570 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41571 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41572 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41573 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41574 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41575 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41576 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41577 @};
41578 @end smallexample
41579
41580 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41581 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41582 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41583
41584 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41585 range of values.
41586
41587 @table @code
41588
41589 @item st_dev
41590 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41591
41592 @item st_ino
41593 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41594
41595 @item st_mode
41596 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41597 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41598
41599 @item st_uid
41600 @itemx st_gid
41601 @itemx st_rdev
41602 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41603
41604 @item st_atime
41605 @itemx st_mtime
41606 @itemx st_ctime
41607 These values have a host and file system dependent
41608 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41609 support exact timing values.
41610 @end table
41611
41612 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41613 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41614 continuing.
41615
41616 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41617 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41618 get truncated on the target.
41619
41620 @node struct timeval
41621 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41622 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41623
41624 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41625 is defined as follows:
41626
41627 @smallexample
41628 struct timeval @{
41629 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41630 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41631 @};
41632 @end smallexample
41633
41634 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41635 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41636 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41637
41638 @node Constants
41639 @subsection Constants
41640 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41641
41642 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41643 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41644 values before and after the call as needed.
41645
41646 @menu
41647 * Open Flags::
41648 * mode_t Values::
41649 * Errno Values::
41650 * Lseek Flags::
41651 * Limits::
41652 @end menu
41653
41654 @node Open Flags
41655 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41656 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41657
41658 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41659
41660 @smallexample
41661 O_RDONLY 0x0
41662 O_WRONLY 0x1
41663 O_RDWR 0x2
41664 O_APPEND 0x8
41665 O_CREAT 0x200
41666 O_TRUNC 0x400
41667 O_EXCL 0x800
41668 @end smallexample
41669
41670 @node mode_t Values
41671 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41672 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41673
41674 All values are given in octal representation.
41675
41676 @smallexample
41677 S_IFREG 0100000
41678 S_IFDIR 040000
41679 S_IRUSR 0400
41680 S_IWUSR 0200
41681 S_IXUSR 0100
41682 S_IRGRP 040
41683 S_IWGRP 020
41684 S_IXGRP 010
41685 S_IROTH 04
41686 S_IWOTH 02
41687 S_IXOTH 01
41688 @end smallexample
41689
41690 @node Errno Values
41691 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41692 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41693
41694 All values are given in decimal representation.
41695
41696 @smallexample
41697 EPERM 1
41698 ENOENT 2
41699 EINTR 4
41700 EBADF 9
41701 EACCES 13
41702 EFAULT 14
41703 EBUSY 16
41704 EEXIST 17
41705 ENODEV 19
41706 ENOTDIR 20
41707 EISDIR 21
41708 EINVAL 22
41709 ENFILE 23
41710 EMFILE 24
41711 EFBIG 27
41712 ENOSPC 28
41713 ESPIPE 29
41714 EROFS 30
41715 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41716 EUNKNOWN 9999
41717 @end smallexample
41718
41719 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41720 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41721
41722 @node Lseek Flags
41723 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41724 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41725
41726 @smallexample
41727 SEEK_SET 0
41728 SEEK_CUR 1
41729 SEEK_END 2
41730 @end smallexample
41731
41732 @node Limits
41733 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41734 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41735
41736 All values are given in decimal representation.
41737
41738 @smallexample
41739 INT_MIN -2147483648
41740 INT_MAX 2147483647
41741 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41742 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41743 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41744 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41745 @end smallexample
41746
41747 @node File-I/O Examples
41748 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41749 @cindex file-i/o examples
41750
41751 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41752 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41753
41754 @smallexample
41755 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41756 @emph{request memory read from target}
41757 -> @code{m1234,6}
41758 <- XXXXXX
41759 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41760 -> @code{F6}
41761 @end smallexample
41762
41763 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41764 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41765
41766 @smallexample
41767 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41768 @emph{request memory write to target}
41769 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41770 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41771 -> @code{F6}
41772 @end smallexample
41773
41774 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41775 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41776
41777 @smallexample
41778 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41779 -> @code{F-1,9}
41780 @end smallexample
41781
41782 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41783 host is called:
41784
41785 @smallexample
41786 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41787 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41788 <- @code{T02}
41789 @end smallexample
41790
41791 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41792 host is called:
41793
41794 @smallexample
41795 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41796 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41797 <- @code{T02}
41798 @end smallexample
41799
41800 @node Library List Format
41801 @section Library List Format
41802 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41803
41804 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41805 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41806 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41807 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41808 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41809 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41810 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41811 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41812 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41813 are loaded.
41814
41815 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41816 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41817 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41818 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41819
41820 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41821 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41822 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41823 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41824 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41825 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41826
41827 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41828 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41829
41830 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41831 offset, looks like this:
41832
41833 @smallexample
41834 <library-list>
41835 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41836 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41837 </library>
41838 </library-list>
41839 @end smallexample
41840
41841 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41842 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41843
41844 @smallexample
41845 <library-list>
41846 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41847 <section address="0x10000000"/>
41848 <section address="0x20000000"/>
41849 <section address="0x30000000"/>
41850 </library>
41851 </library-list>
41852 @end smallexample
41853
41854 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
41855
41856 @smallexample
41857 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
41858 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
41859 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41860 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
41861 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41862 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
41863 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41864 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
41865 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41866 @end smallexample
41867
41868 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
41869 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
41870 section for each library.
41871
41872 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41873 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41874 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41875
41876 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
41877 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
41878 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
41879 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
41880
41881 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
41882 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
41883 target, the following parameters are reported:
41884
41885 @itemize @minus
41886 @item
41887 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
41888 @code{struct link_map}.
41889 @item
41890 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
41891 (Thread Local Storage) access.
41892 @item
41893 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
41894 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
41895 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
41896 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
41897 @item
41898 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
41899 @end itemize
41900
41901 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
41902 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
41903 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
41904
41905 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41906 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41907
41908 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
41909 looks like this:
41910
41911 @smallexample
41912 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
41913 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
41914 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
41915 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
41916 l_ld="0x152350"/>
41917 </library-list-svr>
41918 @end smallexample
41919
41920 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
41921
41922 @smallexample
41923 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
41924 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
41925 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41926 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
41927 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
41928 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41929 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
41930 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
41931 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
41932 @end smallexample
41933
41934 @node Memory Map Format
41935 @section Memory Map Format
41936 @cindex memory map format
41937
41938 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
41939 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
41940 memory map.
41941
41942 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
41943 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
41944 lists memory regions.
41945
41946 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41947 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
41948
41949 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41950
41951 @smallexample
41952 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41953 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
41954 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41955 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
41956 <memory-map>
41957 region...
41958 </memory-map>
41959 @end smallexample
41960
41961 Each region can be either:
41962
41963 @itemize
41964
41965 @item
41966 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
41967 bytes from there:
41968
41969 @smallexample
41970 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41971 @end smallexample
41972
41973
41974 @item
41975 A region of read-only memory:
41976
41977 @smallexample
41978 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41979 @end smallexample
41980
41981
41982 @item
41983 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
41984 bytes in length:
41985
41986 @smallexample
41987 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
41988 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
41989 </memory>
41990 @end smallexample
41991
41992 @end itemize
41993
41994 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
41995 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
41996 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
41997
41998 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
41999
42000 @smallexample
42001 <!-- ................................................... -->
42002 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42003 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42004 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42005 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42006 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42007 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
42008 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42009 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
42010 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42011 and its type, or device. -->
42012 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
42013 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42014 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42015 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42016 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42017 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
42018 @end smallexample
42019
42020 @node Thread List Format
42021 @section Thread List Format
42022 @cindex thread list format
42023
42024 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42025 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42026 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42027 the following structure:
42028
42029 @smallexample
42030 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42031 <threads>
42032 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
42033 ... description ...
42034 </thread>
42035 </threads>
42036 @end smallexample
42037
42038 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42039 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42040 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42041 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
42042 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
42043 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
42044 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
42045 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
42046
42047
42048 @node Traceframe Info Format
42049 @section Traceframe Info Format
42050 @cindex traceframe info format
42051
42052 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42053 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42054 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42055 collected in a traceframe.
42056
42057 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42058 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42059
42060 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42061 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42062
42063 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42064
42065 @smallexample
42066 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42067 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42068 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42069 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42070 <traceframe-info>
42071 block...
42072 </traceframe-info>
42073 @end smallexample
42074
42075 Each traceframe block can be either:
42076
42077 @itemize
42078
42079 @item
42080 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42081 @var{length} bytes from there:
42082
42083 @smallexample
42084 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42085 @end smallexample
42086
42087 @item
42088 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42089 collected:
42090
42091 @smallexample
42092 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42093 @end smallexample
42094
42095 @end itemize
42096
42097 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42098
42099 @smallexample
42100 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42101 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42102
42103 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42104 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42105 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42106 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42107 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42108 @end smallexample
42109
42110 @node Branch Trace Format
42111 @section Branch Trace Format
42112 @cindex branch trace format
42113
42114 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42115 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42116 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42117 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42118
42119 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42120 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42121
42122 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42123 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42124
42125 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42126
42127 @smallexample
42128 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42129 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42130 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42131 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42132 <btrace>
42133 block...
42134 </btrace>
42135 @end smallexample
42136
42137 @itemize
42138
42139 @item
42140 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42141 and ending at @var{end}:
42142
42143 @smallexample
42144 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42145 @end smallexample
42146
42147 @end itemize
42148
42149 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42150
42151 @smallexample
42152 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
42153 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42154
42155 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42156 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42157 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42158
42159 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
42160
42161 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
42162
42163 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
42164 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
42165 family CDATA #REQUIRED
42166 model CDATA #REQUIRED
42167 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
42168
42169 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
42170 @end smallexample
42171
42172 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
42173 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
42174 @cindex branch trace configuration format
42175
42176 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
42177 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
42178 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
42179
42180 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
42181 settings for that format. The following information is described:
42182
42183 @table @code
42184 @item bts
42185 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
42186 @table @code
42187 @item size
42188 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
42189 @end table
42190 @item pt
42191 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
42192 PT}) format.
42193 @table @code
42194 @item size
42195 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
42196 @end table
42197 @end table
42198
42199 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42200 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42201
42202 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
42203
42204 @smallexample
42205 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42206 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42207
42208 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42209 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42210
42211 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42212 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42213 @end smallexample
42214
42215 @include agentexpr.texi
42216
42217 @node Target Descriptions
42218 @appendix Target Descriptions
42219 @cindex target descriptions
42220
42221 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42222 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42223 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42224 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42225 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42226 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42227 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42228
42229 @itemize @bullet
42230 @item
42231 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42232 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42233 @item
42234 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42235 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42236 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42237 @item
42238 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42239 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42240 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42241 @end itemize
42242
42243 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42244 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42245 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42246 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42247 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42248
42249 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42250 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42251
42252 @menu
42253 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42254 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42255 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42256 descriptions.
42257 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42258 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42259 @end menu
42260
42261 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42262 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42263
42264 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42265 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42266 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42267 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42268 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42269 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42270 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42271 Format}.
42272
42273 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42274 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42275 specify a file are:
42276
42277 @table @code
42278 @cindex set tdesc filename
42279 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42280 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42281
42282 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42283 @item unset tdesc filename
42284 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42285 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42286
42287 @cindex show tdesc filename
42288 @item show tdesc filename
42289 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42290 @end table
42291
42292
42293 @node Target Description Format
42294 @section Target Description Format
42295 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42296
42297 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42298 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42299 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42300 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42301 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42302 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42303 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42304
42305 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42306 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42307 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42308 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42309 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42310
42311 Here is a simple target description:
42312
42313 @smallexample
42314 <target version="1.0">
42315 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42316 </target>
42317 @end smallexample
42318
42319 @noindent
42320 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42321 the x86-64 architecture.
42322
42323 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42324 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42325 are explained further below.
42326
42327 @smallexample
42328 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42329 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42330 <target version="1.0">
42331 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42332 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42333 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42334 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42335 </target>
42336 @end smallexample
42337
42338 @noindent
42339 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42340 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42341 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42342 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42343 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42344 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42345 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42346 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42347 the version mismatch.
42348
42349 @subsection Inclusion
42350 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42351 @cindex XInclude
42352 @ifnotinfo
42353 @cindex <xi:include>
42354 @end ifnotinfo
42355
42356 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42357 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42358 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42359 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42360 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42361
42362 @smallexample
42363 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42364 @end smallexample
42365
42366 @noindent
42367 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42368 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42369 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42370 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42371 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42372 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42373 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42374 original description.
42375
42376 @subsection Architecture
42377 @cindex <architecture>
42378
42379 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42380
42381 @smallexample
42382 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42383 @end smallexample
42384
42385 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42386 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42387
42388 @subsection OS ABI
42389 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42390
42391 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42392 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42393
42394 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42395
42396 @smallexample
42397 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42398 @end smallexample
42399
42400 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42401 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42402
42403 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42404 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42405
42406 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42407 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42408
42409 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42410
42411 @smallexample
42412 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42413 @end smallexample
42414
42415 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42416 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42417
42418 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42419 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42420 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42421 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42422 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42423 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42424 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42425
42426 @smallexample
42427 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42428 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42429 @end smallexample
42430
42431 @subsection Features
42432 @cindex <feature>
42433
42434 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42435 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42436 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42437 has this form:
42438
42439 @smallexample
42440 <feature name="@var{name}">
42441 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42442 @var{reg}@dots{}
42443 </feature>
42444 @end smallexample
42445
42446 @noindent
42447 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42448 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42449 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42450 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42451
42452 @subsection Types
42453
42454 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42455 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42456 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42457 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42458 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42459 and enum types.
42460
42461 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42462 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42463 Types must be defined before they are used.
42464
42465 @cindex <vector>
42466 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42467 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42468 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42469 @var{count}:
42470
42471 @smallexample
42472 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42473 @end smallexample
42474
42475 @cindex <union>
42476 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42477 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42478 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42479 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42480
42481 @smallexample
42482 <union id="@var{id}">
42483 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42484 @dots{}
42485 </union>
42486 @end smallexample
42487
42488 @cindex <struct>
42489 @cindex <flags>
42490 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42491 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42492 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42493 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42494 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42495 specified.
42496
42497 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42498
42499 @smallexample
42500 <struct id="@var{id}">
42501 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42502 @dots{}
42503 </struct>
42504 @end smallexample
42505
42506 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42507 No implicit padding is added.
42508
42509 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42510
42511 @smallexample
42512 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42513 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42514 @dots{}
42515 </struct>
42516 @end smallexample
42517
42518 @smallexample
42519 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42520 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42521 @dots{}
42522 </flags>
42523 @end smallexample
42524
42525 The @var{name} value is required.
42526 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42527 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42528 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42529
42530 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42531 is optional.
42532 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42533 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42534
42535 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42536 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42537
42538 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42539
42540 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42541 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42542
42543 @itemize @bullet
42544 @item
42545 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42546 @item
42547 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42548 @end itemize
42549
42550 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42551 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42552
42553 @itemize @bullet
42554 @item
42555 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42556
42557 @smallexample
42558 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42559 $1 = 42
42560 @end smallexample
42561
42562 @end itemize
42563
42564 @subsection Registers
42565 @cindex <reg>
42566
42567 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42568
42569 @smallexample
42570 <reg name="@var{name}"
42571 bitsize="@var{size}"
42572 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42573 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42574 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42575 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42576 @end smallexample
42577
42578 @noindent
42579 The components are as follows:
42580
42581 @table @var
42582
42583 @item name
42584 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42585
42586 @item bitsize
42587 The register's size, in bits.
42588
42589 @item regnum
42590 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42591 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42592 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42593 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42594 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42595 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42596 in order of increasing register number.
42597
42598 @item save-restore
42599 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42600 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42601 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42602 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42603 ABI.
42604
42605 @item type
42606 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42607 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42608 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42609 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42610 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42611 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42612
42613 @item group
42614 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42615 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42616 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42617 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42618 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42619 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42620 @code{info registers}.
42621
42622 @end table
42623
42624 @node Predefined Target Types
42625 @section Predefined Target Types
42626 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42627
42628 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42629 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42630 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42631 types. The currently supported types are:
42632
42633 @table @code
42634
42635 @item bool
42636 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42637
42638 @item int8
42639 @itemx int16
42640 @itemx int24
42641 @itemx int32
42642 @itemx int64
42643 @itemx int128
42644 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42645
42646 @item uint8
42647 @itemx uint16
42648 @itemx uint24
42649 @itemx uint32
42650 @itemx uint64
42651 @itemx uint128
42652 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42653
42654 @item code_ptr
42655 @itemx data_ptr
42656 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42657 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42658 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42659 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42660 may be marked as data pointers.
42661
42662 @item ieee_single
42663 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42664
42665 @item ieee_double
42666 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42667
42668 @item arm_fpa_ext
42669 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42670
42671 @item i387_ext
42672 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42673
42674 @item i386_eflags
42675 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42676
42677 @item i386_mxcsr
42678 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42679
42680 @end table
42681
42682 @node Enum Target Types
42683 @section Enum Target Types
42684 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42685
42686 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42687 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42688
42689 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42690
42691 @smallexample
42692 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42693 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42694 @dots{}
42695 </enum>
42696 @end smallexample
42697
42698 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42699
42700 @smallexample
42701 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42702 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42703 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42704 </enum>
42705 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42706 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42707 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42708 </flags>
42709 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42710 @end smallexample
42711
42712 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42713 would be printed as:
42714
42715 @smallexample
42716 (gdb) info register flags
42717 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42718 @end smallexample
42719
42720 @node Standard Target Features
42721 @section Standard Target Features
42722 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42723
42724 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42725 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42726 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42727 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42728 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42729 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42730 can recognize them.
42731
42732 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42733 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42734 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42735 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42736 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42737 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42738 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42739 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42740
42741 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42742 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42743 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42744
42745 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42746 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42747 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42748 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42749
42750 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42751 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42752 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42753
42754 @menu
42755 * AArch64 Features::
42756 * ARC Features::
42757 * ARM Features::
42758 * i386 Features::
42759 * MicroBlaze Features::
42760 * MIPS Features::
42761 * M68K Features::
42762 * NDS32 Features::
42763 * Nios II Features::
42764 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42765 * PowerPC Features::
42766 * S/390 and System z Features::
42767 * Sparc Features::
42768 * TIC6x Features::
42769 @end menu
42770
42771
42772 @node AArch64 Features
42773 @subsection AArch64 Features
42774 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42775
42776 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42777 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42778 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42779
42780 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42781 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42782 and @samp{fpcr}.
42783
42784 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
42785 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
42786 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
42787
42788 @node ARC Features
42789 @subsection ARC Features
42790 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42791
42792 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42793 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42794 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42795 that one of the core registers features is present.
42796 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42797
42798 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42799 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42800 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42801 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42802 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42803 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42804 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42805
42806 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42807 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42808 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42809 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42810 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42811 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42812
42813 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42814 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42815 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42816 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42817 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42818 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42819 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42820 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42821 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42822 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42823
42824 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42825 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42826
42827 @node ARM Features
42828 @subsection ARM Features
42829 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42830
42831 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42832 ARM targets.
42833 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42834 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42835
42836 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42837 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42838 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42839 and @samp{xpsr}.
42840
42841 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42842 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42843
42844 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42845 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42846 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42847 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
42848
42849 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
42850 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
42851 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
42852 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
42853 halves of the double-precision registers.
42854
42855 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
42856 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
42857 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
42858 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
42859 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
42860 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
42861
42862 @node i386 Features
42863 @subsection i386 Features
42864 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
42865
42866 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
42867 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42868
42869 @itemize @minus
42870 @item
42871 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
42872 @item
42873 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
42874 @item
42875 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
42876 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
42877 @item
42878 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
42879 @item
42880 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
42881 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
42882 @end itemize
42883
42884 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
42885
42886 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
42887 describe registers:
42888
42889 @itemize @minus
42890 @item
42891 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
42892 @item
42893 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
42894 @item
42895 @samp{mxcsr}
42896 @end itemize
42897
42898 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
42899 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
42900 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
42901
42902 @itemize @minus
42903 @item
42904 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
42905 @item
42906 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
42907 @end itemize
42908
42909 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
42910 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
42911
42912 @itemize @minus
42913 @item
42914 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
42915 @item
42916 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
42917 @end itemize
42918
42919 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
42920 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
42921
42922 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
42923 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
42924
42925 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
42926 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
42927 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
42928
42929 @itemize @minus
42930 @item
42931 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42932 @end itemize
42933
42934 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
42935
42936 @itemize @minus
42937 @item
42938 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42939 @end itemize
42940
42941 It should
42942 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
42943
42944 @itemize @minus
42945 @item
42946 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
42947 @item
42948 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
42949 @end itemize
42950
42951 It should
42952 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
42953
42954 @itemize @minus
42955 @item
42956 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42957 @end itemize
42958
42959 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
42960 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
42961 valid for i386 and amd64.
42962
42963 @node MicroBlaze Features
42964 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
42965 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
42966
42967 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
42968 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42969 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
42970 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
42971 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
42972
42973 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
42974 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
42975
42976 @node MIPS Features
42977 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
42978 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
42979
42980 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
42981 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
42982 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
42983 on the target.
42984
42985 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
42986 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
42987 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42988
42989 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
42990 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
42991 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
42992 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42993
42994 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
42995 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
42996 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
42997 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42998
42999 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43000 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43001 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43002
43003 @node M68K Features
43004 @subsection M68K Features
43005 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43006
43007 @table @code
43008 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43009 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43010 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43011 One of those features must be always present.
43012 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43013 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43014 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43015 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43016
43017 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43018 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43019 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43020 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43021 @end table
43022
43023 @node NDS32 Features
43024 @subsection NDS32 Features
43025 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
43026
43027 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
43028 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
43029 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
43030 and @samp{pc}.
43031
43032 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43033 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
43034 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
43035 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
43036
43037 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
43038 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
43039 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
43040 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
43041 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
43042 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
43043 support to it could be totally removed some day.
43044
43045 @node Nios II Features
43046 @subsection Nios II Features
43047 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43048
43049 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43050 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43051 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43052 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43053 @samp{mpuacc}).
43054
43055 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
43056 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
43057 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
43058
43059 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
43060 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
43061 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
43062
43063 @node PowerPC Features
43064 @subsection PowerPC Features
43065 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43066
43067 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43068 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43069 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43070 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43071
43072 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43073 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43074
43075 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43076 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
43077 and @samp{vrsave}.
43078
43079 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43080 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43081 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
43082 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
43083 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
43084 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
43085
43086 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43087 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43088 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43089 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43090 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43091 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43092 user.
43093
43094 @node S/390 and System z Features
43095 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43096 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43097 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43098
43099 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43100 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43101 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43102 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43103 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43104 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43105 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43106 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43107 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43108
43109 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43110 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43111 @samp{fpc}.
43112
43113 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43114 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43115
43116 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43117 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43118 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43119 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43120 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43121 32-bit wide.
43122
43123 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43124 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43125 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43126
43127 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
43128 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
43129 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
43130 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
43131 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
43132 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
43133 @samp{v31}.
43134
43135 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
43136 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
43137 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
43138
43139 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
43140 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
43141 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
43142
43143 @node Sparc Features
43144 @subsection Sparc Features
43145 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
43146 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
43147 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43148 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43149
43150 @itemize @minus
43151 @item
43152 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
43153 @item
43154 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
43155 @item
43156 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
43157 @item
43158 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
43159 @end itemize
43160
43161 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43162
43163 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43164 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43165
43166 @itemize @minus
43167 @item
43168 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
43169 @item
43170 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
43171 @end itemize
43172
43173 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43174 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43175
43176 @itemize @minus
43177 @item
43178 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
43179 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
43180 @item
43181 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
43182 for sparc64
43183 @end itemize
43184
43185 @node TIC6x Features
43186 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43187 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43188 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43189 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43190 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43191 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43192
43193 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43194 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43195 through @samp{B31}.
43196
43197 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43198 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43199
43200 @node Operating System Information
43201 @appendix Operating System Information
43202 @cindex operating system information
43203
43204 @menu
43205 * Process list::
43206 @end menu
43207
43208 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43209 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43210 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43211 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43212 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43213 on a different aspect of target.
43214
43215 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43216 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43217 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43218 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43219
43220 @node Process list
43221 @appendixsection Process list
43222 @cindex operating system information, process list
43223
43224 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43225 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43226 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43227 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43228
43229 An example document is:
43230
43231 @smallexample
43232 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43233 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43234 <osdata type="processes">
43235 <item>
43236 <column name="pid">1</column>
43237 <column name="user">root</column>
43238 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43239 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43240 </item>
43241 </osdata>
43242 @end smallexample
43243
43244 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43245 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43246 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43247 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43248 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43249 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43250 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43251
43252 @node Trace File Format
43253 @appendix Trace File Format
43254 @cindex trace file format
43255
43256 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43257 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43258
43259 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43260 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43261 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43262 in the future.
43263
43264 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43265 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43266 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43267 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43268 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43269 of this section.
43270
43271 @table @code
43272 @item R @var{size}
43273 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43274 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43275 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43276 a single trace file.
43277
43278 @item status @var{status}
43279 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43280 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43281 file.
43282
43283 @item tp @var{payload}
43284 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43285 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43286 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43287 reply packets.
43288
43289 @item tsv @var{payload}
43290 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43291 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43292 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43293 reply packets.
43294
43295 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43296 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43297 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43298 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43299 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43300 file. Includes are not allowed.
43301
43302 @end table
43303
43304 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43305 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43306 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43307 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43308 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43309 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43310 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43311 endianness.
43312
43313 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43314
43315 @table @code
43316 @item R @var{bytes}
43317 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43318 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43319 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43320
43321 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43322 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43323 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43324 @var{length} bytes.
43325
43326 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43327 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43328 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43329
43330 @end table
43331
43332 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43333 of blocks.
43334
43335 @node Index Section Format
43336 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43337 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43338 @cindex index section format
43339
43340 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43341 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43342 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43343 description.
43344
43345 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43346 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43347 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43348 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43349 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43350 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43351
43352 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43353
43354 @enumerate
43355 @item
43356 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43357 unless otherwise noted:
43358
43359 @enumerate
43360 @item
43361 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43362 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43363 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43364 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43365 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43366 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43367 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43368
43369 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43370 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43371 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43372 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43373
43374 @item
43375 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43376
43377 @item
43378 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43379 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43380 to the next offset.
43381
43382 @item
43383 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43384
43385 @item
43386 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43387
43388 @item
43389 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43390 @end enumerate
43391
43392 @item
43393 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43394 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43395 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43396 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43397 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43398 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43399 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43400 CU indices.
43401
43402 @item
43403 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43404 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43405 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43406 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43407
43408 @item
43409 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43410 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43411
43412 @enumerate
43413 @item
43414 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43415
43416 @item
43417 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43418 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43419
43420 @item
43421 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43422 @end enumerate
43423
43424 @item
43425 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43426 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43427
43428 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43429 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43430 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43431 constant pool.
43432
43433 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43434 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43435 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43436
43437 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43438 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43439 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43440 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43441 index version:
43442
43443 @table @asis
43444 @item Version 4
43445 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43446
43447 @item Versions 5 to 7
43448 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43449 @end table
43450
43451 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43452
43453 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43454 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43455 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43456 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43457 collision.
43458
43459 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43460 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43461 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43462 the code.
43463
43464 @item
43465 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43466 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43467 strings.
43468
43469 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43470 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43471 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43472 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43473 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43474 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43475
43476 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43477 @end enumerate
43478
43479 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43480 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43481 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43482
43483 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43484 (bit 0 = LSB):
43485
43486 @table @asis
43487
43488 @item Bits 0-23
43489 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43490 @item Bits 24-27
43491 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43492 @item Bits 28-30
43493 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43494
43495 @table @asis
43496 @item 0
43497 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43498 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43499 with previous versions of the index.
43500 @item 1
43501 The symbol is a type.
43502 @item 2
43503 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43504 @item 3
43505 The symbol is a function.
43506 @item 4
43507 Any other kind of symbol.
43508 @item 5,6,7
43509 These values are reserved.
43510 @end table
43511
43512 @item Bit 31
43513 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43514
43515 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43516 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43517 @value{GDBN} sources.
43518
43519 @end table
43520
43521 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43522 global/static attributes in the index.
43523
43524 @smallexample
43525 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43526 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43527 switch (die->tag)
43528 @{
43529 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43530 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43531 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43532 kind = TYPE;
43533 is_static = 1;
43534 break;
43535 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43536 kind = VARIABLE;
43537 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43538 break;
43539 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43540 kind = FUNCTION;
43541 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43542 break;
43543 case DW_TAG_constant:
43544 kind = VARIABLE;
43545 is_static = ! is_external;
43546 break;
43547 case DW_TAG_variable:
43548 kind = VARIABLE;
43549 is_static = ! is_external;
43550 break;
43551 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43552 kind = TYPE;
43553 is_static = 0;
43554 break;
43555 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43556 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43557 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43558 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43559 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43560 kind = TYPE;
43561 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43562 break;
43563 default:
43564 assert (0);
43565 @}
43566 @end smallexample
43567
43568 @node Man Pages
43569 @appendix Manual pages
43570 @cindex Man pages
43571
43572 @menu
43573 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43574 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43575 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43576 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43577 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
43578 @end menu
43579
43580 @node gdb man
43581 @heading gdb man
43582
43583 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43584
43585 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43586 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43587 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43588 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43589 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43590 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43591 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43592 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43593 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43594 @c man end
43595
43596 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43597 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43598 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43599 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43600
43601 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43602 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43603
43604 @itemize @bullet
43605 @item
43606 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43607
43608 @item
43609 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43610
43611 @item
43612 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43613
43614 @item
43615 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43616 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43617 @end itemize
43618
43619 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43620 Modula-2.
43621
43622 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43623 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43624 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43625 by using the command @code{help}.
43626
43627 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43628 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43629 executable program as the argument:
43630
43631 @smallexample
43632 gdb program
43633 @end smallexample
43634
43635 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43636
43637 @smallexample
43638 gdb program core
43639 @end smallexample
43640
43641 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43642 to debug a running process:
43643
43644 @smallexample
43645 gdb program 1234
43646 gdb -p 1234
43647 @end smallexample
43648
43649 @noindent
43650 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43651 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43652 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43653
43654 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43655
43656 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43657 @table @env
43658 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43659 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43660
43661 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43662 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43663
43664 @item bt
43665 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43666
43667 @item print @var{expr}
43668 Display the value of an expression.
43669
43670 @item c
43671 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43672
43673 @item next
43674 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43675 function calls in the line.
43676
43677 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43678 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43679
43680 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43681 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43682
43683 @item step
43684 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43685 function calls in the line.
43686
43687 @item help [@var{name}]
43688 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43689 about using @value{GDBN}.
43690
43691 @item quit
43692 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43693 @end table
43694
43695 @ifset man
43696 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43697 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43698 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43699 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43700 @end ifset
43701 @c man end
43702
43703 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43704 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43705 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43706 encountered with no
43707 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43708 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43709 Many options have
43710 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43711 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43712 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43713 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43714 more usual convention.)
43715
43716 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43717 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43718 option is used.
43719
43720 @table @env
43721 @item -help
43722 @itemx -h
43723 List all options, with brief explanations.
43724
43725 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43726 @itemx -s @var{file}
43727 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43728
43729 @item -write
43730 Enable writing into executable and core files.
43731
43732 @item -exec=@var{file}
43733 @itemx -e @var{file}
43734 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
43735 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
43736 dump.
43737
43738 @item -se=@var{file}
43739 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
43740 file.
43741
43742 @item -core=@var{file}
43743 @itemx -c @var{file}
43744 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
43745
43746 @item -command=@var{file}
43747 @itemx -x @var{file}
43748 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
43749
43750 @item -ex @var{command}
43751 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
43752
43753 @item -directory=@var{directory}
43754 @itemx -d @var{directory}
43755 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
43756
43757 @item -nh
43758 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43759
43760 @item -nx
43761 @itemx -n
43762 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43763
43764 @item -quiet
43765 @itemx -q
43766 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43767 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43768
43769 @item -batch
43770 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43771 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43772 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43773 commands in the command files.
43774
43775 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43776 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43777 more useful, the message
43778
43779 @smallexample
43780 Program exited normally.
43781 @end smallexample
43782
43783 @noindent
43784 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43785 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43786
43787 @item -cd=@var{directory}
43788 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
43789 instead of the current directory.
43790
43791 @item -fullname
43792 @itemx -f
43793 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
43794 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
43795 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
43796 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
43797 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
43798 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
43799 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
43800 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
43801
43802 @item -b @var{bps}
43803 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
43804 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
43805
43806 @item -tty=@var{device}
43807 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
43808 @end table
43809 @c man end
43810
43811 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
43812 @ifset man
43813 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43814 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43815 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43816
43817 @smallexample
43818 info gdb
43819 @end smallexample
43820
43821 @noindent
43822 should give you access to the complete manual.
43823
43824 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43825 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43826 @end ifset
43827 @c man end
43828
43829 @node gdbserver man
43830 @heading gdbserver man
43831
43832 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
43833 @format
43834 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
43835 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43836
43837 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43838
43839 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43840 @c man end
43841 @end format
43842
43843 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
43844 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
43845 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
43846
43847 @ifclear man
43848 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
43849 @end ifclear
43850 @ifset man
43851 Usage (server (target) side):
43852 @end ifset
43853
43854 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
43855 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
43856 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
43857 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
43858
43859 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
43860 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
43861 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
43862
43863 @smallexample
43864 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
43865 @end smallexample
43866
43867 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
43868
43869 @smallexample
43870 @ifset man
43871 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
43872 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
43873 @end ifset
43874 @ifclear man
43875 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
43876 @end ifclear
43877 @end smallexample
43878
43879 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
43880 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
43881 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
43882
43883 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
43884
43885 @smallexample
43886 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
43887 @end smallexample
43888
43889 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
43890 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
43891 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
43892 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
43893 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
43894 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
43895 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
43896 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
43897 print an error message and exit.
43898
43899 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
43900 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
43901
43902 @smallexample
43903 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43904 @end smallexample
43905
43906 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43907 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43908
43909 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43910 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
43911 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
43912 the program you want to debug.
43913
43914 @smallexample
43915 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43916 @end smallexample
43917
43918 @ifclear man
43919 @subheading Usage (host side)
43920 @end ifclear
43921 @ifset man
43922 Usage (host side):
43923 @end ifset
43924
43925 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
43926 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
43927 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
43928 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
43929 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
43930 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
43931 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
43932 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
43933 descriptor. For example:
43934
43935 @smallexample
43936 @ifset man
43937 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
43938 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
43939 @end ifset
43940 @ifclear man
43941 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
43942 @end ifclear
43943 @end smallexample
43944
43945 @noindent
43946 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
43947
43948 @smallexample
43949 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
43950 @end smallexample
43951
43952 @noindent
43953 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
43954 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
43955 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
43956 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
43957 `Connection refused'.
43958
43959 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
43960 described in
43961 @ifset man
43962 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
43963 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
43964 @end ifset
43965 @ifclear man
43966 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
43967 @end ifclear
43968 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
43969
43970 @smallexample
43971 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
43972 @end smallexample
43973
43974 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
43975 case.
43976 @c man end
43977
43978 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
43979 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
43980
43981 @itemize @bullet
43982
43983 @item
43984 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
43985
43986 @smallexample
43987 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43988 @end smallexample
43989
43990 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
43991 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
43992 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
43993 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
43994 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
43995 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
43996 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43997
43998 @item
43999 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44000 program:
44001
44002 @smallexample
44003 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44004 @end smallexample
44005
44006 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44007 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44008 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44009 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44010
44011 @item
44012 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44013
44014 @smallexample
44015 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44016 @end smallexample
44017
44018 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44019 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44020 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44021 debug several processes in the same session.
44022 @end itemize
44023
44024 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44025
44026 @table @env
44027
44028 @item --help
44029 List all options, with brief explanations.
44030
44031 @item --version
44032 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44033
44034 @item --attach
44035 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44036
44037 @smallexample
44038 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44039 @end smallexample
44040
44041 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44042 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44043
44044 @item --multi
44045 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44046 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44047 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44048 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44049
44050 @smallexample
44051 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44052 @end smallexample
44053
44054 @item --debug
44055 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44056 process.
44057 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44058 the developers.
44059
44060 @item --remote-debug
44061 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44062 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44063 the developers.
44064
44065 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
44066 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
44067 of debugging output.
44068 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
44069
44070 @item --wrapper
44071 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44072 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44073 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44074 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44075
44076 @item --once
44077 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44078 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44079 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44080 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44081
44082 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44083
44084 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44085 @c QDisableRandomization.
44086
44087 @end table
44088 @c man end
44089
44090 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44091 @ifset man
44092 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44093 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44094 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44095
44096 @smallexample
44097 info gdb
44098 @end smallexample
44099
44100 should give you access to the complete manual.
44101
44102 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44103 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44104 @end ifset
44105 @c man end
44106
44107 @node gcore man
44108 @heading gcore
44109
44110 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44111
44112 @format
44113 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44114 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
44115 @c man end
44116 @end format
44117
44118 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44119 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
44120 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
44121 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
44122 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
44123 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
44124 its job the program remains running without any change.
44125 @c man end
44126
44127 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44128 @table @env
44129 @item -a
44130 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
44131 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
44132 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
44133 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
44134 dump-excluded-mappings}).
44135
44136 @item -o @var{prefix}
44137 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
44138 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
44139 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
44140 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
44141 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
44142 @end table
44143 @c man end
44144
44145 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44146 @ifset man
44147 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44148 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44149 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44150
44151 @smallexample
44152 info gdb
44153 @end smallexample
44154
44155 @noindent
44156 should give you access to the complete manual.
44157
44158 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44159 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44160 @end ifset
44161 @c man end
44162
44163 @node gdbinit man
44164 @heading gdbinit
44165
44166 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44167
44168 @format
44169 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44170 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44171 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44172 @end ifset
44173
44174 ~/.gdbinit
44175
44176 ./.gdbinit
44177 @c man end
44178 @end format
44179
44180 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44181 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44182 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44183 described in
44184 @ifset man
44185 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44186 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44187 @end ifset
44188 @ifclear man
44189 @ref{Sequences}.
44190 @end ifclear
44191
44192 Please read more in
44193 @ifset man
44194 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44195 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44196 @end ifset
44197 @ifclear man
44198 @ref{Startup}.
44199 @end ifclear
44200
44201 @table @env
44202 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44203 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44204 @end ifset
44205 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44206 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44207 @end ifclear
44208 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44209 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44210 See more in
44211 @ifset man
44212 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44213 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44214 @end ifset
44215 @ifclear man
44216 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44217 @end ifclear
44218
44219 @item ~/.gdbinit
44220 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44221 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44222
44223 @item ./.gdbinit
44224 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44225 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44226 See more in
44227 @ifset man
44228 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44229 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44230 @end ifset
44231 @ifclear man
44232 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44233 @end ifclear
44234 @end table
44235 @c man end
44236
44237 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44238 @ifset man
44239 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44240
44241 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44242 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44243 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44244
44245 @smallexample
44246 info gdb
44247 @end smallexample
44248
44249 should give you access to the complete manual.
44250
44251 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44252 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44253 @end ifset
44254 @c man end
44255
44256 @node gdb-add-index man
44257 @heading gdb-add-index
44258 @pindex gdb-add-index
44259 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44260
44261 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44262
44263 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44264 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44265 @c man end
44266
44267 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44268 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44269 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44270 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44271 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44272 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44273
44274 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44275 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44276 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44277 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44278 named @code{.debug_*}).
44279
44280 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44281 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44282 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44283 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44284
44285 See more in
44286 @ifset man
44287 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44288 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44289 @end ifset
44290 @ifclear man
44291 @ref{Index Files}.
44292 @end ifclear
44293 @c man end
44294
44295 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44296 @ifset man
44297 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44298 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44299 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44300
44301 @smallexample
44302 info gdb
44303 @end smallexample
44304
44305 should give you access to the complete manual.
44306
44307 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44308 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44309 @end ifset
44310 @c man end
44311
44312 @include gpl.texi
44313
44314 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44315 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44316 @include fdl.texi
44317
44318 @node Concept Index
44319 @unnumbered Concept Index
44320
44321 @printindex cp
44322
44323 @node Command and Variable Index
44324 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44325
44326 @printindex fn
44327
44328 @tex
44329 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44330 % meantime:
44331 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44332 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44333 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44334 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44335 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44336 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44337 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44338 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44339 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44340 \page\colophon
44341 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44342 @end tex
44343
44344 @bye
This page took 0.913884 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.